zshall man page on YellowDog

Man page or keyword search:  
man Server   18644 pages
apropos Keyword Search (all sections)
Output format
YellowDog logo
[printable version]

ZSHALL(1)							     ZSHALL(1)

NAME
       zshall - the Z shell meta-man page

OVERVIEW
       Because	zsh contains many features, the zsh manual has been split into
       a number of sections.  This manual page includes all the separate  man‐
       ual pages in the following order:

       zshmisc	    Anything not fitting into the other sections
       zshexpn	    Zsh command and parameter expansion
       zshparam	    Zsh parameters
       zshoptions   Zsh options
       zshbuiltins  Zsh built-in functions
       zshzle	    Zsh command line editing
       zshcompwid   Zsh completion widgets
       zshcompsys   Zsh completion system
       zshcompctl   Zsh completion control
       zshmodules   Zsh loadable modules
       zshzftpsys   Zsh built-in FTP client

DESCRIPTION
       Zsh  is	a  UNIX	 command  interpreter (shell) usable as an interactive
       login shell and as a shell script command processor.  Of	 the  standard
       shells,	zsh most closely resembles ksh but includes many enhancements.
       Zsh has command line editing, builtin spelling correction, programmable
       command completion, shell functions (with autoloading), a history mech‐
       anism, and a host of other features.

AUTHOR
       Zsh was originally written by Paul Falstad <pf@zsh.org>.	  Zsh  is  now
       maintained  by  the  members of the zsh-workers mailing list <zsh-work‐
       ers@sunsite.dk>.	 The development is  currently	coordinated  by	 Peter
       Stephenson <pws@zsh.org>.  The coordinator can be contacted at <coordi‐
       nator@zsh.org>, but matters relating to the code should generally go to
       the mailing list.

AVAILABILITY
       Zsh  is available from the following anonymous FTP sites.  These mirror
       sites are kept frequently up to date.  The sites marked with (H) may be
       mirroring ftp.cs.elte.hu instead of the primary site.

       Primary site
	      ftp://ftp.zsh.org/pub/zsh/
	      http://www.zsh.org/pub/zsh/

       Australia
	      ftp://ftp.zsh.org/pub/zsh/
	      http://www.zsh.org/pub/zsh/

       Denmark
	      ftp://sunsite.dk/pub/unix/shells/zsh/

       Finland
	      ftp://ftp.funet.fi/pub/unix/shells/zsh/

       Germany
	      ftp://ftp.fu-berlin.de/pub/unix/shells/zsh/  (H)
	      ftp://ftp.gmd.de/packages/zsh/
	      ftp://ftp.uni-trier.de/pub/unix/shell/zsh/

       Hungary
	      ftp://ftp.cs.elte.hu/pub/zsh/
	      http://www.cs.elte.hu/pub/zsh/
	      ftp://ftp.kfki.hu/pub/packages/zsh/

       Israel
	      ftp://ftp.math.technion.ac.il/pub/zsh/
	      http://www.math.technion.ac.il/pub/zsh/

       Japan
	      ftp://ftp.win.ne.jp/pub/shell/zsh/
	      ftp://ftp.ayamura.org/pub/zsh/

       Korea
	      ftp://linux.sarang.net/mirror/system/shell/zsh/

       Netherlands
	      ftp://ftp.demon.nl/pub/mirrors/zsh/

       Norway
	      ftp://ftp.uit.no/pub/unix/shells/zsh/

       Poland
	      ftp://sunsite.icm.edu.pl/pub/unix/shells/zsh/

       Romania
	      ftp://ftp.roedu.net/pub/mirrors/ftp.zsh.org/pub/zsh/
	      ftp://ftp.kappa.ro/pub/mirrors/ftp.zsh.org/pub/zsh/

       Slovenia
	      ftp://ftp.siol.net/mirrors/zsh/

       Sweden
	      ftp://ftp.lysator.liu.se/pub/unix/zsh/

       UK
	      ftp://ftp.net.lut.ac.uk/zsh/
	      ftp://sunsite.org.uk/packages/zsh/

       USA
	      ftp://uiarchive.uiuc.edu/mirrors/ftp/ftp.zsh.org/pub/
	      ftp://ftp.rge.com/pub/shells/zsh/
	      http://zsh.disillusion.org/
	      http://foad.org/zsh/

       The  up-to-date source code is available via anonymous CVS from Source‐
       forge.  See http://sourceforge.net/projects/zsh/ for details.

MAILING LISTS
       Zsh has 3 mailing lists:

       <zsh-announce@sunsite.dk>
	      Announcements about releases, major changes in the shell and the
	      monthly posting of the Zsh FAQ.  (moderated)

       <zsh-users@sunsite.dk>
	      User discussions.

       <zsh-workers@sunsite.dk>
	      Hacking, development, bug reports and patches.

       To subscribe or unsubscribe, send mail to the associated administrative
       address for the mailing list.

       <zsh-announce-subscribe@sunsite.dk>
       <zsh-users-subscribe@sunsite.dk>
       <zsh-workers-subscribe@sunsite.dk>
       <zsh-announce-unsubscribe@sunsite.dk>
       <zsh-users-unsubscribe@sunsite.dk>
       <zsh-workers-unsubscribe@sunsite.dk>

       YOU ONLY NEED TO JOIN ONE OF THE MAILING LISTS AS THEY ARE NESTED.  All
       submissions  to	zsh-announce are automatically forwarded to zsh-users.
       All submissions to zsh-users are automatically forwarded	 to  zsh-work‐
       ers.

       If  you	have  problems subscribing/unsubscribing to any of the mailing
       lists, send mail to <listmaster@zsh.org>.  The mailing lists are	 main‐
       tained by Karsten Thygesen <karthy@kom.auc.dk>.

       The  mailing  lists  are archived; the archives can be accessed via the
       administrative addresses listed above.  There is also a	hypertext  ar‐
       chive,	maintained   by	  Geoff	  Wing	 <gcw@zsh.org>,	 available  at
       http://www.zsh.org/mla/.

THE ZSH FAQ
       Zsh has a list of Frequently Asked Questions (FAQ), maintained by Peter
       Stephenson  <pws@zsh.org>.   It	is  regularly  posted to the newsgroup
       comp.unix.shell and the zsh-announce mailing list.  The latest  version
       can    be    found   at	 any   of   the	  Zsh	FTP   sites,   or   at
       http://www.zsh.org/FAQ/.	 The contact address for  FAQ-related  matters
       is <faqmaster@zsh.org>.

THE ZSH WEB PAGE
       Zsh  has	 a  web page which is located at http://www.zsh.org/.  This is
       maintained by Karsten Thygesen <karthy@zsh.org>,	 of  SunSITE  Denmark.
       The contact address for web-related matters is <webmaster@zsh.org>.

THE ZSH USERGUIDE
       A  userguide is currently in preparation.  It is intended to complement
       the manual, with explanations and hints on issues where the manual  can
       be cabbalistic, hierographic, or downright mystifying (for example, the
       word `hierographic' does not exist).  It can be viewed in  its  current
       state  at  http://zsh.sunsite.dk/Guide/.	 At the time of writing, chap‐
       ters dealing with startup files and their contents and the new  comple‐
       tion system were essentially complete.

THE ZSH WIKI
       A  `wiki'  website for zsh has been created at http://www.zshwiki.org/.
       This is a site which can be added to and	 modified  directly  by	 users
       without any special permission.	You can add your own zsh tips and con‐
       figurations.

INVOCATION OPTIONS
       The following flags are interpreted by the shell when invoked to deter‐
       mine where the shell will read commands from:

       -c     Take  the	 first	argument  as a command to execute, rather than
	      reading commands from a script or standard input.	 If  any  fur‐
	      ther  arguments  are  given,  the	 first	one is assigned to $0,
	      rather than being used as a positional parameter.

       -i     Force shell to be interactive.

       -s     Force shell to read commands from the standard input.  If the -s
	      flag is not present and an argument is given, the first argument
	      is taken to be the pathname of a script to execute.

       After the  first	 one  or  two  arguments  have	been  appropriated  as
       described above, the remaining arguments are assigned to the positional
       parameters.

       For further options,  which  are	 common	 to  invocation	 and  the  set
       builtin, see zshoptions(1).

       Options	may  be specified by name using the -o option.	-o acts like a
       single-letter option, but takes a following string as the option	 name.
       For example,

	      zsh -x -o shwordsplit scr

       runs  the  script  scr,	setting the XTRACE option by the corresponding
       letter `-x' and the SH_WORD_SPLIT  option  by  name.   Options  may  be
       turned  off  by	name  by using +o instead of -o.  -o can be stacked up
       with preceding single-letter options, so for example `-xo  shwordsplit'
       or `-xoshwordsplit' is equivalent to `-x -o shwordsplit'.

       Options	may  also  be  specified  by  name  in	GNU long option style,
       `--option-name'.	 When this is done, `-' characters in the option  name
       are permitted: they are translated into `_', and thus ignored.  So, for
       example, `zsh  --sh-word-split'	invokes	 zsh  with  the	 SH_WORD_SPLIT
       option  turned  on.   Like other option syntaxes, options can be turned
       off by replacing the initial `-' with a `+'; thus `+-sh-word-split'  is
       equivalent  to  `--no-sh-word-split'.   Unlike  other  option syntaxes,
       GNU-style long options cannot be stacked with any other options, so for
       example	`-x-shwordsplit'  is  an error, rather than being treated like
       `-x --shwordsplit'.

       The special GNU-style option `--version' is handled; it sends to	 stan‐
       dard  output  the shell's version information, then exits successfully.
       `--help' is also handled; it sends to standard output a list of options
       that can be used when invoking the shell, then exits successfully.

       Option  processing  may	be finished, allowing following arguments that
       start with `-' or `+' to be treated as normal arguments, in  two	 ways.
       Firstly,	 a lone `-' (or `+') as an argument by itself ends option pro‐
       cessing.	 Secondly, a special option `--' (or `+-'), which may be spec‐
       ified  on its own (which is the standard POSIX usage) or may be stacked
       with preceding options (so `-x-' is equivalent to  `-x  --').   Options
       are not permitted to be stacked after `--' (so `-x-f' is an error), but
       note the GNU-style option form discussed above,	where  `--shwordsplit'
       is permitted and does not end option processing.

       Except  when  the sh/ksh emulation single-letter options are in effect,
       the option `-b' (or `+b') ends option processing.  `-b' is  like	 `--',
       except that further single-letter options can be stacked after the `-b'
       and will take effect as normal.

COMPATIBILITY
       Zsh tries to emulate sh or ksh when it is invoked as sh or ksh  respec‐
       tively;	more  precisely,  it  looks at the first letter of the name by
       which it was invoked, excluding any initial `r' (assumed to  stand  for
       `restricted'),  and  if	that  is `s' or `k' it will emulate sh or ksh.
       Furthermore, if invoked as su (which happens on	certain	 systems  when
       the shell is executed by the su command), the shell will try to find an
       alternative name from the SHELL environment variable and perform emula‐
       tion based on that.

       In sh and ksh compatibility modes the following parameters are not spe‐
       cial and not initialized by the shell:  ARGC,  argv,  cdpath,  fignore,
       fpath,  HISTCHARS,  mailpath,  MANPATH,	manpath, path, prompt, PROMPT,
       PROMPT2, PROMPT3, PROMPT4, psvar, status, watch.

       The usual zsh startup/shutdown scripts are not executed.	 Login	shells
       source /etc/profile followed by $HOME/.profile.	If the ENV environment
       variable is set on  invocation,	$ENV  is  sourced  after  the  profile
       scripts.	 The value of ENV is subjected to parameter expansion, command
       substitution, and arithmetic expansion before being  interpreted	 as  a
       pathname.   Note	 that the PRIVILEGED option also affects the execution
       of startup files.

       The following options are set if the shell is invoked  as  sh  or  ksh:
       NO_BAD_PATTERN,	  NO_BANG_HIST,	   NO_BG_NICE,	 NO_EQUALS,   NO_FUNC‐
       TION_ARGZERO, GLOB_SUBST,  NO_GLOBAL_EXPORT,  NO_HUP,  INTERACTIVE_COM‐
       MENTS,  KSH_ARRAYS,  NO_MULTIOS, NO_NOMATCH, NO_NOTIFY, POSIX_BUILTINS,
       NO_PROMPT_PERCENT,    RM_STAR_SILENT,	SH_FILE_EXPANSION,    SH_GLOB,
       SH_OPTION_LETTERS,   SH_WORD_SPLIT.    Additionally  the	 BSD_ECHO  and
       IGNORE_BRACES options are set if zsh  is	 invoked  as  sh.   Also,  the
       KSH_OPTION_PRINT,  LOCAL_OPTIONS,  PROMPT_BANG,	PROMPT_SUBST  and SIN‐
       GLE_LINE_ZLE options are set if zsh is invoked as ksh.

RESTRICTED SHELL
       When the basename of the command used to invoke	zsh  starts  with  the
       letter  `r'  or the `-r' command line option is supplied at invocation,
       the shell becomes  restricted.	Emulation  mode	 is  determined	 after
       stripping  the  letter `r' from the invocation name.  The following are
       disabled in restricted mode:

       ·      changing directories with the cd builtin

       ·      changing or unsetting the PATH, path, MODULE_PATH,  module_path,
	      SHELL,  HISTFILE,	 HISTSIZE,  GID,  EGID,	 UID,  EUID, USERNAME,
	      LD_LIBRARY_PATH,	  LD_AOUT_LIBRARY_PATH,	    LD_PRELOAD	   and
	      LD_AOUT_PRELOAD parameters

       ·      specifying command names containing /

       ·      specifying command pathnames using hash

       ·      redirecting output to files

       ·      using the exec builtin command to replace the shell with another
	      command

       ·      using jobs -Z to overwrite the shell process' argument and envi‐
	      ronment space

       ·      using  the ARGV0 parameter to override argv[0] for external com‐
	      mands

       ·      turning off restricted mode with set +r or unsetopt RESTRICTED

       These restrictions are enforced after  processing  the  startup	files.
       The  startup  files  should set up PATH to point to a directory of com‐
       mands which can be safely invoked in the restricted environment.	  They
       may also add further restrictions by disabling selected builtins.

       Restricted  mode	 can  also  be	activated  any	time  by  setting  the
       RESTRICTED option.   This  immediately  enables	all  the  restrictions
       described  above	 even if the shell still has not processed all startup
       files.

STARTUP/SHUTDOWN FILES
       Commands are first read from /etc/zshenv; this  cannot  be  overridden.
       Subsequent behaviour is modified by the RCS and GLOBAL_RCS options; the
       former affects all startup files, while the second only	affects	 those
       in  the	/etc  directory.  If one of the options is unset at any point,
       any subsequent startup file(s) of the corresponding type	 will  not  be
       read.   It  is  also  possible  for  a  file  in	 $ZDOTDIR to re-enable
       GLOBAL_RCS. Both RCS and GLOBAL_RCS are set by default.

       Commands are then read from $ZDOTDIR/.zshenv.  If the shell is a	 login
       shell,  commands	 are  read from /etc/zprofile and then $ZDOTDIR/.zpro‐
       file.  Then, if the  shell  is  interactive,  commands  are  read  from
       /etc/zshrc  and then $ZDOTDIR/.zshrc.  Finally, if the shell is a login
       shell, /etc/zlogin and $ZDOTDIR/.zlogin are read.

       When  a	login  shell  exits,  the  files  $ZDOTDIR/.zlogout  and  then
       /etc/zlogout  are  read.	 This happens with either an explicit exit via
       the exit or logout commands, or an implicit exit by reading end-of-file
       from  the  terminal.   However, if the shell terminates due to exec'ing
       another process, the  logout  files  are	 not  read.   These  are  also
       affected	 by  the  RCS  and GLOBAL_RCS options.	Note also that the RCS
       option affects the saving of history files, i.e. if RCS is  unset  when
       the shell exits, no history file will be saved.

       If ZDOTDIR is unset, HOME is used instead.  Those files listed above as
       being in /etc may be in another directory, depending on	the  installa‐
       tion.

       As /etc/zshenv is run for all instances of zsh, it is important that it
       be kept as small as possible.  In particular, it is a good idea to  put
       code  that does not need to be run for every single shell behind a test
       of the form `if [[ -o rcs ]]; then ...' so that it will not be executed
       when zsh is invoked with the `-f' option.

       Any  of	these files may be pre-compiled with the zcompile builtin com‐
       mand (see zshbuiltins(1)).  If a compiled file exists  (named  for  the
       original	 file plus the .zwc extension) and it is newer than the origi‐
       nal file, the compiled file will be used instead.

ZSHMISC(1)							    ZSHMISC(1)

NAME
       zshmisc - everything and then some

SIMPLE COMMANDS & PIPELINES
       A simple command is a sequence of optional parameter  assignments  fol‐
       lowed  by  blank-separated  words,  with	 optional  redirections inter‐
       spersed.	 The first word is the command to be executed, and the remain‐
       ing  words, if any, are arguments to the command.  If a command name is
       given, the parameter assignments modify the environment of the  command
       when it is executed.  The value of a simple command is its exit status,
       or 128 plus the signal number if terminated by a signal.	 For example,

	      echo foo

       is a simple command with arguments.

       A pipeline is either a simple command, or a sequence  of	 two  or  more
       simple commands where each command is separated from the next by `|' or
       `|&'.  Where commands are separated by `|', the standard output of  the
       first  command is connected to the standard input of the next.  `|&' is
       shorthand for `2>&1 |', which connects both the standard output and the
       standard	 error	of the command to the standard input of the next.  The
       value of a pipeline is the value of the last command, unless the	 pipe‐
       line  is preceded by `!' in which case the value is the logical inverse
       of the value of the last command.  For example,

	      echo foo | sed 's/foo/bar/'

       is a pipeline, where the output (`foo' plus a  newline)	of  the	 first
       command will be passed to the input of the second.

       If a pipeline is preceded by `coproc', it is executed as a coprocess; a
       two-way pipe is established between it and the parent shell.  The shell
       can read from or write to the coprocess by means of the `>&p' and `<&p'
       redirection operators or with `print -p' and  `read  -p'.   A  pipeline
       cannot be preceded by both `coproc' and `!'.  If job control is active,
       the coprocess can be treated in other than input and output as an ordi‐
       nary background job.

       A  sublist  is  either  a single pipeline, or a sequence of two or more
       pipelines separated by `&&' or `||'.  If two pipelines are separated by
       `&&',  the  second  pipeline  is	 executed  only	 if the first succeeds
       (returns a zero value).	If two pipelines are separated	by  `||',  the
       second  is  executed only if the first fails (returns a nonzero value).
       Both operators have equal precedence and	 are  left  associative.   The
       value  of  the sublist is the value of the last pipeline executed.  For
       example,

	      dmesg | grep panic && print yes

       is a sublist consisting of two pipelines, the second just a simple com‐
       mand  which  will be executed if and only if the grep command returns a
       zero value.  If it does not, the value of the sublist  is  that	return
       value,  else  it	 is  the value returned by the print (almost certainly
       zero).

       A list is a sequence of zero or more sublists, in which each sublist is
       terminated  by `;', `&', `&|', `&!', or a newline.  This terminator may
       optionally be omitted from the last sublist in the list when  the  list
       appears	as  a complex command inside `(...)'  or `{...}'.  When a sub‐
       list is terminated by `;' or newline, the shell waits for it to	finish
       before  executing  the  next  sublist.  If a sublist is terminated by a
       `&', `&|', or `&!', the shell executes the last pipeline in it  in  the
       background,  and	 does  not  wait for it to finish (note the difference
       from other shells which execute the whole sublist in  the  background).
       A backgrounded pipeline returns a status of zero.

       More generally, a list can be seen as a set of any shell commands what‐
       soever, including the complex commands below; this is implied  wherever
       the  word  `list' appears in later descriptions.	 For example, the com‐
       mands in a shell function form a special sort of list.

PRECOMMAND MODIFIERS
       A simple command may be preceded by a precommand modifier,  which  will
       alter  how  the	command	 is  interpreted.   These  modifiers are shell
       builtin commands with the exception of nocorrect which  is  a  reserved
       word.

       -      The  command  is	executed  with	a `-' prepended to its argv[0]
	      string.

       noglob Filename generation (globbing) is not performed on  any  of  the
	      words.

       nocorrect
	      Spelling	correction is not done on any of the words.  This must
	      appear before any other precommand modifier,  as	it  is	inter‐
	      preted  immediately,  before  any	 parsing  is  done.  It has no
	      effect in non-interactive shells.

       exec   The command is executed in the parent shell without forking.

       command
	      The command word is taken to be the name of an external command,
	      rather than a shell function or builtin.

       builtin
	      The  command  word is taken to be the name of a builtin command,
	      rather than a shell function or external command.

COMPLEX COMMANDS
       A complex command in zsh is one of the following:

       if list then list [ elif list then list ] ... [ else list ] fi
	      The if list is executed, and if it returns a zero	 exit  status,
	      the then list is executed.  Otherwise, the elif list is executed
	      and if its value is zero, the then list is  executed.   If  each
	      elif list returns nonzero, the else list is executed.

       for name ... [ in word ... ] term do list done
	      where  term  is  at  least one newline or ;.  Expand the list of
	      words, and set the parameter name to each of them in turn,  exe‐
	      cuting list each time.  If the in word is omitted, use the posi‐
	      tional parameters instead of the words.

	      More than one parameter name  can	 appear	 before	 the  list  of
	      words.  If N names are given, then on each execution of the loop
	      the next N words are assigned to the  corresponding  parameters.
	      If  there	 are  more  names  than remaining words, the remaining
	      parameters are each set to the empty string.  Execution  of  the
	      loop ends when there is no remaining word to assign to the first
	      name.  It is only possible for in to appear as the first name in
	      the  list,  else	it  will  be treated as marking the end of the
	      list.

       for (( [expr1] ; [expr2] ; [expr3] )) do list done
	      The arithmetic expression expr1 is evaluated first (see the sec‐
	      tion  `Arithmetic Evaluation').  The arithmetic expression expr2
	      is repeatedly evaluated until it	evaluates  to  zero  and  when
	      non-zero,	 list  is executed and the arithmetic expression expr3
	      evaluated.  If any expression is omitted, then it behaves as  if
	      it evaluated to 1.

       while list do list done
	      Execute  the  do	list  as long as the while list returns a zero
	      exit status.

       until list do list done
	      Execute the do list as long as until list returns a nonzero exit
	      status.

       repeat word do list done
	      word  is expanded and treated as an arithmetic expression, which
	      must evaluate to a number n.  list is then executed n times.

       case word in [ [(] pattern [ | pattern ] ... ) list (;;|;&) ] ... esac
	      Execute the list associated with the first pattern that  matches
	      word, if any.  The form of the patterns is the same as that used
	      for filename generation.	See the section `Filename Generation'.
	      If  the  list that is executed is terminated with ;& rather than
	      ;;, the following list is also executed.	This  continues	 until
	      either a list is terminated with ;; or the esac is reached.

       select name [ in word ... term ] do list done
	      where  term  is one or more newline or ; to terminate the words.
	      Print the set of words, each preceded by a number.   If  the  in
	      word  is	omitted,  use  the positional parameters.  The PROMPT3
	      prompt is printed and a line is read from the line editor if the
	      shell is interactive and that is active, or else standard input.
	      If this line consists of the number of one of the listed	words,
	      then the parameter name is set to the word corresponding to this
	      number.  If this line is empty, the selection  list  is  printed
	      again.   Otherwise,  the	value  of the parameter name is set to
	      null.  The contents of the line  read  from  standard  input  is
	      saved  in the parameter REPLY.  list is executed for each selec‐
	      tion until a break or end-of-file is encountered.

       ( list )
	      Execute list in a subshell.  Traps set by the trap  builtin  are
	      reset to their default values while executing list.

       { list }
	      Execute list.

       { try-list } always { always-list }
	      First  execute  try-list.	  Regardless of errors, or break, con‐
	      tinue, or return commands encountered within  try-list,  execute
	      always-list.   Execution	then  continues from the result of the
	      execution of try-list; in other words, any error, or break, con‐
	      tinue,  or  return  command  is treated in the normal way, as if
	      always-list were not  present.   The  two	 chunks	 of  code  are
	      referred to as the `try block' and the `always block'.

	      Optional	newlines  or  semicolons  may appear after the always;
	      note, however, that they may not appear between  the  preceeding
	      closing brace and the always.

	      An `error' in this context is a condition such as a syntax error
	      which causes the shell to abort execution of the	current	 func‐
	      tion,  script,  or  list.	  Syntax  errors encountered while the
	      shell is parsing the code do not cause  the  always-list	to  be
	      executed.	  For  example, an erroneously constructed if block in
	      try-list would cause the shell to abort during parsing, so  that
	      always-list  would not be executed, while an erroneous substitu‐
	      tion such as ${*foo*} would cause a run-time error, after	 which
	      always-list would be executed.

	      An  error	 condition  can	 be  tested and reset with the special
	      integer variable TRY_BLOCK_ERROR.	 Outside  an  always-list  the
	      value  is	 irrelevant,  but  it  is  initialised	to -1.	Inside
	      always-list, the	value  is  1  if  an  error  occurred  in  the
	      try-list,	 else  0.   If	TRY_BLOCK_ERROR is set to 0 during the
	      always-list, the error  condition	 caused	 by  the  try-list  is
	      reset,  and  shell execution continues normally after the end of
	      always-list.  Altering the value during the try-list is not use‐
	      ful (unless this forms part of an enclosing always block).

	      Regardless  of TRY_BLOCK_ERROR, after the end of always-list the
	      normal shell status $? is the value returned  from  always-list.
	      This   will   be	non-zero  if  there  was  an  error,  even  if
	      TRY_BLOCK_ERROR was set to zero.

	      The following executes the given code, ignoring  any  errors  it
	      causes.	This is an alternative to the usual convention of pro‐
	      tecting code by executing it in a subshell.

		     {
			 # code which may cause an error
		       } always {
			 # This code is executed regardless of the error.
			 (( TRY_BLOCK_ERROR = 0 ))
		     }
		     # The error condition has been reset.

	      An exit command encountered in try-list does not cause the  exe‐
	      cution  of  always-list.	 Instead,  the shell exits immediately
	      after any EXIT trap has been executed.

       function word ... [ () ] [ term ] { list }
       word ... () [ term ] { list }
       word ... () [ term ] command
	      where term is one or more newline or ;.  Define a function which
	      is  referenced  by  any one of word.  Normally, only one word is
	      provided; multiple words are usually  only  useful  for  setting
	      traps.   The  body of the function is the list between the { and
	      }.  See the section `Functions'.

	      If the option  SH_GLOB  is  set  for  compatibility  with	 other
	      shells,  then whitespace may appear between between the left and
	      right parentheses when there is a single word;   otherwise,  the
	      parentheses  will	 be  treated  as forming a globbing pattern in
	      that case.

       time [ pipeline ]
	      The pipeline is executed, and timing statistics are reported  on
	      the  standard error in the form specified by the TIMEFMT parame‐
	      ter.  If pipeline is omitted, print statistics about  the	 shell
	      process and its children.

       [[ exp ]]
	      Evaluates	 the conditional expression exp and return a zero exit
	      status if it is true.  See the section `Conditional Expressions'
	      for a description of exp.

ALTERNATE FORMS FOR COMPLEX COMMANDS
       Many  of zsh's complex commands have alternate forms.  These particular
       versions of complex commands should be considered deprecated and may be
       removed	in the future.	The versions in the previous section should be
       preferred instead.

       The short versions below only work if sublist is of the form `{ list }'
       or  if the SHORT_LOOPS option is set.  For the if, while and until com‐
       mands, in both these cases the test part of the loop must also be suit‐
       ably  delimited, such as by `[[ ... ]]' or `(( ... ))', else the end of
       the test will not be recognized.	 For the for, repeat, case and	select
       commands	 no  such special form for the arguments is necessary, but the
       other condition (the special form of sublist or use of the  SHORT_LOOPS
       option) still applies.

       if list { list } [ elif list { list } ] ... [ else { list } ]
	      An alternate form of if.	The rules mean that

		     if [[ -o ignorebraces ]] {
		       print yes
		     }

	      works, but

		     if true {	# Does not work!
		       print yes
		     }

	      does not, since the test is not suitably delimited.

       if list sublist
	      A short form of the alternate `if'.  The same limitations on the
	      form of list apply as for the previous form.

       for name ... ( word ... ) sublist
	      A short form of for.

       for name ... [ in word ... ] term sublist
	      where term is at least one newline or ;.	Another short form  of
	      for.

       for (( [expr1] ; [expr2] ; [expr3] )) sublist
	      A short form of the arithmetic for command.

       foreach name ... ( word ... ) list end
	      Another form of for.

       while list { list }
	      An  alternative form of while.  Note the limitations on the form
	      of list mentioned above.

       until list { list }
	      An alternative form of until.  Note the limitations on the  form
	      of list mentioned above.

       repeat word sublist
	      This is a short form of repeat.

       case word { [ [(] pattern [ | pattern ] ... ) list (;;|;&) ] ... }
	      An alternative form of case.

       select name [ in word term ] sublist
	      where  term  is  at  least  one  newline	or ;.  A short form of
	      select.

RESERVED WORDS
       The following words are recognized as reserved words when used  as  the
       first word of a command unless quoted or disabled using disable -r:

       do  done	 esac then elif else fi for case if while function repeat time
       until select coproc nocorrect foreach end ! [[ { }

       Additionally, `}' is recognized in any position	if  the	 IGNORE_BRACES
       option is not set.

COMMENTS
       In  noninteractive  shells,  or in interactive shells with the INTERAC‐
       TIVE_COMMENTS option set, a word beginning with the third character  of
       the  histchars  parameter (`#' by default) causes that word and all the
       following characters up to a newline to be ignored.

ALIASING
       Every token in the shell input is checked to see if there is  an	 alias
       defined	for  it.  If so, it is replaced by the text of the alias if it
       is in command position (if it could be the first word of a simple  com‐
       mand),  or  if the alias is global.  If the text ends with a space, the
       next word in the shell input is treated as though it  were  in  command
       position	 for  purposes	of alias expansion.  An alias is defined using
       the alias builtin; global aliases may be defined using the -g option to
       that builtin.

       Alias  expansion	 is done on the shell input before any other expansion
       except history expansion.  Therefore, if an alias is  defined  for  the
       word  foo,  alias expansion may be avoided by quoting part of the word,
       e.g. \foo.  But there is nothing to prevent an alias being defined  for
       \foo as well.

QUOTING
       A  character  may be quoted (that is, made to stand for itself) by pre‐
       ceding it with a `\'.  `\' followed by a newline is ignored.

       A string enclosed between `$'' and `'' is processed the same way as the
       string arguments of the print builtin, and the resulting string is con‐
       sidered to be entirely quoted.  A literal `'' character can be included
       in the string by using the `\'' escape.

       All  characters	enclosed  between a pair of single quotes ('') that is
       not preceded by a `$' are quoted.  A single quote cannot appear	within
       single  quotes unless the option RC_QUOTES is set, in which case a pair
       of single quotes are turned into a single quote.	 For example,

	      print ''''

       outputs nothing apart from a newline if RC_QUOTES is not set,  but  one
       single quote if it is set.

       Inside  double  quotes  (""), parameter and command substitution occur,
       and `\' quotes the characters `\', ``', `"', and `$'.

REDIRECTION
       If a command is followed by & and job control is not active,  then  the
       default	standard  input	 for  the command is the empty file /dev/null.
       Otherwise, the environment for the execution of a command contains  the
       file  descriptors  of  the  invoking  shell as modified by input/output
       specifications.

       The following may appear anywhere in a simple command or may precede or
       follow  a  complex  command.   Expansion occurs before word or digit is
       used except as noted below.  If the result of substitution on word pro‐
       duces  more  than  one  filename,  redirection occurs for each separate
       filename in turn.

       < word Open file word for reading as standard input.

       <> word
	      Open file word for reading and writing as	 standard  input.   If
	      the file does not exist then it is created.

       > word Open file word for writing as standard output.  If the file does
	      not exist then it is created.  If the file exists, and the CLOB‐
	      BER  option  is  unset,  this  causes an error; otherwise, it is
	      truncated to zero length.

       >| word
       >! word
	      Same as >, except that the file is truncated to zero  length  if
	      it exists, even if CLOBBER is unset.

       >> word
	      Open  file  word	for writing in append mode as standard output.
	      If the file does not exist, and the  CLOBBER  option  is	unset,
	      this causes an error; otherwise, the file is created.

       >>| word
       >>! word
	      Same  as	>>,  except  that  the	file is created if it does not
	      exist, even if CLOBBER is unset.

       <<[-] word
	      The shell input is read up to a line that is the same  as	 word,
	      or to an end-of-file.  No parameter expansion, command substitu‐
	      tion or filename generation is performed on word.	 The resulting
	      document, called a here-document, becomes the standard input.

	      If  any character of word is quoted with single or double quotes
	      or a `\', no interpretation is placed upon the characters of the
	      document.	 Otherwise, parameter and command substitution occurs,
	      `\' followed by a newline is removed, and `\' must  be  used  to
	      quote  the  characters  `\', `$', ``' and the first character of
	      word.

	      Note that word itself does not undergo shell  expansion.	 Back‐
	      quotes  in  word	do  not	 have their usual effect; instead they
	      behave similarly to double quotes, except	 that  the  backquotes
	      themselves  are  passed through unchanged.  (This information is
	      given for completeness and it is not recommended that backquotes
	      be  used.)  Quotes in the form $'...' have their standard effect
	      of expanding backslashed references to special characters.

	      If <<- is used, then all leading tabs are stripped from word and
	      from the document.

       <<< word
	      Perform  shell expansion on word and pass the result to standard
	      input.  This is known as a here-string.  Compare the use of word
	      in  here-documents  above,  where	 word  does  not undergo shell
	      expansion.

       <& number
       >& number
	      The standard input/output is  duplicated	from  file  descriptor
	      number (see dup2(2)).

       <& -
       >& -   Close the standard input/output.

       <& p
       >& p   The  input/output from/to the coprocess is moved to the standard
	      input/output.

       >& word
       &> word
	      (Except where `>& word' matches one of the above syntaxes;  `&>'
	      can  always  be  used  to avoid this ambiguity.)	Redirects both
	      standard output and standard error (file descriptor  2)  in  the
	      manner  of  `>  word'.   Note  that  this does not have the same
	      effect as `> word 2>&1' in the presence of multios (see the sec‐
	      tion below).

       >&| word
       >&! word
       &>| word
       &>! word
	      Redirects both standard output and standard error (file descrip‐
	      tor 2) in the manner of `>| word'.

       >>& word
       &>> word
	      Redirects both standard output and standard error (file descrip‐
	      tor 2) in the manner of `>> word'.

       >>&| word
       >>&! word
       &>>| word
       &>>! word
	      Redirects both standard output and standard error (file descrip‐
	      tor 2) in the manner of `>>| word'.

       If one of the above is preceded by a digit, then	 the  file  descriptor
       referred	 to is that specified by the digit instead of the default 0 or
       1.  The order in which redirections are specified is significant.   The
       shell  evaluates	 each  redirection  in	terms of the (file descriptor,
       file) association at the time of evaluation.  For example:

	      ... 1>fname 2>&1

       first associates file descriptor 1 with file fname.  It then associates
       file descriptor 2 with the file associated with file descriptor 1 (that
       is, fname).  If the order of redirections were reversed, file  descrip‐
       tor 2 would be associated with the terminal (assuming file descriptor 1
       had been) and then file descriptor 1  would  be	associated  with  file
       fname.

       The  `|&' command separator described in Simple Commands & Pipelines in
       zshmisc(1) is a shorthand for `2>&1 |'.

       For output redirections only, if word is of the form `>(list)' then the
       output  is  piped to the command represented by list.  See Process Sub‐
       stitution in zshexpn(1).

MULTIOS
       If the user tries to open a file descriptor for writing more than once,
       the  shell opens the file descriptor as a pipe to a process that copies
       its input to all the specified outputs, similar to  tee,	 provided  the
       MULTIOS option is set, as it is by default.  Thus:

	      date >foo >bar

       writes  the date to two files, named `foo' and `bar'.  Note that a pipe
       is an implicit redirection; thus

	      date >foo | cat

       writes the date to the file `foo', and also pipes it to cat.

       If the MULTIOS option is set, the word after a redirection operator  is
       also subjected to filename generation (globbing).  Thus

	      : > *

       will  truncate  all files in the current directory, assuming there's at
       least one.  (Without the MULTIOS option, it would create an empty  file
       called `*'.)  Similarly, you can do

	      echo exit 0 >> *.sh

       If the user tries to open a file descriptor for reading more than once,
       the shell opens the file descriptor as a pipe to a process that	copies
       all  the specified inputs to its output in the order specified, similar
       to cat, provided the MULTIOS option is set.  Thus

	      sort <foo <fubar

       or even

	      sort <f{oo,ubar}

       is equivalent to `cat foo fubar | sort'.

       Note that a pipe is an implicit redirection; thus

	      cat bar | sort <foo

       is equivalent to `cat bar foo | sort' (note the order of the inputs).

       If the MULTIOS option is unset, each redirection replaces the  previous
       redirection for that file descriptor.  However, all files redirected to
       are actually opened, so

	      echo foo > bar > baz

       when MULTIOS is unset will truncate bar, and write `foo' into baz.

       There is a problem when an output multio is  attached  to  an  external
       program.	 A simple example shows this:

	      cat file >file1 >file2
	      cat file1 file2

       Here,  it  is  possible that the second `cat' will not display the full
       contents of file1  and  file2  (i.e.  the  original  contents  of  file
       repeated twice).

       The  reason  for	 this  is  that	 the multios are spawned after the cat
       process is forked from the parent shell, so the parent shell  does  not
       wait for the multios to finish writing data.  This means the command as
       shown can exit before file1 and file2 are  completely  written.	 As  a
       workaround,  it	is possible to run the cat process as part of a job in
       the current shell:

	      { cat file } >file >file2

       Here, the {...} job will pause to wait for both files to be written.

REDIRECTIONS WITH NO COMMAND
       When a simple command consists of one or more redirection operators and
       zero or more parameter assignments, but no command name, zsh can behave
       in several ways.

       If the parameter NULLCMD is not set or the option CSH_NULLCMD  is  set,
       an error is caused.  This is the csh behavior and CSH_NULLCMD is set by
       default when emulating csh.

       If the option SH_NULLCMD is set, the builtin `:' is inserted as a  com‐
       mand  with  the given redirections.  This is the default when emulating
       sh or ksh.

       Otherwise, if the parameter NULLCMD is set, its value will be used as a
       command	with  the given redirections.  If both NULLCMD and READNULLCMD
       are set, then the value of the latter will be used instead of  that  of
       the  former  when the redirection is an input.  The default for NULLCMD
       is `cat' and for READNULLCMD is `more'. Thus

	      < file

       shows the contents of file on standard output, with paging if that is a
       terminal.  NULLCMD and READNULLCMD may refer to shell functions.

COMMAND EXECUTION
       If a command name contains no slashes, the shell attempts to locate it.
       If there exists a shell function by that name, the function is  invoked
       as  described  in  the  section	`Functions'.   If there exists a shell
       builtin by that name, the builtin is invoked.

       Otherwise, the shell searches each element of  $path  for  a  directory
       containing  an  executable  file by that name.  If the search is unsuc‐
       cessful, the shell prints an error message and returns a	 nonzero  exit
       status.

       If  execution  fails  because the file is not in executable format, and
       the file is not a directory, it	is  assumed  to	 be  a	shell  script.
       /bin/sh	is  spawned to execute it.  If the program is a file beginning
       with `#!', the remainder of the first line specifies an interpreter for
       the program.  The shell will execute the specified interpreter on oper‐
       ating systems that do not handle this executable format in the kernel.

FUNCTIONS
       Shell functions are defined with the function reserved word or the spe‐
       cial  syntax  `funcname	()'.   Shell  functions are read in and stored
       internally.  Alias names are resolved when the function is read.	 Func‐
       tions  are  executed  like  commands with the arguments passed as posi‐
       tional parameters.  (See the section `Command Execution'.)

       Functions execute in the same process as the caller and share all files
       and  present  working  directory	 with  the caller.  A trap on EXIT set
       inside a function is executed after the function completes in the envi‐
       ronment of the caller.

       The return builtin is used to return from function calls.

       Function	 identifiers  can be listed with the functions builtin.	 Func‐
       tions can be undefined with the unfunction builtin.

AUTOLOADING FUNCTIONS
       A function can be marked as undefined using the	autoload  builtin  (or
       `functions  -u'	or `typeset -fu').  Such a function has no body.  When
       the function is first executed, the shell searches for  its  definition
       using the elements of the fpath variable.  Thus to define functions for
       autoloading, a typical sequence is:

	      fpath=(~/myfuncs $fpath)
	      autoload myfunc1 myfunc2 ...

       The usual alias expansion during reading	 will  be  suppressed  if  the
       autoload builtin or its equivalent is given the option -U. This is rec‐
       ommended for the use of functions supplied with the  zsh	 distribution.
       Note  that  for functions precompiled with the zcompile builtin command
       the flag -U must be provided when the .zwc file is created, as the cor‐
       responding information is compiled into the latter.

       For  each  element  in fpath, the shell looks for three possible files,
       the newest of which is used to load the definition for the function:

       element.zwc
	      A file created with  the	zcompile  builtin  command,  which  is
	      expected	to  contain  the  definitions for all functions in the
	      directory named element.	The file is treated in the same manner
	      as  a  directory	containing files for functions and is searched
	      for the definition of the function.   If the definition  is  not
	      found,  the  search for a definition proceeds with the other two
	      possibilities described below.

	      If element already includes a .zwc extension (i.e. the extension
	      was  explicitly  given by the user), element is searched for the
	      definition of the function without comparing its age to that  of
	      other  files;  in	 fact, there does not need to be any directory
	      named element without the suffix.	  Thus	including  an  element
	      such as `/usr/local/funcs.zwc' in fpath will speed up the search
	      for functions, with the  disadvantage  that  functions  included
	      must  be	explicitly recompiled by hand before the shell notices
	      any changes.

       element/function.zwc
	      A file created with zcompile, which is expected to  contain  the
	      definition  for function.	 It may include other function defini‐
	      tions as well, but those are neither loaded nor executed; a file
	      found  in	 this way is searched only for the definition of func‐
	      tion.

       element/function
	      A file of zsh command text, taken to be the definition for func‐
	      tion.

       In  summary, the order of searching is, first, in the parents of direc‐
       tories in fpath for the newer of	 either	 a  compiled  directory	 or  a
       directory  in fpath; second, if more than one of these contains a defi‐
       nition for the function that is sought, the leftmost in	the  fpath  is
       chosen;	and  third, within a directory, the newer of either a compiled
       function or an ordinary function definition is used.

       If the KSH_AUTOLOAD option is set, or the file contains only  a	simple
       definition of the function, the file's contents will be executed.  This
       will normally define the function in question,  but  may	 also  perform
       initialization, which is executed in the context of the function execu‐
       tion, and may therefore define local parameters.	 It is an error if the
       function is not defined by loading the file.

       Otherwise,  the	function body (with no surrounding `funcname() {...}')
       is taken to be the complete contents of the file.  This form allows the
       file  to be used directly as an executable shell script.	 If processing
       of the file results in the  function  being  re-defined,	 the  function
       itself  is  not re-executed.  To force the shell to perform initializa‐
       tion and then call the function defined, the file should	 contain  ini‐
       tialization code (which will be executed then discarded) in addition to
       a complete function definition (which will be retained  for  subsequent
       calls to the function), and a call to the shell function, including any
       arguments, at the end.

       For example, suppose the autoload file func contains

	      func() { print This is func; }
	      print func is initialized

       then `func; func' with KSH_AUTOLOAD set will produce both  messages  on
       the  first  call, but only the message `This is func' on the second and
       subsequent calls.  Without KSH_AUTOLOAD set, it will produce  the  ini‐
       tialization  message  on	 the  first call, and the other message on the
       second and subsequent calls.

       It is also possible  to	create	a  function  that  is  not  marked  as
       autoloaded,  but	 which loads its own definition by searching fpath, by
       using `autoload -X' within a shell function.  For example, the  follow‐
       ing are equivalent:

	      myfunc() {
		autoload -X
	      }
	      myfunc args...

       and

	      unfunction myfunc	  # if myfunc was defined
	      autoload myfunc
	      myfunc args...

       In  fact,  the  functions  command outputs `builtin autoload -X' as the
       body of an autoloaded function.	This is done so that

	      eval "$(functions)"

       produces a reasonable result.  A true autoloaded function can be	 iden‐
       tified  by  the	presence  of  the  comment  `# undefined' in the body,
       because all comments are discarded from defined functions.

       To load the definition of an autoloaded function myfunc without execut‐
       ing myfunc, use:

	      autoload +X myfunc

SPECIAL FUNCTIONS
       The following functions, if defined, have special meaning to the shell:

       chpwd  Executed whenever the current working directory is changed.

       periodic
	      If  the parameter PERIOD is set, this function is executed every
	      $PERIOD seconds, just before a prompt.

       precmd Executed before each prompt.

       preexec
	      Executed just after a command has been read and is about	to  be
	      executed.	  If the history mechanism is active (and the line was
	      not discarded from the history buffer), the string that the user
	      typed  is passed as the first argument, otherwise it is an empty
	      string.  The actual command that	will  be  executed  (including
	      expanded	aliases)  is passed in two different forms: the second
	      argument is a single-line, size-limited version of  the  command
	      (with  things  like  function bodies elided); the third argument
	      contains the full text that is being executed.

       TRAPNAL
	      If defined and non-null, this function will be executed whenever
	      the shell catches a signal SIGNAL, where NAL is a signal name as
	      specified for the kill  builtin.	 The  signal  number  will  be
	      passed as the first parameter to the function.

	      If  a  function  of this form is defined and null, the shell and
	      processes spawned by it will ignore SIGNAL.

	      The return value from the function is handled specially.	If  it
	      is  zero, the signal is assumed to have been handled, and execu‐
	      tion continues normally.	Otherwise, the normal  effect  of  the
	      signal  is  produced; if this causes execution to terminate, the
	      status returned to the shell is the  status  returned  from  the
	      function.

	      Programs	terminated  by	uncaught  signals typically return the
	      status 128 plus the signal number.  Hence the  following	causes
	      the  handler for SIGINT to print a message, then mimic the usual
	      effect of the signal.

		     TRAPINT() {
		       print "Caught SIGINT, aborting."
		       return $(( 128 + $1 ))
		     }

	      The functions TRAPZERR, TRAPDEBUG and TRAPEXIT  are  never  exe‐
	      cuted inside other traps.

       TRAPDEBUG
	      Executed after each command.

       TRAPEXIT
	      Executed	when  the  shell  exits,  or when the current function
	      exits if defined inside a function.

       TRAPZERR
	      Executed whenever a command has a non-zero  exit	status.	  How‐
	      ever,  the function is not executed if the command occurred in a
	      sublist followed by `&&' or `||'; only the final	command	 in  a
	      sublist of this type causes the trap to be executed.

       The  functions  beginning  `TRAP' may alternatively be defined with the
       trap builtin:  this may be preferable for some uses, as they  are  then
       run in the environment of the calling process, rather than in their own
       function environment.  Apart from the difference in  calling  procedure
       and  the fact that the function form appears in lists of functions, the
       forms

	      TRAPNAL() {
	       # code
	      }

       and

	      trap '
	       # code

       are equivalent.

JOBS
       If the MONITOR option is set, an interactive  shell  associates	a  job
       with  each  pipeline.  It keeps a table of current jobs, printed by the
       jobs command, and assigns them small integer numbers.  When  a  job  is
       started	asynchronously	with  `&', the shell prints a line to standard
       error which looks like:

	      [1] 1234

       indicating that the job which was started asynchronously was job number
       1 and had one (top-level) process, whose process ID was 1234.

       If  a  job  is  started with `&|' or `&!', then that job is immediately
       disowned.  After startup, it does not have a place in  the  job	table,
       and is not subject to the job control features described here.

       If  you are running a job and wish to do something else you may hit the
       key ^Z (control-Z) which sends a TSTP signal to the current job:	  this
       key  may	 be redefined by the susp option of the external stty command.
       The shell will then normally indicate  that  the	 job  has  been	 `sus‐
       pended',	 and  print another prompt.  You can then manipulate the state
       of this job, putting it in the background with the bg command,  or  run
       some  other  commands  and  then eventually bring the job back into the
       foreground with the foreground command fg.  A ^Z takes  effect  immedi‐
       ately  and is like an interrupt in that pending output and unread input
       are discarded when it is typed.

       A job being run in the background will suspend if it tries to read from
       the  terminal.  Background jobs are normally allowed to produce output,
       but this can be disabled by giving the command `stty tostop'.   If  you
       set this tty option, then background jobs will suspend when they try to
       produce output like they do when they try to read input.

       When a command is suspended and continued later with  the  fg  or  wait
       builtins,  zsh  restores tty modes that were in effect when it was sus‐
       pended.	This (intentionally) does not apply if the command is  contin‐
       ued via `kill -CONT', nor when it is continued with bg.

       There  are  several  ways  to refer to jobs in the shell.  A job can be
       referred to by the process ID of any process of the job or  by  one  of
       the following:

       %number
	      The job with the given number.
       %string
	      Any job whose command line begins with string.
       %?string
	      Any job whose command line contains string.
       %%     Current job.
       %+     Equivalent to `%%'.
       %-     Previous job.

       The shell learns immediately whenever a process changes state.  It nor‐
       mally informs you whenever a job becomes blocked	 so  that  no  further
       progress	 is possible.  If the NOTIFY option is not set, it waits until
       just before it prints a prompt before it informs you.  All such notifi‐
       cations	are  sent directly to the terminal, not to the standard output
       or standard error.

       When the monitor mode is on, each background job that  completes	 trig‐
       gers any trap set for CHLD.

       When  you  try  to leave the shell while jobs are running or suspended,
       you will be warned that `You have suspended (running) jobs'.   You  may
       use  the	 jobs command to see what they are.  If you do this or immedi‐
       ately try to exit again, the shell will not warn you a second time; the
       suspended  jobs will be terminated, and the running jobs will be sent a
       SIGHUP signal, if the HUP option is set.

       To avoid having the shell terminate the running jobs,  either  use  the
       nohup command (see nohup(1)) or the disown builtin.

SIGNALS
       The INT and QUIT signals for an invoked command are ignored if the com‐
       mand is followed by `&' and the MONITOR option is not  active.	Other‐
       wise,  signals  have  the values inherited by the shell from its parent
       (but see the TRAPNAL special functions in the section `Functions').

ARITHMETIC EVALUATION
       The shell can perform integer and  floating  point  arithmetic,	either
       using the builtin let, or via a substitution of the form $((...)).  For
       integers, the shell is usually compiled to use 8-byte  precision	 where
       this is available, otherwise precision is 4 bytes.  This can be tested,
       for example, by giving the command `print - $(( 12345678901 ))'; if the
       number  appears unchanged, the precision is at least 8 bytes.  Floating
       point arithmetic is always double precision.

       The let builtin command takes arithmetic expressions as arguments; each
       is  evaluated  separately.   Since many of the arithmetic operators, as
       well as spaces, require quoting, an alternative form is	provided:  for
       any command which begins with a `((', all the characters until a match‐
       ing `))' are treated as a quoted expression  and	 arithmetic  expansion
       performed  as  for  an  argument	 of let.  More precisely, `((...))' is
       equivalent to `let "..."'.  For example, the following statement

	      (( val = 2 + 1 ))

       is equivalent to

	      let "val = 2 + 1"

       both assigning the value 3 to the shell variable val  and  returning  a
       zero status.

       Integers can be in bases other than 10.	A leading `0x' or `0X' denotes
       hexadecimal.  Integers may also be of the form `base#n', where base  is
       a decimal number between two and thirty-six representing the arithmetic
       base and n is a number in that base (for example,  `16#ff'  is  255  in
       hexadecimal).   The base# may also be omitted, in which case base 10 is
       used.  For backwards compatibility the form `[base]n' is also accepted.

       It is also possible to specify a base to be used for output in the form
       `[#base]',  for	example	 `[#16]'.  This is used when outputting arith‐
       metical substitutions or when assigning to scalar  parameters,  but  an
       explicitly  defined  integer  or	 floating  point parameter will not be
       affected.  If an integer variable is implicitly defined	by  an	arith‐
       metic  expression,  any	base  specified in this way will be set as the
       variable's output arithmetic base as if the option  `-i	base'  to  the
       typeset builtin had been used.  The expression has no precedence and if
       it occurs more than once in a mathematical expression, the last encoun‐
       tered  is  used.	  For  clarity it is recommended that it appear at the
       beginning of an expression.  As an example:

	      typeset -i 16 y
	      print $(( [#8] x = 32, y = 32 ))
	      print $x $y

       outputs first `8#40', the rightmost value in the given output base, and
       then  `8#40 16#20', because y has been explicitly declared to have out‐
       put base 16, while x (assuming it does not already exist) is implicitly
       typed  by  the arithmetic evaluation, where it acquires the output base
       8.

       If the C_BASES option is set, hexadecimal numbers  in  the  standard  C
       format,	for  example 0xFF instead of the usual `16#FF'.	 If the option
       OCTAL_ZEROES is also set (it is not by default), octal numbers will  be
       treated	similarly  and	hence appear as `077' instead of `8#77'.  This
       option has no effect on the output of bases other than hexadecimal  and
       octal, and these formats are always understood on input.

       When  an output base is specified using the `[#base]' syntax, an appro‐
       priate base prefix will be output if necessary, so that the value  out‐
       put  is	valid  syntax  for  input.   If	 the # is doubled, for example
       `[##16]', then no base prefix is output.

       Floating point constants are recognized by the presence	of  a  decimal
       point  or an exponent.  The decimal point may be the first character of
       the constant, but the exponent character e or E may not, as it will  be
       taken for a parameter name.

       An  arithmetic  expression uses nearly the same syntax, precedence, and
       associativity of expressions in C.  The following  operators  are  sup‐
       ported (listed in decreasing order of precedence):

       + - ! ~ ++ --
	      unary plus/minus, logical NOT, complement, {pre,post}{in,de}cre‐
	      ment
       << >>  bitwise shift left, right
       &      bitwise AND
       ^      bitwise XOR
       |      bitwise OR
       **     exponentiation
       * / %  multiplication, division, modulus (remainder)
       + -    addition, subtraction
       < > <= >=
	      comparison
       == !=  equality and inequality
       &&     logical AND
       || ^^  logical OR, XOR
       ? :    ternary operator
       = += -= *= /= %= &= ^= |= <<= >>= &&= ||= ^^= **=
	      assignment
       ,      comma operator

       The operators `&&', `||', `&&=', and `||='  are	short-circuiting,  and
       only  one of the latter two expressions in a ternary operator is evalu‐
       ated.  Note the precedence of the bitwise AND, OR, and XOR operators.

       Mathematical functions can be  called  with  the	 syntax	 `func(args)',
       where  the  function  decides  if  the  args  is	 used as a string or a
       comma-separated list of arithmetic  expressions.	 The  shell  currently
       defines	no mathematical functions by default, but the module zsh/math‐
       func may be loaded with the zmodload builtin to provide standard float‐
       ing point mathematical functions.

       An  expression of the form `##x' where x is any character sequence such
       as `a', `^A', or `\M-\C-x' gives the ASCII value of this character  and
       an  expression  of  the	form `#foo' gives the ASCII value of the first
       character of the value of the parameter foo.  Note that this is differ‐
       ent  from  the  expression  `$#foo',  a standard parameter substitution
       which gives the length of the parameter foo.  `#\' is accepted  instead
       of `##', but its use is deprecated.

       Named  parameters  and  subscripted  arrays  can	 be referenced by name
       within an arithmetic expression without using the  parameter  expansion
       syntax.	For example,

	      ((val2 = val1 * 2))

       assigns twice the value of $val1 to the parameter named val2.

       An  internal  integer representation of a named parameter can be speci‐
       fied with the integer builtin.  Arithmetic evaluation is	 performed  on
       the  value  of each assignment to a named parameter declared integer in
       this manner.  Assigning a floating point number to an  integer  results
       in rounding down to the next integer.

       Likewise,  floating  point  numbers  can	 be  declared  with  the float
       builtin; there are two types, differing only in their output format, as
       described  for  the typeset builtin.  The output format can be bypassed
       by using arithmetic substitution instead of the parameter substitution,
       i.e.  `${float}'	 uses  the  defined  format,  but  `$((float))' uses a
       generic floating point format.

       Promotion of integer to floating point values is performed where neces‐
       sary.   In  addition,  if  any operator which requires an integer (`~',
       `&', `|', `^', `%', `<<', `>>' and their equivalents  with  assignment)
       is given a floating point argument, it will be silently rounded down to
       the next integer.

       Scalar variables can hold integer or floating point values at different
       times; there is no memory of the numeric type in this case.

       If a variable is first assigned in a numeric context without previously
       being declared, it will be implicitly typed as  integer	or  float  and
       retain  that  type either until the type is explicitly changed or until
       the end of the scope.  This  can	 have  unforeseen  consequences.   For
       example, in the loop

	      for (( f = 0; f < 1; f += 0.1 )); do
	      # use $f
	      done

       if  f has not already been declared, the first assignment will cause it
       to be created as an integer, and consequently the operation `f +=  0.1'
       will  always cause the result to be truncated to zero, so that the loop
       will fail.  A simple fix would be to turn the initialization into `f  =
       0.0'.   It is therefore best to declare numeric variables with explicit
       types.

CONDITIONAL EXPRESSIONS
       A conditional expression is used with the [[ compound command  to  test
       attributes  of  files  and  to compare strings.	Each expression can be
       constructed from one or more of the following unary or  binary  expres‐
       sions:

       -a file
	      true if file exists.

       -b file
	      true if file exists and is a block special file.

       -c file
	      true if file exists and is a character special file.

       -d file
	      true if file exists and is a directory.

       -e file
	      true if file exists.

       -f file
	      true if file exists and is a regular file.

       -g file
	      true if file exists and has its setgid bit set.

       -h file
	      true if file exists and is a symbolic link.

       -k file
	      true if file exists and has its sticky bit set.

       -n string
	      true if length of string is non-zero.

       -o option
	      true if option named option is on.  option may be a single char‐
	      acter, in which case it is a single letter  option  name.	  (See
	      the section `Specifying Options'.)

       -p file
	      true if file exists and is a FIFO special file (named pipe).

       -r file
	      true if file exists and is readable by current process.

       -s file
	      true if file exists and has size greater than zero.

       -t fd  true  if file descriptor number fd is open and associated with a
	      terminal device.	(note: fd is not optional)

       -u file
	      true if file exists and has its setuid bit set.

       -w file
	      true if file exists and is writable by current process.

       -x file
	      true if file exists and is executable by	current	 process.   If
	      file  exists  and	 is  a directory, then the current process has
	      permission to search in the directory.

       -z string
	      true if length of string is zero.

       -L file
	      true if file exists and is a symbolic link.

       -O file
	      true if file exists and is owned by the  effective  user	ID  of
	      this process.

       -G file
	      true if file exists and its group matches the effective group ID
	      of this process.

       -S file
	      true if file exists and is a socket.

       -N file
	      true if file exists and its access time is not  newer  than  its
	      modification time.

       file1 -nt file2
	      true if file1 exists and is newer than file2.

       file1 -ot file2
	      true if file1 exists and is older than file2.

       file1 -ef file2
	      true if file1 and file2 exist and refer to the same file.

       string = pattern
       string == pattern
	      true  if string matches pattern.	The `==' form is the preferred
	      one.  The `=' form is for backward compatibility and  should  be
	      considered obsolete.

       string != pattern
	      true if string does not match pattern.

       string1 < string2
	      true  if	string1	 comes	before string2 based on ASCII value of
	      their characters.

       string1 > string2
	      true if string1 comes after string2  based  on  ASCII  value  of
	      their characters.

       exp1 -eq exp2
	      true if exp1 is numerically equal to exp2.

       exp1 -ne exp2
	      true if exp1 is numerically not equal to exp2.

       exp1 -lt exp2
	      true if exp1 is numerically less than exp2.

       exp1 -gt exp2
	      true if exp1 is numerically greater than exp2.

       exp1 -le exp2
	      true if exp1 is numerically less than or equal to exp2.

       exp1 -ge exp2
	      true if exp1 is numerically greater than or equal to exp2.

       ( exp )
	      true if exp is true.

       ! exp  true if exp is false.

       exp1 && exp2
	      true if exp1 and exp2 are both true.

       exp1 || exp2
	      true if either exp1 or exp2 is true.

       Normal  shell  expansion	 is  performed on the file, string and pattern
       arguments, but the result of each expansion is constrained to be a sin‐
       gle  word,  similar  to	the effect of double quotes.  However, pattern
       metacharacters are active for the pattern arguments; the	 patterns  are
       the  same  as  those  used for filename generation, see zshexpn(1), but
       there is no special behaviour of `/' nor	 initial  dots,	 and  no  glob
       qualifiers are allowed.

       In  each	 of the above expressions, if file is of the form `/dev/fd/n',
       where n is an integer, then the test applied to	the  open  file	 whose
       descriptor  number is n, even if the underlying system does not support
       the /dev/fd directory.

       In the forms which do numeric comparison, the expressions  exp  undergo
       arithmetic expansion as if they were enclosed in $((...)).

       For example, the following:

	      [[ ( -f foo || -f bar ) && $report = y* ]] && print File exists.

       tests if either file foo or file bar exists, and if so, if the value of
       the parameter report begins with `y';  if  the  complete	 condition  is
       true, the message `File exists.' is printed.

PROMPT EXPANSION
       Prompt  sequences  undergo  a  special form of expansion.  This type of
       expansion is also available using the -P option to the print builtin.

       If the PROMPT_SUBST option is set, the prompt string is first subjected
       to  parameter expansion, command substitution and arithmetic expansion.
       See zshexpn(1).

       Certain escape sequences may be recognised in the prompt string.

       If the PROMPT_BANG option is set, a `!' in the prompt  is  replaced  by
       the  current  history  event  number.  A literal `!' may then be repre‐
       sented as `!!'.

       If the PROMPT_PERCENT option is	set,  certain  escape  sequences  that
       start  with  `%'	 are  expanded.	 Some escapes take an optional integer
       argument, which should appear between the `%' and the next character of
       the sequence.  The following escape sequences are recognized:

   Special characters
       %%     A `%'.

       %)     A `)'.

   Login information
       %l     The line (tty) the user is logged in on, without `/dev/' prefix.
	      If the name starts with `/dev/tty', that prefix is stripped.

       %M     The full machine hostname.

       %m     The hostname up to the first `.'.	 An integer may follow the `%'
	      to  specify  how	many  components  of the hostname are desired.
	      With a negative integer, trailing components of the hostname are
	      shown.

       %n     $USERNAME.

       %y     The line (tty) the user is logged in on, without `/dev/' prefix.
	      This does not treat `/dev/tty' names specially.

   Shell state
       %#     A `#' if the shell is running with privileges,  a	 `%'  if  not.
	      Equivalent  to `%(!.#.%%)'.  The definition of `privileged', for
	      these purposes, is that either the effective user	 ID  is	 zero,
	      or,  if  POSIX.1e	 capabilities are supported, that at least one
	      capability is raised in  either  the  Effective  or  Inheritable
	      capability vectors.

       %?     The  return  code	 of  the last command executed just before the
	      prompt.

       %_     The status of the parser, i.e. the shell constructs  (like  `if'
	      and  `for') that have been started on the command line. If given
	      an integer number that many strings will	be  printed;  zero  or
	      negative	or  no integer means print as many as there are.  This
	      is most useful in prompts PS2 for continuation lines and PS4 for
	      debugging	 with  the  XTRACE  option; in the latter case it will
	      also work non-interactively.

       %d
       %/     Present working directory ($PWD).	 If  an	 integer  follows  the
	      `%',  it	specifies  a  number of trailing components of $PWD to
	      show; zero means the whole path.	A negative  integer  specifies
	      leading components, i.e. %-1d specifies the first component.

       %~     As  %d  and %/, but if $PWD has a named directory as its prefix,
	      that part is replaced by a `~'  followed	by  the	 name  of  the
	      directory.   If it starts with $HOME, that part is replaced by a
	      `~'.

       %h
       %!     Current history event number.

       %i     The line number currently being executed in the script,  sourced
	      file,  or	 shell	function given by %N.  This is most useful for
	      debugging as part of $PS4.

       %j     The number of jobs.

       %L     The current value of $SHLVL.

       %N     The name of the script, sourced file, or shell function that zsh
	      is currently executing, whichever was started most recently.  If
	      there is none, this is equivalent to the parameter $0.  An inte‐
	      ger may follow the `%' to specify a number of trailing path com‐
	      ponents to show; zero means the full path.  A  negative  integer
	      specifies leading components.

       %c
       %.
       %C     Trailing	component  of  $PWD.  An integer may follow the `%' to
	      get more than one component.  Unless `%C' is  used,  tilde  con‐
	      traction	is performed first.  These are deprecated as %c and %C
	      are equivalent to %1~ and %1/, respectively, while explicit pos‐
	      itive  integers  have  the  same	effect	as  for the latter two
	      sequences.

   Date and time
       %D     The date in yy-mm-dd format.

       %T     Current time of day, in 24-hour format.

       %t
       %@     Current time of day, in 12-hour, am/pm format.

       %*     Current time of day in 24-hour format, with seconds.

       %w     The date in day-dd format.

       %W     The date in mm/dd/yy format.

       %D{string}
	      string is formatted using	 the  strftime	function.   See	 strf‐
	      time(3) for more details.	 Three additional codes are available:
	      %f prints the day of the month, like %e but without any  preced‐
	      ing  space if the day is a single digit, and %K/%L correspond to
	      %k/%l for the hour of the day (24/12 hour	 clock)	 in  the  same
	      way.

   Visual effects
       %B (%b)
	      Start (stop) boldface mode.

       %E     Clear to end of line.

       %U (%u)
	      Start (stop) underline mode.

       %S (%s)
	      Start (stop) standout mode.

       %{...%}
	      Include  a  string  as  a	 literal  escape sequence.  The string
	      within the braces should not change the cursor position.	 Brace
	      pairs can nest.

   Conditional substrings
       %v     The  value  of  the  first element of the psvar array parameter.
	      Following the `%' with an integer	 gives	that  element  of  the
	      array.  Negative integers count from the end of the array.

       %(x.true-text.false-text)
	      Specifies	 a  ternary expression.	 The character following the x
	      is arbitrary; the same character is used to  separate  the  text
	      for  the	`true'	result from that for the `false' result.  This
	      separator may not appear in the true-text, except as part	 of  a
	      %-escape	sequence.  A `)' may appear in the false-text as `%)'.
	      true-text and false-text	may  both  contain  arbitrarily-nested
	      escape sequences, including further ternary expressions.

	      The  left	 parenthesis may be preceded or followed by a positive
	      integer n, which defaults to zero.  A negative integer  will  be
	      multiplied  by  -1.  The test character x may be any of the fol‐
	      lowing:

	      !	     True if the shell is running with privileges.
	      #	     True if the effective uid of the current process is n.
	      ?	     True if the exit status of the last command was n.
	      _	     True if at least n shell constructs were started.
	      C
	      /	     True if the current absolute path has at least n elements
		     relative  to  the root directory, hence / is counted as 0
		     elements.
	      c
	      .
	      ~	     True if the current path, with prefix replacement, has at
		     least  n elements relative to the root directory, hence /
		     is counted as 0 elements.
	      D	     True if the month is equal to n (January = 0).
	      d	     True if the day of the month is equal to n.
	      g	     True if the effective gid of the current process is n.
	      j	     True if the number of jobs is at least n.
	      L	     True if the SHLVL parameter is at least n.
	      l	     True if at least n characters have already	 been  printed
		     on the current line.
	      S	     True if the SECONDS parameter is at least n.
	      T	     True if the time in hours is equal to n.
	      t	     True if the time in minutes is equal to n.
	      v	     True if the array psvar has at least n elements.
	      w	     True if the day of the week is equal to n (Sunday = 0).

       %<string<
       %>string>
       %[xstring]
	      Specifies	 truncation  behaviour for the remainder of the prompt
	      string.	The  third,  deprecated,   form	  is   equivalent   to
	      `%xstringx',  i.e.  x  may be `<' or `>'.	 The numeric argument,
	      which in the third form may appear immediately  after  the  `[',
	      specifies	 the  maximum  permitted length of the various strings
	      that can be displayed in the prompt.  The string	will  be  dis‐
	      played  in  place	 of  the truncated portion of any string; note
	      this does not undergo prompt expansion.

	      The forms with `<' truncate at the left of the string,  and  the
	      forms  with  `>' truncate at the right of the string.  For exam‐
	      ple, if  the  current  directory	is  `/home/pike',  the	prompt
	      `%8<..<%/'  will expand to `..e/pike'.  In this string, the ter‐
	      minating character (`<', `>' or `]'), or in fact any  character,
	      may be quoted by a preceding `\'; note when using print -P, how‐
	      ever, that this must be doubled as the string is also subject to
	      standard	print  processing,  in	addition  to  any  backslashes
	      removed by a double quoted string:  the worst case is  therefore
	      `print -P "%<\\\\<<..."'.

	      If the string is longer than the specified truncation length, it
	      will appear in full, completely replacing the truncated string.

	      The part of the prompt string to be truncated runs to the end of
	      the  string,  or	to  the end of the next enclosing group of the
	      `%(' construct, or to the next  truncation  encountered  at  the
	      same  grouping  level  (i.e. truncations inside a `%(' are sepa‐
	      rate), which ever comes first.  In particular, a truncation with
	      argument	zero  (e.g.  `%<<')  marks the end of the range of the
	      string to be truncated while turning off truncation  from	 there
	      on.  For	example,  the  prompt  '%10<...<%~%<<%# ' will print a
	      truncated representation of the current directory, followed by a
	      `%'  or  `#', followed by a space.  Without the `%<<', those two
	      characters would be included in the string to be truncated.

ZSHEXPN(1)							    ZSHEXPN(1)

NAME
       zshexpn - zsh expansion and substitution

DESCRIPTION
       The following types of expansions are performed in the indicated	 order
       in five steps:

       History Expansion
	      This is performed only in interactive shells.

       Alias Expansion
	      Aliases  are  expanded  immediately  before  the command line is
	      parsed as explained under Aliasing in zshmisc(1).

       Process Substitution
       Parameter Expansion
       Command Substitution
       Arithmetic Expansion
       Brace Expansion
	      These five are performed in one step in  left-to-right  fashion.
	      After  these expansions, all unquoted occurrences of the charac‐
	      ters `\', `'' and `"' are removed.

       Filename Expansion
	      If the SH_FILE_EXPANSION option is set, the order	 of  expansion
	      is  modified  for	 compatibility	with sh and ksh.  In that case
	      filename expansion is performed immediately after	 alias	expan‐
	      sion, preceding the set of five expansions mentioned above.

       Filename Generation
	      This expansion, commonly referred to as globbing, is always done
	      last.

       The following sections explain the types of expansion in detail.

HISTORY EXPANSION
       History expansion allows you to use words from previous	command	 lines
       in  the	command line you are typing.  This simplifies spelling correc‐
       tions and the repetition of complicated commands or arguments.  Immedi‐
       ately  before execution, each command is saved in the history list, the
       size of which is controlled by the HISTSIZE parameter.	The  one  most
       recent  command	is always retained in any case.	 Each saved command in
       the history list is called a history event and is  assigned  a  number,
       beginning  with	1  (one) when the shell starts up.  The history number
       that you may see in your prompt (see Prompt Expansion in zshmisc(1)) is
       the number that is to be assigned to the next command.

   Overview
       A  history  expansion  begins with the first character of the histchars
       parameter, which is `!' by default, and may occur anywhere on the  com‐
       mand line; history expansions do not nest.  The `!' can be escaped with
       `\' or can be enclosed between a pair of single quotes ('') to suppress
       its  special meaning.  Double quotes will not work for this.  Following
       this history character is an optional event designator (see the section
       `Event  Designators') and then an optional word designator (the section
       `Word Designators'); if neither of these	 designators  is  present,  no
       history expansion occurs.

       Input  lines  containing	 history  expansions  are  echoed  after being
       expanded, but before any other expansions take  place  and  before  the
       command	is executed.  It is this expanded form that is recorded as the
       history event for later references.

       By default, a history reference with no event designator refers to  the
       same  event as any preceding history reference on that command line; if
       it is the only history reference in a command, it refers to the	previ‐
       ous  command.   However,	 if the option CSH_JUNKIE_HISTORY is set, then
       every history reference with no event specification  always  refers  to
       the previous command.

       For  example,  `!' is the event designator for the previous command, so
       `!!:1' always refers to the first word of  the  previous	 command,  and
       `!!$'  always  refers  to  the last word of the previous command.  With
       CSH_JUNKIE_HISTORY set, then `!:1' and `!$' function in the same manner
       as  `!!:1'  and `!!$', respectively.  Conversely, if CSH_JUNKIE_HISTORY
       is unset, then `!:1' and `!$'  refer  to	 the  first  and  last	words,
       respectively, of the same event referenced by the nearest other history
       reference preceding them on the current command line, or to the	previ‐
       ous command if there is no preceding reference.

       The  character  sequence	 `^foo^bar'  (where `^' is actually the second
       character of the histchars parameter) repeats the last command, replac‐
       ing  the string foo with bar.  More precisely, the sequence `^foo^bar^'
       is synonymous with `!!:s^foo^bar^', hence other modifiers (see the sec‐
       tion `Modifiers') may follow the final `^'.

       If  the shell encounters the character sequence `!"'  in the input, the
       history mechanism is temporarily disabled until the current  list  (see
       zshmisc(1))  is	fully parsed.  The `!"' is removed from the input, and
       any subsequent `!' characters have no special significance.

       A less convenient but more comprehensible form of command history  sup‐
       port is provided by the fc builtin.

   Event Designators
       An  event designator is a reference to a command-line entry in the his‐
       tory list.  In the list below, remember that the initial	 `!'  in  each
       item  may  be  changed  to  another  character by setting the histchars
       parameter.

       !      Start a history expansion, except when followed by a blank, new‐
	      line,  `=' or `('.  If followed immediately by a word designator
	      (see the section `Word Designators'), this forms a history  ref‐
	      erence with no event designator (see the section `Overview').

       !!     Refer  to	 the  previous	command.   By  itself,	this expansion
	      repeats the previous command.

       !n     Refer to command-line n.

       !-n    Refer to the current command-line minus n.

       !str   Refer to the most recent command starting with str.

       !?str[?]
	      Refer to the most recent command containing str.	 The  trailing
	      `?'  is necessary if this reference is to be followed by a modi‐
	      fier or followed by any text that is not to be  considered  part
	      of str.

       !#     Refer  to the current command line typed in so far.  The line is
	      treated as if it were complete up	 to  and  including  the  word
	      before the one with the `!#' reference.

       !{...} Insulate a history reference from adjacent characters (if neces‐
	      sary).

   Word Designators
       A word designator indicates which word or words of a given command line
       are to be included in a history reference.  A `:' usually separates the
       event specification from the word designator.  It may be	 omitted  only
       if  the	word designator begins with a `^', `$', `*', `-' or `%'.  Word
       designators include:

       0      The first input word (command).
       n      The nth argument.
       ^      The first argument.  That is, 1.
       $      The last argument.
       %      The word matched by (the most recent) ?str search.
       x-y    A range of words; x defaults to 0.
       *      All the arguments, or a null value if there are none.
       x*     Abbreviates `x-$'.
       x-     Like `x*' but omitting word $.

       Note that a `%' word designator works only when used in	one  of	 `!%',
       `!:%'  or `!?str?:%', and only when used after a !? expansion (possibly
       in an earlier command).	Anything else results in  an  error,  although
       the error may not be the most obvious one.

   Modifiers
       After  the  optional  word designator, you can add a sequence of one or
       more of the following modifiers, each preceded by a `:'.	  These	 modi‐
       fiers  also  work  on  the  result of filename generation and parameter
       expansion, except where noted.

       h      Remove a trailing pathname component, leaving  the  head.	  This
	      works like `dirname'.

       r      Remove a filename extension of the form `.xxx', leaving the root
	      name.

       e      Remove all but the extension.

       t      Remove all leading pathname components, leaving the tail.	  This
	      works like `basename'.

       p      Print  the  new  command but do not execute it.  Only works with
	      history expansion.

       q      Quote the substituted  words,  escaping  further	substitutions.
	      Works with history expansion and parameter expansion, though for
	      parameters it is only useful if the  resulting  text  is	to  be
	      re-evaluated such as by eval.

       Q      Remove one level of quotes from the substituted words.

       x      Like  q, but break into words at whitespace.  Does not work with
	      parameter expansion.

       l      Convert the words to all lowercase.

       u      Convert the words to all uppercase.

       s/l/r[/]
	      Substitute r for l as described below.  Unless preceded  immedi‐
	      ately  by	 a  g, with no colon between, the substitution is done
	      only for the first string that matches l.	 For  arrays  and  for
	      filename	generation,  this applies to each word of the expanded
	      text.

       &      Repeat the previous s substitution.  Like	 s,  may  be  preceded
	      immediately  by  a  g.  In parameter expansion the & must appear
	      inside braces, and in filename generation it must be quoted with
	      a backslash.

       The  s/l/r/  substitution works as follows.  The left-hand side of sub‐
       stitutions are not regular expressions,	but  character	strings.   Any
       character  can  be  used as the delimiter in place of `/'.  A backslash
       quotes  the  delimiter  character.    The   character   `&',   in   the
       right-hand-side	r,  is replaced by the text from the left-hand-side l.
       The `&' can be quoted with a backslash.	A null	l  uses	 the  previous
       string  either from the previous l or from the contextual scan string s
       from `!?s'.  You can omit the rightmost delimiter if a newline  immedi‐
       ately  follows  r; the rightmost `?' in a context scan can similarly be
       omitted.	 Note the same record of the last l and r is maintained across
       all forms of expansion.

       The  following  f, F, w and W modifiers work only with parameter expan‐
       sion and filename generation.  They are listed here to provide a single
       point of reference for all modifiers.

       f      Repeats  the  immediately	 (without  a colon) following modifier
	      until the resulting word doesn't change any more.

       F:expr:
	      Like f, but repeats only n times if the expression  expr	evalu‐
	      ates  to	n.   Any  character can be used instead of the `:'; if
	      `(', `[', or `{' is used as the opening delimiter,  the  closing
	      delimiter should be ')', `]', or `}', respectively.

       w      Makes  the  immediately  following modifier work on each word in
	      the string.

       W:sep: Like w but words are considered to be the parts  of  the	string
	      that  are separated by sep. Any character can be used instead of
	      the `:'; opening parentheses are handled specially, see above.

PROCESS SUBSTITUTION
       Each command argument of the form `<(list)', `>(list)' or `=(list)'  is
       subject	to process substitution.  In the case of the < or > forms, the
       shell runs process list asynchronously.	If  the	 system	 supports  the
       /dev/fd	mechanism, the command argument is the name of the device file
       corresponding to a file descriptor; otherwise, if the  system  supports
       named pipes (FIFOs), the command argument will be a named pipe.	If the
       form with > is selected then writing on this special file will  provide
       input for list.	If < is used, then the file passed as an argument will
       be connected to the output of the list process.	For example,

	      paste <(cut -f1 file1) <(cut -f3 file2) |
	      tee >(process1) >(process2) >/dev/null

       cuts fields 1 and 3 from the files file1 and file2 respectively, pastes
       the  results  together,	and  sends  it	to  the processes process1 and
       process2.

       If =(...) is used instead of <(...), then the file passed as  an	 argu‐
       ment  will be the name of a temporary file containing the output of the
       list process.  This may be used instead of the <	 form  for  a  program
       that expects to lseek (see lseek(2)) on the input file.

       The = form is useful as both the /dev/fd and the named pipe implementa‐
       tion of <(...) have drawbacks.  In the former case, some programmes may
       automatically  close  the  file descriptor in question before examining
       the file on the command line, particularly if  this  is	necessary  for
       security	 reasons such as when the programme is running setuid.	In the
       second case, if the programme does not actually open the file, the sub‐
       shell  attempting  to read from or write to the pipe will (in a typical
       implementation, different operating systems may have  different	behav‐
       iour)  block for ever and have to be killed explicitly.	In both cases,
       the shell actually supplies the information using a pipe, so that  pro‐
       grammes that expect to lseek (see lseek(2)) on the file will not work.

       Also  note  that	 the  previous example can be more compactly and effi‐
       ciently written (provided the MULTIOS option is set) as:

	      paste <(cut -f1 file1) <(cut -f3 file2) \
	      > >(process1) > >(process2)

       The shell uses pipes instead of	FIFOs  to  implement  the  latter  two
       process substitutions in the above example.

       There  is  an additional problem with >(process); when this is attached
       to an external command, the parent shell does not wait for  process  to
       finish  and  hence  an immediately following command cannot rely on the
       results being complete.	The problem  and  solution  are	 the  same  as
       described  in the section MULTIOS in zshmisc(1).	 Hence in a simplified
       version of the example above:

	      paste <(cut -f1 file1) <(cut -f3 file2) > >(process)

       (note that  no  MULTIOS	are  involved),	 process  will	be  run	 asyn‐
       chronously.  The workaround is:

	      { paste <(cut -f1 file1) <(cut -f3 file2) } > >(process)

       The  extra  processes here are spawned from the parent shell which will
       wait for their completion.

PARAMETER EXPANSION
       The character `$' is used to introduce parameter expansions.  See  zsh‐
       param(1) for a description of parameters, including arrays, associative
       arrays, and subscript notation to access individual array elements.

       Note in particular the fact that words of unquoted parameters  are  not
       automatically  split  on	 whitespace unless the option SH_WORD_SPLIT is
       set; see references to this option below for more details.  This is  an
       important difference from other shells.

       In  the	expansions discussed below that require a pattern, the form of
       the pattern is the same as that used for filename generation;  see  the
       section	`Filename  Generation'.	  Note that these patterns, along with
       the replacement text of any substitutions, are  themselves  subject  to
       parameter  expansion,  command  substitution, and arithmetic expansion.
       In addition to the following operations, the colon modifiers  described
       in  the	section	 `Modifiers' in the section `History Expansion' can be
       applied:	 for example, ${i:s/foo/bar/} performs string substitution  on
       the expansion of parameter $i.

       ${name}
	      The  value,  if  any, of the parameter name is substituted.  The
	      braces are required if the expansion is to be followed by a let‐
	      ter,  digit, or underscore that is not to be interpreted as part
	      of name.	In addition, more complicated  forms  of  substitution
	      usually require the braces to be present; exceptions, which only
	      apply if the option KSH_ARRAYS is not set,  are  a  single  sub‐
	      script  or  any colon modifiers appearing after the name, or any
	      of the characters `^', `=', `~', `#' or `+' appearing before the
	      name, all of which work with or without braces.

	      If  name is an array parameter, and the KSH_ARRAYS option is not
	      set, then the value of each element of name is substituted,  one
	      element  per word.  Otherwise, the expansion results in one word
	      only; with KSH_ARRAYS, this is the first element	of  an	array.
	      No   field   splitting   is   done  on  the  result  unless  the
	      SH_WORD_SPLIT option is set.

       ${+name}
	      If name is the name of a set parameter `1' is substituted,  oth‐
	      erwise `0' is substituted.

       ${name:-word}
	      If name is set and is non-null then substitute its value; other‐
	      wise substitute word. If name is missing, substitute word.

       ${name:=word}
       ${name::=word}
	      In the first form, if name is unset or is null then  set	it  to
	      word;  in the second form, unconditionally set name to word.  In
	      both forms, the value of the parameter is then substituted.

       ${name:?word}
	      If name is set and is non-null then substitute its value; other‐
	      wise,  print  word  and exit from the shell.  Interactive shells
	      instead return to the prompt.  If word is omitted, then a	 stan‐
	      dard message is printed.

       ${name:+word}
	      If  name	is set and is non-null then substitute word; otherwise
	      substitute nothing.

       If the colon is omitted from one of the above expressions containing  a
       colon,  then the shell only checks whether name is set, not whether its
       value is null.

       In the following expressions, when name is an array and	the  substitu‐
       tion is not quoted, or if the `(@)' flag or the name[@] syntax is used,
       matching and replacement is performed on each array element separately.

       ${name#pattern}
       ${name##pattern}
	      If the pattern matches the beginning of the value of name,  then
	      substitute  the  value of name with the matched portion deleted;
	      otherwise, just substitute the value  of	name.	In  the	 first
	      form,  the smallest matching pattern is preferred; in the second
	      form, the largest matching pattern is preferred.

       ${name%pattern}
       ${name%%pattern}
	      If the pattern matches the end of the value of name,  then  sub‐
	      stitute the value of name with the matched portion deleted; oth‐
	      erwise, just substitute the value of name.  In the  first	 form,
	      the  smallest matching pattern is preferred; in the second form,
	      the largest matching pattern is preferred.

       ${name:#pattern}
	      If the pattern matches the value of name,	 then  substitute  the
	      empty  string; otherwise, just substitute the value of name.  If
	      name is an array the matching array elements  are	 removed  (use
	      the `(M)' flag to remove the non-matched elements).

       ${name/pattern/repl}
       ${name//pattern/repl}
	      Replace  the  longest possible match of pattern in the expansion
	      of parameter name by string repl.	 The first form replaces  just
	      the  first  occurrence,  the  second form all occurrences.  Both
	      pattern and repl are subject to double-quoted  substitution,  so
	      that  expressions	 like  ${name/$opat/$npat} will work, but note
	      the usual rule that pattern characters in $opat are not  treated
	      specially	 unless	 either the option GLOB_SUBST is set, or $opat
	      is instead substituted as ${~opat}.

	      The pattern may begin with a `#', in which case the pattern must
	      match  at the start of the string, or `%', in which case it must
	      match at the end of the  string.	 The  repl  may	 be  an	 empty
	      string,  in  which  case	the final `/' may also be omitted.  To
	      quote the final `/' in other cases it should be  preceded	 by  a
	      single backslash; this is not necessary if the `/' occurs inside
	      a substituted parameter.	Note also that the `#' and `%' are not
	      active if they occur inside a substituted parameter, even at the
	      start.

	      The first `/' may be preceded by a `:', in which case the	 match
	      will  only succeed if it matches the entire word.	 Note also the
	      effect of the I and S parameter expansion flags below;  however,
	      the flags M, R, B, E and N are not useful.

	      For example,

		     foo="twinkle twinkle little star" sub="t*e" rep="spy"
		     print ${foo//${~sub}/$rep}
		     print ${(S)foo//${~sub}/$rep}

	      Here, the `~' ensures that the text of $sub is treated as a pat‐
	      tern rather than a plain string.	In the first case, the longest
	      match for t*e is substituted and the result is `spy star', while
	      in the second case, the  shortest	 matches  are  taken  and  the
	      result is `spy spy lispy star'.

       ${#spec}
	      If spec is one of the above substitutions, substitute the length
	      in characters of the result instead of the  result  itself.   If
	      spec  is	an array expression, substitute the number of elements
	      of the result.  Note that `^', `=', and `~', below, must	appear
	      to the left of `#' when these forms are combined.

       ${^spec}
	      Turn  on	the RC_EXPAND_PARAM option for the evaluation of spec;
	      if the `^' is doubled, turn it off.  When this  option  is  set,
	      array expansions of the form foo${xx}bar, where the parameter xx
	      is set to	 (a  b	c),  are  substituted  with  `fooabar  foobbar
	      foocbar' instead of the default `fooa b cbar'.

	      Internally, each such expansion is converted into the equivalent
	      list   for   brace    expansion.	   E.g.,    ${^var}    becomes
	      {$var[1],$var[2],...}, and is processed as described in the sec‐
	      tion `Brace Expansion' below.  If	 word  splitting  is  also  in
	      effect  the  $var[N] may themselves be split into different list
	      elements.

       ${=spec}
	      Perform word splitting using the rules for SH_WORD_SPLIT	during
	      the  evaluation of spec, but regardless of whether the parameter
	      appears in double quotes; if the `=' is doubled,	turn  it  off.
	      This forces parameter expansions to be split into separate words
	      before substitution, using IFS as a delimiter.  This is done  by
	      default in most other shells.

	      Note  that  splitting is applied to word in the assignment forms
	      of spec before  the  assignment  to  name	 is  performed.	  This
	      affects the result of array assignments with the A flag.

       ${~spec}
	      Turn on the GLOB_SUBST option for the evaluation of spec; if the
	      `~' is doubled, turn it off.   When  this	 option	 is  set,  the
	      string  resulting	 from  the  expansion will be interpreted as a
	      pattern anywhere that is possible, such as in filename expansion
	      and  filename  generation and pattern-matching contexts like the
	      right hand side of the `=' and `!=' operators in conditions.

       If a ${...} type parameter expression or a $(...) type command  substi‐
       tution  is  used	 in  place of name above, it is expanded first and the
       result is used as if it were the value of name.	Thus it is possible to
       perform	nested	operations:  ${${foo#head}%tail} substitutes the value
       of $foo with both `head' and `tail' deleted.  The form with  $(...)  is
       often  useful  in  combination  with  the flags described next; see the
       examples below.	Each name or nested ${...} in  a  parameter  expansion
       may  also  be  followed by a subscript expression as described in Array
       Parameters in zshparam(1).

       Note that double quotes may appear around nested expressions, in	 which
       case   only  the	 part  inside  is  treated  as	quoted;	 for  example,
       ${(f)"$(foo)"} quotes the result of $(foo), but	the  flag  `(f)'  (see
       below)  is  applied using the rules for unquoted expansions.  Note fur‐
       ther that quotes are themselves nested in this context; for example, in
       "${(@f)"$(foo)"}",  there  are  two sets of quotes, one surrounding the
       whole expression, the  other  (redundant)  surrounding  the  $(foo)  as
       before.

   Parameter Expansion Flags
       If  the	opening	 brace is directly followed by an opening parenthesis,
       the string up to the matching closing parenthesis will be  taken	 as  a
       list of flags.  In cases where repeating a flag is meaningful, the rep‐
       etitions need not be consecutive; for example, `(q%q%q)' means the same
       thing  as  the  more  readable `(%%qqq)'.  The following flags are sup‐
       ported:

       %      Expand all % escapes in the resulting words in the same  way  as
	      in in prompts (see the section `Prompt Expansion'). If this flag
	      is given twice, full prompt expansion is done on	the  resulting
	      words,   depending   on	the  setting  of  the  PROMPT_PERCENT,
	      PROMPT_SUBST and PROMPT_BANG options.

       @      In double quotes, array elements are put	into  separate	words.
	      E.g.,   `"${(@)foo}"'   is   equivalent	to  `"${foo[@]}"'  and
	      `"${(@)foo[1,2]}"' is the same as `"$foo[1]"  "$foo[2]"'.	  This
	      is  distinct  from  field	 splitting by the the f, s or z flags,
	      which still applies within each array element.

       A      Create an array parameter with  `${...=...}',  `${...:=...}'  or
	      `${...::=...}'.	If  this flag is repeated (as in `AA'), create
	      an associative array parameter.  Assignment is made before sort‐
	      ing  or  padding.	  The name part may be a subscripted range for
	      ordinary arrays; the word part must be converted	to  an	array,
	      for example by using `${(AA)=name=...}' to activate field split‐
	      ting, when creating an associative array.

       a      With o or O, sort in array index order. Note that `oa' is there‐
	      fore  equivalent to the default but `Oa' is useful for obtaining
	      an array's elements in reverse order.

       c      With ${#name}, count the total number of characters in an array,
	      as if the elements were concatenated with spaces between them.

       C      Capitalize  the resulting words.	`Words' in this case refers to
	      sequences of alphanumeric characters separated  by  non-alphanu‐
	      merics, not to words that result from field splitting.

       e      Perform parameter expansion, command substitution and arithmetic
	      expansion on the result. Such expansions can be nested  but  too
	      deep recursion may have unpredictable effects.

       f      Split  the result of the expansion to lines. This is a shorthand
	      for `ps:\n:'.

       F      Join the words of arrays together using newline as a  separator.
	      This is a shorthand for `pj:\n:'.

       i      With o or O, sort case-independently.

       k      If  name	refers	to  an	associative array, substitute the keys
	      (element names) rather than the values of	 the  elements.	  Used
	      with  subscripts	(including  ordinary arrays), force indices or
	      keys to be substituted even if the subscript form refers to val‐
	      ues.   However,  this  flag  may	not be combined with subscript
	      ranges.

       L      Convert all letters in the result to lower case.

       n      With o or O, sort numerically.

       o      Sort the resulting words in ascending order.

       O      Sort the resulting words in descending order.

       P      This forces the value of the parameter name to be interpreted as
	      a	 further parameter name, whose value will be used where appro‐
	      priate. If used with a nested parameter or command substitution,
	      the result of that will be taken as a parameter name in the same
	      way.  For example, if you	 have  `foo=bar'  and  `bar=baz',  the
	      strings  ${(P)foo},  ${(P)${foo}}, and ${(P)$(echo bar)} will be
	      expanded to `baz'.

       q      Quote the resulting words with  backslashes.  If	this  flag  is
	      given twice, the resulting words are quoted in single quotes and
	      if it is given three times,  the	words  are  quoted  in	double
	      quotes.  If it is given four times, the words are quoted in sin‐
	      gle quotes preceded by a $.

       Q      Remove one level of quotes from the resulting words.

       t      Use a string describing the type	of  the	 parameter  where  the
	      value  of	 the  parameter would usually appear. This string con‐
	      sists of keywords separated by hyphens (`-'). The first  keyword
	      in  the  string  describes  the  main  type,  it	can  be one of
	      `scalar', `array',  `integer',  `float'  or  `association'.  The
	      other keywords describe the type in more detail:

	      local  for local parameters

	      left   for left justified parameters

	      right_blanks
		     for right justified parameters with leading blanks

	      right_zeros
		     for right justified parameters with leading zeros

	      lower  for parameters whose value is converted to all lower case
		     when it is expanded

	      upper  for parameters whose value is converted to all upper case
		     when it is expanded

	      readonly
		     for readonly parameters

	      tag    for tagged parameters

	      export for exported parameters

	      unique for arrays which keep only the first occurrence of dupli‐
		     cated values

	      hide   for parameters with the `hide' flag

	      special
		     for special parameters defined by the shell

       u      Expand only the first occurrence of each unique word.

       U      Convert all letters in the result to upper case.

       v      Used with k, substitute (as two consecutive words) both the  key
	      and the value of each associative array element.	Used with sub‐
	      scripts, force values to be substituted even  if	the  subscript
	      form refers to indices or keys.

       V      Make any special characters in the resulting words visible.

       w      With  ${#name}, count words in arrays or strings; the s flag may
	      be used to set a word delimiter.

       W      Similar to w  with  the  difference  that	 empty	words  between
	      repeated delimiters are also counted.

       X      With  this  flag parsing errors occurring with the Q and e flags
	      or the pattern matching  forms  such  as	`${name#pattern}'  are
	      reported. Without the flag they are silently ignored.

       z      Split the result of the expansion into words using shell parsing
	      to find the words, i.e. taking into account any quoting  in  the
	      value.

	      Note  that  this is done very late, as for the `(s)' flag. So to
	      access single words in the result, one has to use nested	expan‐
	      sions as in `${${(z)foo}[2]}'. Likewise, to remove the quotes in
	      the resulting words one would do: `${(Q)${(z)foo}}'.

       The following flags (except p) are followed by one or more arguments as
       shown.  Any character, or the matching pairs `(...)', `{...}', `[...]',
       or `<...>', may be used in place of a colon  as	delimiters,  but  note
       that when a flag takes more than one argument, a matched pair of delim‐
       iters must surround each argument.

       p      Recognize the same escape sequences  as  the  print  builtin  in
	      string arguments to any of the flags described below.

       j:string:
	      Join  the	 words of arrays together using string as a separator.
	      Note  that  this	occurs	 before	  field	  splitting   by   the
	      SH_WORD_SPLIT option.

       l:expr::string1::string2:
	      Pad  the	resulting  words on the left.  Each word will be trun‐
	      cated if required and placed in a field  expr  characters	 wide.
	      The  space to the left will be filled with string1 (concatenated
	      as often as needed) or spaces if string1 is not given.  If  both
	      string1  and  string2  are  given,  this string is inserted once
	      directly to the left of each word, before padding.

       r:expr::string1::string2:
	      As l, but pad the words on the right and insert string2  on  the
	      right.

       s:string:
	      Force field splitting (see the option SH_WORD_SPLIT) at the sep‐
	      arator string.  Note that a string of  two  or  more  characters
	      means  all  must	all  match  in sequence; this differs from the
	      treatment of two or more characters in the IFS parameter.

       The following flags are meaningful with the  ${...#...}	or  ${...%...}
       forms.  The S and I flags may also be used with the ${.../...} forms.

       S      Search  substrings  as  well as beginnings or ends; with # start
	      from the beginning and with % start from the end of the  string.
	      With  substitution  via  ${.../...}  or  ${...//...},  specifies
	      non-greedy matching, i.e. that the shortest instead of the long‐
	      est match should be replaced.

       I:expr:
	      Search  the  exprth  match  (where  expr evaluates to a number).
	      This only applies when searching for substrings, either with the
	      S	 flag,	or  with  ${.../...} (only the exprth match is substi‐
	      tuted) or ${...//...} (all matches from the exprth on  are  sub‐
	      stituted).  The default is to take the first match.

	      The  exprth  match  is  counted such that there is either one or
	      zero matches from each starting position in the string, although
	      for  global  substitution	 matches overlapping previous replace‐
	      ments are ignored.  With the ${...%...} and  ${...%%...}	forms,
	      the starting position for the match moves backwards from the end
	      as the index increases, while with the other forms it moves for‐
	      ward from the start.

	      Hence with the string
		     which switch is the right switch for Ipswich?
	      substitutions  of	 the form ${(SI:N:)string#w*ch} as N increases
	      from 1 will match	 and  remove  `which',	`witch',  `witch'  and
	      `wich';  the form using `##' will match and remove `which switch
	      is the right switch for Ipswich', `witch is the right switch for
	      Ipswich',	 `witch	 for  Ipswich'	and `wich'. The form using `%'
	      will remove the same matches as for `#', but in  reverse	order,
	      and the form using `%%' will remove the same matches as for `##'
	      in reverse order.

       B      Include the index of the beginning of the match in the result.

       E      Include the index of the end of the match in the result.

       M      Include the matched portion in the result.

       N      Include the length of the match in the result.

       R      Include the unmatched portion in the result (the Rest).

   Rules
       Here is a summary of the rules  for  substitution;  this	 assumes  that
       braces are present around the substitution, i.e. ${...}.	 Some particu‐
       lar examples are given below.  Note  that  the  Zsh  Development	 Group
       accepts	no  responsibility for any brain damage which may occur during
       the reading of the following rules.

       1. Nested Substitution
	      If multiple nested ${...} forms  are  present,  substitution  is
	      performed	 from the inside outwards.  At each level, the substi‐
	      tution takes account of whether the current value is a scalar or
	      an  array,  whether  the whole substitution is in double quotes,
	      and what flags are supplied to the current  level	 of  substitu‐
	      tion,  just  as  if  the nested substitution were the outermost.
	      The flags are not propagated up to enclosing substitutions;  the
	      nested  substitution  will return either a scalar or an array as
	      determined by the flags, possibly adjusted for quoting.  All the
	      following	 steps	take  place  where applicable at all levels of
	      substitution.  Note that, unless the `(P)' flag is present,  the
	      flags  and  any  subscripts  apply  directly to the value of the
	      nested  substitution;  for  example,  the	 expansion   ${${foo}}
	      behaves exactly the same as ${foo}.

       2. Parameter Subscripting
	      If the value is a raw parameter reference with a subscript, such
	      as ${var[3]}, the effect of subscripting is applied directly  to
	      the  parameter.	Subscripts are evaluated left to right; subse‐
	      quent subscripts apply to the scalar or array value  yielded  by
	      the  previous  subscript.	 Thus if var is an array, ${var[1][2]}
	      is the second character of the first word, but ${var[2,4][2]} is
	      the entire third word (the second word of the range of words two
	      through four of the original array).  Any number	of  subscripts
	      may appear.

       3. Parameter Name Replacement
	      The  effect  of any (P) flag, which treats the value so far as a
	      parameter name and replaces it with the corresponding value,  is
	      applied.

       4. Double-Quoted Joining
	      If  the  value after this process is an array, and the substitu‐
	      tion appears in double quotes, and no (@) flag is present at the
	      current  level, the words of the value are joined with the first
	      character of the parameter $IFS, by  default  a  space,  between
	      each  word  (single  word	 arrays are not modified).  If the (j)
	      flag is present, that is used for joining instead of $IFS.

       5. Nested Subscripting
	      Any remaining subscripts (i.e. of	 a  nested  substitution)  are
	      evaluated	 at this point, based on whether the value is an array
	      or a scalar.  As with 2., multiple subscripts can appear.	  Note
	      that  ${foo[2,4][2]} is thus equivalent to ${${foo[2,4]}[2]} and
	      also to "${${(@)foo[2,4]}[2]}" (the nested substitution  returns
	      an  array	 in  both  cases), but not to "${${foo[2,4]}[2]}" (the
	      nested substitution returns a scalar because of the quotes).

       6. Modifiers
	      Any modifiers, as specified by a trailing `#', `%', `/'  (possi‐
	      bly  doubled) or by a set of modifiers of the form :... (see the
	      section `Modifiers' in the  section  `History  Expansion'),  are
	      applied to the words of the value at this level.

       7. Forced Joining
	      If  the  `(j)'  flag is present, or no `(j)' flag is present but
	      the string is to be split as given by rules 8. or 9., and	 join‐
	      ing  did	not  take place at step 4., any words in the value are
	      joined together using the given string or the first character of
	      $IFS  if	none.	Note that the `(F)' flag implicitly supplies a
	      string for joining in this manner.

       8. Forced Splitting
	      If one of the `(s)', `(f)' or `(z)' flags are  present,  or  the
	      `='  specifier  was present (e.g. ${=var}), the word is split on
	      occurrences of the specified string, or (for = with  neither  of
	      the two flags present) any of the characters in $IFS.

       9. Shell Word Splitting
	      If  no `(s)', `(f)' or `=' was given, but the word is not quoted
	      and the option SH_WORD_SPLIT is set, the word is split on occur‐
	      rences  of  any of the characters in $IFS.  Note this step, too,
	      takes place at all levels of a nested substitution.

       10. Uniqueness
	      If the result is an array and the `(u)' flag was present, dupli‐
	      cate elements are removed from the array.

       11. Ordering
	      If  the  result  is still an array and one of the `(o)' or `(O)'
	      flags was present, the array is reordered.

       12. Re-Evaluation
	      Any `(e)' flag is	 applied  to  the  value,  forcing  it	to  be
	      re-examined  for	new parameter substitutions, but also for com‐
	      mand and arithmetic substitutions.

       13. Padding
	      Any padding of the value by the `(l.fill.)' or `(r.fill.)' flags
	      is applied.

       14. Semantic Joining
	      In  contexts where expansion semantics requires a single word to
	      result, all words are rejoined with the first character  of  IFS
	      between.	 So  in	 `${(P)${(f)lines}}'  the value of ${lines} is
	      split at newlines, but then must be joined again	before	the  P
	      flag can be applied.

	      If a single word is not required, this rule is skipped.

   Examples
       The  flag  f  is	 useful	 to split a double-quoted substitution line by
       line.  For example, ${(f)"$(<file)"} substitutes the contents  of  file
       divided	so  that each line is an element of the resulting array.  Com‐
       pare this with the effect of $(<file) alone, which divides the file  up
       by words, or the same inside double quotes, which makes the entire con‐
       tent of the file a single string.

       The following illustrates the rules for	nested	parameter  expansions.
       Suppose that $foo contains the array (bar baz):

       "${(@)${foo}[1]}"
	      This  produces  the  result  b.	First,	the inner substitution
	      "${foo}", which has no array (@) flag, produces  a  single  word
	      result "bar baz".	 The outer substitution "${(@)...[1]}" detects
	      that this is a scalar, so that (despite the `(@)' flag) the sub‐
	      script picks the first character.

       "${${(@)foo}[1]}"
	      This produces the result `bar'.  In this case, the inner substi‐
	      tution "${(@)foo}" produces the array `(bar  baz)'.   The	 outer
	      substitution "${...[1]}" detects that this is an array and picks
	      the first word.  This is similar to the simple case "${foo[1]}".

       As an example of the rules for word splitting and joining, suppose $foo
       contains the array `(ax1 bx1)'.	Then

       ${(s/x/)foo}
	      produces the words `a', `1 b' and `1'.

       ${(j/x/s/x/)foo}
	      produces `a', `1', `b' and `1'.

       ${(s/x/)foo%%1*}
	      produces	`a'  and ` b' (note the extra space).  As substitution
	      occurs before either joining or splitting, the operation	 first
	      generates	 the  modified	array (ax bx), which is joined to give
	      "ax bx", and then split to give `a', ` b'	 and  `'.   The	 final
	      empty string will then be elided, as it is not in double quotes.

COMMAND SUBSTITUTION
       A  command  enclosed  in	 parentheses  preceded	by a dollar sign, like
       `$(...)', or quoted with grave accents, like ``...`', is replaced  with
       its  standard  output, with any trailing newlines deleted.  If the sub‐
       stitution is not enclosed in double quotes, the output is  broken  into
       words  using  the  IFS parameter.  The substitution `$(cat foo)' may be
       replaced by the equivalent but faster `$(<foo)'.	 In  either  case,  if
       the  option GLOB_SUBST is set, the output is eligible for filename gen‐
       eration.

ARITHMETIC EXPANSION
       A string of the form `$[exp]' or `$((exp))'  is	substituted  with  the
       value  of the arithmetic expression exp.	 exp is subjected to parameter
       expansion, command substitution and arithmetic expansion before	it  is
       evaluated.  See the section `Arithmetic Evaluation'.

BRACE EXPANSION
       A  string  of the form `foo{xx,yy,zz}bar' is expanded to the individual
       words `fooxxbar', `fooyybar' and `foozzbar'.   Left-to-right  order  is
       preserved.   This  construct  may  be  nested.  Commas may be quoted in
       order to include them literally in a word.

       An expression of the form `{n1..n2}', where n1 and n2 are integers,  is
       expanded to every number between n1 and n2 inclusive.  If either number
       begins with a zero, all the resulting numbers will be padded with lead‐
       ing  zeroes  to	that  minimum width.  If the numbers are in decreasing
       order the resulting sequence will also be in decreasing order.

       If a brace expression matches none of  the  above  forms,  it  is  left
       unchanged,  unless  the	BRACE_CCL  option is set.  In that case, it is
       expanded to a sorted list of  the  individual  characters  between  the
       braces,	in the manner of a search set.	`-' is treated specially as in
       a search set, but `^' or `!' as the first  character  is	 treated  nor‐
       mally.

       Note  that  brace  expansion  is not part of filename generation (glob‐
       bing); an expression such as */{foo,bar} is  split  into	 two  separate
       words  */foo and */bar before filename generation takes place.  In par‐
       ticular, note that this is liable to produce  a	`no  match'  error  if
       either  of the two expressions does not match; this is to be contrasted
       with */(foo|bar), which is treated as a single  pattern	but  otherwise
       has similar effects.

FILENAME EXPANSION
       Each  word  is checked to see if it begins with an unquoted `~'.	 If it
       does, then the word up to a `/', or the end of the word if there is  no
       `/',  is	 checked  to  see  if it can be substituted in one of the ways
       described here.	If so, then  the  `~'  and  the	 checked  portion  are
       replaced with the appropriate substitute value.

       A `~' by itself is replaced by the value of $HOME.  A `~' followed by a
       `+' or a `-' is replaced by the value of $PWD or $OLDPWD, respectively.

       A `~' followed by a number is replaced by the directory at  that	 posi‐
       tion  in	 the directory stack.  `~0' is equivalent to `~+', and `~1' is
       the top of the stack.  `~+' followed by a number	 is  replaced  by  the
       directory at that position in the directory stack.  `~+0' is equivalent
       to `~+', and `~+1' is the top of the stack.  `~-' followed by a	number
       is replaced by the directory that many positions from the bottom of the
       stack.  `~-0' is the bottom  of	the  stack.   The  PUSHD_MINUS	option
       exchanges  the  effects	of  `~+' and `~-' where they are followed by a
       number.

       A `~' followed by anything not already covered is looked up as a	 named
       directory,  and replaced by the value of that named directory if found.
       Named directories are typically home directories for users on the  sys‐
       tem.  They may also be defined if the text after the `~' is the name of
       a string shell parameter whose value begins with a  `/'.	  It  is  also
       possible	 to  define  directory	names  using the -d option to the hash
       builtin.

       In certain circumstances (in prompts, for  instance),  when  the	 shell
       prints  a  path, the path is checked to see if it has a named directory
       as its prefix.  If so, then the prefix portion is replaced with	a  `~'
       followed	 by  the name of the directory.	 The shortest way of referring
       to the directory is used, with ties broken in favour of using  a	 named
       directory,  except when the directory is / itself.  The parameters $PWD
       and $OLDPWD are never abbreviated in this fashion.

       If a word begins with an unquoted `=' and the EQUALS option is set, the
       remainder  of the word is taken as the name of a command.  If a command
       exists by that name, the word is replaced by the full pathname  of  the
       command.

       Filename	 expansion  is performed on the right hand side of a parameter
       assignment, including those appearing after  commands  of  the  typeset
       family.	 In  this  case,  the  right  hand  side  will be treated as a
       colon-separated list in the manner of the PATH parameter, so that a `~'
       or  an  `=' following a `:' is eligible for expansion.  All such behav‐
       iour can be disabled by quoting the `~', the `=', or the whole  expres‐
       sion (but not simply the colon); the EQUALS option is also respected.

       If  the option MAGIC_EQUAL_SUBST is set, any unquoted shell argument in
       the form `identifier=expression' becomes eligible for file expansion as
       described  in  the  previous  paragraph.	  Quoting  the	first `=' also
       inhibits this.

FILENAME GENERATION
       If a word contains an unquoted instance of one of the  characters  `*',
       `(',  `|',  `<',	 `[', or `?', it is regarded as a pattern for filename
       generation, unless the GLOB option  is  unset.	If  the	 EXTENDED_GLOB
       option is set, the `^' and `#' characters also denote a pattern; other‐
       wise they are not treated specially by the shell.

       The word is replaced with a list of sorted  filenames  that  match  the
       pattern.	  If  no  matching  pattern is found, the shell gives an error
       message, unless the NULL_GLOB option is set, in which case the word  is
       deleted;	 or unless the NOMATCH option is unset, in which case the word
       is left unchanged.

       In filename generation, the character `/' must be  matched  explicitly;
       also, a `.' must be matched explicitly at the beginning of a pattern or
       after a `/', unless the GLOB_DOTS option is set.	 No  filename  genera‐
       tion pattern matches the files `.' or `..'.  In other instances of pat‐
       tern matching, the `/' and `.' are not treated specially.

   Glob Operators
       *      Matches any string, including the null string.

       ?      Matches any character.

       [...]  Matches any of the enclosed characters.	Ranges	of  characters
	      can  be  specified by separating two characters by a `-'.	 A `-'
	      or `]' may be matched by including it as the first character  in
	      the  list.   There are also several named classes of characters,
	      in the form `[:name:]' with the following meanings:  `[:alnum:]'
	      alphanumeric,   `[:alpha:]'   alphabetic,	  `[:ascii:]'	7-bit,
	      `[:blank:]'  space  or  tab,  `[:cntrl:]'	  control   character,
	      `[:digit:]'   decimal  digit,  `[:graph:]'  printable  character
	      except whitespace,  `[:lower:]'  lowercase  letter,  `[:print:]'
	      printable	 character,  `[:punct:]'  printable  character neither
	      alphanumeric nor whitespace, `[:space:]'	whitespace  character,
	      `[:upper:]'  uppercase  letter,  `[:xdigit:]' hexadecimal digit.
	      These use the macros provided by the operating  system  to  test
	      for  the	given  character combinations, including any modifica‐
	      tions due to local language settings:  see ctype(3).  Note  that
	      the  square brackets are additional to those enclosing the whole
	      set of characters, so to test for a single alphanumeric  charac‐
	      ter  you	need  `[[:alnum:]]'.  Named character sets can be used
	      alongside other types, e.g. `[[:alpha:]0-9]'.

       [^...]
       [!...] Like [...], except that it matches any character which is not in
	      the given set.

       <[x]-[y]>
	      Matches  any  number  in the range x to y, inclusive.  Either of
	      the numbers may be omitted to make the range  open-ended;	 hence
	      `<->' matches any number.	 To match individual digits, the [...]
	      form is more efficient.

	      Be careful when using other wildcards adjacent  to  patterns  of
	      this  form;  for	example, <0-9>* will actually match any number
	      whatsoever at the start of the string, since  the	 `<0-9>'  will
	      match  the first digit, and the `*' will match any others.  This
	      is a trap for the unwary, but is in fact	an  inevitable	conse‐
	      quence  of  the rule that the longest possible match always suc‐
	      ceeds.  Expressions such as  `<0-9>[^[:digit:]]*'	 can  be  used
	      instead.

       (...)  Matches  the  enclosed  pattern.	This is used for grouping.  If
	      the KSH_GLOB option is set, then a `@', `*',  `+',  `?'  or  `!'
	      immediately  preceding the `(' is treated specially, as detailed
	      below. The option SH_GLOB prevents bare parentheses  from	 being
	      used in this way, though the KSH_GLOB option is still available.

	      Note  that  grouping cannot extend over multiple directories: it
	      is an error to have a `/' within a group (this only applies  for
	      patterns	used in filename generation).  There is one exception:
	      a group of the form (pat/)# appearing as a complete path segment
	      can match a sequence of directories.  For example, foo/(a*/)#bar
	      matches foo/bar, foo/any/bar, foo/any/anyother/bar, and so on.

       x|y    Matches either x or y.  This operator has lower precedence  than
	      any  other.   The	 `|'  character must be within parentheses, to
	      avoid interpretation as a pipeline.

       ^x     (Requires EXTENDED_GLOB to be set.)  Matches anything except the
	      pattern x.  This has a higher precedence than `/', so `^foo/bar'
	      will search directories in `.' except `./foo' for a  file	 named
	      `bar'.

       x~y    (Requires EXTENDED_GLOB to be set.)  Match anything that matches
	      the pattern x but does not match y.  This has  lower  precedence
	      than  any	 operator except `|', so `*/*~foo/bar' will search for
	      all files in all directories in `.'  and then exclude  `foo/bar'
	      if there was such a match.  Multiple patterns can be excluded by
	      `foo~bar~baz'.  In the exclusion pattern (y), `/'	 and  `.'  are
	      not treated specially the way they usually are in globbing.

       x#     (Requires EXTENDED_GLOB to be set.)  Matches zero or more occur‐
	      rences of the pattern x.	This  operator	has  high  precedence;
	      `12#'  is	 equivalent to `1(2#)', rather than `(12)#'.  It is an
	      error for an unquoted `#' to follow something  which  cannot  be
	      repeated;	 this includes an empty string, a pattern already fol‐
	      lowed by `##', or parentheses when part of  a  KSH_GLOB  pattern
	      (for  example,  `!(foo)#'	 is  invalid  and  must be replaced by
	      `*(!(foo))').

       x##    (Requires EXTENDED_GLOB to be set.)  Matches one or more	occur‐
	      rences  of  the  pattern	x.  This operator has high precedence;
	      `12##' is equivalent to `1(2##)', rather than `(12)##'.  No more
	      than two active `#' characters may appear together.

   ksh-like Glob Operators
       If  the KSH_GLOB option is set, the effects of parentheses can be modi‐
       fied by a preceding `@', `*', `+', `?' or `!'.  This character need not
       be unquoted to have special effects, but the `(' must be.

       @(...) Match the pattern in the parentheses.  (Like `(...)'.)

       *(...) Match any number of occurrences.	(Like `(...)#'.)

       +(...) Match at least one occurrence.  (Like `(...)##'.)

       ?(...) Match zero or one occurrence.  (Like `(|...)'.)

       !(...) Match   anything	but  the  expression  in  parentheses.	 (Like
	      `(^(...))'.)

   Precedence
       The precedence of the operators given above is (highest) `^', `/', `~',
       `|'  (lowest);  the remaining operators are simply treated from left to
       right as part of a string, with `#' and `##' applying to	 the  shortest
       possible	 preceding unit (i.e. a character, `?', `[...]', `<...>', or a
       parenthesised expression).  As mentioned above, a `/' used as a	direc‐
       tory  separator	may not appear inside parentheses, while a `|' must do
       so; in patterns used in other contexts than  filename  generation  (for
       example,	 in  case statements and tests within `[[...]]'), a `/' is not
       special; and `/' is also not special  after  a  `~'  appearing  outside
       parentheses in a filename pattern.

   Globbing Flags
       There  are various flags which affect any text to their right up to the
       end of the enclosing group or to the end of the pattern;	 they  require
       the  EXTENDED_GLOB  option. All take the form (#X) where X may have one
       of the following forms:

       i      Case insensitive:	 upper or lower case characters in the pattern
	      match upper or lower case characters.

       l      Lower  case  characters in the pattern match upper or lower case
	      characters; upper case characters	 in  the  pattern  still  only
	      match upper case characters.

       I      Case  sensitive:	locally negates the effect of i or l from that
	      point on.

       b      Activate backreferences for parenthesised groups in the pattern;
	      this  does not work in filename generation.  When a pattern with
	      a set of active parentheses is matched, the strings  matched  by
	      the  groups  are	stored in the array $match, the indices of the
	      beginning of the matched parentheses in the array	 $mbegin,  and
	      the  indices  of the end in the array $mend, with the first ele‐
	      ment of each array  corresponding	 to  the  first	 parenthesised
	      group, and so on.	 These arrays are not otherwise special to the
	      shell.  The indices use the same convention  as  does  parameter
	      substitution,  so that elements of $mend and $mbegin may be used
	      in subscripts; the KSH_ARRAYS  option  is	 respected.   Sets  of
	      globbing flags are not considered parenthesised groups; only the
	      first nine active parentheses can be referenced.

	      For example,

		     foo="a string with a message"
		     if [[ $foo = (a|an)' '(#b)(*)' '* ]]; then
		       print ${foo[$mbegin[1],$mend[1]]}
		     fi

	      prints `string with a'.  Note  that  the	first  parenthesis  is
	      before the (#b) and does not create a backreference.

	      Backreferences  work  with  all  forms of pattern matching other
	      than filename generation, but note that when performing  matches
	      on  an  entire array, such as ${array#pattern}, or a global sub‐
	      stitution, such as ${param//pat/repl}, only  the	data  for  the
	      last  match  remains  available.	In the case of global replace‐
	      ments this may still be useful.  See the example for the m  flag
	      below.

	      The  numbering  of  backreferences strictly follows the order of
	      the opening parentheses  from  left  to  right  in  the  pattern
	      string,  although	 sets of parentheses may be nested.  There are
	      special rules for parentheses followed by `#' or `##'.  Only the
	      last match of the parenthesis is remembered: for example, in `[[
	      abab =  (#b)([ab])#  ]]',	 only  the  final  `b'	is  stored  in
	      match[1].	  Thus extra parentheses may be necessary to match the
	      complete segment: for example, use  `X((ab|cd)#)Y'  to  match  a
	      whole  string  of either `ab' or `cd' between `X' and `Y', using
	      the value of $match[1] rather than $match[2].

	      If the match fails none of the parameters is altered, so in some
	      cases  it	 may  be  necessary to initialise them beforehand.  If
	      some of the backreferences fail to match ---  which  happens  if
	      they are in an alternate branch which fails to match, or if they
	      are followed by # and matched zero times ---  then  the  matched
	      string is set to the empty string, and the start and end indices
	      are set to -1.

	      Pattern matching with backreferences  is	slightly  slower  than
	      without.

       B      Deactivate  backreferences,  negating  the  effect of the b flag
	      from that point on.

       m      Set references to the match data for the entire string  matched;
	      this is similar to backreferencing and does not work in filename
	      generation.  The flag must be in effect at the end of  the  pat‐
	      tern, i.e. not local to a group. The parameters $MATCH,  $MBEGIN
	      and $MEND will be set to the string matched and to  the  indices
	      of  the  beginning and end of the string, respectively.  This is
	      most useful in parameter substitutions, as otherwise the	string
	      matched is obvious.

	      For example,

		     arr=(veldt jynx grimps waqf zho buck)
		     print ${arr//(#m)[aeiou]/${(U)MATCH}}

	      forces  all the matches (i.e. all vowels) into uppercase, print‐
	      ing `vEldt jynx grImps wAqf zhO bUck'.

	      Unlike backreferences, there is no speed penalty for using match
	      references,  other than the extra substitutions required for the
	      replacement strings in cases such as the example shown.

       M      Deactivate the m flag, hence no references to match data will be
	      created.

       anum   Approximate  matching:  num  errors  are	allowed	 in the string
	      matched by the pattern.  The rules for this are described in the
	      next subsection.

       s, e   Unlike the other flags, these have only a local effect, and each
	      must appear on its own:  `(#s)' and `(#e)' are  the  only	 valid
	      forms.   The  `(#s)' flag succeeds only at the start of the test
	      string, and the `(#e)' flag succeeds only at the end of the test
	      string;  they  correspond	 to  `^'  and  `$' in standard regular
	      expressions.  They are useful for matching path segments in pat‐
	      terns  other  than those in filename generation (where path seg‐
	      ments  are  in  any  case	 treated  separately).	 For  example,
	      `*((#s)|/)test((#e)|/)*' matches a path segment `test' in any of
	      the  following  strings:	 test,	 test/at/start,	  at/end/test,
	      in/test/middle.

	      Another	use   is   in	parameter  substitution;  for  example
	      `${array/(#s)A*Z(#e)}' will remove only  elements	 of  an	 array
	      which match the complete pattern `A*Z'.  There are other ways of
	      performing many operations of this type, however the combination
	      of  the substitution operations `/' and `//' with the `(#s)' and
	      `(#e)' flags provides a single simple and memorable method.

	      Note that assertions of the form `(^(#s))' also work, i.e. match
	      anywhere	except at the start of the string, although this actu‐
	      ally means `anything except a zero-length portion at  the	 start
	      of  the  string';	 you  need  to	use  `(""~(#s))'  to  match  a
	      zero-length portion of the string not at the start.

       q      A `q' and everything up to the closing parenthesis of the	 glob‐
	      bing  flags  are	ignored by the pattern matching code.  This is
	      intended to support the use of glob qualifiers, see below.   The
	      result is that the pattern `(#b)(*).c(#q.)' can be used both for
	      globbing and for matching against a string.  In the former case,
	      the  `(#q.)'  will be treated as a glob qualifier and the `(#b)'
	      will not be useful, while in the latter case the `(#b)' is  use‐
	      ful  for	backreferences	and the `(#q.)' will be ignored.  Note
	      that colon modifiers in the glob qualifiers are also not applied
	      in ordinary pattern matching.

       For  example,  the  test	 string	 fooxx	can  be matched by the pattern
       (#i)FOOXX, but not by (#l)FOOXX,	 (#i)FOO(#I)XX	or  ((#i)FOOX)X.   The
       string  (#ia2)readme specifies case-insensitive matching of readme with
       up to two errors.

       When using the ksh syntax for grouping both KSH_GLOB and	 EXTENDED_GLOB
       must  be	 set  and  the left parenthesis should be preceded by @.  Note
       also that the flags do not affect letters inside [...] groups, in other
       words  (#i)[a-z]	 still	matches only lowercase letters.	 Finally, note
       that when examining whole paths case-insensitively every directory must
       be  searched  for  all files which match, so that a pattern of the form
       (#i)/foo/bar/... is potentially slow.

   Approximate Matching
       When matching approximately, the shell keeps  a	count  of  the	errors
       found,  which  cannot exceed the number specified in the (#anum) flags.
       Four types of error are recognised:

       1.     Different characters, as in fooxbar and fooybar.

       2.     Transposition of characters, as in banana and abnana.

       3.     A character missing in the target string, as  with  the  pattern
	      road and target string rod.

       4.     An extra character appearing in the target string, as with stove
	      and strove.

       Thus, the pattern (#a3)abcd matches dcba, with the errors occurring  by
       using  the first rule twice and the second once, grouping the string as
       [d][cb][a] and [a][bc][d].

       Non-literal parts of the pattern must match exactly, including  charac‐
       ters  in	 character  ranges:  hence (#a1)???  matches strings of length
       four, by applying rule 4 to an empty  part  of  the  pattern,  but  not
       strings	of  length  two, since all the ? must match.  Other characters
       which must match exactly are initial  dots  in  filenames  (unless  the
       GLOB_DOTS option is set), and all slashes in filenames, so that a/bc is
       two errors from ab/c (the slash cannot be transposed with another char‐
       acter).	 Similarly,  errors  are counted separately for non-contiguous
       strings in the pattern, so that (ab|cd)ef is two errors from aebf.

       When using exclusion  via  the  ~  operator,  approximate  matching  is
       treated entirely separately for the excluded part and must be activated
       separately.  Thus, (#a1)README~READ_ME matches READ.ME but not READ_ME,
       as  the	trailing  READ_ME  is matched without approximation.  However,
       (#a1)README~(#a1)READ_ME does not match any pattern of the form READ?ME
       as all such forms are now excluded.

       Apart  from exclusions, there is only one overall error count; however,
       the maximum errors allowed may be altered  locally,  and	 this  can  be
       delimited  by  grouping.	 For example, (#a1)cat((#a0)dog)fox allows one
       error in total, which may not occur in the dog section, and the pattern
       (#a1)cat(#a0)dog(#a1)fox	 is  equivalent.  Note that the point at which
       an error is first found is the crucial one for establishing whether  to
       use   approximation;  for  example,  (#a1)abc(#a0)xyz  will  not	 match
       abcdxyz, because the error occurs at the `x',  where  approximation  is
       turned off.

       Entire	path   segments	  may	be   matched  approximately,  so  that
       `(#a1)/foo/d/is/available/at/the/bar' allows one error in any path seg‐
       ment.   This  is	 much  less efficient than without the (#a1), however,
       since every directory in the  path  must	 be  scanned  for  a  possible
       approximate  match.   It is best to place the (#a1) after any path seg‐
       ments which are known to be correct.

   Recursive Globbing
       A pathname component of the form `(foo/)#' matches a path consisting of
       zero or more directories matching the pattern foo.

       As  a  shorthand, `**/' is equivalent to `(*/)#'; note that this there‐
       fore matches files in the current directory as well as  subdirectories.
       Thus:

	      ls (*/)#bar

       or

	      ls **/bar

       does  a	recursive  directory search for files named `bar' (potentially
       including the file `bar' in the current directory).  This form does not
       follow  symbolic links; the alternative form `***/' does, but is other‐
       wise identical.	Neither of these can be combined with other  forms  of
       globbing	 within the same path segment; in that case, the `*' operators
       revert to their usual effect.

   Glob Qualifiers
       Patterns used for filename generation may end in a list	of  qualifiers
       enclosed	 in  parentheses.  The qualifiers specify which filenames that
       otherwise match the given pattern will  be  inserted  in	 the  argument
       list.

       If the option BARE_GLOB_QUAL is set, then a trailing set of parentheses
       containing no `|' or `(' characters (or `~' if it is special) is	 taken
       as  a set of glob qualifiers.  A glob subexpression that would normally
       be taken as glob qualifiers, for example `(^x)', can be	forced	to  be
       treated	as  part  of  the glob pattern by doubling the parentheses, in
       this case producing `((^x))'.

       If the option EXTENDED_GLOB is set, a different syntax for glob	quali‐
       fiers  is  available,  namely  `(#qx)'  where x is any of the same glob
       qualifiers used in the other format.  The qualifiers must still	appear
       at  the	end  of	 the pattern.  However, with this syntax multiple glob
       qualifiers may be chained together.  They are treated as a logical  AND
       of  the	individual sets of flags.  Also, as the syntax is unambiguous,
       the expression will be treated as glob  qualifiers  just	 as  long  any
       parentheses contained within it are balanced; appearance of `|', `(' or
       `~' does not negate the effect.	Note that qualifiers  will  be	recog‐
       nised  in  this form even if a bare glob qualifier exists at the end of
       the pattern, for example `*(#q*)(.)' will recognise executable  regular
       files if both options are set; however, mixed syntax should probably be
       avoided for the sake of clarity.

       A qualifier may be any one of the following:

       /      directories

       F      `full' (i.e. non-empty) directories.   Note  that	 the  opposite
	      sense (^F) expands to empty directories and all non-directories.
	      Use (/^F) for empty directories

       .      plain files

       @      symbolic links

       =      sockets

       p      named pipes (FIFOs)

       *      executable plain files (0100)

       %      device files (character or block special)

       %b     block special files

       %c     character special files

       r      owner-readable files (0400)

       w      owner-writable files (0200)

       x      owner-executable files (0100)

       A      group-readable files (0040)

       I      group-writable files (0020)

       E      group-executable files (0010)

       R      world-readable files (0004)

       W      world-writable files (0002)

       X      world-executable files (0001)

       s      setuid files (04000)

       S      setgid files (02000)

       t      files with the sticky bit (01000)

       fspec  files with access rights matching spec. This spec may be a octal
	      number optionally preceded by a `=', a `+', or a `-'. If none of
	      these characters is given, the behavior is the same as for  `='.
	      The octal number describes the mode bits to be expected, if com‐
	      bined with a `=', the value  given  must	match  the  file-modes
	      exactly,	with a `+', at least the bits in the given number must
	      be set in the file-modes, and with a `-', the bits in the number
	      must  not be set. Giving a `?' instead of a octal digit anywhere
	      in the  number  ensures  that  the  corresponding	 bits  in  the
	      file-modes  are  not checked, this is only useful in combination
	      with `='.

	      If the qualifier `f' is followed by any other character anything
	      up  to the next matching character (`[', `{', and `<' match `]',
	      `}', and `>' respectively, any other character  matches  itself)
	      is  taken	 as a list of comma-separated sub-specs. Each sub-spec
	      may be either an octal number as described above or  a  list  of
	      any of the characters `u', `g', `o', and `a', followed by a `=',
	      a `+', or a `-', followed by a list of  any  of  the  characters
	      `r',  `w',  `x', `s', and `t', or an octal digit. The first list
	      of characters specify which access rights are to be checked.  If
	      a	 `u'  is given, those for the owner of the file are used, if a
	      `g' is given, those of the group are checked,  a	`o'  means  to
	      test  those  of  other users, and the `a' says to test all three
	      groups. The `=', `+', and `-' again says how the modes are to be
	      checked  and  have  the  same meaning as described for the first
	      form above. The second list of  characters  finally  says	 which
	      access  rights  are to be expected: `r' for read access, `w' for
	      write access, `x' for the right  to  execute  the	 file  (or  to
	      search a directory), `s' for the setuid and setgid bits, and `t'
	      for the sticky bit.

	      Thus, `*(f70?)' gives the files for which the  owner  has	 read,
	      write, and execute permission, and for which other group members
	      have no rights, independent of the permissions for other	users.
	      The  pattern `*(f-100)' gives all files for which the owner does
	      not have execute permission,  and	 `*(f:gu+w,o-rx:)'  gives  the
	      files  for  which	 the  owner and the other members of the group
	      have at least write permission, and for which other users	 don't
	      have read or execute permission.

       estring
       +cmd   The string will be executed as shell code.  The filename will be
	      included in the list if and only if the code returns a zero sta‐
	      tus (usually the status of the last command).  The first charac‐
	      ter after the `e' will be used as a separator and anything up to
	      the  next	 matching separator will be taken  as the string; `[',
	      `{', and `<' match `]', `}', and `>',  respectively,  while  any
	      other  character	matches	 itself.  Note that expansions must be
	      quoted in the string to prevent them from being expanded	before
	      globbing is done.

	      During  the  execution  of  string  the filename currently being
	      tested is available in the parameter REPLY; the parameter may be
	      altered  to a string to be inserted into the list instead of the
	      original filename.  In addition, the parameter reply may be  set
	      to an array or a string, which overrides the value of REPLY.  If
	      set to an array, the latter is inserted into  the	 command  line
	      word by word.

	      For   example,  suppose  a  directory  contains  a  single  file
	      `lonely'.	 Then the  expression  `*(e:'reply=(${REPLY}{1,2})':)'
	      will  cause  the words `lonely1 lonely2' to be inserted into the
	      command line.  Note the quotation marks.

	      The form +cmd has the same  effect,  but	no  delimiters	appear
	      around  cmd.   Instead,  cmd is taken as the longest sequence of
	      characters following the + that are alphanumeric or  underscore.
	      Typically cmd will be the name of a shell function that contains
	      the appropriate test.  For example,

		     nt() { [[ $REPLY -nt $NTREF ]] }
		     NTREF=reffile
		     ls -l *(+nt)

	      lists all files in the directory that have  been	modified  more
	      recently than reffile.

       ddev   files on the device dev

       l[-|+]ct
	      files having a link count less than ct (-), greater than ct (+),
	      or equal to ct

       U      files owned by the effective user ID

       G      files owned by the effective group ID

       uid    files owned by user ID id if it is a number, if  not,  than  the
	      character	 after	the  `u'  will	be used as a separator and the
	      string between it and the next matching separator (`[', `{', and
	      `<'  match  `]',	`}', and `>' respectively, any other character
	      matches itself) will be taken as a user name, and the user ID of
	      this  user  will	be  taken  (e.g. `u:foo:' or `u[foo]' for user
	      `foo')

       gid    like uid but with group IDs or names

       a[Mwhms][-|+]n
	      files accessed exactly n days ago.  Files	 accessed  within  the
	      last  n  days  are  selected  using a negative value for n (-n).
	      Files accessed more than n days ago are selected by a positive n
	      value  (+n).  Optional unit specifiers `M', `w', `h', `m' or `s'
	      (e.g. `ah5') cause the check to be performed with months (of  30
	      days), weeks, hours, minutes or seconds instead of days, respec‐
	      tively.  For instance, `echo *(ah-5)' would echo files  accessed
	      within the last five hours.

       m[Mwhms][-|+]n
	      like  the	 file  access  qualifier, except that it uses the file
	      modification time.

       c[Mwhms][-|+]n
	      like the file access qualifier, except that  it  uses  the  file
	      inode change time.

       L[+|-]n
	      files less than n bytes (-), more than n bytes (+), or exactly n
	      bytes in length. If this flag is	directly  followed  by	a  `k'
	      (`K'),  `m' (`M'), or `p' (`P') (e.g. `Lk-50') the check is per‐
	      formed with kilobytes,  megabytes,  or  blocks  (of  512	bytes)
	      instead.

       ^      negates all qualifiers following it

       -      toggles  between	making	the  qualifiers work on symbolic links
	      (the default) and the files they point to

       M      sets the MARK_DIRS option for the current pattern

       T      appends a trailing qualifier mark to the filenames, analogous to
	      the LIST_TYPES option, for the current pattern (overrides M)

       N      sets the NULL_GLOB option for the current pattern

       D      sets the GLOB_DOTS option for the current pattern

       n      sets the NUMERIC_GLOB_SORT option for the current pattern

       oc     specifies how the names of the files should be sorted. If c is n
	      they are sorted by name (the default);  if  it  is  L  they  are
	      sorted  depending	 on  the size (length) of the files; if l they
	      are sorted by the number of links; if a, m, or c they are sorted
	      by  the  time  of the last access, modification, or inode change
	      respectively; if d, files in subdirectories appear before	 those
	      in the current directory at each level of the search --- this is
	      best combined with other criteria, for example `odon' to sort on
	      names  for files within the same directory.  Note that a, m, and
	      c compare the age against the current time, hence the first name
	      in the list is the youngest file. Also note that the modifiers ^
	      and - are used, so `*(^-oL)' gives a list of all files sorted by
	      file size in descending order, following any symbolic links.

       Oc     like  `o',  but  sorts in descending order; i.e. `*(^oc)' is the
	      same as `*(Oc)' and `*(^Oc)' is the same as `*(oc)';  `Od'  puts
	      files in the current directory before those in subdirectories at
	      each level of the search.

       [beg[,end]]
	      specifies which of the matched filenames should be  included  in
	      the  returned  list.  The	 syntax	 is the same as for array sub‐
	      scripts. beg and the optional end may  be	 mathematical  expres‐
	      sions. As in parameter subscripting they may be negative to make
	      them count from the last	match  backward.  E.g.:	 `*(-OL[1,3])'
	      gives a list of the names of the three largest files.

       More  than one of these lists can be combined, separated by commas. The
       whole list matches if at least one of the sublists  matches  (they  are
       `or'ed,	the qualifiers in the sublists are `and'ed).  Some qualifiers,
       however, affect all matches generated, independent of  the  sublist  in
       which  they  are	 given.	  These are the qualifiers `M', `T', `N', `D',
       `n', `o', `O' and the subscripts given in brackets (`[...]').

       If a `:' appears in a qualifier list, the remainder of  the  expression
       in  parenthesis	is  interpreted	 as a modifier (see the section `Modi‐
       fiers' in the section `History Expansion').  Note  that	each  modifier
       must  be introduced by a separate `:'.  Note also that the result after
       modification does not have to be an existing file.   The	 name  of  any
       existing file can be followed by a modifier of the form `(:..)' even if
       no actual filename generation is performed.  Thus:

	      ls *(-/)

       lists all directories and symbolic links that point to directories, and

	      ls *(%W)

       lists all world-writable device files in the current directory, and

	      ls *(W,X)

       lists all files in the current directory	 that  are  world-writable  or
       world-executable, and

	      echo /tmp/foo*(u0^@:t)

       outputs	the basename of all root-owned files beginning with the string
       `foo' in /tmp, ignoring symlinks, and

	      ls *.*~(lex|parse).[ch](^D^l1)

       lists all files having a link count of one whose names  contain	a  dot
       (but  not  those	 starting  with	 a  dot, since GLOB_DOTS is explicitly
       switched off) except for lex.c, lex.h, parse.c and parse.h.

	      print b*.pro(#q:s/pro/shmo/)(#q.:s/builtin/shmiltin/)

       demonstrates how colon modifiers and other qualifiers  may  be  chained
       together.   The ordinary qualifier `.' is applied first, then the colon
       modifiers in order from left to right.  So if EXTENDED_GLOB is set  and
       the  base  pattern matches the regular file builtin.pro, the shell will
       print `shmiltin.shmo'.

ZSHPARAM(1)							   ZSHPARAM(1)

NAME
       zshparam - zsh parameters

DESCRIPTION
       A parameter has a name, a value, and a number of	 attributes.   A  name
       may  be any sequence of alphanumeric characters and underscores, or the
       single characters `*', `@', `#', `?', `-', `$', or `!'.	The value  may
       be  a scalar (a string), an integer, an array (indexed numerically), or
       an associative array (an unordered set of name-value pairs, indexed  by
       name).	To  declare  the type of a parameter, or to assign a scalar or
       integer value to a parameter, use the typeset builtin.

       The value of a scalar or integer parameter  may	also  be  assigned  by
       writing:

	      name=value

       If  the integer attribute, -i, is set for name, the value is subject to
       arithmetic evaluation.  Furthermore, by	replacing  `='	with  `+=',  a
       parameter  can be added or appended to.	See the section `Array Parame‐
       ters' for additional forms of assignment.

       To refer to the value of a parameter, write `$name' or `${name}'.   See
       Parameter Expansion in zshexpn(1) for complete details.

       In  the	parameter lists that follow, the mark `<S>' indicates that the
       parameter is  special.	Special	 parameters  cannot  have  their  type
       changed or their readonly attribute turned off, and if a special param‐
       eter is unset, then later recreated, the	 special  properties  will  be
       retained.   `<Z>'  indicates that the parameter does not exist when the
       shell initializes in sh or ksh emulation mode.

ARRAY PARAMETERS
       To assign an array value, write one of:

	      set -A name value ...
	      name=(value ...)

       If no parameter name exists, an ordinary array  parameter  is  created.
       If  the	parameter name exists and is a scalar, it is replaced by a new
       array.  Ordinary array parameters may also be explicitly declared with:

	      typeset -a name

       Associative arrays must be declared before assignment, by using:

	      typeset -A name

       When name refers to an associative array, the list in an assignment  is
       interpreted as alternating keys and values:

	      set -A name key value ...
	      name=(key value ...)

       Every  key  must	 have a value in this case.  Note that this assigns to
       the entire array, deleting any elements that do not appear in the list.

       To create an empty array (including associative arrays), use one of:

	      set -A name
	      name=()

   Array Subscripts
       Individual elements of an array may be selected using a	subscript.   A
       subscript of the form `[exp]' selects the single element exp, where exp
       is an arithmetic expression which will be subject to arithmetic	expan‐
       sion as if it were surrounded by `$((...))'.  The elements are numbered
       beginning with 1, unless the KSH_ARRAYS option is  set  in  which  case
       they are numbered from zero.

       Subscripts  may be used inside braces used to delimit a parameter name,
       thus `${foo[2]}' is equivalent to `$foo[2]'.  If the KSH_ARRAYS	option
       is  set,	 the  braced  form  is	the  only one that works, as bracketed
       expressions otherwise are not treated as subscripts.

       The same subscripting syntax is used  for  associative  arrays,	except
       that  no	 arithmetic expansion is applied to exp.  However, the parsing
       rules for arithmetic expressions still apply,  which  affects  the  way
       that  certain special characters must be protected from interpretation.
       See Subscript Parsing below for details.

       A subscript of the form `[*]' or `[@]' evaluates to all elements of  an
       array;  there  is no difference between the two except when they appear
       within double  quotes.	`"$foo[*]"'  evaluates	to  `"$foo[1]  $foo[2]
       ..."', whereas `"$foo[@]"' evaluates to `"$foo[1]" "$foo[2]" ...'.  For
       associative arrays, `[*]' or `[@]' evaluate to all the  values,	in  no
       particular order.  Note that this does not substitute the keys; see the
       documentation for the `k' flag under Parameter Expansion Flags in  zsh‐
       expn(1) for complete details.  When an array parameter is referenced as
       `$name' (with no subscript) it  evaluates  to  `$name[*]',  unless  the
       KSH_ARRAYS  option  is  set  in which case it evaluates to `${name[0]}'
       (for an associative array, this means the value of the key  `0',	 which
       may not exist even if there are values for other keys).

       A subscript of the form `[exp1,exp2]' selects all elements in the range
       exp1 to exp2, inclusive. (Associative arrays are unordered, and	so  do
       not  support  ranges.) If one of the subscripts evaluates to a negative
       number, say -n, then the nth element from the end of the array is used.
       Thus `$foo[-3]' is the third element from the end of the array foo, and
       `$foo[1,-1]' is the same as `$foo[*]'.

       Subscripting may also be performed on non-array values, in  which  case
       the  subscripts	specify	 a substring to be extracted.  For example, if
       FOO is set to `foobar', then `echo $FOO[2,5]' prints `ooba'.

   Array Element Assignment
       A subscript may be used on the left side of an assignment like so:

	      name[exp]=value

       In this form of assignment the element or range	specified  by  exp  is
       replaced	 by  the  expression  on the right side.  An array (but not an
       associative array) may be created by assignment to a range or  element.
       Arrays  do  not nest, so assigning a parenthesized list of values to an
       element or range changes the number of elements in the array,  shifting
       the  other  elements  to accommodate the new values.  (This is not sup‐
       ported for associative arrays.)

       This syntax also works as an argument to the typeset command:

	      typeset "name[exp]"=value

       The value may not be a parenthesized  list  in  this  case;  only  sin‐
       gle-element assignments may be made with typeset.  Note that quotes are
       necessary in this case to prevent the brackets from  being  interpreted
       as filename generation operators.  The noglob precommand modifier could
       be used instead.

       To delete an element of an ordinary array, assign `()' to that element.
       To delete an element of an associative array, use the unset command:

	      unset "name[exp]"

   Subscript Flags
       If  the	opening	 bracket,  or  the  comma in a range, in any subscript
       expression is directly followed by an opening parenthesis,  the	string
       up  to the matching closing one is considered to be a list of flags, as
       in `name[(flags)exp]'.  The flags currently understood are:

       w      If the parameter subscripted is a scalar than  this  flag	 makes
	      subscripting  work  on words instead of characters.  The default
	      word separator is whitespace.

       s:string:
	      This gives the string that separates words (for use with	the  w
	      flag).

       p      Recognize	 the same escape sequences as the print builtin in the
	      string argument of a subsequent `s' flag.

       f      If the parameter subscripted is a scalar than  this  flag	 makes
	      subscripting work on lines instead of characters, i.e. with ele‐
	      ments separated by newlines.  This is a shorthand for `pws:\n:'.

       r      Reverse subscripting: if this flag is given, the exp is taken as
	      a	 pattern  and  the result is the first matching array element,
	      substring or word (if the parameter is an	 array,	 if  it	 is  a
	      scalar,  or if it is a scalar and the `w' flag is given, respec‐
	      tively).	The subscript used is the number of the matching  ele‐
	      ment,  so	 that  pairs of subscripts such as `$foo[(r)??,3]' and
	      `$foo[(r)??,(r)f*]' are possible if  the	parameter  is  not  an
	      associative  array.   If	the parameter is an associative array,
	      only the value part of each pair is compared to the pattern, and
	      the result is that value.

       R      Like  `r',  but  gives  the last match.  For associative arrays,
	      gives all possible matches. May be used for assigning  to	 ordi‐
	      nary  array  elements,  but  not	for  assigning	to associative
	      arrays.

       i      Like `r', but gives the index of the match instead; this may not
	      be  combined  with  a  second  argument.	On the left side of an
	      assignment, behaves like `r'.  For associative arrays,  the  key
	      part  of	each  pair  is	compared to the pattern, and the first
	      matching key found is the result.

       I      Like `i', but gives the index of the last match, or all possible
	      matching keys in an associative array.

       k      If used in a subscript on an associative array, this flag causes
	      the keys to be interpreted as patterns, and  returns  the	 value
	      for  the	first key found where exp is matched by the key.  This
	      flag does not work on the left side of an assignment to an asso‐
	      ciative  array  element.	 If used on another type of parameter,
	      this behaves like `r'.

       K      On an associative array this is like `k' but returns all	values
	      where  exp is matched by the keys.  On other types of parameters
	      this has the same effect as `R'.

       n:expr:
	      If combined with `r', `R', `i' or `I', makes them give  the  nth
	      or  nth  last  match  (if	 expr  evaluates  to n).  This flag is
	      ignored when the array is associative.

       b:expr:
	      If combined with `r', `R', `i' or `I', makes them begin  at  the
	      nth  or  nth last element, word, or character (if expr evaluates
	      to n).  This flag is ignored when the array is associative.

       e      This flag has no effect and for ordinary arrays is retained  for
	      backward	compatibility only.  For associative arrays, this flag
	      can be used to force * or @ to be interpreted as	a  single  key
	      rather than as a reference to all values.	 This flag may be used
	      on the left side of an assignment.

       See Parameter Expansion	Flags  (zshexpn(1))  for  additional  ways  to
       manipulate the results of array subscripting.

   Subscript Parsing
       This  discussion applies mainly to associative array key strings and to
       patterns used for reverse subscripting (the `r', `R', `i', etc. flags),
       but  it	may also affect parameter substitutions that appear as part of
       an arithmetic expression in an ordinary subscript.

       It is possible to avoid the use of subscripts in assignments  to	 asso‐
       ciative array elements by using the syntax:

		 aa+=('key with "*strange*" characters' 'value string')

       This  adds  a new key/value pair if the key is not already present, and
       replaces the value for the existing key if it is.

       The basic rule to remember when writing a subscript expression is  that
       all  text between the opening `[' and the closing `]' is interpreted as
       if it were in double quotes (see zshmisc(1)).  However,	unlike	double
       quotes  which  normally	cannot	nest, subscript expressions may appear
       inside double-quoted strings or inside other subscript expressions  (or
       both!), so the rules have two important differences.

       The first difference is that brackets (`[' and `]') must appear as bal‐
       anced pairs in a subscript expression unless they  are  preceded	 by  a
       backslash  (`\').  Therefore, within a subscript expression (and unlike
       true double-quoting) the sequence `\[' becomes `[', and similarly  `\]'
       becomes	`]'.  This applies even in cases where a backslash is not nor‐
       mally required; for example, the pattern `[^[]' (to match any character
       other than an open bracket) should be written `[^\[]' in a reverse-sub‐
       script pattern.	However, note that `\[^\[\]' and even `\[^[]' mean the
       same  thing,  because  backslashes are always stripped when they appear
       before brackets!

       The same rule applies to parentheses (`(' and `)') and braces (`{'  and
       `}'):  they must appear either in balanced pairs or preceded by a back‐
       slash, and backslashes that protect parentheses or braces  are  removed
       during parsing.	This is because parameter expansions may be surrounded
       balanced braces, and subscript flags are introduced by balanced	paren‐
       thesis.

       The  second  difference is that a double-quote (`"') may appear as part
       of a subscript expression without being preceded by  a  backslash,  and
       therefore  that the two characters `\"' remain as two characters in the
       subscript (in true double-quoting, `\"' becomes `"').  However, because
       of the standard shell quoting rules, any double-quotes that appear must
       occur in balanced pairs unless preceded by a backslash.	This makes  it
       more  difficult	to  write  a subscript expression that contains an odd
       number of double-quote characters, but the reason for  this  difference
       is  so  that  when  a  subscript	 expression  appears  inside true dou‐
       ble-quotes, one can still write `\"' (rather than `\\\"') for `"'.

       To use an odd number of double quotes as a key in  an  assignment,  use
       the typeset builtin and an enclosing pair of double quotes; to refer to
       the value of that key, again use double quotes:

	      typeset -A aa
	      typeset "aa[one\"two\"three\"quotes]"=QQQ
	      print "$aa[one\"two\"three\"quotes]"

       It is important to note that the quoting rules do  not  change  when  a
       parameter expansion with a subscript is nested inside another subscript
       expression.  That is, it is not necessary to use additional backslashes
       within the inner subscript expression; they are removed only once, from
       the innermost subscript outwards.  Parameters are  also	expanded  from
       the innermost subscript first, as each expansion is encountered left to
       right in the outer expression.

       A further complication arises from a way in which subscript parsing  is
       not  different  from  double quote parsing.  As in true double-quoting,
       the sequences `\*', and `\@' remain as two characters when they	appear
       in  a subscript expression.  To use a literal `*' or `@' as an associa‐
       tive array key, the `e' flag must be used:

	      typeset -A aa
	      aa[(e)*]=star
	      print $aa[(e)*]

       A last detail must be considered	 when  reverse	subscripting  is  per‐
       formed.	 Parameters  appearing	in  the subscript expression are first
       expanded and then the complete expression is interpreted as a  pattern.
       This has two effects: first, parameters behave as if GLOB_SUBST were on
       (and it cannot be turned	 off);	second,	 backslashes  are  interpreted
       twice, once when parsing the array subscript and again when parsing the
       pattern.	 In a reverse subscript, it's  necessary  to  use  four	 back‐
       slashes	to cause a single backslash to match literally in the pattern.
       For complex patterns, it is often easiest to assign the desired pattern
       to  a  parameter	 and  then  refer  to that parameter in the subscript,
       because then the backslashes, brackets,	parentheses,  etc.,  are  seen
       only  when the complete expression is converted to a pattern.  To match
       the value of a parameter literally in a reverse subscript, rather  than
       as  a  pattern, use `${(q)name}' (see zshexpn(1)) to quote the expanded
       value.

       Note that the `k' and `K' flags are reverse subscripting for  an	 ordi‐
       nary  array, but are not reverse subscripting for an associative array!
       (For an associative array, the keys in the array itself are interpreted
       as  patterns  by	 those	flags; the subscript is a plain string in that
       case.)

       One final note, not directly related to subscripting: the numeric names
       of positional parameters (described below) are parsed specially, so for
       example `$2foo' is equivalent to `${2}foo'.   Therefore,	 to  use  sub‐
       script  syntax  to extract a substring from a positional parameter, the
       expansion must be surrounded by braces; for example, `${2[3,5]}' evalu‐
       ates  to	 the  third  through fifth characters of the second positional
       parameter, but `$2[3,5]' is the entire  second  parameter  concatenated
       with the filename generation pattern `[3,5]'.

POSITIONAL PARAMETERS
       The  positional parameters provide access to the command-line arguments
       of a shell function, shell script, or the shell itself; see the section
       `Invocation', and also the section `Functions'.	The parameter n, where
       n is a number, is the nth positional parameter.	The  parameters	 *,  @
       and  argv  are  arrays  containing  all the positional parameters; thus
       `$argv[n]', etc., is equivalent to simply `$n'.

       Positional parameters may be changed after the shell or function starts
       by  using the set builtin, by assigning to the argv array, or by direct
       assignment of the form `n=value' where n is the	number	of  the	 posi‐
       tional  parameter to be changed.	 This also creates (with empty values)
       any of the positions from 1 to n that do not already have values.  Note
       that, because the positional parameters form an array, an array assign‐
       ment of the form `n=(value ...)' is allowed,  and  has  the  effect  of
       shifting	 all  the  values at positions greater than n by as many posi‐
       tions as necessary to accommodate the new values.

LOCAL PARAMETERS
       Shell function executions delimit scopes for shell parameters.  (Param‐
       eters  are  dynamically scoped.)	 The typeset builtin, and its alterna‐
       tive forms declare, integer, local and readonly (but not	 export),  can
       be used to declare a parameter as being local to the innermost scope.

       When a parameter is read or assigned to, the innermost existing parame‐
       ter of that name is used.  (That is,  the  local	 parameter  hides  any
       less-local parameter.)  However, assigning to a non-existent parameter,
       or declaring a new parameter with export, causes it to  be  created  in
       the outermost scope.

       Local parameters disappear when their scope ends.  unset can be used to
       delete a parameter while it is still in scope; any outer	 parameter  of
       the same name remains hidden.

       Special	parameters  may	 also be made local; they retain their special
       attributes unless either the existing or	 the  newly-created  parameter
       has  the	 -h (hide) attribute.  This may have unexpected effects: there
       is no default value, so if there is no  assignment  at  the  point  the
       variable	 is  made  local, it will be set to an empty value (or zero in
       the case of integers).  The following:

	      typeset PATH=/new/directory:$PATH

       is valid for temporarily allowing the shell or programmes  called  from
       it to find the programs in /new/directory inside a function.

       Note  that  the restriction in older versions of zsh that local parame‐
       ters were never exported has been removed.

PARAMETERS SET BY THE SHELL
       The following parameters are automatically set by the shell:

       ! <S>  The process ID of the last background command invoked.

       # <S>  The number of positional parameters in decimal.  Note that  some
	      confusion	 may  occur  with the syntax $#param which substitutes
	      the length of param.  Use ${#} to resolve ambiguities.  In  par‐
	      ticular,	the  sequence  `$#-...' in an arithmetic expression is
	      interpreted as the length of the parameter -, q.v.

       ARGC <S> <Z>
	      Same as #.

       $ <S>  The process ID of this shell.

       - <S>  Flags supplied to the shell on  invocation  or  by  the  set  or
	      setopt commands.

       * <S>  An array containing the positional parameters.

       argv <S> <Z>
	      Same  as	*.   Assigning	to  argv  changes the local positional
	      parameters, but argv is not itself a local parameter.   Deleting
	      argv  with unset in any function deletes it everywhere, although
	      only the innermost positional parameter array is deleted	(so  *
	      and @ in other scopes are not affected).

       @ <S>  Same as argv[@], even when argv is not set.

       ? <S>  The exit value returned by the last command.

       0 <S>  The  name	 used  to  invoke  the	current	 shell.	  If the FUNC‐
	      TION_ARGZERO option is set, this is  set	temporarily  within  a
	      shell function to the name of the function, and within a sourced
	      script to the name of the script.

       status <S> <Z>
	      Same as ?.

       pipestatus <S> <Z>
	      An array containing the exit values returned by all commands  in
	      the last pipeline.

       _ <S>  The last argument of the previous command.  Also, this parameter
	      is set in the environment of every command executed to the  full
	      pathname of the command.

       CPUTYPE
	      The  machine  type  (microprocessor  class or machine model), as
	      determined at run time.

       EGID <S>
	      The effective group ID of the shell process.  If you have suffi‐
	      cient  privileges,  you may change the effective group ID of the
	      shell process by assigning to this  parameter.   Also  (assuming
	      sufficient  privileges),	you  may start a single command with a
	      different effective group ID by `(EGID=gid; command)'

       EUID <S>
	      The effective user ID of the shell process.  If you have	suffi‐
	      cient  privileges,  you  may change the effective user ID of the
	      shell process by assigning to this  parameter.   Also  (assuming
	      sufficient  privileges),	you  may start a single command with a
	      different effective user ID by `(EUID=uid; command)'

       ERRNO <S>
	      The value of errno (see errno(3)) as set by  the	most  recently
	      failed  system  call.   This  value  is  system dependent and is
	      intended for debugging purposes.	It is  also  useful  with  the
	      zsh/system  module  which	 allows the number to be turned into a
	      name or message.

       GID <S>
	      The real group ID of the shell process.  If you have  sufficient
	      privileges,  you may change the group ID of the shell process by
	      assigning to this parameter.  Also (assuming  sufficient	privi‐
	      leges),  you  may start a single command under a different group
	      ID by `(GID=gid; command)'

       HISTCMD
	      The current history line number  in  an  interactive  shell,  in
	      other words the line number for the command that caused $HISTCMD
	      to be read.

       HOST   The current hostname.

       LINENO <S>
	      The line number of the current line within the  current  script,
	      sourced  file,  or  shell function being executed, whichever was
	      started most recently.  Note that in the case of shell functions
	      the  line	 number	 refers	 to the function as it appeared in the
	      original definition, not necessarily as displayed by  the	 func‐
	      tions builtin.

       LOGNAME
	      If  the  corresponding variable is not set in the environment of
	      the shell, it is initialized to the login name corresponding  to
	      the current login session. This parameter is exported by default
	      but this can be disabled using the typeset builtin.

       MACHTYPE
	      The machine type (microprocessor class  or  machine  model),  as
	      determined at compile time.

       OLDPWD The previous working directory.  This is set when the shell ini‐
	      tializes and whenever the directory changes.

       OPTARG <S>
	      The value of the last option argument processed by  the  getopts
	      command.

       OPTIND <S>
	      The  index  of the last option argument processed by the getopts
	      command.

       OSTYPE The operating system, as determined at compile time.

       PPID <S>
	      The process ID of the parent of the shell.

       PWD    The present working directory.  This is set when the shell  ini‐
	      tializes and whenever the directory changes.

       RANDOM <S>
	      A	 pseudo-random	integer	 from 0 to 32767, newly generated each
	      time this parameter is referenced.  The random number  generator
	      can be seeded by assigning a numeric value to RANDOM.

	      The   values   of	  RANDOM   form	  an  intentionally-repeatable
	      pseudo-random sequence; subshells	 that  reference  RANDOM  will
	      result  in  identical  pseudo-random  values unless the value of
	      RANDOM is referenced or seeded in the parent  shell  in  between
	      subshell invocations.

       SECONDS <S>
	      The number of seconds since shell invocation.  If this parameter
	      is assigned a value, then the value returned upon reference will
	      be  the value that was assigned plus the number of seconds since
	      the assignment.

	      Unlike other special parameters, the type of the SECONDS parame‐
	      ter  can be changed using the typeset command.  Only integer and
	      one of the floating  point  types	 are  allowed.	 For  example,
	      `typeset -F SECONDS' causes the value to be reported as a float‐
	      ing point number.	 The precision is six decimal places, although
	      not all places may be useful.

       SHLVL <S>
	      Incremented by one each time a new shell is started.

       signals
	      An array containing the names of the signals.

       TRY_BLOCK_ERROR <S>
	      In an always block, indicates whether the preceding list of code
	      caused an error.	The value is 1 to indicate an error, 0	other‐
	      wise.   It may be reset, clearing the error condition.  See Com‐
	      plex Commands in zshmisc(1)

       TTY    The name of the tty associated with the shell, if any.

       TTYIDLE <S>
	      The idle time of the tty associated with the shell in seconds or
	      -1 if there is no such tty.

       UID <S>
	      The  real	 user ID of the shell process.	If you have sufficient
	      privileges, you may change the user ID of the shell by assigning
	      to  this	parameter.  Also (assuming sufficient privileges), you
	      may start	 a  single  command  under  a  different  user	ID  by
	      `(UID=uid; command)'

       USERNAME <S>
	      The  username  corresponding  to	the  real user ID of the shell
	      process.	If you have sufficient privileges, you may change  the
	      username	(and  also  the	 user ID and group ID) of the shell by
	      assigning to this parameter.  Also (assuming  sufficient	privi‐
	      leges),  you  may start a single command under a different user‐
	      name (and user ID and group  ID)	by  `(USERNAME=username;  com‐
	      mand)'

       VENDOR The vendor, as determined at compile time.

       ZSH_NAME
	      Expands  to  the	basename  of  the  command used to invoke this
	      instance of zsh.

       ZSH_VERSION
	      The version number of this zsh.

PARAMETERS USED BY THE SHELL
       The following parameters are used by the shell.

       In cases where there are two parameters with an	upper-	and  lowercase
       form  of the same name, such as path and PATH, the lowercase form is an
       array and the uppercase form is a scalar with the elements of the array
       joined  together	 by colons.  These are similar to tied parameters cre‐
       ated via `typeset -T'.  The normal use for the colon-separated form  is
       for  exporting  to  the	environment, while the array form is easier to
       manipulate within the shell.  Note that unsetting either	 of  the  pair
       will  unset the other; they retain their special properties when recre‐
       ated, and recreating one of the pair will recreate the other.

       ARGV0  If exported, its value is used as the argv[0] of	external  com‐
	      mands.  Usually used in constructs like `ARGV0=emacs nethack'.

       BAUD   The  baud rate of the current connection.	 Used by the line edi‐
	      tor update mechanism to compensate for a slow terminal by delay‐
	      ing  updates  until  necessary.  This may be profitably set to a
	      lower value in some circumstances, e.g.  for slow modems dialing
	      into  a communications server which is connected to a host via a
	      fast link; in this case, this variable would be set  by  default
	      to  the speed of the fast link, and not the modem.  This parame‐
	      ter should be set to the baud rate of the slowest	 part  of  the
	      link  for	 best  performance.  The compensation mechanism can be
	      turned off by setting the variable to zero.

       cdpath <S> <Z> (CDPATH <S>)
	      An array (colon-separated list) of  directories  specifying  the
	      search path for the cd command.

       COLUMNS <S>
	      The  number  of  columns	for  this  terminal session.  Used for
	      printing select lists and for the line editor.

       DIRSTACKSIZE
	      The maximum size of the directory	 stack.	  If  the  stack  gets
	      larger  than  this, it will be truncated automatically.  This is
	      useful with the AUTO_PUSHD option.

       ENV    If the ENV environment variable is set when zsh is invoked as sh
	      or ksh, $ENV is sourced after the profile scripts.  The value of
	      ENV is subjected to parameter expansion,	command	 substitution,
	      and arithmetic expansion before being interpreted as a pathname.
	      Note that ENV is not used unless zsh is emulating sh or ksh.

       FCEDIT The default editor for the fc builtin.

       fignore <S> <Z> (FIGNORE <S>)
	      An array (colon separated list) containing the suffixes of files
	      to  be  ignored during filename completion.  However, if comple‐
	      tion only generates files with suffixes in this list, then these
	      files are completed anyway.

       fpath <S> <Z> (FPATH <S>)
	      An  array	 (colon	 separated list) of directories specifying the
	      search path for function definitions.   This  path  is  searched
	      when a function with the -u attribute is referenced.  If an exe‐
	      cutable file is found, then it is read and executed in the  cur‐
	      rent environment.

       histchars <S>
	      Three  characters used by the shell's history and lexical analy‐
	      sis mechanism.  The first character signals the start of a  his‐
	      tory  expansion (default `!').  The second character signals the
	      start of a quick history substitution (default `^').  The	 third
	      character is the comment character (default `#').

       HISTCHARS <S> <Z>
	      Same as histchars.  (Deprecated.)

       HISTFILE
	      The file to save the history in when an interactive shell exits.
	      If unset, the history is not saved.

       HISTSIZE <S>
	      The maximum number of events  stored  in	the  internal  history
	      list.   If  you  use  the HIST_EXPIRE_DUPS_FIRST option, setting
	      this value larger than the SAVEHIST size will give you the  dif‐
	      ference as a cushion for saving duplicated history events.

       HOME <S>
	      The default argument for the cd command.

       IFS <S>
	      Internal	field  separators  (by default space, tab, newline and
	      NUL), that are used to separate words which result from  command
	      or  parameter expansion and words read by the read builtin.  Any
	      characters from the set space, tab and newline  that  appear  in
	      the IFS are called IFS white space.  One or more IFS white space
	      characters or one non-IFS white space  character	together  with
	      any  adjacent  IFS white space character delimit a field.	 If an
	      IFS white space character appears	 twice	consecutively  in  the
	      IFS,  this  character  is treated as if it were not an IFS white
	      space character.

       KEYTIMEOUT
	      The time the shell waits, in hundredths of seconds, for  another
	      key to be pressed when reading bound multi-character sequences.

       LANG <S>
	      This  variable  determines  the locale category for any category
	      not specifically selected via a variable starting with `LC_'.

       LC_ALL <S>
	      This variable overrides the value of the `LANG' variable and the
	      value of any of the other variables starting with `LC_'.

       LC_COLLATE <S>
	      This  variable determines the locale category for character col‐
	      lation information within ranges in glob brackets and for	 sort‐
	      ing.

       LC_CTYPE <S>
	      This  variable determines the locale category for character han‐
	      dling functions.

       LC_MESSAGES <S>
	      This variable determines the language in which  messages	should
	      be written.  Note that zsh does not use message catalogs.

       LC_NUMERIC <S>
	      This  variable affects the decimal point character and thousands
	      separator character for the formatted input/output functions and
	      string conversion functions.  Note that zsh ignores this setting
	      when parsing floating point mathematical expressions.

       LC_TIME <S>
	      This variable determines the locale category for date  and  time
	      formatting in prompt escape sequences.

       LINES <S>
	      The  number of lines for this terminal session.  Used for print‐
	      ing select lists and for the line editor.

       LISTMAX
	      In the line editor, the number of matches to list without asking
	      first.  If  the  value is negative, the list will be shown if it
	      spans at most as many lines as given by the absolute value.   If
	      set to zero, the shell asks only if the top of the listing would
	      scroll off the screen.

       LOGCHECK
	      The interval in seconds between checks for login/logout activity
	      using the watch parameter.

       MAIL   If  this	parameter  is  set  and mailpath is not set, the shell
	      looks for mail in the specified file.

       MAILCHECK
	      The interval in seconds between checks for new mail.

       mailpath <S> <Z> (MAILPATH <S>)
	      An array (colon-separated list) of filenames to  check  for  new
	      mail.  Each filename can be followed by a `?' and a message that
	      will be printed.	The message will undergo parameter  expansion,
	      command  substitution and arithmetic expansion with the variable
	      $_ defined as the name  of  the  file  that  has	changed.   The
	      default  message	is  `You  have	new mail'.  If an element is a
	      directory instead of a file the  shell  will  recursively	 check
	      every file in every subdirectory of the element.

       manpath <S> <Z> (MANPATH <S> <Z>)
	      An  array	 (colon-separated list) whose value is not used by the
	      shell.  The manpath array can be useful, however, since  setting
	      it also sets MANPATH, and vice versa.

       module_path <S> <Z> (MODULE_PATH <S>)
	      An  array	 (colon-separated  list)  of directories that zmodload
	      searches for dynamically loadable modules.  This is  initialized
	      to  a  standard  pathname, usually `/usr/local/lib/zsh/$ZSH_VER‐
	      SION'.  (The `/usr/local/lib' part varies from  installation  to
	      installation.)  For security reasons, any value set in the envi‐
	      ronment when the shell is started will be ignored.

	      These parameters only exist if the installation supports dynamic
	      module loading.

       NULLCMD <S>
	      The command name to assume if a redirection is specified with no
	      command.	Defaults to cat.  For sh/ksh behavior, change this  to
	      :.   For csh-like behavior, unset this parameter; the shell will
	      print an error message if null commands are entered.

       path <S> <Z> (PATH <S>)
	      An array (colon-separated list) of  directories  to  search  for
	      commands.	 When this parameter is set, each directory is scanned
	      and all files found are put in a hash table.

       POSTEDIT <S>
	      This string is output whenever the line editor exits.   It  usu‐
	      ally contains termcap strings to reset the terminal.

       PROMPT <S> <Z>
       PROMPT2 <S> <Z>
       PROMPT3 <S> <Z>
       PROMPT4 <S> <Z>
	      Same as PS1, PS2, PS3 and PS4, respectively.

       prompt <S> <Z>
	      Same as PS1.

       PS1 <S>
	      The  primary  prompt  string,  printed before a command is read.
	      the default is `%m%# '.  It undergoes a special form  of	expan‐
	      sion before being displayed; see the section `Prompt Expansion'.

       PS2 <S>
	      The secondary prompt, printed when the shell needs more informa‐
	      tion to complete a command.  It is expanded in the same  way  as
	      PS1.  The default is `%_> ', which displays any shell constructs
	      or quotation marks which are currently being processed.

       PS3 <S>
	      Selection prompt used within a select loop.  It is  expanded  in
	      the same way as PS1.  The default is `?# '.

       PS4 <S>
	      The  execution  trace prompt.  Default is `+%N:%i> ', which dis‐
	      plays the name of the current shell structure and the line  num‐
	      ber within it.  In sh or ksh emulation, the default is `+ '.

       psvar <S> <Z> (PSVAR <S>)
	      An  array	 (colon-separated list) whose first nine values can be
	      used in PROMPT strings.  Setting psvar also sets PSVAR, and vice
	      versa.

       READNULLCMD <S>
	      The  command  name  to  assume  if a single input redirection is
	      specified with no command.  Defaults to more.

       REPORTTIME
	      If nonnegative, commands whose combined user and	system	execu‐
	      tion  times  (measured  in  seconds) are greater than this value
	      have timing statistics printed for them.

       REPLY  This parameter is reserved by convention to pass	string	values
	      between  shell  scripts and shell builtins in situations where a
	      function call or redirection are impossible or undesirable.  The
	      read  builtin  and the select complex command may set REPLY, and
	      filename generation both sets and examines its value when evalu‐
	      ating  certain  expressions.  Some modules also employ REPLY for
	      similar purposes.

       reply  As REPLY, but for array values rather than strings.

       RPROMPT <S>
       RPS1 <S>
	      This prompt is displayed on the right-hand side  of  the	screen
	      when  the	 primary  prompt is being displayed on the left.  This
	      does not work  if	 the  SINGLELINEZLE  option  is	 set.	It  is
	      expanded in the same way as PS1.

       RPROMPT2 <S>
       RPS2 <S>
	      This  prompt  is	displayed on the right-hand side of the screen
	      when the secondary prompt is being displayed on the left.	  This
	      does  not	 work  if  the	SINGLELINEZLE  option  is  set.	 It is
	      expanded in the same way as PS2.

       SAVEHIST
	      The maximum number of history events  to	save  in  the  history
	      file.

       SPROMPT <S>
	      The  prompt  used	 for  spelling	correction.  The sequence `%R'
	      expands to the string which presumably  needs  spelling  correc‐
	      tion,  and  `%r'	expands to the proposed correction.  All other
	      prompt escapes are also allowed.

       STTY   If this parameter is set in a command's environment,  the	 shell
	      runs  the stty command with the value of this parameter as argu‐
	      ments in order to set up the terminal before executing the  com‐
	      mand. The modes apply only to the command, and are reset when it
	      finishes or is suspended. If the command is suspended  and  con‐
	      tinued  later with the fg or wait builtins it will see the modes
	      specified by STTY, as if it were not  suspended.	 This  (inten‐
	      tionally)	 does  not apply if the command is continued via `kill
	      -CONT'.  STTY is ignored if the command  is  run	in  the	 back‐
	      ground,  or  if  it  is  in the environment of the shell but not
	      explicitly assigned to in the input line.	 This  avoids  running
	      stty  at	every  external	 command by accidentally exporting it.
	      Also note that STTY should not be used for window size  specifi‐
	      cations; these will not be local to the command.

       TERM <S>
	      The type of terminal in use.  This is used when looking up term‐
	      cap sequences.  An assignment to TERM causes zsh to  re-initial‐
	      ize  the	terminal,  even	 if  the  value does not change (e.g.,
	      `TERM=$TERM').  It is necessary to make such an assignment  upon
	      any  change to the terminal definition database or terminal type
	      in order for the new settings to take effect.

       TIMEFMT
	      The format of process time reports with the time	keyword.   The
	      default is `%E real  %U user  %S system  %P %J'.	Recognizes the
	      following escape sequences, although not all may be available on
	      all systems, and some that are available may not be useful:

	      %%     A `%'.
	      %U     CPU seconds spent in user mode.
	      %S     CPU seconds spent in kernel mode.
	      %E     Elapsed time in seconds.
	      %P     The CPU percentage, computed as (100*%U+%S)/%E.
	      %W     Number of times the process was swapped.
	      %X     The average amount in (shared) text space used in Kbytes.
	      %D     The average amount in (unshared) data/stack space used in
		     Kbytes.
	      %K     The total space used (%X+%D) in Kbytes.
	      %M     The  maximum memory the process had in use at any time in
		     Kbytes.
	      %F     The  number  of  major  page  faults  (page  needed to be
		     brought from disk).
	      %R     The number of minor page faults.
	      %I     The number of input operations.
	      %O     The number of output operations.
	      %r     The number of socket messages received.
	      %s     The number of socket messages sent.
	      %k     The number of signals received.
	      %w     Number of voluntary context switches (waits).
	      %c     Number of involuntary context switches.
	      %J     The name of this job.

	      A star may be inserted between the percent sign and flags print‐
	      ing  time.   This cause the time to be printed in `hh:mm:ss.ttt'
	      format (hours and minutes are  only  printed  if	they  are  not
	      zero).

       TMOUT  If  this	parameter  is  nonzero, the shell will receive an ALRM
	      signal if a command is not entered within the  specified	number
	      of  seconds  after  issuing  a  prompt.  If  there  is a trap on
	      SIGALRM, it will be executed and a new alarm is scheduled	 using
	      the  value  of the TMOUT parameter after executing the trap.  If
	      no trap is set, and the idle time of the terminal	 is  not  less
	      than  the	 value of the TMOUT parameter, zsh terminates.	Other‐
	      wise a new alarm is scheduled to TMOUT seconds  after  the  last
	      keypress.

       TMPPREFIX
	      A	 pathname  prefix  which  the shell will use for all temporary
	      files.  Note that this should include an initial	part  for  the
	      file  name  as  well  as	any  directory	names.	The default is
	      `/tmp/zsh'.

       watch <S> <Z> (WATCH <S>)
	      An  array	 (colon-separated  list)  of  login/logout  events  to
	      report.	If  it	contains  the  single  word  `all',  then  all
	      login/logout events are reported.	 If  it	 contains  the	single
	      word  `notme', then all events are reported as with `all' except
	      $USERNAME.  An entry in this list may consist of a username,  an
	      `@'  followed by a remote hostname, and a `%' followed by a line
	      (tty).  Any or all of these components  may  be  present	in  an
	      entry;  if  a  login/logout  event  matches  all	of them, it is
	      reported.

       WATCHFMT
	      The format of login/logout reports if  the  watch	 parameter  is
	      set.  Default is `%n has %a %l from %m'.	Recognizes the follow‐
	      ing escape sequences:

	      %n     The name of the user that logged in/out.

	      %a     The observed action, i.e. "logged on" or "logged off".

	      %l     The line (tty) the user is logged in on.

	      %M     The full hostname of the remote host.

	      %m     The hostname up to the first `.'.	If only the IP address
		     is	 available  or	the utmp field contains the name of an
		     X-windows display, the whole name is printed.

		     NOTE: The `%m' and `%M' escapes will work only  if	 there
		     is a host name field in the utmp on your machine.	Other‐
		     wise they are treated as ordinary strings.

	      %S (%s)
		     Start (stop) standout mode.

	      %U (%u)
		     Start (stop) underline mode.

	      %B (%b)
		     Start (stop) boldface mode.

	      %t
	      %@     The time, in 12-hour, am/pm format.

	      %T     The time, in 24-hour format.

	      %w     The date in `day-dd' format.

	      %W     The date in `mm/dd/yy' format.

	      %D     The date in `yy-mm-dd' format.

	      %(x:true-text:false-text)
		     Specifies a ternary expression.  The character  following
		     the  x  is arbitrary; the same character is used to sepa‐
		     rate the text for the "true" result  from	that  for  the
		     "false"  result.  Both the separator and the right paren‐
		     thesis may be escaped with a backslash.  Ternary  expres‐
		     sions may be nested.

		     The  test	character x may be any one of `l', `n', `m' or
		     `M', which indicate a `true' result if the	 corresponding
		     escape sequence would return a non-empty value; or it may
		     be `a', which indicates a `true' result  if  the  watched
		     user  has	logged	in,  or	 `false' if he has logged out.
		     Other characters evaluate to neither true nor false;  the
		     entire expression is omitted in this case.

		     If	 the result is `true', then the true-text is formatted
		     according	to  the	 rules	above  and  printed,  and  the
		     false-text	 is  skipped.	If  `false',  the true-text is
		     skipped and the  false-text  is  formatted	 and  printed.
		     Either  or	 both  of  the branches may be empty, but both
		     separators must be present in any case.

       WORDCHARS <S>
	      A list of non-alphanumeric characters considered part of a  word
	      by the line editor.

       ZBEEP  If set, this gives a string of characters, which can use all the
	      same codes as the bindkey command as described  in  the  zsh/zle
	      module entry in zshmodules(1), that will be output to the termi‐
	      nal instead of beeping.  This may have a visible instead	of  an
	      audible  effect;	for  example,  the  string `\e[?5h\e[?5l' on a
	      vt100 or xterm will have the effect of flashing reverse video on
	      and  off	(if  you usually use reverse video, you should use the
	      string `\e[?5l\e[?5h' instead).  This takes precedence over  the
	      NOBEEP option.

       ZDOTDIR
	      The  directory  to search for shell startup files (.zshrc, etc),
	      if not $HOME.

ZSHOPTIONS(1)							 ZSHOPTIONS(1)

NAME
       zshoptions - zsh options

SPECIFYING OPTIONS
       Options are primarily referred to by name.  These names are case insen‐
       sitive and underscores are ignored.  For example, `allexport' is equiv‐
       alent to `A__lleXP_ort'.

       The sense of an option name may be inverted by preceding it with	 `no',
       so  `setopt  No_Beep' is equivalent to `unsetopt beep'.	This inversion
       can only be done once, so `nonobeep' is not a synonym for `beep'.  Sim‐
       ilarly,	`tify'	is  not	 a  synonym  for  `nonotify' (the inversion of
       `notify').

       Some options also have one or more single letter names.	There are  two
       sets of single letter options: one used by default, and another used to
       emulate sh/ksh (used when the SH_OPTION_LETTERS option  is  set).   The
       single  letter  options	can be used on the shell command line, or with
       the set, setopt and unsetopt builtins, as normal Unix options  preceded
       by `-'.

       The  sense  of  the  single letter options may be inverted by using `+'
       instead of `-'.	Some of the single letter option  names	 refer	to  an
       option  being  off,  in which case the inversion of that name refers to
       the option being on.  For example, `+n' is the short  name  of  `exec',
       and `-n' is the short name of its inversion, `noexec'.

       In  strings  of single letter options supplied to the shell at startup,
       trailing whitespace will be ignored; for example the  string  `-f     '
       will  be treated just as `-f', but the string `-f i' is an error.  This
       is because many systems which implement the `#!' mechanism for  calling
       scripts do not strip trailing whitespace.

DESCRIPTION OF OPTIONS
       In  the	following  list,  options set by default in all emulations are
       marked <D>; those set by default only in csh, ksh, sh,  or  zsh	emula‐
       tions  are  marked  <C>,	 <K>,  <S>,  <Z> as appropriate.  When listing
       options (by `setopt', `unsetopt', `set -o' or `set +o'),	 those	turned
       on  by  default	appear	in the list prefixed with `no'.	 Hence (unless
       KSH_OPTION_PRINT is set), `setopt' shows all options whose settings are
       changed from the default.

   Changing Directories
       AUTO_CD (-J)
	      If  a  command is issued that can't be executed as a normal com‐
	      mand, and the command is the name of a directory, perform the cd
	      command to that directory.

       AUTO_PUSHD (-N)
	      Make cd push the old directory onto the directory stack.

       CDABLE_VARS (-T)
	      If  the  argument	 to  a	cd  command (or an implied cd with the
	      AUTO_CD option set) is not a directory, and does not begin  with
	      a	 slash, try to expand the expression as if it were preceded by
	      a `~' (see the section `Filename Expansion').

       CHASE_DOTS
	      When changing to a directory  containing	a  path	 segment  `..'
	      which  would otherwise be treated as canceling the previous seg‐
	      ment in the path (in other words, `foo/..' would be removed from
	      the  path,  or  if  `..' is the first part of the path, the last
	      part of $PWD would be deleted), instead resolve the path to  the
	      physical directory.  This option is overridden by CHASE_LINKS.

	      For  example,  suppose  /foo/bar	is  a  link  to	 the directory
	      /alt/rod.	 Without this option set, `cd /foo/bar/..' changes  to
	      /foo;  with it set, it changes to /alt.  The same applies if the
	      current directory is /foo/bar and `cd ..' is  used.   Note  that
	      all other symbolic links in the path will also be resolved.

       CHASE_LINKS (-w)
	      Resolve symbolic links to their true values when changing direc‐
	      tory.  This also has the effect of CHASE_DOTS, i.e. a `..'  path
	      segment  will  be	 treated  as referring to the physical parent,
	      even if the preceding path segment is a symbolic link.

       PUSHD_IGNORE_DUPS
	      Don't push multiple copies of the same directory onto the direc‐
	      tory stack.

       PUSHD_MINUS
	      Exchanges the meanings of `+' and `-' when used with a number to
	      specify a directory in the stack.

       PUSHD_SILENT (-E)
	      Do not print the directory stack after pushd or popd.

       PUSHD_TO_HOME (-D)
	      Have pushd with no arguments act like `pushd $HOME'.

   Completion
       ALWAYS_LAST_PROMPT <D>
	      If unset, key functions that list completions try to  return  to
	      the  last prompt if given a numeric argument. If set these func‐
	      tions try to return to the last prompt if given no numeric argu‐
	      ment.

       ALWAYS_TO_END
	      If  a completion is performed with the cursor within a word, and
	      a full completion is inserted, the cursor is moved to the end of
	      the  word.   That is, the cursor is moved to the end of the word
	      if either a single match is inserted or menu completion is  per‐
	      formed.

       AUTO_LIST (-9) <D>
	      Automatically list choices on an ambiguous completion.

       AUTO_MENU <D>
	      Automatically  use  menu completion after the second consecutive
	      request for completion, for example  by  pressing	 the  tab  key
	      repeatedly. This option is overridden by MENU_COMPLETE.

       AUTO_NAME_DIRS
	      Any  parameter  that  is set to the absolute name of a directory
	      immediately becomes a name for that directory, that will be used
	      by  the `%~' and related prompt sequences, and will be available
	      when completion is performed on a word starting with `~'.	 (Oth‐
	      erwise, the parameter must be used in the form `~param' first.)

       AUTO_PARAM_KEYS <D>
	      If  a  parameter	name  was  completed and a following character
	      (normally a space) automatically inserted, and the next  charac‐
	      ter  typed  is one of those that have to come directly after the
	      name (like `}', `:', etc.), the automatically added character is
	      deleted, so that the character typed comes immediately after the
	      parameter name.  Completion in a	brace  expansion  is  affected
	      similarly:  the  added character is a `,', which will be removed
	      if `}' is typed next.

       AUTO_PARAM_SLASH <D>
	      If a parameter is completed whose	 content  is  the  name	 of  a
	      directory, then add a trailing slash instead of a space.

       AUTO_REMOVE_SLASH <D>
	      When  the	 last character resulting from a completion is a slash
	      and the next character typed is a word delimiter, a slash, or  a
	      character	 that ends a command (such as a semicolon or an amper‐
	      sand), remove the slash.

       BASH_AUTO_LIST
	      On an ambiguous completion, automatically list choices when  the
	      completion  function  is called twice in succession.  This takes
	      precedence over AUTO_LIST.  The  setting	of  LIST_AMBIGUOUS  is
	      respected.   If  AUTO_MENU  is set, the menu behaviour will then
	      start with the third press.  Note that this will not  work  with
	      MENU_COMPLETE, since repeated completion calls immediately cycle
	      through the list in that case.

       COMPLETE_ALIASES
	      Prevents aliases on the command line from being internally  sub‐
	      stituted	before completion is attempted.	 The effect is to make
	      the alias a distinct command for completion purposes.

       COMPLETE_IN_WORD
	      If unset, the cursor is set to the end of the word if completion
	      is started. Otherwise it stays there and completion is done from
	      both ends.

       GLOB_COMPLETE
	      When the current word has a glob pattern, do not insert all  the
	      words  resulting	from the expansion but generate matches as for
	      completion  and  cycle  through  them  like  MENU_COMPLETE.  The
	      matches  are  generated  as if a `*' was added to the end of the
	      word, or inserted at the cursor when  COMPLETE_IN_WORD  is  set.
	      This  actually  uses pattern matching, not globbing, so it works
	      not only for files but for any completion, such as options, user
	      names, etc.

	      Note  that  when	the  pattern matcher is used, matching control
	      (for example, case-insensitive or anchored matching)  cannot  be
	      used.   This  limitation only applies when the current word con‐
	      tains a pattern; simply turning on the GLOB_COMPLETE option does
	      not have this effect.

       HASH_LIST_ALL <D>
	      Whenever a command completion is attempted, make sure the entire
	      command path is hashed first.  This makes the  first  completion
	      slower.

       LIST_AMBIGUOUS <D>
	      This  option works when AUTO_LIST or BASH_AUTO_LIST is also set.
	      If there is an unambiguous prefix to insert on the command line,
	      that is done without a completion list being displayed; in other
	      words, auto-listing behaviour  only  takes  place	 when  nothing
	      would  be	 inserted.   In the case of BASH_AUTO_LIST, this means
	      that the list will be delayed to the third call of the function.

       LIST_BEEP <D>
	      Beep on an ambiguous completion.	More accurately,  this	forces
	      the  completion  widgets to return status 1 on an ambiguous com‐
	      pletion, which causes the shell to beep if the  option  BEEP  is
	      also  set;  this	may be modified if completion is called from a
	      user-defined widget.

       LIST_PACKED
	      Try to make the completion list smaller (occupying  less	lines)
	      by printing the matches in columns with different widths.

       LIST_ROWS_FIRST
	      Lay  out	the  matches  in completion lists sorted horizontally,
	      that is, the second match is to the right of the first one,  not
	      under it as usual.

       LIST_TYPES (-X) <D>
	      When  listing files that are possible completions, show the type
	      of each file with a trailing identifying mark.

       MENU_COMPLETE (-Y)
	      On an ambiguous completion, instead of listing possibilities  or
	      beeping,	insert the first match immediately.  Then when comple‐
	      tion is requested again, remove the first match and  insert  the
	      second  match,  etc.  When there are no more matches, go back to
	      the first one again.  reverse-menu-complete may be used to  loop
	      through  the  list in the other direction. This option overrides
	      AUTO_MENU.

       REC_EXACT (-S)
	      In completion, recognize exact matches even if they are  ambigu‐
	      ous.

   Expansion and Globbing
       BAD_PATTERN (+2) <C> <Z>
	      If  a  pattern for filename generation is badly formed, print an
	      error message.  (If this option is unset, the  pattern  will  be
	      left unchanged.)

       BARE_GLOB_QUAL <Z>
	      In  a  glob  pattern,  treat  a trailing set of parentheses as a
	      qualifier list, if it contains no `|', `(' or (if	 special)  `~'
	      characters.  See the section `Filename Generation'.

       BRACE_CCL
	      Expand  expressions  in braces which would not otherwise undergo
	      brace expansion to a lexically ordered list of all  the  charac‐
	      ters.  See the section `Brace Expansion'.

       CASE_GLOB <D>
	      Make  globbing  (filename	 generation)  sensitive to case.  Note
	      that other uses of patterns are always sensitive	to  case.   If
	      the option is unset, the presence of any character which is spe‐
	      cial to filename generation will cause  case-insensitive	match‐
	      ing.   For  example, cvs(/) can match the directory CVS owing to
	      the  presence  of	 the  globbing	 flag	(unless	  the	option
	      BARE_GLOB_QUAL is unset).

       CSH_NULL_GLOB <C>
	      If  a pattern for filename generation has no matches, delete the
	      pattern from the argument list; do not report  an	 error	unless
	      all  the	patterns  in  a	 command  have	no matches.  Overrides
	      NOMATCH.

       EQUALS <Z>
	      Perform = filename expansion.  (See the section `Filename Expan‐
	      sion'.)

       EXTENDED_GLOB
	      Treat  the  `#',	`~' and `^' characters as part of patterns for
	      filename generation, etc.	 (An initial unquoted `~' always  pro‐
	      duces named directory expansion.)

       GLOB (+F, ksh: +f) <D>
	      Perform filename generation (globbing).  (See the section `File‐
	      name Generation'.)

       GLOB_ASSIGN <C>
	      If this option is set, filename generation  (globbing)  is  per‐
	      formed on the right hand side of scalar parameter assignments of
	      the form `name=pattern (e.g. `foo=*').  If the result  has  more
	      than  one	 word  the  parameter  will become an array with those
	      words as arguments. This option is provided for  backwards  com‐
	      patibility  only: globbing is always performed on the right hand
	      side of array  assignments  of  the  form	 `name=(value)'	 (e.g.
	      `foo=(*)')  and  this form is recommended for clarity; with this
	      option set, it is not possible to	 predict  whether  the	result
	      will be an array or a scalar.

       GLOB_DOTS (-4)
	      Do not require a leading `.' in a filename to be matched explic‐
	      itly.

       GLOB_SUBST <C> <K> <S>
	      Treat any characters resulting from parameter expansion as being
	      eligible	for  file  expansion  and filename generation, and any
	      characters resulting from command substitution as being eligible
	      for  filename generation.	 Braces (and commas in between) do not
	      become eligible for expansion.

       IGNORE_BRACES (-I) <S>
	      Do not perform brace expansion.

       KSH_GLOB <K>
	      In  pattern  matching,  the  interpretation  of  parentheses  is
	      affected by a preceding `@', `*', `+', `?' or `!'.  See the sec‐
	      tion `Filename Generation'.

       MAGIC_EQUAL_SUBST
	      All unquoted arguments of the form `anything=expression' appear‐
	      ing  after  the  command	name have filename expansion (that is,
	      where expression has a leading `~' or `=') performed on  expres‐
	      sion  as if it were a parameter assignment.  The argument is not
	      otherwise treated specially; it is passed to the	command	 as  a
	      single argument, and not used as an actual parameter assignment.
	      For example, in echo  foo=~/bar:~/rod,  both  occurrences	 of  ~
	      would  be	 replaced.  Note that this happens anyway with typeset
	      and similar statements.

	      This option respects the setting of the KSH_TYPESET option.   In
	      other  words,  if	 both options are in effect, arguments looking
	      like assignments will not undergo wordsplitting.

       MARK_DIRS (-8, ksh: -X)
	      Append a trailing `/' to	all  directory	names  resulting  from
	      filename generation (globbing).

       NOMATCH (+3) <C> <Z>
	      If  a  pattern  for filename generation has no matches, print an
	      error, instead of leaving it unchanged  in  the  argument	 list.
	      This also applies to file expansion of an initial `~' or `='.

       NULL_GLOB (-G)
	      If  a pattern for filename generation has no matches, delete the
	      pattern from the argument list instead of	 reporting  an	error.
	      Overrides NOMATCH.

       NUMERIC_GLOB_SORT
	      If  numeric  filenames are matched by a filename generation pat‐
	      tern, sort the filenames numerically rather  than	 lexicographi‐
	      cally.

       RC_EXPAND_PARAM (-P)
	      Array  expansions of the form `foo${xx}bar', where the parameter
	      xx is set to (a b c),  are  substituted  with  `fooabar  foobbar
	      foocbar' instead of the default `fooa b cbar'.

       SH_GLOB <K> <S>
	      Disables	the special meaning of `(', `|', `)' and '<' for glob‐
	      bing the result of parameter and command substitutions,  and  in
	      some other places where the shell accepts patterns.  This option
	      is set by default if zsh is invoked as sh or ksh.

       UNSET (+u, ksh: +u) <K> <S> <Z>
	      Treat unset parameters as if they were empty when	 substituting.
	      Otherwise they are treated as an error.

   History
       APPEND_HISTORY <D>
	      If  this	is set, zsh sessions will append their history list to
	      the history file, rather than overwrite it. Thus, multiple  par‐
	      allel  zsh  sessions  will all have their history lists added to
	      the history file, in the order they are killed.

       BANG_HIST (+K) <C> <Z>
	      Perform textual history expansion, csh-style, treating the char‐
	      acter `!' specially.

       EXTENDED_HISTORY <C>
	      Save  each  command's  beginning timestamp (in seconds since the
	      epoch) and the duration (in seconds) to the history  file.   The
	      format of this prefixed data is:

	      `:<beginning time>:<elapsed seconds>:<command>'.

       HIST_ALLOW_CLOBBER
	      Add `|' to output redirections in the history.  This allows his‐
	      tory references to clobber files even when CLOBBER is unset.

       HIST_BEEP <D>
	      Beep when an attempt is made to access  a	 history  entry	 which
	      isn't there.

       HIST_EXPIRE_DUPS_FIRST
	      If  the  internal history needs to be trimmed to add the current
	      command line, setting this option will cause the oldest  history
	      event  that  has	a  duplicate to be lost before losing a unique
	      event from the list.  You should be sure to  set	the  value  of
	      HISTSIZE	to  a larger number than SAVEHIST in order to give you
	      some room for the duplicated events, otherwise this option  will
	      behave  just like HIST_IGNORE_ALL_DUPS once the history fills up
	      with unique events.

       HIST_FIND_NO_DUPS
	      When searching for history entries in the line  editor,  do  not
	      display  duplicates  of  a  line	previously  found, even if the
	      duplicates are not contiguous.

       HIST_IGNORE_ALL_DUPS
	      If a new command line being added to the history list duplicates
	      an  older	 one, the older command is removed from the list (even
	      if it is not the previous event).

       HIST_IGNORE_DUPS (-h)
	      Do not enter command lines into the history  list	 if  they  are
	      duplicates of the previous event.

       HIST_IGNORE_SPACE (-g)
	      Remove  command lines from the history list when the first char‐
	      acter on the line is a  space,  or  when	one  of	 the  expanded
	      aliases contains a leading space.	 Note that the command lingers
	      in the internal history until the next command is entered before
	      it vanishes, allowing you to briefly reuse or edit the line.  If
	      you want to make it vanish right away without  entering  another
	      command, type a space and press return.

       HIST_NO_FUNCTIONS
	      Remove  function	definitions  from the history list.  Note that
	      the function lingers in the internal history until the next com‐
	      mand  is entered before it vanishes, allowing you to briefly re‐
	      use or edit the definition.

       HIST_NO_STORE
	      Remove the history (fc -l) command from the  history  list  when
	      invoked.	 Note that the command lingers in the internal history
	      until the next command is entered before it  vanishes,  allowing
	      you to briefly reuse or edit the line.

       HIST_REDUCE_BLANKS
	      Remove  superfluous blanks from each command line being added to
	      the history list.

       HIST_SAVE_NO_DUPS
	      When writing out the history file, older commands that duplicate
	      newer ones are omitted.

       HIST_VERIFY
	      Whenever	the  user  enters a line with history expansion, don't
	      execute the line directly; instead,  perform  history  expansion
	      and reload the line into the editing buffer.

       INC_APPEND_HISTORY
	      This  options  works like APPEND_HISTORY except that new history
	      lines are added to the $HISTFILE incrementally (as soon as  they
	      are  entered),  rather  than  waiting until the shell is killed.
	      The file is periodically trimmed to the number of	 lines	speci‐
	      fied by $SAVEHIST, but can exceed this value between trimmings.

       SHARE_HISTORY <K>

	      This option both imports new commands from the history file, and
	      also causes your typed commands to be appended  to  the  history
	      file  (the  latter  is like specifying INC_APPEND_HISTORY).  The
	      history lines are also output with timestamps ala	 EXTENDED_HIS‐
	      TORY  (which  makes it easier to find the spot where we left off
	      reading the file after it gets re-written).

	      By default, history movement commands visit the  imported	 lines
	      as  well	as the local lines, but you can toggle this on and off
	      with the set-local-history zle binding.  It is also possible  to
	      create a zle widget that will make some commands ignore imported
	      commands, and some include them.

	      If you find that you want more control over  when	 commands  get
	      imported,	   you	 may   wish   to   turn	  SHARE_HISTORY	  off,
	      INC_APPEND_HISTORY on, and then manually import  commands	 when‐
	      ever you need them using `fc -RI'.

   Initialisation
       ALL_EXPORT (-a, ksh: -a)
	      All parameters subsequently defined are automatically exported.

       GLOBAL_EXPORT (<Z>)
	      If  this	option	is  set,  passing  the -x flag to the builtins
	      declare, float, integer, readonly and typeset  (but  not	local)
	      will  also  set  the  -g flag;  hence parameters exported to the
	      environment will not be made local to  the  enclosing  function,
	      unless they were already or the flag +g is given explicitly.  If
	      the option is unset, exported parameters will be made  local  in
	      just the same way as any other parameter.

	      This  option is set by default for backward compatibility; it is
	      not recommended that its behaviour be relied  upon.   Note  that
	      the  builtin  export  always  sets both the -x and -g flags, and
	      hence its effect extends beyond the scope of the enclosing func‐
	      tion; this is the most portable way to achieve this behaviour.

       GLOBAL_RCS (-d) <D>
	      If  this	option	is  unset,  the	 startup  files /etc/zprofile,
	      /etc/zshrc, /etc/zlogin and /etc/zlogout will not	 be  run.   It
	      can  be  disabled	 and  re-enabled at any time, including inside
	      local startup files (.zshrc, etc.).

       RCS (+f) <D>
	      After /etc/zshenv is sourced on  startup,	 source	 the  .zshenv,
	      /etc/zprofile, .zprofile, /etc/zshrc, .zshrc, /etc/zlogin, .zlo‐
	      gin, and .zlogout files, as described in	the  section  `Files'.
	      If  this option is unset, the /etc/zshenv file is still sourced,
	      but any of the others will not be; it can be set at any time  to
	      prevent  the remaining startup files after the currently execut‐
	      ing one from being sourced.

   Input/Output
       ALIASES <D>
	      Expand aliases.

       CLOBBER (+C, ksh: +C) <D>
	      Allows `>' redirection to truncate existing files, and  `>>'  to
	      create files.  Otherwise `>!' or `>|' must be used to truncate a
	      file, and `>>!' or `>>|' to create a file.

       CORRECT (-0)
	      Try to correct the spelling of commands.	Note  that,  when  the
	      HASH_LIST_ALL  option is not set or when some directories in the
	      path are not readable, this may falsely report  spelling	errors
	      the first time some commands are used.

       CORRECT_ALL (-O)
	      Try to correct the spelling of all arguments in a line.

       DVORAK Use  the Dvorak keyboard instead of the standard qwerty keyboard
	      as a basis for examining spelling mistakes for the  CORRECT  and
	      CORRECT_ALL options and the spell-word editor command.

       FLOW_CONTROL <D>
	      If  this	option	is  unset,  output flow control via start/stop
	      characters (usually  assigned  to	 ^S/^Q)	 is  disabled  in  the
	      shell's editor.

       IGNORE_EOF (-7)
	      Do  not  exit on end-of-file.  Require the use of exit or logout
	      instead.	However, ten consecutive EOFs will cause the shell  to
	      exit anyway, to avoid the shell hanging if its tty goes away.

	      Also,  if	 this  option  is set and the Zsh Line Editor is used,
	      widgets implemented by shell functions can be bound to EOF (nor‐
	      mally  Control-D)	 without  printing the normal warning message.
	      This works only for normal widgets, not for completion widgets.

       INTERACTIVE_COMMENTS (-k) <K> <S>
	      Allow comments even in interactive shells.

       HASH_CMDS <D>
	      Note the location of each command the first time it is executed.
	      Subsequent  invocations  of  the same command will use the saved
	      location, avoiding a path search.	 If this option is  unset,  no
	      path hashing is done at all.  However, when CORRECT is set, com‐
	      mands whose names do not appear in the functions or aliases hash
	      tables  are  hashed in order to avoid reporting them as spelling
	      errors.

       HASH_DIRS <D>
	      Whenever a command name is hashed, hash the directory containing
	      it,  as  well as all directories that occur earlier in the path.
	      Has no effect if neither HASH_CMDS nor CORRECT is set.

       MAIL_WARNING (-U)
	      Print a warning message if a mail file has been  accessed	 since
	      the shell last checked.

       PATH_DIRS (-Q)
	      Perform  a  path	search	even  on command names with slashes in
	      them.  Thus if `/usr/local/bin' is in the user's path, and he or
	      she  types  `X11/xinit',	the command `/usr/local/bin/X11/xinit'
	      will be executed	(assuming  it  exists).	  Commands  explicitly
	      beginning	 with  `/',  `./' or `../' are not subject to the path
	      search.  This also applies to the . builtin.

	      Note that subdirectories of the  current	directory  are	always
	      searched	for  executables  specified  in this form.  This takes
	      place before any search indicated by this option, and regardless
	      of  whether  `.'	or the current directory appear in the command
	      search path.

       PRINT_EIGHT_BIT
	      Print eight bit characters literally in completion  lists,  etc.
	      This  option  is	not necessary if your system correctly returns
	      the printability of eight bit characters (see ctype(3)).

       PRINT_EXIT_VALUE (-1)
	      Print the exit value of programs with non-zero exit status.

       RC_QUOTES
	      Allow the character sequence `'''	 to  signify  a	 single	 quote
	      within  singly  quoted  strings.	 Note  this  does not apply in
	      quoted strings using the format $'...', where a backslashed sin‐
	      gle quote can be used.

       RM_STAR_SILENT (-H) <K> <S>
	      Do not query the user before executing `rm *' or `rm path/*'.

       RM_STAR_WAIT
	      If  querying  the	 user  before executing `rm *' or `rm path/*',
	      first wait ten seconds and ignore anything typed in  that	 time.
	      This  avoids  the	 problem of reflexively answering `yes' to the
	      query when one didn't really mean it.  The wait  and  query  can
	      always be avoided by expanding the `*' in ZLE (with tab).

       SHORT_LOOPS <C> <Z>
	      Allow  the  short forms of for, repeat, select, if, and function
	      constructs.

       SUN_KEYBOARD_HACK (-L)
	      If a line ends with a backquote, and there are an odd number  of
	      backquotes  on the line, ignore the trailing backquote.  This is
	      useful on some keyboards where the return key is too small,  and
	      the backquote key lies annoyingly close to it.

   Job Control
       AUTO_CONTINUE
	      With this option set, stopped jobs that are removed from the job
	      table with the disown builtin command are automatically  sent  a
	      CONT signal to make them running.

       AUTO_RESUME (-W)
	      Treat  single word simple commands without redirection as candi‐
	      dates for resumption of an existing job.

       BG_NICE (-6) <C> <Z>
	      Run all background jobs at a lower priority.  This option is set
	      by default.

       CHECK_JOBS <Z>
	      Report  the status of background and suspended jobs before exit‐
	      ing a shell with job control; a second attempt to exit the shell
	      will  succeed.   NO_CHECK_JOBS  is best used only in combination
	      with NO_HUP, else such jobs will be killed automatically.

	      The check is omitted if the commands run from the previous  com‐
	      mand  line  included  a  `jobs' command, since it is assumed the
	      user is aware that there are background or  suspended  jobs.   A
	      `jobs'  command  run from the precmd function is not counted for
	      this purpose.

       HUP <Z>
	      Send the HUP signal to running jobs when the shell exits.

       LONG_LIST_JOBS (-R)
	      List jobs in the long format by default.

       MONITOR (-m, ksh: -m)
	      Allow job control.  Set by default in interactive shells.

       NOTIFY (-5, ksh: -b) <Z>
	      Report the status of background jobs  immediately,  rather  than
	      waiting until just before printing a prompt.

   Prompting
       PROMPT_BANG <K>
	      If  set,	`!' is treated specially in prompt expansion.  See the
	      section `Prompt Expansion'.

       PROMPT_CR (+V) <D>
	      Print a carriage return just before printing  a  prompt  in  the
	      line  editor.   This  is	on by default as multi-line editing is
	      only possible if the editor knows where the start	 of  the  line
	      appears.

       PROMPT_PERCENT <C> <Z>
	      If  set,	`%' is treated specially in prompt expansion.  See the
	      section `Prompt Expansion'.

       PROMPT_SUBST <K>
	      If set, parameter expansion, command substitution and arithmetic
	      expansion	  are  performed  in  prompts.	 Substitutions	within
	      prompts do not affect the command status.

       TRANSIENT_RPROMPT
	      Remove any right prompt from display when	 accepting  a  command
	      line.   This  may	 be useful with terminals with other cut/paste
	      methods.

   Scripts and Functions
       C_BASES
	      Output hexadecimal numbers in the standard C format, for example
	      `0xFF' instead of the usual `16#FF'.  If the option OCTAL_ZEROES
	      is also set (it is  not  by  default),  octal  numbers  will  be
	      treated  similarly  and hence appear as `077' instead of `8#77'.
	      This option has no effect on the choice of the output base,  nor
	      on  the  output of bases other than hexadecimal and octal.  Note
	      that these formats will be understood on input  irrespective  of
	      the setting of C_BASES.

       ERR_EXIT (-e, ksh: -e)
	      If  a command has a non-zero exit status, execute the ZERR trap,
	      if set, and exit.	 This is disabled while running initialization
	      scripts.

       ERR_RETURN
	      If a command has a non-zero exit status, return immediately from
	      the enclosing function.  The logic  is  identical	 to  that  for
	      ERR_EXIT,	 except	 that an implicit return statement is executed
	      instead of an exit.  This will trigger an exit at the  outermost
	      level of a non-interactive script.

       EVAL_LINENO <Z>
	      If  set, line numbers of expressions evaluated using the builtin
	      eval are tracked separately of the enclosing environment.	  This
	      applies  both to the parameter LINENO and the line number output
	      by the prompt escape %i.	If  the	 option	 is  set,  the	prompt
	      escape  %N will output the string `(eval)' instead of the script
	      or function name as an indication.   (The two prompt escapes are
	      typically used in the parameter PS4 to be output when the option
	      XTRACE is set.)  If EVAL_LINENO is unset, the line number of the
	      surrounding  script  or  function is retained during the evalua‐
	      tion.

       EXEC (+n, ksh: +n) <D>
	      Do execute commands.  Without this option, commands are read and
	      checked for syntax errors, but not executed.  This option cannot
	      be turned off in an interactive shell, except when `-n' is  sup‐
	      plied to the shell at startup.

       FUNCTION_ARGZERO <C> <Z>
	      When  executing  a  shell	 function or sourcing a script, set $0
	      temporarily to the name of the function/script.

       LOCAL_OPTIONS <K>
	      If this option is set at the point of return from a shell	 func‐
	      tion,  all  the options (including this one) which were in force
	      upon entry to the function are restored.	Otherwise,  only  this
	      option and the XTRACE and PRINT_EXIT_VALUE options are restored.
	      Hence if this is explicitly unset by a shell function the	 other
	      options in force at the point of return will remain so.  A shell
	      function can also guarantee itself a known  shell	 configuration
	      with  a  formulation  like  `emulate  -L	zsh'; the -L activates
	      LOCAL_OPTIONS.

       LOCAL_TRAPS <K>
	      If this option is set when a signal trap is set inside  a	 func‐
	      tion,  then the previous status of the trap for that signal will
	      be restored when the function exits.  Note that this option must
	      be  set  prior  to  altering  the	 trap behaviour in a function;
	      unlike LOCAL_OPTIONS, the value on exit  from  the  function  is
	      irrelevant.   However,  it  does	not  need to be set before any
	      global trap for that to be correctly  restored  by  a  function.
	      For example,

		     unsetopt localtraps
		     trap - INT
		     fn() { setopt localtraps; trap '' INT; sleep 3; }

	      will  restore  normally  handling	 of  SIGINT after the function
	      exits.

       MULTIOS <Z>
	      Perform implicit tees or cats  when  multiple  redirections  are
	      attempted (see the section `Redirection').

       OCTAL_ZEROES <S>
	      Interpret	 any integer constant beginning with a 0 as octal, per
	      IEEE Std 1003.2-1992 (ISO 9945-2:1993).  This is not enabled  by
	      default as it causes problems with parsing of, for example, date
	      and time strings with leading zeroes.

       TYPESET_SILENT
	      If this is unset, executing any of the `typeset' family of  com‐
	      mands with no options and a list of parameters that have no val‐
	      ues to be assigned but already exist will display the  value  of
	      the  parameter.	If  the option is set, they will only be shown
	      when parameters are selected with the `-m' option.   The	option
	      `-p' is available whether or not the option is set.

       VERBOSE (-v, ksh: -v)
	      Print shell input lines as they are read.

       XTRACE (-x, ksh: -x)
	      Print commands and their arguments as they are executed.

   Shell Emulation
       BSD_ECHO <S>
	      Make  the	 echo builtin compatible with the BSD echo(1) command.
	      This disables  backslashed  escape  sequences  in	 echo  strings
	      unless the -e option is specified.

       CSH_JUNKIE_HISTORY <C>
	      A history reference without an event specifier will always refer
	      to the previous command.	Without this option,  such  a  history
	      reference	 refers to the same event as the previous history ref‐
	      erence, defaulting to the previous command.

       CSH_JUNKIE_LOOPS <C>
	      Allow loop bodies to take the form `list; end'  instead  of  `do
	      list; done'.

       CSH_JUNKIE_QUOTES <C>
	      Changes  the  rules  for single- and double-quoted text to match
	      that of csh.  These require that embedded newlines  be  preceded
	      by  a backslash; unescaped newlines will cause an error message.
	      In double-quoted strings, it is made impossible to  escape  `$',
	      ``'  or  `"' (and `\' itself no longer needs escaping).  Command
	      substitutions are only expanded once, and cannot be nested.

       CSH_NULLCMD <C>
	      Do not use the values of NULLCMD and  READNULLCMD	 when  running
	      redirections  with no command.  This make such redirections fail
	      (see the section `Redirection').

       KSH_ARRAYS <K> <S>
	      Emulate ksh array handling as  closely  as  possible.   If  this
	      option  is  set, array elements are numbered from zero, an array
	      parameter without subscript refers to the first element  instead
	      of  the  whole  array, and braces are required to delimit a sub‐
	      script (`${path[2]}' rather than just `$path[2]').

       KSH_AUTOLOAD <K> <S>
	      Emulate ksh function autoloading.	 This means that when a	 func‐
	      tion  is	autoloaded, the corresponding file is merely executed,
	      and must define the function itself.  (By default, the  function
	      is  defined to the contents of the file.	However, the most com‐
	      mon ksh-style case - of the file containing only a simple	 defi‐
	      nition of the function - is always handled in the ksh-compatible
	      manner.)

       KSH_OPTION_PRINT <K>
	      Alters the way options settings are printed: instead of separate
	      lists  of	 set  and unset options, all options are shown, marked
	      `on' if they are in the non-default state, `off' otherwise.

       KSH_TYPESET <K>
	      Alters the way arguments to  the	typeset	 family	 of  commands,
	      including	 declare,  export, float, integer, local and readonly,
	      are processed.  Without this option,  zsh	 will  perform	normal
	      word  splitting  after  command and parameter expansion in argu‐
	      ments of an assignment; with it, word splitting  does  not  take
	      place in those cases.

       POSIX_BUILTINS <K> <S>
	      When  this option is set the command builtin can be used to exe‐
	      cute shell builtin commands.   Parameter	assignments  specified
	      before  shell  functions and special builtins are kept after the
	      command completes unless the special builtin  is	prefixed  with
	      the  command  builtin.   Special	builtins are ., :, break, con‐
	      tinue, declare, eval, exit, export,  integer,  local,  readonly,
	      return, set, shift, source, times, trap and unset.

       SH_FILE_EXPANSION <K> <S>
	      Perform  filename expansion (e.g., ~ expansion) before parameter
	      expansion, command substitution, arithmetic expansion and	 brace
	      expansion.  If this option is unset, it is performed after brace
	      expansion, so things like `~$USERNAME' and `~{pfalstad,rc}' will
	      work.

       SH_NULLCMD <K> <S>
	      Do  not  use  the	 values	 of NULLCMD and READNULLCMD when doing
	      redirections, use `:' instead (see the section `Redirection').

       SH_OPTION_LETTERS <K> <S>
	      If this option is set the shell tries to interpret single letter
	      options  (which  are  used  with	set and setopt) like ksh does.
	      This also affects the value of the - special parameter.

       SH_WORD_SPLIT (-y) <K> <S>
	      Causes field splitting to be  performed  on  unquoted  parameter
	      expansions.   Note  that this option has nothing to do with word
	      splitting.  (See the section `Parameter Expansion'.)

       TRAPS_ASYNC
	      While waiting for a program to  exit,  handle  signals  and  run
	      traps  immediately.   Otherwise  the  trap  is run after a child
	      process has exited.  Note this does  not	affect	the  point  at
	      which  traps  are	 run for any case other than when the shell is
	      waiting for a child process.

   Shell State
       INTERACTIVE (-i, ksh: -i)
	      This is an interactive shell.  This option is set upon initiali‐
	      sation  if  the  standard	 input is a tty and commands are being
	      read from standard input.	 (See the discussion  of  SHIN_STDIN.)
	      This  heuristic may be overridden by specifying a state for this
	      option on the command line.  The value of this option cannot  be
	      changed anywhere other than the command line.

       LOGIN (-l, ksh: -l)
	      This  is	a  login shell.	 If this option is not explicitly set,
	      the shell is a login shell if the first character of the argv[0]
	      passed to the shell is a `-'.

       PRIVILEGED (-p, ksh: -p)
	      Turn  on	privileged  mode.  This	 is  enabled  automatically on
	      startup if the effective user (group) ID is  not	equal  to  the
	      real user (group) ID.  Turning this option off causes the effec‐
	      tive user and group IDs to be set to the	real  user  and	 group
	      IDs.  This  option disables sourcing user startup files.	If zsh
	      is invoked as `sh' or `ksh' with this option set, /etc/suid_pro‐
	      file  is	sourced	 (after	 /etc/profile  on interactive shells).
	      Sourcing ~/.profile is disabled and  the	contents  of  the  ENV
	      variable	is ignored. This option cannot be changed using the -m
	      option of setopt and unsetopt, and changing it inside a function
	      always  changes  it  globally  regardless	 of  the LOCAL_OPTIONS
	      option.

       RESTRICTED (-r)
	      Enables restricted mode.	This option cannot  be	changed	 using
	      unsetopt,	 and  setting  it  inside a function always changes it
	      globally regardless of the LOCAL_OPTIONS option.	See  the  sec‐
	      tion `Restricted Shell'.

       SHIN_STDIN (-s, ksh: -s)
	      Commands	are  being read from the standard input.  Commands are
	      read from standard input if no command is specified with -c  and
	      no  file of commands is specified.  If SHIN_STDIN is set explic‐
	      itly on the command line, any argument that would otherwise have
	      been  taken as a file to run will instead be treated as a normal
	      positional parameter.   Note  that  setting  or  unsetting  this
	      option on the command line does not necessarily affect the state
	      the option will have while the shell is running - that is purely
	      an  indicator of whether on not commands are actually being read
	      from standard input.  The value of this option cannot be changed
	      anywhere other than the command line.

       SINGLE_COMMAND (-t, ksh: -t)
	      If  the  shell  is reading from standard input, it exits after a
	      single command has been executed.	 This  also  makes  the	 shell
	      non-interactive, unless the INTERACTIVE option is explicitly set
	      on the command line.  The value of this option cannot be changed
	      anywhere other than the command line.

   Zle
       BEEP (+B) <D>
	      Beep on error in ZLE.

       EMACS  If  ZLE  is  loaded,  turning  on this option has the equivalent
	      effect of `bindkey -e'.  In addition, the VI  option  is	unset.
	      Turning it off has no effect.  The option setting is not guaran‐
	      teed to reflect the current keymap.  This option is provided for
	      compatibility; bindkey is the recommended interface.

       OVERSTRIKE
	      Start up the line editor in overstrike mode.

       SINGLE_LINE_ZLE (-M) <K>
	      Use single-line command line editing instead of multi-line.

       VI     If  ZLE  is  loaded,  turning  on this option has the equivalent
	      effect of `bindkey -v'.  In addition, the EMACS option is unset.
	      Turning it off has no effect.  The option setting is not guaran‐
	      teed to reflect the current keymap.  This option is provided for
	      compatibility; bindkey is the recommended interface.

       ZLE (-Z)
	      Use  the	zsh line editor.  Set by default in interactive shells
	      connected to a terminal.

OPTION ALIASES
       Some options have alternative names.  These aliases are never used  for
       output,	but  can be used just like normal option names when specifying
       options to the shell.

       BRACE_EXPAND
	      NO_IGNORE_BRACES (ksh and bash compatibility)

       DOT_GLOB
	      GLOB_DOTS (bash compatibility)

       HASH_ALL
	      HASH_CMDS (bash compatibility)

       HIST_APPEND
	      APPEND_HISTORY (bash compatibility)

       HIST_EXPAND
	      BANG_HIST (bash compatibility)

       LOG    NO_HIST_NO_FUNCTIONS (ksh compatibility)

       MAIL_WARN
	      MAIL_WARNING (bash compatibility)

       ONE_CMD
	      SINGLE_COMMAND (bash compatibility)

       PHYSICAL
	      CHASE_LINKS (ksh and bash compatibility)

       PROMPT_VARS
	      PROMPT_SUBST (bash compatibility)

       STDIN  SHIN_STDIN (ksh compatibility)

       TRACK_ALL
	      HASH_CMDS (ksh compatibility)

SINGLE LETTER OPTIONS
   Default set
       -0     CORRECT
       -1     PRINT_EXIT_VALUE
       -2     NO_BAD_PATTERN
       -3     NO_NOMATCH
       -4     GLOB_DOTS
       -5     NOTIFY
       -6     BG_NICE
       -7     IGNORE_EOF
       -8     MARK_DIRS
       -9     AUTO_LIST
       -B     NO_BEEP
       -C     NO_CLOBBER
       -D     PUSHD_TO_HOME
       -E     PUSHD_SILENT
       -F     NO_GLOB
       -G     NULL_GLOB
       -H     RM_STAR_SILENT
       -I     IGNORE_BRACES
       -J     AUTO_CD
       -K     NO_BANG_HIST
       -L     SUN_KEYBOARD_HACK
       -M     SINGLE_LINE_ZLE
       -N     AUTO_PUSHD
       -O     CORRECT_ALL
       -P     RC_EXPAND_PARAM
       -Q     PATH_DIRS
       -R     LONG_LIST_JOBS
       -S     REC_EXACT
       -T     CDABLE_VARS
       -U     MAIL_WARNING
       -V     NO_PROMPT_CR
       -W     AUTO_RESUME
       -X     LIST_TYPES
       -Y     MENU_COMPLETE
       -Z     ZLE
       -a     ALL_EXPORT
       -e     ERR_EXIT
       -f     NO_RCS
       -g     HIST_IGNORE_SPACE
       -h     HIST_IGNORE_DUPS
       -i     INTERACTIVE
       -k     INTERACTIVE_COMMENTS
       -l     LOGIN
       -m     MONITOR
       -n     NO_EXEC
       -p     PRIVILEGED
       -r     RESTRICTED
       -s     SHIN_STDIN
       -t     SINGLE_COMMAND
       -u     NO_UNSET
       -v     VERBOSE
       -w     CHASE_LINKS
       -x     XTRACE
       -y     SH_WORD_SPLIT

   sh/ksh emulation set
       -C     NO_CLOBBER
       -T     TRAPS_ASYNC
       -X     MARK_DIRS
       -a     ALL_EXPORT
       -b     NOTIFY
       -e     ERR_EXIT
       -f     NO_GLOB
       -i     INTERACTIVE
       -l     LOGIN
       -m     MONITOR
       -n     NO_EXEC
       -p     PRIVILEGED
       -r     RESTRICTED
       -s     SHIN_STDIN
       -t     SINGLE_COMMAND
       -u     NO_UNSET
       -v     VERBOSE
       -x     XTRACE

   Also note
       -A     Used by set for setting arrays
       -b     Used on the command line to specify end of option processing
       -c     Used on the command line to specify a single command
       -m     Used by setopt for pattern-matching option setting
       -o     Used in all places to allow use of long option names
       -s     Used by set to sort positional parameters

ZSHBUILTINS(1)							ZSHBUILTINS(1)

NAME
       zshbuiltins - zsh built-in commands

SHELL BUILTIN COMMANDS
       - simple command
	      See the section `Precommand Modifiers'.

       . file [ arg ... ]
	      Read commands from file and execute them in  the	current	 shell
	      environment.

	      If  file	does  not contain a slash, or if PATH_DIRS is set, the
	      shell looks in the components of $path  to  find	the  directory
	      containing  file.	  Files	 in the current directory are not read
	      unless  `.'  appears  somewhere  in  $path.   If	a  file	 named
	      `file.zwc'  is  found,  is  newer than file, and is the compiled
	      form (created with the zcompile builtin) of file, then  commands
	      are read from that file instead of file.

	      If  any  arguments  arg  are  given,  they become the positional
	      parameters; the old positional parameters are restored when  the
	      file  is	done executing.	 The exit status is the exit status of
	      the last command executed.

       : [ arg ... ]
	      This command does nothing, although normal  argument  expansions
	      is performed which may have effects on shell parameters.	A zero
	      exit code is returned.

       alias [ {+|-}gmrsL ] [ name[=value] ... ]
	      For each name with a corresponding value, define an  alias  with
	      that  value.   A trailing space in value causes the next word to
	      be checked for alias expansion.  If  the	-g  flag  is  present,
	      define  a global alias; global aliases are expanded even if they
	      do not occur in command position.

	      If the -s flags is present, define a suffix alias: if  the  com‐
	      mand  word  on  a command line is in the form `text.name', where
	      text is any non-empty string, it is replaced by the text	`value
	      text.name'.   Note that name is treated as a literal string, not
	      a pattern.  A trailing space in value is	not  special  in  this
	      case.  For example,

		     alias -s ps=gv

	      will  cause  the command `*.ps' to be expanded to `gv *.ps'.  As
	      alias expansion is carried out earlier than globbing, the `*.ps'
	      will  then  be  expanded.	 Suffix aliases constitute a different
	      name space from other aliases (so in the	above  example	it  is
	      still  possible  to  create an alias for the command ps) and the
	      two sets are never listed together.

	      For each name with no value, print the value of  name,  if  any.
	      With  no	arguments,  print  all currently defined aliases other
	      than suffix aliases.  If the -m flag is given the arguments  are
	      taken  as	 patterns (they should be quoted to preserve them from
	      being interpreted as glob patterns), and	the  aliases  matching
	      these  patterns  are  printed.  When printing aliases and one of
	      the -g, -r or -s flags is	 present,  restrict  the  printing  to
	      global, regular or suffix aliases, respectively; a regular alias
	      is one which is neither a global nor a suffix alias.   Using `+'
	      instead  of  `-',	 or  ending the option list with a single `+',
	      prevents the values of the aliases from being printed.

	      If the -L flag is present, then print each  alias	 in  a	manner
	      suitable	for  putting  in a startup script.  The exit status is
	      nonzero if a name (with no value) is given for  which  no	 alias
	      has been defined.

       autoload [ {+|-}UXktz ] [ -w ] [ name ... ]
	      Equivalent to functions -u, with the exception of -X/+X and -w.

	      The  flag	 -X  may be used only inside a shell function, and may
	      not be followed by a name.  It causes the calling function to be
	      marked for autoloading and then immediately loaded and executed,
	      with the current array of positional  parameters	as  arguments.
	      This  replaces  the  previous definition of the function.	 If no
	      function definition is found, an error is printed and the	 func‐
	      tion remains undefined and marked for autoloading.

	      The  flag	 +X  attempts to load each name as an autoloaded func‐
	      tion, but does not execute it.  The exit status  is  zero	 (suc‐
	      cess)  if	 the function was not previously defined and a defini‐
	      tion for it was found.  This does not replace any existing defi‐
	      nition of the function.  The exit status is nonzero (failure) if
	      the function was already	defined	 or  when  no  definition  was
	      found.   In  the	latter case the function remains undefined and
	      marked for autoloading.  If ksh-style  autoloading  is  enabled,
	      the  function created will contain the contents of the file plus
	      a call to the function itself appended to it, thus giving normal
	      ksh autoloading behaviour on the first call to the function.

	      With the -w flag, the names are taken as names of files compiled
	      with the zcompile builtin, and all functions defined in them are
	      marked for autoloading.

       bg [ job ... ]
       job ... &
	      Put  each specified job in the background, or the current job if
	      none is specified.

       bindkey
	      See the section `Zle Builtins' in zshzle(1).

       break [ n ]
	      Exit from an enclosing for, while, until, select or repeat loop.
	      If n is specified, then break n levels instead of just one.

       builtin name [ args ... ]
	      Executes the builtin name, with the given args.

       bye    Same as exit.

       cap    See the section `The zsh/cap Module' in zshmodules(1).

       cd [ -sLP ] [ arg ]
       cd [ -sLP ] old new
       cd [ -sLP ] {+|-}n
	      Change  the  current  directory.	 In the first form, change the
	      current directory to arg, or to the value of $HOME if arg is not
	      specified.   If  arg is `-', change to the value of $OLDPWD, the
	      previous directory.  Otherwise, if a directory named arg is  not
	      found  in	 the  current  directory and arg does not begin with a
	      slash, search each component of the shell parameter cdpath.   If
	      no  directory  is found and the option CDABLE_VARS is set, and a
	      parameter named arg exists whose	value  begins  with  a	slash,
	      treat  its  value as the directory.  In that case, the parameter
	      is added to the named directory hash table.

	      The second form of cd substitutes the string new for the	string
	      old in the name of the current directory, and tries to change to
	      this new directory.

	      The third form of cd extracts an entry from the directory stack,
	      and  changes  to	that  directory.  An argument of the form `+n'
	      identifies a stack entry by counting from the left of  the  list
	      shown  by	 the dirs command, starting with zero.	An argument of
	      the form `-n' counts from the right.  If the PUSHD_MINUS	option
	      is set, the meanings of `+' and `-' in this context are swapped.

	      If  the -s option is specified, cd refuses to change the current
	      directory if the given pathname contains symlinks.   If  the  -P
	      option is given or the CHASE_LINKS option is set, symbolic links
	      are resolved to their true values.  If the -L  option  is	 given
	      symbolic	links  are  followed  regardless  of  the state of the
	      CHASE_LINKS option.

       chdir  Same as cd.

       clone  See the section `The zsh/clone Module' in zshmodules(1).

       command [ -pvV ] simple command
	      The simple command argument is  taken  as	 an  external  command
	      instead  of  a  function	or  builtin  and  is  executed. If the
	      POSIX_BUILTINS option is set, builtins will also be executed but
	      certain  special	properties of them are suppressed. The -p flag
	      causes a default path to be searched instead of that  in	$path.
	      With  the	 -v flag, command is similar to whence and with -V, it
	      is equivalent to whence -v.

	      See also the section `Precommand Modifiers'.

       comparguments
	      See the section `The zsh/computil Module' in zshmodules(1).

       compcall
	      See the section `The zsh/compctl Module' in zshmodules(1).

       compctl
	      See the section `The zsh/compctl Module' in zshmodules(1).

       compdescribe
	      See the section `The zsh/computil Module' in zshmodules(1).

       compfiles
	      See the section `The zsh/computil Module' in zshmodules(1).

       compgroups
	      See the section `The zsh/computil Module' in zshmodules(1).

       compquote
	      See the section `The zsh/computil Module' in zshmodules(1).

       comptags
	      See the section `The zsh/computil Module' in zshmodules(1).

       comptry
	      See the section `The zsh/computil Module' in zshmodules(1).

       compvalues
	      See the section `The zsh/computil Module' in zshmodules(1).

       continue [ n ]
	      Resume the next iteration of the enclosing  for,	while,	until,
	      select  or  repeat  loop.	  If  n is specified, break out of n-1
	      loops and resume at the nth enclosing loop.

       declare
	      Same as typeset.

       dirs [ -c ] [ arg ... ]
       dirs [ -lpv ]
	      With no arguments, print the contents of	the  directory	stack.
	      Directories  are added to this stack with the pushd command, and
	      removed with the cd or popd commands.  If arguments  are	speci‐
	      fied,  load  them	 onto  the directory stack, replacing anything
	      that was there, and push the current directory onto the stack.

	      -c     clear the directory stack.

	      -l     print directory names in full instead of using of using ~
		     expressions.

	      -p     print directory entries one per line.

	      -v     number the directories in the stack when printing.

       disable [ -afmrs ] name ...
	      Temporarily  disable the named hash table elements.  The default
	      is to disable builtin commands.	This  allows  you  to  use  an
	      external	command	 with the same name as a builtin command.  The
	      -a option causes disable to act on regular  or  global  aliases.
	      The  -s  option causes disable to act on suffix aliases.	The -f
	      option causes disable to act on shell functions.	The -r options
	      causes  disable to act on reserved words.	 Without arguments all
	      disabled hash table elements from the corresponding  hash	 table
	      are  printed.   With the -m flag the arguments are taken as pat‐
	      terns (which should be quoted to prevent	them  from  undergoing
	      filename expansion), and all hash table elements from the corre‐
	      sponding hash table matching these patterns are disabled.	  Dis‐
	      abled objects can be enabled with the enable command.

       disown [ job ... ]
       job ... &|
       job ... &!
	      Remove  the specified jobs from the job table; the shell will no
	      longer report their status, and will not complain if you try  to
	      exit  an	interactive shell with them running or stopped.	 If no
	      job is specified, disown the current job.

	      If the jobs are currently stopped and the	 AUTO_CONTINUE	option
	      is  not  set,  a warning is printed containing information about
	      how to make them running after they have been disowned.  If  one
	      of  the latter two forms is used, the jobs will automatically be
	      made running, independent of the setting	of  the	 AUTO_CONTINUE
	      option.

       echo [ -neE ] [ arg ... ]
	      Write  each  arg on the standard output, with a space separating
	      each one.	 If the -n flag is not present, print a newline at the
	      end.  echo recognizes the following escape sequences:

	      \a     bell character
	      \b     backspace
	      \c     suppress final newline
	      \e     escape
	      \f     form feed
	      \n     linefeed (newline)
	      \r     carriage return
	      \t     horizontal tab
	      \v     vertical tab
	      \\     backslash
	      \0NNN  character code in octal
	      \xNN   character code in hexadecimal
	      \uNNNN unicode character code in hexadecimal
	      \UNNNNNNNN
		     unicode character code in hexadecimal

	      The  -E  flag,  or  the  BSD_ECHO option, can be used to disable
	      these escape sequences.  In the latter case, -e flag can be used
	      to enable them.

       echotc See the section `The zsh/termcap Module' in zshmodules(1).

       echoti See the section `The zsh/terminfo Module' in zshmodules(1).

       emulate [ -LR ] {zsh|sh|ksh|csh}
	      Set  up  zsh  options  to emulate the specified shell as much as
	      possible.	 csh will never be fully emulated.  If the argument is
	      not  one	of  the	 shells	 listed	 above,	 zsh will be used as a
	      default; more precisely, the tests performed on the argument are
	      the  same	 as  those  used to determine the emulation at startup
	      based on the shell name, see the section `Compatibility' in zsh‐
	      misc(1)  .   If the -R option is given, all options are reset to
	      their default value corresponding	 to  the  specified  emulation
	      mode,  except  for  certain  options  describing the interactive
	      environment; otherwise,  only  those  options  likely  to	 cause
	      portability  problems  in scripts and functions are altered.  If
	      the  -L  option  is  given,  the	 options   LOCAL_OPTIONS   and
	      LOCAL_TRAPS will be set as well, causing the effects of the emu‐
	      late command and any setopt and trap commands to be local to the
	      immediately  surrounding	shell function, if any; normally these
	      options are turned off in all emulation modes except ksh.

       enable [ -afmrs ] name ...
	      Enable the named hash table elements, presumably	disabled  ear‐
	      lier  with  disable.  The default is to enable builtin commands.
	      The -a option causes enable to act on regular or global aliases.
	      The  -s  option  causes enable to act on suffix aliases.	The -f
	      option causes enable to act on shell functions.  The  -r	option
	      causes  enable  to act on reserved words.	 Without arguments all
	      enabled hash table elements from the  corresponding  hash	 table
	      are  printed.   With the -m flag the arguments are taken as pat‐
	      terns (should be quoted) and all hash table  elements  from  the
	      corresponding  hash  table  matching these patterns are enabled.
	      Enabled objects can be disabled with the	disable	 builtin  com‐
	      mand.

       eval [ arg ... ]
	      Read the arguments as input to the shell and execute the result‐
	      ing command in the current shell process.

       exec simple command
	      See the section `Precommand Modifiers'.

       exit [ n ]
	      Exit the shell with the exit code specified by  n;  if  none  is
	      specified, use the exit code from the last command executed.  An
	      EOF condition will also cause the	 shell	to  exit,  unless  the
	      IGNORE_EOF option is set.

       export [ name[=value] ... ]
	      The specified names are marked for automatic export to the envi‐
	      ronment of subsequently executed commands.  Equivalent to	 type‐
	      set -gx.	If a parameter specified does not already exist, it is
	      created in the global scope.

       false [ arg ... ]
	      Do nothing and return an exit code of 1.

       fc [ -e ename ] [ -nlrdDfEim ] [ old=new ... ] [ first [ last ] ]
       fc -p [ -a ] [ filename [ histsize [ savehistsize ] ] ]
       fc -P
       fc -ARWI [ filename ]
	      Select a range of commands from first to last from  the  history
	      list.  The arguments first and last may be specified as a number
	      or as a string.  A negative number is used as an offset  to  the
	      current  history	event  number.	 A  string  specifies the most
	      recent event beginning with the given string.  All substitutions
	      old=new, if any, are then performed on the commands.

	      If  the  -l  flag is given, the resulting commands are listed on
	      standard output.	If the -m flag is also given the  first	 argu‐
	      ment  is taken as a pattern (should be quoted) and only the his‐
	      tory events matching this pattern will be shown.	Otherwise  the
	      editor  program ename is invoked on a file containing these his‐
	      tory events.  If ename is not given, the value of the  parameter
	      FCEDIT  is  used.	  If ename is `-', no editor is invoked.  When
	      editing is complete, the edited command is executed.

	      If first is not specified, it will be set to -1 (the most recent
	      event), or to -16 if the -l flag is given.  If last is not spec‐
	      ified, it will be set to first, or to  -1	 if  the  -l  flag  is
	      given.

	      The  flag	 -r reverses the order of the commands and the flag -n
	      suppresses command numbers when listing.	Also when listing,  -d
	      prints timestamps for each command, and -f prints full time-date
	      stamps.  Adding the -E flag causes the dates to  be  printed  as
	      `dd.mm.yyyy',  instead  of the default `mm/dd/yyyy'.  Adding the
	      -i flag causes the dates to be printed in	 ISO8601  `yyyy-mm-dd'
	      format.  With the -D flag, fc prints elapsed times.

	      `fc  -p'	pushes	the  current  history  list  onto  a stack and
	      switches to a new history list.  If the -a option is also speci‐
	      fied,  this  history  list will be automatically popped when the
	      current function scope is exited, which is a much	 better	 solu‐
	      tion than creating a trap function to call `fc -P' manually.  If
	      no arguments are specified, the  history	list  is  left	empty,
	      $HISTFILE	 is  unset, and $HISTSIZE & $SAVEHIST are set to their
	      default values.  If one argument is given, $HISTFILE is  set  to
	      that filename, $HISTSIZE & $SAVEHIST are left unchanged, and the
	      history file is read in (if it exists)  to  initialize  the  new
	      list.   If a second argument is specified, $HISTSIZE & $SAVEHIST
	      are instead set to the single specified numeric value.  Finally,
	      if a third argument is specified, $SAVEHIST is set to a separate
	      value from $HISTSIZE.  You are free to change these  environment
	      values  for  the new history list however you desire in order to
	      manipulate the new history list.

	      `fc -P' pops the history list back to an older list saved by `fc
	      -p'.   The  current  list is saved to its $HISTFILE before it is
	      destroyed (assuming that $HISTFILE and $SAVEHIST are set	appro‐
	      priately,	 of  course).  The values of $HISTFILE, $HISTSIZE, and
	      $SAVEHIST are restored to the values they had when `fc  -p'  was
	      called.	Note  that  this  restoration can conflict with making
	      these variables "local", so your best bet is to avoid local dec‐
	      larations	 for  these  variables	in functions that use `fc -p'.
	      The one other guaranteed-safe  combination  is  declaring	 these
	      variables	 to be local at the top of your function and using the
	      automatic option (-a) with `fc -p'.  Finally, note  that	it  is
	      legal to manually pop a push marked for automatic popping if you
	      need to do so before the function exits.

	      `fc -R' reads the history from the given file,  `fc  -W'	writes
	      the  history out to the given file, and `fc -A' appends the his‐
	      tory out to the given file.  If no filename  is  specified,  the
	      $HISTFILE	 is  assumed.	If  the -I option is added to -R, only
	      those events that are not already contained within the  internal
	      history  list are added.	If the -I option is added to -A or -W,
	      only  those  events  that	 are  new   since   last   incremental
	      append/write  to	the history file are appended/written.	In any
	      case, the created file will have no more than $SAVEHIST entries.

       fg [ job ... ]
       job ...
	      Bring each specified job in turn to the foreground.  If  no  job
	      is specified, resume the current job.

       float [ {+|-}EFHghlprtux ] [ -LRZ [ n ]] [ name[=value] ... ]
	      Equivalent  to  typeset  -E,  except  that options irrelevant to
	      floating point numbers are not permitted.

       functions [ {+|-}UXkmtuz ] [ name ... ]
	      Equivalent to typeset -f.

       getcap See the section `The zsh/cap Module' in zshmodules(1).

       getln [ -AclneE ] name ...
	      Read the top value from the buffer stack and put it in the shell
	      parameter name.  Equivalent to read -zr.

       getopts optstring name [ arg ... ]
	      Checks the args for legal options.  If the args are omitted, use
	      the positional parameters.  A valid option argument begins  with
	      a	 `+' or a `-'.	An argument not beginning with a `+' or a `-',
	      or the argument `--', ends the options.  Note that a single  `-'
	      is  not  considered a valid option argument.  optstring contains
	      the letters that getopts recognizes.  If a letter is followed by
	      a `:', that option is expected to have an argument.  The options
	      can be separated from the argument by blanks.

	      Each time it is invoked, getopts places  the  option  letter  it
	      finds in the shell parameter name, prepended with a `+' when arg
	      begins with a `+'.  The index of	the  next  arg	is  stored  in
	      OPTIND.  The option argument, if any, is stored in OPTARG.

	      The  first  option  to  be examined may be changed by explicitly
	      assigning to OPTIND.  OPTIND has an initial value of 1,  and  is
	      normally	reset to 1 upon exit from a shell function.  OPTARG is
	      not reset and retains its value from the	most  recent  call  to
	      getopts.	 If either of OPTIND or OPTARG is explicitly unset, it
	      remains unset, and the index or option argument is  not  stored.
	      The option itself is still stored in name in this case.

	      A leading `:' in optstring causes getopts to store the letter of
	      any invalid option in OPTARG, and to set	name  to  `?'  for  an
	      unknown  option  and  to	`:' when a required option is missing.
	      Otherwise, getopts sets name to `?' and prints an error  message
	      when  an	option	is  invalid.   The exit status is nonzero when
	      there are no more options.

       hash [ -Ldfmrv ] [ name[=value] ] ...
	      hash can be used to directly modify the contents of the  command
	      hash  table,  and	 the named directory hash table.  Normally one
	      would modify these tables by modifying one's PATH (for the  com‐
	      mand  hash  table)  or  by creating appropriate shell parameters
	      (for the named directory hash table).  The choice of hash	 table
	      to  work	on  is determined by the -d option; without the option
	      the command hash table is used, and with the  option  the	 named
	      directory hash table is used.

	      Given  no	 arguments,  and  neither  the	-r  or -f options, the
	      selected hash table will be listed in full.

	      The -r option causes the selected hash table to be emptied.   It
	      will  be	subsequently  rebuilt  in  the normal fashion.	The -f
	      option causes the selected hash table to be fully rebuilt	 imme‐
	      diately.	 For  the command hash table this hashes all the abso‐
	      lute directories in the PATH, and for the named  directory  hash
	      table  this adds all users' home directories.  These two options
	      cannot be used with any arguments.

	      The -m option causes the	arguments  to  be  taken  as  patterns
	      (which  should  be  quoted)  and	the elements of the hash table
	      matching those patterns are printed.  This is the	 only  way  to
	      display a limited selection of hash table elements.

	      For  each	 name  with  a	corresponding value, put `name' in the
	      selected hash table, associating it with the  pathname  `value'.
	      In  the  command	hash table, this means that whenever `name' is
	      used as a command argument, the shell will try  to  execute  the
	      file  given by `value'.  In the named directory hash table, this
	      means that `value' may be referred to as `~name'.

	      For each name with no corresponding value, attempt to  add  name
	      to the hash table, checking what the appropriate value is in the
	      normal manner for that hash  table.   If	an  appropriate	 value
	      can't be found, then the hash table will be unchanged.

	      The -v option causes hash table entries to be listed as they are
	      added by explicit specification.	If has no effect if used  with
	      -f.

	      If the -L flag is present, then each hash table entry is printed
	      in the form of a call to hash.

       history
	      Same as fc -l.

       integer [ {+|-}Hghilprtux ] [ -LRZ [ n ]] [ name[=value] ... ]
	      Equivalent to typeset -i,	 except	 that  options	irrelevant  to
	      integers are not permitted.

       jobs [ -dlprs ] [ job ... ]
       jobs -Z string
	      Lists  information  about	 each given job, or all jobs if job is
	      omitted.	The -l flag lists process IDs, and the -p  flag	 lists
	      process  groups.	 If the -r flag is specified only running jobs
	      will be listed and if the -s flag is given only stopped jobs are
	      shown.   If  the	-d flag is given, the directory from which the
	      job was started (which may not be the current directory  of  the
	      job) will also be shown.

	      The  -Z  option  replaces	 the  shell's argument and environment
	      space with the given string,  truncated  if  necessary  to  fit.
	      This will normally be visible in ps (ps(1)) listings.  This fea‐
	      ture is typically used by daemons, to indicate their state.

       kill [ -s signal_name | -n signal_number | -sig ] job ...
       kill -l [ sig ... ]
	      Sends either SIGTERM or the specified signal to the  given  jobs
	      or  processes.  Signals are given by number or by names, with or
	      without the `SIG' prefix.	 If  the  signal  being	 sent  is  not
	      `KILL'  or  `CONT', then the job will be sent a `CONT' signal if
	      it is stopped.  The argument job can be the process ID of a  job
	      not in the job list.  In the second form, kill -l, if sig is not
	      specified the signal names are listed.  Otherwise, for each  sig
	      that  is a name, the corresponding signal number is listed.  For
	      each sig that is a signal number or a  number  representing  the
	      exit  status  of	a process which was terminated or stopped by a
	      signal the name of the signal is printed.

	      On some systems, alternative signal names are allowed for a  few
	      signals.	Typical examples are SIGCHLD and SIGCLD or SIGPOLL and
	      SIGIO, assuming they correspond to the same signal number.  kill
	      -l  will	only list the preferred form, however kill -l alt will
	      show if the alternative form corresponds	to  a  signal  number.
	      For example, under Linux kill -l IO and kill -l POLL both output
	      29, hence kill -IO and kill -POLL have the same effect.

       let arg ...
	      Evaluate each arg as an arithmetic expression.  See the  section
	      `Arithmetic  Evaluation' for a description of arithmetic expres‐
	      sions.  The exit status is 0 if the value of the last expression
	      is nonzero, and 1 otherwise.

       limit [ -hs ] [ resource [ limit ] ] ...
	      Set  or  display	resource limits.  Unless the -s flag is given,
	      the limit applies only the children of  the  shell.   If	-s  is
	      given  without  other arguments, the resource limits of the cur‐
	      rent shell is set to the previously set resource limits  of  the
	      children.

	      If  limit	 is  not  specified, print the current limit placed on
	      resource, otherwise set the limit to the	specified  value.   If
	      the  -h  flag  is given, use hard limits instead of soft limits.
	      If no resource is given, print all limits.

	      When looping over multiple resources, the shell will abort imme‐
	      diately  if  it detects a badly formed argument.	However, if it
	      fails to set a limit for some other reason it will continue try‐
	      ing to set the remaining limits.

	      resource can be one of:

	      addressspace
		     Maximum amount of address space used.
	      aiomemorylocked
		     Maximum  amount  of  memory  locked in RAM for AIO opera‐
		     tions.
	      aiooperations
		     Maximum number of AIO operations.
	      cachedthreads
		     Maximum number of cached threads.
	      coredumpsize
		     Maximum size of a core dump.
	      cputime
		     Maximum CPU seconds per process.
	      datasize
		     Maximum data size (including stack) for each process.
	      descriptors
		     Maximum value for a file descriptor.
	      filesize
		     Largest single file allowed.
	      maxproc
		     Maximum number of processes.
	      maxpthreads
		     Maximum number of threads per process.
	      memorylocked
		     Maximum amount of memory locked in RAM.
	      memoryuse
		     Maximum resident set size.
	      msgqueue
		     Maximum number of bytes in POSIX message queues.
	      resident
		     Maximum resident set size.
	      sigpending
		     Maximum number of pending signals.
	      sockbufsize
		     Maximum size of all socket buffers.
	      stacksize
		     Maximum stack size for each process.
	      vmemorysize
		     Maximum amount of virtual memory.

	      Which of these resource limits are available depends on the sys‐
	      tem.  resource can be abbreviated to any unambiguous prefix.  It
	      can also be an integer, which corresponds to the integer defined
	      for the resource by the operating system.

	      If argument corresponds to a number which is out of the range of
	      the resources configured into the shell, the shell will  try  to
	      read or write the limit anyway, and will report an error if this
	      fails.  As the shell does not store such	resources  internally,
	      an  attempt  to  set the limit will fail unless the -s option is
	      present.

	      limit is a number, with an optional scaling factor, as follows:

	      nh     hours
	      nk     kilobytes (default)
	      nm     megabytes or minutes
	      [mm:]ss
		     minutes and seconds

       local [ {+|-}AEFHUahlprtux ] [ -LRZi [ n ]] [ name[=value] ] ...
	      Same as typeset, except that the options -g, and -f are not per‐
	      mitted.	In  this  case the -x option does not force the use of
	      -g, i.e. exported variables will be local to functions.

       log    List all users currently logged in who are affected by the  cur‐
	      rent setting of the watch parameter.

       logout [ n ]
	      Same as exit, except that it only works in a login shell.

       noglob simple command
	      See the section `Precommand Modifiers'.

       popd [ {+|-}n ]
	      Remove  an  entry	 from the directory stack, and perform a cd to
	      the new top directory.  With no argument, the current top	 entry
	      is  removed.   An	 argument  of the form `+n' identifies a stack
	      entry by counting from the left of the list shown	 by  the  dirs
	      command,	starting with zero.  An argument of the form -n counts
	      from the right.  If the PUSHD_MINUS option is set, the  meanings
	      of `+' and `-' in this context are swapped.

       print [ -abcDilmnNoOpPrsz ] [ -u n ] [ -f format ] [ -C cols ]
	 [ -R [ -en ]] [ arg ... ]
	      With  the	 `-f' option the arguments are printed as described by
	      printf.  With no flags or with the flag `-', the	arguments  are
	      printed  on  the	standard output as described by echo, with the
	      following differences: the escape sequence `\M-x'	 metafies  the
	      character	 x  (sets  the highest bit), `\C-x' produces a control
	      character	 (`\C-@'  and  `\C-?'  give  the  characters  NUL  and
	      delete),	and `\E' is a synonym for `\e'.	 Finally, if not in an
	      escape sequence, `\' escapes the following character and is  not
	      printed.

	      -a     Print arguments with the column incrementing first.  Only
		     useful with the -c and -C options.

	      -b     Recognize all the escape sequences defined for the	 bind‐
		     key command, see zshzle(1).

	      -c     Print the arguments in columns.  Unless -a is also given,
		     arguments are printed with the row incrementing first.

	      -C cols
		     Print the arguments in cols columns.  Unless -a  is  also
		     given,  arguments	are  printed with the row incrementing
		     first.

	      -D     Treat the arguments as directory  names,  replacing  pre‐
		     fixes with ~ expressions, as appropriate.

	      -i     If	 given	together  with	-o or -O, sorting is performed
		     case-independently.

	      -l     Print the arguments separated by newlines instead of spa‐
		     ces.

	      -m     Take  the first argument as a pattern (should be quoted),
		     and remove it from the argument list together with subse‐
		     quent arguments that do not match this pattern.

	      -n     Do not add a newline to the output.

	      -N     Print the arguments separated and terminated by nulls.

	      -o     Print the arguments sorted in ascending order.

	      -O     Print the arguments sorted in descending order.

	      -p     Print the arguments to the input of the coprocess.

	      -P     Perform prompt expansion (see zshmisc(1)).

	      -r     Ignore the escape conventions of echo.

	      -R     Emulate  the  BSD	echo  command,	which does not process
		     escape sequences unless the -e flag  is  given.   The  -n
		     flag suppresses the trailing newline.  Only the -e and -n
		     flags are recognized after -R; all	 other	arguments  and
		     options are printed.

	      -s     Place  the	 results in the history list instead of on the
		     standard output.

	      -u n   Print the arguments to file descriptor n.

	      -z     Push the arguments onto the editing buffer	 stack,	 sepa‐
		     rated by spaces.

	      If  any  of `-m', `-o' or `-O' are used in combination with `-f'
	      and there are no arguments (after the  removal  process  in  the
	      case of `-m') then nothing is printed.

       printf format [ arg ... ]
	      Print  the arguments according to the format specification. For‐
	      matting rules are the  same  as  used  in	 C.  The  same	escape
	      sequences	 as  for echo are recognised in the format. All C con‐
	      version specifications ending in one of csdiouxXeEfgGn are  han‐
	      dled.  In	 addition to this, `%b' can be used instead of `%s' to
	      cause escape sequences in the argument to be recognised and `%q'
	      can  be  used to quote the argument in such a way that allows it
	      to be reused as shell input. With the numeric format specifiers,
	      if the corresponding argument starts with a quote character, the
	      numeric value of the following character is used as  the	number
	      to  print	 otherwise  the argument is evaluated as an arithmetic
	      expression.  See	the  section  `Arithmetic  Evaluation'	for  a
	      description  of  arithmetic  expressions.	 With `%n', the corre‐
	      sponding argument is taken as an identifier which is created  as
	      an integer parameter.

	      Normally, conversion specifications are applied to each argument
	      in order but they can explicitly specify the nth argument is  to
	      be  used by replacing `%' by `%n$' and `*' by `*n$'.  It is rec‐
	      ommended that you do not mix references of this  explicit	 style
	      with  the normal style and the handling of such mixed styles may
	      be subject to future change.

	      If arguments remain unused after formatting, the	format	string
	      is reused until all arguments have been consumed. With the print
	      builtin, this can be suppressed by using the -r option. If  more
	      arguments	 are  required by the format than have been specified,
	      the behaviour is as if zero or an empty string had  been	speci‐
	      fied as the argument.

       pushd [ -sLP ] [ arg ]
       pushd [ -sLP ] old new
       pushd [ -sLP ] {+|-}n
	      Change the current directory, and push the old current directory
	      onto the directory stack.	 In the first form, change the current
	      directory to arg.	 If arg is not specified, change to the second
	      directory on the stack (that is, exchange the top two  entries),
	      or  change  to  $HOME  if	 the PUSHD_TO_HOME option is set or if
	      there is only one entry on the stack.  Otherwise, arg is	inter‐
	      preted  as it would be by cd.  The meaning of old and new in the
	      second form is also the same as for cd.

	      The third form of pushd changes directory by rotating the direc‐
	      tory  list.   An	argument  of  the form `+n' identifies a stack
	      entry by counting from the left of the list shown	 by  the  dirs
	      command,	starting  with	zero.	An  argument  of the form `-n'
	      counts from the right.  If the PUSHD_MINUS option	 is  set,  the
	      meanings of `+' and `-' in this context are swapped.

	      If  the option PUSHD_SILENT is not set, the directory stack will
	      be printed after a pushd is performed.

	      The options -s, -L and -P have the same meanings as for  the  cd
	      builtin.

       pushln [ arg ... ]
	      Equivalent to print -nz.

       pwd [ -rLP ]
	      Print  the  absolute  pathname of the current working directory.
	      If the -r or the -P flag is specified, or the CHASE_LINKS option
	      is  set  and the -L flag is not given, the printed path will not
	      contain symbolic links.

       r      Same as fc -e -.

       read [ -rszpqAclneE ] [ -t [ num ] ] [ -k [ num ] ] [ -d delim ]
	[ -u n ] [ name[?prompt] ] [ name ...  ]
	      Read one line and break it into fields using the	characters  in
	      $IFS  as	separators, except as noted below.  The first field is
	      assigned to the first name, the second field to the second name,
	      etc.,  with  leftover fields assigned to the last name.  If name
	      is omitted then REPLY is used for scalars and reply for arrays.

	      -r     Raw mode: a `\' at the end of a  line  does  not  signify
		     line continuation and backslashes in the line don't quote
		     the following character and are not removed.

	      -s     Don't echo back characters if reading from the  terminal.
		     Currently does not work with the -q option.

	      -q     Read only one character from the terminal and set name to
		     `y' if this character was `y' or `Y' and  to  `n'	other‐
		     wise.   With  this flag set the return value is zero only
		     if the character was `y' or `Y'.  Note that  this	always
		     reads  from  the terminal, even if used with the -p or -u
		     or -z flags or with redirected input.   This  option  may
		     also be used within zle widgets.

	      -k [ num ]
		     Read  only	 one (or num) characters.  All are assigned to
		     the first name, without word  splitting.	This  flag  is
		     ignored  when -q is present.  Input is read from the ter‐
		     minal unless one of -u or -p is present.  This option may
		     also be used within zle widgets.

	      -z     Read one entry from the editor buffer stack and assign it
		     to the first  name,  without  word	 splitting.   Text  is
		     pushed  onto  the stack with `print -z' or with push-line
		     from the line  editor  (see  zshzle(1)).	This  flag  is
		     ignored when the -k or -q flags are present.

	      -e
	      -E     The  input	 read is printed (echoed) to the standard out‐
		     put.  If the -e flag is used, no input is assigned to the
		     parameters.

	      -A     The  first	 name is taken as the name of an array and all
		     words are assigned to it.

	      -c
	      -l     These flags are allowed only if called inside a  function
		     used  for	completion (specified with the -K flag to com‐
		     pctl).  If the -c flag is given, the words of the current
		     command are read. If the -l flag is given, the whole line
		     is assigned as a scalar.  If both flags are  present,  -l
		     is used and -c is ignored.

	      -n     Together with -c, the number of the word the cursor is on
		     is read.  With -l, the index of the character the	cursor
		     is on is read.  Note that the command name is word number
		     1, not word 0, and that when the cursor is at the end  of
		     the  line,	 its character index is the length of the line
		     plus one.

	      -u n   Input is read from file descriptor n.

	      -p     Input is read from the coprocess.

	      -d delim
		     Input is terminated  by  the  first  character  of	 delim
		     instead of by newline.

	      -t [ num ]
		     Test if input is available before attempting to read.  If
		     num is present, it must begin with a digit	 and  will  be
		     evaluated	to  give  a  number of seconds, which may be a
		     floating point number; in this case the read times out if
		     input  is	not available within this time.	 If num is not
		     present, it is taken to be zero,  so  that	 read  returns
		     immediately  if  no  input	 is available.	If no input is
		     available, return status 1 and do not set any variables.

		     This option is not available when reading from the editor
		     buffer  with  -z, when called from within completion with
		     -c or -l, with -q which clears  the  input	 queue	before
		     reading,  or  within zle where other mechanisms should be
		     used to test for input.

		     Note that read does not attempt to alter the  input  pro‐
		     cessing  mode.   The  default mode is canonical input, in
		     which an entire line is read at a time, so usually	 `read
		     -t'  will not read anything until an entire line has been
		     typed.  However, when reading from the terminal  with  -k
		     input  is processed one key at a time; in this case, only
		     availability of the first character is  tested,  so  that
		     e.g. `read -t -k 2' can still block on the second charac‐
		     ter.  Use two instances of `read -t -k' if	 this  is  not
		     what  is  wanted.	 If the first argument contains a `?',
		     the remainder of this word is used as a prompt  on	 stan‐
		     dard error when the shell is interactive.

	      The  value  (exit	 status)  of  read is 1 when an end-of-file is
	      encountered, or when -c or -l is present and the command is  not
	      called  from a compctl function, or as described for -q.	Other‐
	      wise the value is 0.

	      The behavior of some combinations of the -k, -p, -q, -u  and  -z
	      flags  is	 undefined.   Presently	 -q cancels all the others, -p
	      cancels -u, -k cancels -z, and otherwise -z cancels both -p  and
	      -u.

	      The -c or -l flags cancel any and all of -kpquz.

       readonly
	      Same as typeset -r.

       rehash Same as hash -r.

       return [ n ]
	      Causes  a	 shell	function or . script to return to the invoking
	      script with the return status specified by n.  If n is  omitted,
	      the return status is that of the last command executed.

	      If  return  was  executed from a trap in a TRAPNAL function, the
	      effect is different for zero and non-zero return	status.	  With
	      zero  status  (or	 after	an  implicit  return at the end of the
	      trap), the shell will return to whatever it was previously  pro‐
	      cessing; with a non-zero status, the shell will behave as inter‐
	      rupted except that the return status of the  trap	 is  retained.
	      Note  that the numeric value of the signal which caused the trap
	      is passed as  the	 first	argument,  so  the  statement  `return
	      $((128+$1))'  will  return  the same status as if the signal had
	      not been trapped.

       sched  See the section `The zsh/sched Module' in zshmodules(1).

       set [ {+|-}options | {+|-}o [ option_name ] ] ... [ {+|-}A [ name ] ] [
       arg ... ]
	      Set  the options for the shell and/or set the positional parame‐
	      ters, or declare and set an array.  If the -s option  is	given,
	      it  causes the specified arguments to be sorted before assigning
	      them to the positional parameters (or to the array name if -A is
	      used).   With  +s	 sort  arguments in descending order.  For the
	      meaning of the other flags, see  zshoptions(1).	Flags  may  be
	      specified by name using the -o option. If no option name is sup‐
	      plied with -o, the current option states are printed.   With  +o
	      they  are	 printed  in  a	 form that can be used as input to the
	      shell.

	      If the -A flag is specified, name is set to an array  containing
	      the  given args; if no name is specified, all arrays are printed
	      together with their values.

	      If +A is used and name is an array,  the	given  arguments  will
	      replace the initial elements of that array; if no name is speci‐
	      fied, all arrays are printed without their values.

	      The behaviour of arguments after -A name or +A name  depends  on
	      whether  the  option  KSH_ARRAYS	is set.	 If it is not set, all
	      arguments following name are treated as values  for  the	array,
	      regardless  of  their form.  If the option is set, normal option
	      processing continues at that point; only regular	arguments  are
	      treated as values for the array.	This means that

		     set -A array -x -- foo

	      sets array to `-x -- foo' if KSH_ARRAYS is not set, but sets the
	      array to foo and turns on the option `-x' if it is set.

	      If the -A flag is not present, but there	are  arguments	beyond
	      the  options,  the positional parameters are set.	 If the option
	      list (if any) is terminated by `--', and there  are  no  further
	      arguments, the positional parameters will be unset.

	      If no arguments and no `--' are given, then the names and values
	      of all parameters are printed on the standard  output.   If  the
	      only argument is `+', the names of all parameters are printed.

       setcap See the section `The zsh/cap Module' in zshmodules(1).

       setopt [ {+|-}options | {+|-}o option_name ] [ name ... ]
	      Set  the	options	 for  the shell.  All options specified either
	      with flags or by name are set.  If no  arguments	are  supplied,
	      the  names  of all options currently set are printed.  If the -m
	      flag is given the arguments are taken as patterns (which	should
	      be  quoted  to  protect  them  from filename expansion), and all
	      options with names matching these patterns are set.

       shift [ n ] [ name ... ]
	      The positional parameters ${n+1} ...  are	 renamed  to  $1  ...,
	      where  n is an arithmetic expression that defaults to 1.	If any
	      names are given then the arrays with  these  names  are  shifted
	      instead of the positional parameters.

       source file [ arg ... ]
	      Same  as ., except that the current directory is always searched
	      and is always searched first, before directories in $path.

       stat   See the section `The zsh/stat Module' in zshmodules(1).

       suspend [ -f ]
	      Suspend the execution of the shell (send it a SIGTSTP) until  it
	      receives	a  SIGCONT.   Unless the -f option is given, this will
	      refuse to suspend a login shell.

       test [ arg ... ]
       [ [ arg ... ] ]
	      Like the system version of test.	Added for  compatibility;  use
	      conditional  expressions	instead	 (see the section `Conditional
	      Expressions').  The main	differences  between  the  conditional
	      expression  syntax  and the test and [ builtins are:  these com‐
	      mands are not handled syntactically, so  for  example  an	 empty
	      variable	expansion  may cause an argument to be omitted; syntax
	      errors cause status 2 to be returned instead of a	 shell	error;
	      and  arithmetic  operators  expect integer arguments rather than
	      arithemetic expressions.

       times  Print the accumulated user and system times for  the  shell  and
	      for processes run from the shell.

       trap [ arg [ sig ... ] ]
	      arg  is  a series of commands (usually quoted to protect it from
	      immediate evaluation by the shell) to be read and executed  when
	      the shell receives sig.  Each sig can be given as a number or as
	      the name of a signal.  If arg is `-', then  all  traps  sig  are
	      reset to their default values.  If arg is the empty string, then
	      this signal is ignored by the  shell  and	 by  the  commands  it
	      invokes.

	      If sig is ZERR then arg will be executed after each command with
	      a nonzero exit status.  If sig is DEBUG then arg	will  be  exe‐
	      cuted  after  each  command.   If	 sig is 0 or EXIT and the trap
	      statement is executed inside the body of a  function,  then  the
	      command arg is executed after the function completes.  If sig is
	      0 or EXIT and the trap statement is not executed inside the body
	      of  a  function, then the command arg is executed when the shell
	      terminates.

	      ZERR, DEBUG and EXIT traps are not executed inside other traps.

	      The trap command with no arguments prints	 a  list  of  commands
	      associated with each signal.

	      Note  that traps defined with the trap builtin are slightly dif‐
	      ferent from those defined as `TRAPNAL () { ... }', as the latter
	      have  their  own function environment (line numbers, local vari‐
	      ables, etc.) while the former use the environment of the command
	      in which they were called.  For example,

		     trap 'print $LINENO' DEBUG

	      will  print  the	line number of a command executed after it has
	      run, while

		     TRAPDEBUG() { print $LINENO; }

	      will always print the number zero.

	      Alternative signal names are allowed  as	described  under  kill
	      above.   Defining a trap under either name causes any trap under
	      an alternative name to be removed.  However, it  is  recommended
	      that  for	 consistency  users  stick  exclusively to one name or
	      another.

       true [ arg ... ]
	      Do nothing and return an exit code of 0.

       ttyctl -fu
	      The -f option freezes the tty, and -u unfreezes  it.   When  the
	      tty  is  frozen, no changes made to the tty settings by external
	      programs will be honored by the shell, except for changes in the
	      size  of the screen; the shell will simply reset the settings to
	      their previous values as soon as each command exits or  is  sus‐
	      pended.  Thus, stty and similar programs have no effect when the
	      tty is frozen.  Without options it reports whether the  terminal
	      is frozen or not.

       type [ -wfpams ] name ...
	      Equivalent to whence -v.

       typeset [ {+|-}AEFHUafghklprtuxmz ] [ -LRZi [ n ]] [ name[=value] ... ]
       typeset -T [ {+|-}Urux ] [ -LRZ [ n ]] SCALAR[=value] array [ sep ]
	      Set or display attributes and values for shell parameters.

	      A parameter is created for each name that does not already refer
	      to one.  When inside a function, a new parameter is created  for
	      every  name  (even those that already exist), and is unset again
	      when the function completes.  See	 `Local	 Parameters'  in  zsh‐
	      param(1).	  The  same  rules  apply to special shell parameters,
	      which retain their special attributes when made local.

	      For each name=value assignment, the parameter  name  is  set  to
	      value.  Note that arrays currently cannot be assigned in typeset
	      expressions, only scalars and integers.

	      If the shell option TYPESET_SILENT is not set, for each  remain‐
	      ing  name	 that  refers to a parameter that is set, the name and
	      value of the parameter are printed in the form of an assignment.
	      Nothing  is  printed  for	 newly-created parameters, or when any
	      attribute flags listed below are	given  along  with  the	 name.
	      Using  `+'  instead  of minus to introduce an attribute turns it
	      off.

	      If the -p option is given, parameters and values are printed  in
	      the  form	 of  a typeset comand and an assignment (which will be
	      printed separately for arrays and associative  arrays),  regard‐
	      less  of	other  flags  and  options.   Note that the -h flag on
	      parameters is respected; no value will be shown for these param‐
	      eters.

	      If  the  -T  option  is  given,  two  or three arguments must be
	      present (an exception is that zero arguments are allowed to show
	      the  list of parameters created in this fashion).	 The first two
	      are the name of a scalar and an array parameter (in that	order)
	      that  will  be  tied  together in the manner of $PATH and $path.
	      The optional third  argument  is	a  single-character  separator
	      which will be used to join the elements of the array to form the
	      scalar; if absent, a colon is used, as  with  $PATH.   Only  the
	      first  character	of the separator is significant; any remaining
	      characters are  ignored.	 Only  the  scalar  parameter  may  be
	      assigned	an  initial  value.  Both the scalar and the array may
	      otherwise be manipulated as normal.  If one is unset, the	 other
	      will automatically be unset too.	There is no way of untying the
	      variables without unsetting them, or converting the type of  one
	      of  them with another typeset command; +T does not work, assign‐
	      ing an array to SCALAR is an error, and assigning	 a  scalar  to
	      array  sets  it  to  be  a single-element array.	Note that both
	      `typeset -xT ...'	 and `export -T ...' work, but only the scalar
	      will  be	marked for export.  Setting the value using the scalar
	      version causes a	split  on  all	separators  (which  cannot  be
	      quoted).

	      The  -g  (global)	 flag  is treated specially: it means that any
	      resulting parameter will not be restricted to local scope.  Note
	      that  this  does not necessarily mean that the parameter will be
	      global, as the flag will apply to any existing  parameter	 (even
	      if unset) from an enclosing function.  This flag does not affect
	      the parameter after creation, hence it has no effect when	 list‐
	      ing  existing  parameters,  nor does the flag +g have any effect
	      except in combination with -m (see below).

	      If no name is present, the names and values  of  all  parameters
	      are printed.  In this case the attribute flags restrict the dis‐
	      play  to	only  those  parameters	 that	have   the   specified
	      attributes,  and using `+' rather than `-' to introduce the flag
	      suppresses printing of the values of parameters when there is no
	      parameter	 name.	Also, if the last option is the word `+', then
	      names are printed but values are not.

	      If the -m flag is given the name arguments are taken as patterns
	      (which  should be quoted).  With no attribute flags, all parame‐
	      ters (or functions with the -f flag)  with  matching  names  are
	      printed  (the  shell  option  TYPESET_SILENT is not used in this
	      case).  Note that -m is ignored if no patterns  are  given.   If
	      the  +g  flag is combined with -m, a new local parameter is cre‐
	      ated for every matching parameter that  is  not  already	local.
	      Otherwise	 -m  applies  all  other  flags	 or assignments to the
	      existing parameters.  Except  when  assignments  are  made  with
	      name=value,  using  +m  forces  the  matching  parameters	 to be
	      printed, even inside a function.

	      If no attribute flags are given and either no -m flag is present
	      or the +m form was used, each parameter name printed is preceded
	      by a list of the attributes of that parameter  (array,  associa‐
	      tion,   exported,	 integer,  readonly).	If  +m	is  used  with
	      attribute flags, and all those flags are introduced with +,  the
	      matching parameter names are printed but their values are not.

	      The following attribute flags may be specified:

	      -A     The  names	 refer	to  associative	 array parameters; see
		     `Array Parameters' in zshparam(1).

	      -L     Left justify and remove leading blanks from value.	 If  n
		     is	 nonzero,  it defines the width of the field.  If n is
		     zero, the width is determined by the width of  the	 value
		     of	 the first assignment.	In the case of numeric parame‐
		     ters, the length of the complete value  assigned  to  the
		     parameter	is  used to determine the width, not the value
		     that would be output.  When the parameter is expanded, it
		     is filled on the right with blanks or truncated if neces‐
		     sary to fit the field.  Note truncation can lead to unex‐
		     pected  results  with  numeric parameters.	 Leading zeros
		     are removed if the -Z flag is also set.

	      -R     Similar to -L, except that right justification  is	 used;
		     when  the parameter is expanded, the field is left filled
		     with blanks or truncated from the end.  May not  be  com‐
		     bined with the -Z flag.

	      -U     For  arrays  (but	not for associative arrays), keep only
		     the first occurrence of each duplicated value.  This  may
		     also  be  set for colon-separated special parameters like
		     PATH or FIGNORE, etc.  This flag has a different  meaning
		     when used with -f; see below.

	      -Z     Specially	handled if set along with the -L flag.	Other‐
		     wise, similar to -R, except that leading zeros  are  used
		     for  padding  instead  of	blanks	if the first non-blank
		     character is a digit.  Numeric parameters	are  specially
		     handled:  they  are  always  eligible  for	 padding  with
		     zeroes, and the zeroes are	 inserted  at  an  appropriate
		     place in the output.

	      -a     The  names refer to array parameters.  An array parameter
		     may be created this way, but it may not be assigned to in
		     the  typeset statement.  When displaying, both normal and
		     associative arrays are shown.

	      -f     The names refer to functions rather than parameters.   No
		     assignments  can  be made, and the only other valid flags
		     are -t, -k, -u, -U and -z.	 The flag -t turns  on	execu‐
		     tion  tracing  for	 this  function.   The -u and -U flags
		     cause the function to be marked for autoloading; -U  also
		     causes alias expansion to be suppressed when the function
		     is loaded.	 The fpath parameter will be searched to  find
		     the function definition when the function is first refer‐
		     enced; see the section `Functions'. The -k and  -z	 flags
		     make  the function be loaded using ksh-style or zsh-style
		     autoloading respectively. If neither is given,  the  set‐
		     ting  of the KSH_AUTOLOAD option determines how the func‐
		     tion is loaded.

	      -h     Hide: only useful for special  parameters	(those	marked
		     `<S>' in the table in zshparams(1)), and for local param‐
		     eters with the same name as a special  parameter,	though
		     harmless  for  others.   A	 special  parameter  with this
		     attribute will not retain its special  effect  when  made
		     local.  Thus after `typeset -h PATH', a function contain‐
		     ing `typeset PATH' will create an ordinary local  parame‐
		     ter  without the usual behaviour of PATH.	Alternatively,
		     the local parameter may itself be given  this  attribute;
		     hence  inside  a  function	 `typeset  -h PATH' creates an
		     ordinary local parameter and the special  PATH  parameter
		     is not altered in any way.	 It is also possible to create
		     a local parameter using `typeset +h special',  where  the
		     local  copy of special will retain its special properties
		     regardless of having the -h  attribute.   Global  special
		     parameters	 loaded from shell modules (currently those in
		     zsh/mapfile and zsh/parameter)  are  automatically	 given
		     the -h attribute to avoid name clashes.

	      -H     Hide  value:  specifies that typeset will not display the
		     value of the parameter when listing parameters; the  dis‐
		     play for such parameters is always as if the `+' flag had
		     been given.  Use of the parameter is  in  other  respects
		     normal, and the option does not apply if the parameter is
		     specified by name, or by  pattern	with  the  -m  option.
		     This   is	on  by	default	 for  the  parameters  in  the
		     zsh/parameter and zsh/mapfile  modules.   Note,  however,
		     that  unlike the -h flag this is also useful for non-spe‐
		     cial parameters.

	      -i     Use an internal integer representation.  If n is  nonzero
		     it	 defines  the  output arithmetic base, otherwise it is
		     determined by the first assignment.

	      -E     Use an internal double-precision floating point represen‐
		     tation.  On output the variable will be converted to sci‐
		     entific notation.	If n is nonzero it defines the	number
		     of significant figures to display; the default is ten.

	      -F     Use an internal double-precision floating point represen‐
		     tation.  On output the  variable  will  be	 converted  to
		     fixed-point decimal notation.  If n is nonzero it defines
		     the number of digits to display after the decimal	point;
		     the default is ten.

	      -l     Convert  the  result to lower case whenever the parameter
		     is expanded.  The value is not converted when assigned.

	      -r     The given names are marked readonly.  Note that  if  name
		     is	 a  special  parameter,	 the readonly attribute can be
		     turned on, but cannot then be turned off.

	      -t     Tags the named parameters.	 Tags have no special  meaning
		     to	 the  shell.   This  flag has a different meaning when
		     used with -f; see above.

	      -u     Convert the result to upper case whenever	the  parameter
		     is	 expanded.   The value is not converted when assigned.
		     This flag has a different meaning when used with -f;  see
		     above.

	      -x     Mark  for	automatic  export to the environment of subse‐
		     quently executed commands.	 If the	 option	 GLOBAL_EXPORT
		     is	 set,  this  implies  the option -g, unless +g is also
		     explicitly given; in other words  the  parameter  is  not
		     made  local  to the enclosing function.  This is for com‐
		     patibility with previous versions of zsh.

       ulimit [ [ -SHacdfilmnpqstvx | -N resource [ limit ] ... ]
	      Set or display resource limits of the shell  and	the  processes
	      started by the shell.  The value of limit can be a number in the
	      unit specified below or the value `unlimited'.  By default, only
	      soft  limits  are	 manipulated. If the -H flag is given use hard
	      limits instead of soft limits.  If the -S flag is given together
	      with  the	 -H flag set both hard and soft limits.	 If no options
	      are used, the file size limit (-f)  is  assumed.	 If  limit  is
	      omitted  the  current  value  of	the  specified	resources  are
	      printed.	When more than one resource  values  are  printed  the
	      limit name and unit is printed before each value.

	      When looping over multiple resources, the shell will abort imme‐
	      diately if it detects a badly formed argument.  However,	if  it
	      fails  to set a limit for some other reson it will continue try‐
	      ing to set the remaining limits.

	      -a     Lists all of the current resource limits.
	      -c     512-byte blocks on the size of core dumps.
	      -d     K-bytes on the size of the data segment.
	      -f     512-byte blocks on the size of files written.
	      -i     The number of pending signals.
	      -l     K-bytes on the size of locked-in memory.
	      -m     K-bytes on the size of physical memory.
	      -n     open file descriptors.
	      -q     Bytes in POSIX message queues.
	      -s     K-bytes on the size of the stack.
	      -t     CPU seconds to be used.
	      -u     processes available to the user.
	      -v     K-bytes on the size of virtual memory.  On	 some  systems
		     this refers to the limit called `address space'.
	      -x     The number of locks on files.

	      A	 resource  may	also  be  specified by integer in the form `-N
	      resource', where resource corresponds to the integer defined for
	      the  resource  by the operating system.  This may be used to set
	      the limits for resources known to the shell which do not	corre‐
	      spond to option letters.	Such limits will be shown by number in
	      the output of `ulimit -a'.

	      The number may alternatively be out of the range of limits  com‐
	      piled  into  the shell.  The shell will try to read or write the
	      limit anyway, and will report an error if this fails.

       umask [ -S ] [ mask ]
	      The umask is set to mask.	 mask can be either an octal number or
	      a	 symbolic value as described in chmod(1).  If mask is omitted,
	      the current value is printed.  The -S option causes the mask  to
	      be  printed as a symbolic value.	Otherwise, the mask is printed
	      as an octal number.  Note that in the symbolic form the  permis‐
	      sions you specify are those which are to be allowed (not denied)
	      to the users specified.

       unalias
	      Same as unhash -a.

       unfunction
	      Same as unhash -f.

       unhash [ -adfms ] name ...
	      Remove the element named name from an internal hash table.   The
	      default  is remove elements from the command hash table.	The -a
	      option causes unhash to remove regular or global	aliases.   The
	      -s option causes unhash to remove suffix aliases.	 The -f option
	      causes unhash to remove shell functions.	The -d options	causes
	      unhash to remove named directories.  If the -m flag is given the
	      arguments are taken as patterns (should be quoted) and all  ele‐
	      ments  of	 the corresponding hash table with matching names will
	      be removed.

       unlimit [ -hs ] resource ...
	      The resource limit for each resource is set to the  hard	limit.
	      If  the  -h  flag	 is given and the shell has appropriate privi‐
	      leges, the hard resource limit for  each	resource  is  removed.
	      The  resources  of  the shell process are only changed if the -s
	      flag is given.

       unset [ -fmv ] name ...
	      Each named parameter is unset.  Local  parameters	 remain	 local
	      even  if unset; they appear unset within scope, but the previous
	      value will still reappear when the scope ends.

	      Individual elements of associative array parameters may be unset
	      by  using	 subscript  syntax on name, which should be quoted (or
	      the entire command prefixed with noglob)	to  protect  the  sub‐
	      script from filename generation.

	      If  the -m flag is specified the arguments are taken as patterns
	      (should be quoted) and all parameters with  matching  names  are
	      unset.  Note that this cannot be used when unsetting associative
	      array elements, as the subscript will be treated as part of  the
	      pattern.

	      The  -v  flag  specifies that name refers to parameters. This is
	      the default behaviour.

	      unset -f is equivalent to unfunction.

       unsetopt [ {+|-}options | {+|-}o option_name ] [ name ... ]
	      Unset the options for the shell.	All options  specified	either
	      with  flags or by name are unset.	 If no arguments are supplied,
	      the names of all options currently unset are printed.  If the -m
	      flag  is given the arguments are taken as patterns (which should
	      be quoted to preserve them from being interpreted as  glob  pat‐
	      terns),  and  all options with names matching these patterns are
	      unset.

       vared  See the section `Zle Builtins' in zshzle(1).

       wait [ job ... ]
	      Wait for the specified jobs or processes.	 If job is  not	 given
	      then  all currently active child processes are waited for.  Each
	      job can be either a job specification or the process ID of a job
	      in  the job table.  The exit status from this command is that of
	      the job waited for.

       whence [ -vcwfpams ] name ...
	      For each name, indicate how it would be interpreted if used as a
	      command name.

	      -v     Produce a more verbose report.

	      -c     Print  the	 results  in  a	 csh-like  format.  This takes
		     precedence over -v.

	      -w     For each name, print `name: word' where word  is  one  of
		     alias,  builtin,  command,	 function, hashed, reserved or
		     none, according  as  name	corresponds  to	 an  alias,  a
		     built-in  command, an external command, a shell function,
		     a command defined with the hash builtin, a reserved word,
		     or	 is not recognised.  This takes precedence over -v and
		     -c.

	      -f     Causes the contents of a shell function to be  displayed,
		     which  would otherwise not happen unless the -c flag were
		     used.

	      -p     Do a path search  for  name  even	if  it	is  an	alias,
		     reserved word, shell function or builtin.

	      -a     Do	 a  search  for all occurrences of name throughout the
		     command path.  Normally  only  the	 first	occurrence  is
		     printed.

	      -m     The  arguments  are taken as patterns (should be quoted),
		     and the information is displayed for each command	match‐
		     ing one of these patterns.

	      -s     If	 a  pathname contains symlinks, print the symlink-free
		     pathname as well.

       where [ -wpms ] name ...
	      Equivalent to whence -ca.

       which [ -wpams ] name ...
	      Equivalent to whence -c.

       zcompile [ -U ] [ -z | -k ] [ -R | -M ] file [ name ... ]
       zcompile -ca [ -m ] [ -R | -M ] file [ name ... ]
       zcompile -t file [ name ... ]
	      This builtin  command  can  be  used  to	compile	 functions  or
	      scripts,	storing	 the  compiled	form in a file, and to examine
	      files  containing	 the  compiled	form.	This   allows	faster
	      autoloading  of  functions  and execution of scripts by avoiding
	      parsing of the text when the files are read.

	      The first form (without the -c, -a or -t options) creates a com‐
	      piled file.  If only the file argument is given, the output file
	      has the name `file.zwc' and will be placed in the same directory
	      as  the  file.  The shell will load the compiled file instead of
	      the normal function file when the function  is  autoloaded;  see
	      the section `Autoloading Functions' in zshfunc(1) for a descrip‐
	      tion of how autoloaded functions are  searched.	The  extension
	      .zwc stands for `zsh word code'.

	      If  there is at least one name argument, all the named files are
	      compiled into the output file given as the first	argument.   If
	      file  does  not  end  in	.zwc,  this extension is automatically
	      appended.	 Files	containing  multiple  compiled	functions  are
	      called  `digest'	files, and are intended to be used as elements
	      of the FPATH/fpath special array.

	      The second form, with the -c or -a options, writes the  compiled
	      definitions  for all the named functions into file.  For -c, the
	      names must be functions currently	 defined  in  the  shell,  not
	      those  marked  for  autoloading.	 Undefined  functions that are
	      marked for autoloading may be written by using the -a option, in
	      which case the fpath is searched and the contents of the defini‐
	      tion files for those functions,  if  found,  are	compiled  into
	      file.   If both -c and -a are given, names of both defined func‐
	      tions and functions marked for autoloading  may  be  given.   In
	      either  case,  the  functions in files written with the -c or -a
	      option will be autoloaded as if  the  KSH_AUTOLOAD  option  were
	      unset.

	      The reason for handling loaded and not-yet-loaded functions with
	      different options is that some definition files for  autoloading
	      define  multiple functions, including the function with the same
	      name as the file, and, at the end, call that function.  In  such
	      cases  the  output  of  `zcompile -c' does not include the addi‐
	      tional functions defined in the file, and any other  initializa‐
	      tion code in the file is lost.  Using `zcompile -a' captures all
	      this extra information.

	      If the -m option is combined with -c or -a, the names  are  used
	      as  patterns  and	 all  functions whose names match one of these
	      patterns will be written. If no name is given,  the  definitions
	      of  all functions currently defined or marked as autoloaded will
	      be written.

	      The third form, with the -t option, examines  an	existing  com‐
	      piled  file.  Without further arguments, the names of the origi‐
	      nal files compiled into it are listed.  The first line of output
	      shows  the  version of the shell which compiled the file and how
	      the file will be used (i.e. by reading it directly or by mapping
	      it  into	memory).   With	 arguments,  nothing is output and the
	      return value is set to zero if definitions for  all  names  were
	      found  in	 the compiled file, and non-zero if the definition for
	      at least one name was not found.

	      Other options:

	      -U     Aliases are not expanded when compiling the named files.

	      -R     When the compiled file is read, its contents  are	copied
		     into  the	shell's memory, rather than memory-mapped (see
		     -M).  This happens automatically on systems that  do  not
		     support memory mapping.

		     When compiling scripts instead of autoloadable functions,
		     it is often desirable to use this option;	otherwise  the
		     whole  file, including the code to define functions which
		     have already been defined,	 will  remain  mapped,	conse‐
		     quently wasting memory.

	      -M     The  compiled file is mapped into the shell's memory when
		     read. This is done in such a way that multiple  instances
		     of	 the  shell  running  on the same host will share this
		     mapped file.  If neither -R nor -M is given, the zcompile
		     builtin  decides what to do based on the size of the com‐
		     piled file.

	      -k
	      -z     These options are used when the  compiled	file  contains
		     functions which are to be autoloaded. If -z is given, the
		     function will be autoloaded as if the KSH_AUTOLOAD option
		     is	 not  set,  even if it is set at the time the compiled
		     file is read, while if the -k is given, the function will
		     be	 loaded as if KSH_AUTOLOAD is set.  These options also
		     take precedence over any -k or -z	options	 specified  to
		     the  autoload  builtin.  If  neither  of these options is
		     given, the function will be loaded as determined  by  the
		     setting  of  the KSH_AUTOLOAD option at the time the com‐
		     piled file is read.

		     These options may also appear as many times as  necessary
		     between  the listed names to specify the loading style of
		     all following functions, up to the next -k or -z.

		     The created file always contains two versions of the com‐
		     piled  format,  one  for  big-endian machines and one for
		     small-endian machines.  The upshot of this	 is  that  the
		     compiled file is machine independent and if it is read or
		     mapped, only one half of the file is actually  used  (and
		     mapped).

       zformat
	      See the section `The zsh/zutil Module' in zshmodules(1).

       zftp   See the section `The zsh/zftp Module' in zshmodules(1).

       zle    See the section `Zle Builtins' in zshzle(1).

       zmodload [ -dL ] [ ... ]
       zmodload -e [ -A ] [ ... ]
       zmodload [ -a [ -bcpf [ -I ] ] ] [ -iL ] ...
       zmodload -u [ -abcdpf [ -I ] ] [ -iL ] ...
       zmodload -A [ -L ] [ modalias[=module] ... ]
       zmodload -R modalias ...
	      Performs operations relating to zsh's loadable modules.  Loading
	      of modules while the shell is running (`dynamical	 loading')  is
	      not  available on all operating systems, or on all installations
	      on a particular operating system, although the zmodload  command
	      itself is always available and can be used to manipulate modules
	      built into versions of the shell	executable  without  dynamical
	      loading.

	      Without  arguments the names of all currently loaded binary mod‐
	      ules are printed.	 The -L option causes this list to be  in  the
	      form  of	a  series  of zmodload commands.  Forms with arguments
	      are:

	      zmodload [ -i ] name ...
	      zmodload -u [ -i ] name ...
		     In the simplest case, zmodload  loads  a  binary  module.
		     The  module  must	be in a file with a name consisting of
		     the specified name followed by a standard suffix, usually
		     `.so'  (`.sl'  on	HPUX).	 If the module to be loaded is
		     already loaded and the -i option is given, the  duplicate
		     module  is	 ignored.   Otherwise zmodload prints an error
		     message.

		     The named module is searched for in the same way  a  com‐
		     mand  is,	using $module_path instead of $path.  However,
		     the path search is performed even when  the  module  name
		     contains  a  `/', which it usually does.  There is no way
		     to prevent the path search.

		     With -u, zmodload unloads modules.	 The same name must be
		     given  that  was given when the module was loaded, but it
		     is not necessary for the module to exist in the  filesys‐
		     tem.  The -i option suppresses the error if the module is
		     already unloaded (or was never loaded).

		     Each module has a boot and a cleanup function.  The  mod‐
		     ule will not be loaded if its boot function fails.	 Simi‐
		     larly a module can only be unloaded if its cleanup	 func‐
		     tion runs successfully.

	      zmodload -d [ -L ] [ name ]
	      zmodload -d name dep ...
	      zmodload -ud name [ dep ... ]
		     The -d option can be used to specify module dependencies.
		     The modules named in the second and subsequent  arguments
		     will be loaded before the module named in the first argu‐
		     ment.

		     With -d and one argument, all dependencies for that  mod‐
		     ule  are  listed.	 With  -d and no arguments, all module
		     dependencies are listed.  This listing is by default in a
		     Makefile-like  format.  The -L option changes this format
		     to a list of zmodload -d commands.

		     If -d and -u are both used, dependencies are removed.  If
		     only  one	argument  is  given, all dependencies for that
		     module are removed.

	      zmodload -ab [ -L ]
	      zmodload -ab [ -i ] name [ builtin ... ]
	      zmodload -ub [ -i ] builtin ...
		     The -ab option defines autoloaded builtins.   It  defines
		     the  specified  builtins.	 When any of those builtins is
		     called, the module specified in  the  first  argument  is
		     loaded.   If  only	 the  name  is	given,	one builtin is
		     defined, with the same name as the module.	 -i suppresses
		     the   error   if	the  builtin  is  already  defined  or
		     autoloaded, regardless of which module it came from.

		     With -ab and no arguments, all  autoloaded	 builtins  are
		     listed,  with  the	 module	 name  (if different) shown in
		     parentheses  after	 the  builtin  name.   The  -L	option
		     changes this format to a list of zmodload -a commands.

		     If	 -b  is	 used  together with the -u option, it removes
		     builtins previously defined with -ab.  This is only  pos‐
		     sible  if	the  builtin is not yet loaded.	 -i suppresses
		     the error if the builtin is  already  removed  (or	 never
		     existed).

	      zmodload -ac [ -IL ]
	      zmodload -ac [ -iI ] name [ cond ... ]
	      zmodload -uc [ -iI ] cond ...
		     The  -ac  option  is  used to define autoloaded condition
		     codes. The cond strings give the names of the  conditions
		     defined  by the module. The optional -I option is used to
		     define infix condition names. Without this option	prefix
		     condition names are defined.

		     If given no condition names, all defined names are listed
		     (as a series of zmodload commands if  the	-L  option  is
		     given).

		     The  -uc option removes definitions for autoloaded condi‐
		     tions.

	      zmodload -ap [ -L ]
	      zmodload -ap [ -i ] name [ parameter ... ]
	      zmodload -up [ -i ] parameter ...
		     The -p option is like the -b and -c  options,  but	 makes
		     zmodload work on autoloaded parameters instead.

	      zmodload -af [ -L ]
	      zmodload -af [ -i ] name [ function ... ]
	      zmodload -uf [ -i ] function ...
		     The  -f  option  is  like the -b, -p, and -c options, but
		     makes zmodload work on autoloaded math functions instead.

	      zmodload -a [ -L ]
	      zmodload -a [ -i ] name [ builtin ... ]
	      zmodload -ua [ -i ] builtin ...
		     Equivalent to -ab and -ub.

	      zmodload -e [ -A ] [ string ... ]
		     The -e option without arguments lists all loaded modules;
		     if	 the  -A  option  is also given, module aliases corre‐
		     sponding to loaded modules are also  shown.   With	 argu‐
		     ments  only  the  return  status  is  set	to zero if all
		     strings given as arguments are names  of  loaded  modules
		     and  to  one  if  at least on string is not the name of a
		     loaded module.  This can be used to test for  the	avail‐
		     ability  of things implemented by modules.	 In this case,
		     any aliases are automatically resolved and the -A flag is
		     not used.

	      zmodload -A [ -L ] [ modalias[=module] ... ]
		     For each argument, if both modalias and module are given,
		     define modalias to be an alias for the module module.  If
		     the  module  modalias  is	ever  subsequently  requested,
		     either via a call to zmodload or  implicitly,  the	 shell
		     will  attempt  to	load module instead.  If module is not
		     given, show the definition of modalias.  If no  arguments
		     are  given,  list all defined module aliases.  When list‐
		     ing, if the -L flag was also given, list  the  definition
		     as a zmodload command to recreate the alias.

		     The  existence of aliases for modules is completely inde‐
		     pendent of whether the name resolved is  actually	loaded
		     as	 a module: while the alias exists, loading and unload‐
		     ing the module under  any	alias  has  exactly  the  same
		     effect  as	 using	the resolved name, and does not affect
		     the connection between the alias and  the	resolved  name
		     which can be removed either by zmodload -R or by redefin‐
		     ing the alias.  Chains of aliases (i.e. where  the	 first
		     resolved  name  is	 itself an alias) are valid so long as
		     these are not circular.  As the  aliases  take  the  same
		     format as module names, they may include path separators:
		     in this case, there is no requirement for any part of the
		     path  named to exist as the alias will be resolved first.
		     For example, `any/old/alias' is always a valid alias.

		     Dependencies added to aliased modules are actually	 added
		     to	 the  resolved	module;	 these	remain if the alias is
		     removed.  It is valid to create an alias  whose  name  is
		     one of the standard shell modules and which resolves to a
		     different module.	However, if a module has dependencies,
		     it	 will  not  be	possible  to use the module name as an
		     alias as the module will already be marked as a  loadable
		     module in its own right.

		     Apart from the above, aliases can be used in the zmodload
		     command anywhere module  names  are  required.   However,
		     aliases will not be shown in lists of loaded modules with
		     a bare `zmodload'.

	      zmodload -R modalias ...
		     For each modalias argument that was previously defined as
		     a module alias via zmodload -A, delete the alias.	If any
		     was not defined, an error is caused and the remainder  of
		     the line is ignored.

	      Note  that  zsh  makes  no distinction between modules that were
	      linked into the shell and modules that are  loaded  dynamically.
	      In both cases this builtin command has to be used to make avail‐
	      able the builtins and other things defined  by  modules  (unless
	      the  module  is  autoloaded  on these definitions). This is true
	      even for systems that don't support dynamic loading of modules.

       zparseopts
	      See the section `The zsh/zutil Module' in zshmodules(1).

       zprof  See the section `The zsh/zprof Module' in zshmodules(1).

       zpty   See the section `The zsh/zpty Module' in zshmodules(1).

       zregexparse
	      See the section `The zsh/zutil Module' in zshmodules(1).

       zsocket
	      See the section `The zsh/net/socket Module' in zshmodules(1).

       zstyle See the section `The zsh/zutil Module' in zshmodules(1).

       ztcp   See the section `The zsh/net/tcp Module' in zshmodules(1).

ZSHZLE(1)							     ZSHZLE(1)

NAME
       zshzle - zsh command line editor

DESCRIPTION
       If the ZLE option is set (which it is by default in interactive shells)
       and  the	 shell	input is attached to the terminal, the user is able to
       edit command lines.

       There are two  display  modes.	The  first,  multiline	mode,  is  the
       default.	  It only works if the TERM parameter is set to a valid termi‐
       nal type that can move the cursor up.  The second, single line mode, is
       used if TERM is invalid or incapable of moving the cursor up, or if the
       SINGLE_LINE_ZLE option is set.  This mode is similar to ksh,  and  uses
       no termcap sequences.  If TERM is "emacs", the ZLE option will be unset
       by default.

       The parameters BAUD, COLUMNS, and LINES are also used by the line  edi‐
       tor.  See Parameters Used By The Shell in zshparam(1).

KEYMAPS
       A  keymap  in  ZLE contains a set of bindings between key sequences and
       ZLE commands.  The empty key sequence cannot be bound.

       There can be any number of keymaps at any time, and each keymap has one
       or  more names.	If all of a keymap's names are deleted, it disappears.
       bindkey can be used to manipulate keymap names.

       Initially, there are four keymaps:

       emacs  EMACS emulation
       viins  vi emulation - insert mode
       vicmd  vi emulation - command mode
       .safe  fallback keymap

       The `.safe' keymap is special.  It can never be altered, and  the  name
       can  never be removed.  However, it can be linked to other names, which
       can be removed.	In the future other  special  keymaps  may  be	added;
       users  should  avoid  using  names  beginning  with  `.'	 for their own
       keymaps.

       In addition to these four names, either	`emacs'	 or  `viins'  is  also
       linked  to the name `main'.  If one of the VISUAL or EDITOR environment
       variables contain the string `vi' when the shell starts up then it will
       be  `viins', otherwise it will be `emacs'.  bindkey's -e and -v options
       provide a convenient way to override this default choice.

       When the editor starts up, it will select the `main' keymap.   If  that
       keymap doesn't exist, it will use `.safe' instead.

       In  the `.safe' keymap, each single key is bound to self-insert, except
       for ^J (line feed) and ^M (return)  which  are  bound  to  accept-line.
       This is deliberately not pleasant to use; if you are using it, it means
       you deleted the main keymap, and you should put it back.

   Reading Commands
       When ZLE is reading a command from the terminal, it may read a sequence
       that  is	 bound	to some command and is also a prefix of a longer bound
       string.	In this case ZLE will wait a certain time to see if more char‐
       acters are typed, and if not (or they don't match any longer string) it
       will execute the binding.  This timeout is defined  by  the  KEYTIMEOUT
       parameter;  its	default is 0.4 sec.  There is no timeout if the prefix
       string is not itself bound to a command.

       As well as ZLE commands, key sequences can be bound to  other  strings,
       by  using  `bindkey -s'.	 When such a sequence is read, the replacement
       string is pushed back as input, and the command reading process	starts
       again  using  these fake keystrokes.  This input can itself invoke fur‐
       ther replacement strings, but in order to detect loops the process will
       be stopped if there are twenty such replacements without a real command
       being read.

ZLE BUILTINS
       The ZLE module contains three related  builtin  commands.  The  bindkey
       command manipulates keymaps and key bindings; the vared command invokes
       ZLE on the value of a shell parameter; and the zle command  manipulates
       editing	widgets	 and  allows  command line access to ZLE commands from
       within shell functions.

       bindkey [ options ] -l
       bindkey [ options ] -d
       bindkey [ options ] -D keymap ...
       bindkey [ options ] -A old-keymap new-keymap
       bindkey [ options ] -N new-keymap [ old-keymap ]
       bindkey [ options ] -m
       bindkey [ options ] -r in-string ...
       bindkey [ options ] -s in-string out-string ...
       bindkey [ options ] in-string command ...
       bindkey [ options ] [ in-string ]
	      bindkey's options can be divided into three  categories:	keymap
	      selection,  operation  selection, and others.  The keymap selec‐
	      tion options are:

	      -e     Selects keymap `emacs', and also links it to `main'.

	      -v     Selects keymap `viins', and also links it to `main'.

	      -a     Selects keymap `vicmd'.

	      -M keymap
		     The keymap specifies a keymap name.

	      If a keymap selection is required and none of the options	 above
	      are  used,  the  `main'  keymap is used.	Some operations do not
	      permit a keymap to be selected, namely:

	      -l     List all existing keymap names.  If the -L option is also
		     used,  list in the form of bindkey commands to create the
		     keymaps.

	      -d     Delete all existing keymaps  and  reset  to  the  default
		     state.

	      -D keymap ...
		     Delete the named keymaps.

	      -A old-keymap new-keymap
		     Make the new-keymap name an alias for old-keymap, so that
		     both names refer to the  same  keymap.   The  names  have
		     equal  standing; if either is deleted, the other remains.
		     If there is already a keymap with the new-keymap name, it
		     is deleted.

	      -N new-keymap [ old-keymap ]
		     Create  a	new  keymap,  named  new-keymap.   If a keymap
		     already has that name, it is deleted.  If	an  old-keymap
		     name  is  given,  the  new	 keymap is initialized to be a
		     duplicate of it, otherwise the new keymap will be empty.

	      To use a newly created keymap, it	 should	 be  linked  to	 main.
	      Hence  the  sequence  of commands to create and use a new keymap
	      `mymap'  initialized  from  the  emacs  keymap  (which   remains
	      unchanged) is:

		     bindkey -N mymap emacs
		     bindkey -A mymap main

	      Note  that  while `bindkey -A newmap main' will work when newmap
	      is emacs or viins, it will not work for vicmd, as switching from
	      vi insert to command mode becomes impossible.

	      The  following  operations act on the `main' keymap if no keymap
	      selection option was given:

	      -m     Add the built-in set of meta-key bindings to the selected
		     keymap.	Only   keys  that  are	unbound	 or  bound  to
		     self-insert are affected.

	      -r in-string ...
		     Unbind the specified in-strings in the  selected  keymap.
		     This  is  exactly	equivalent  to	binding the strings to
		     undefined-key.

		     When -R is also used, interpret the in-strings as ranges.

		     When -p is also used, the	in-strings  specify  prefixes.
		     Any binding that has the given in-string as a prefix, not
		     including the binding for the in-string itself,  if  any,
		     will be removed.  For example,

			    bindkey -rpM viins '^['

		     will  remove  all bindings in the vi-insert keymap begin‐
		     ning with an escape character (probably cursor keys), but
		     leave the binding for the escape character itself (proba‐
		     bly vi-cmd-mode).	This is incompatible with  the	option
		     -R.

	      -s in-string out-string ...
		     Bind  each	 in-string to each out-string.	When in-string
		     is typed, out-string will be pushed back and  treated  as
		     input  to	the line editor.  When -R is also used, inter‐
		     pret the in-strings as ranges.

	      in-string command ...
		     Bind each in-string to each command.  When	 -R  is	 used,
		     interpret the in-strings as ranges.

	      [ in-string ]
		     List  key	bindings.   If	an in-string is specified, the
		     binding of that string in the  selected  keymap  is  dis‐
		     played.   Otherwise,  all	key  bindings  in the selected
		     keymap are displayed.  (As a special case, if the	-e  or
		     -v	 option	 is  used alone, the keymap is not displayed -
		     the implicit linking of keymaps is the  only  thing  that
		     happens.)

		     When  the	option	-p  is	used,  the  in-string  must be
		     present.  The listing shows all bindings which  have  the
		     given  key	 sequence as a prefix, not including any bind‐
		     ings for the key sequence itself.

		     When the -L option is used, the list is in	 the  form  of
		     bindkey commands to create the key bindings.

       When  the  -R  option is used as noted above, a valid range consists of
       two characters, with an optional	 `-'  between  them.   All  characters
       between the two specified, inclusive, are bound as specified.

       For  either in-string or out-string, the following escape sequences are
       recognised:

       \a     bell character
       \b     backspace
       \e, \E escape
       \f     form feed
       \n     linefeed (newline)
       \r     carriage return
       \t     horizontal tab
       \v     vertical tab
       \NNN   character code in octal
       \xNN   character code in hexadecimal
       \M[-]X character with meta bit set
       \C[-]X control character
       ^X     control character

       In all other cases, `\' escapes the  following  character.   Delete  is
       written	as  `^?'.   Note  that `\M^?' and `^\M?' are not the same, and
       that (unlike emacs), the bindings `\M-X' and `\eX'  are	entirely  dis‐
       tinct,  although	 they are initialized to the same bindings by `bindkey
       -m'.

       vared [ -Aache ] [ -p prompt ] [ -r rprompt ]
	 [ -M main-keymap ] [ -m vicmd-keymap ] name
	      The value of the parameter name is loaded into the edit  buffer,
	      and  the line editor is invoked.	When the editor exits, name is
	      set to the string value returned by the  editor.	 When  the  -c
	      flag  is	given,	the parameter is created if it doesn't already
	      exist.  The -a flag may be given with  -c	 to  create  an	 array
	      parameter,  or  the  -A flag to create an associative array.  If
	      the type of an existing parameter does not match the type to  be
	      created, the parameter is unset and recreated.

	      If an array or array slice is being edited, separator characters
	      as defined in $IFS will be shown quoted  with  a	backslash,  as
	      will  backslashes	 themselves.  Conversely, when the edited text
	      is split into an array, a backslash quotes an  immediately  fol‐
	      lowing  separator	 character or backslash; no other special han‐
	      dling of backslashes, or any handling of quotes, is performed.

	      Individual elements  of  existing	 array	or  associative	 array
	      parameters may be edited by using subscript syntax on name.  New
	      elements are created automatically, even without -c.

	      If the -p flag is given, the following string will be  taken  as
	      the prompt to display at the left.  If the -r flag is given, the
	      following string gives the prompt to display at the  right.   If
	      the  -h flag is specified, the history can be accessed from ZLE.
	      If the -e flag is given, typing ^D (Control-D) on an empty  line
	      causes vared to exit immediately with a non-zero return value.

	      The  -M  option gives a keymap to link to the main keymap during
	      editing, and the -m option gives a keymap to link to  the	 vicmd
	      keymap during editing.  For vi-style editing, this allows a pair
	      of keymaps to override viins and vicmd.  For  emacs-style	 edit‐
	      ing,  only  -M is normally needed but the -m option may still be
	      used.  On exit, the previous keymaps will be restored.

       zle
       zle -l [ -L | -a ] [ string ... ]
       zle -D widget ...
       zle -A old-widget new-widget
       zle -N widget [ function ]
       zle -C widget completion-widget function
       zle -R [ -c ] [ display-string ] [ string ... ]
       zle -M string
       zle -U string
       zle -K keymap
       zle -F [ -L ] [ fd [ handler ] ]
       zle -I
       zle widget [ -n num ] [ -N ] args ...
	      The zle builtin performs a number of different actions  concern‐
	      ing ZLE.

	      With no options and no arguments, only the return status will be
	      set.  It is zero if ZLE is currently active and widgets could be
	      invoked using this builtin command and non-zero otherwise.  Note
	      that even if non-zero status  is	returned,  zle	may  still  be
	      active  as  part	of  the completion system; this does not allow
	      direct calls to ZLE widgets.

	      Otherwise, which operation it performs depends on its options:

	      -l [ -L | -a ]
		     List all existing user-defined widgets.  If the -L option
		     is	 used,	list in the form of zle commands to create the
		     widgets.

		     When combined with the -a option, all  widget  names  are
		     listed,  including	 the builtin ones. In this case the -L
		     option is ignored.

		     If at least one string is given, nothing will be  printed
		     but  the  return  status  will be zero if all strings are
		     names of existing widgets (or of user-defined widgets  if
		     the  -a  flag  is not given) and non-zero if at least one
		     string is not a name of an defined widget.

	      -D widget ...
		     Delete the named widgets.

	      -A old-widget new-widget
		     Make the new-widget name an alias for old-widget, so that
		     both  names  refer	 to  the  same widget.	The names have
		     equal standing; if either is deleted, the other  remains.
		     If there is already a widget with the new-widget name, it
		     is deleted.

	      -N widget [ function ]
		     Create a user-defined widget.  If there is already a wid‐
		     get with the specified name, it is overwritten.  When the
		     new widget is invoked from within the editor, the	speci‐
		     fied  shell  function  is called.	If no function name is
		     specified, it defaults to the same name  as  the  widget.
		     For  further information, see the section Widgets in zsh‐
		     zle(1).

	      -C widget completion-widget function
		     Create a user-defined completion widget named widget. The
		     completion	 widget	 will behave like the built-in comple‐
		     tion-widget whose name is given as completion-widget.  To
		     generate  the  completions,  the  shell function function
		     will be called.  For further  information,	 see  zshcomp‐
		     wid(1).

	      -R [ -c ] [ display-string ] [ string ... ]
		     Redisplay	the  command  line;  this is to be called from
		     within a user-defined widget to allow changes  to	become
		     visible.	If  a  display-string  is given and not empty,
		     this is shown in the status line (immediately  below  the
		     line being edited).

		     If	 the  optional strings are given they are listed below
		     the prompt in  the	 same  way  as	completion  lists  are
		     printed.  If  no  strings	are given but the -c option is
		     used such a list is cleared.

		     Note that this option is only useful for widgets that  do
		     not  exit	immediately after using it because the strings
		     displayed will be erased immediately  after  return  from
		     the widget.

		     This  command  can	 safely be called outside user defined
		     widgets; if zle is active, the display will be refreshed,
		     while  if	zle  is not active, the command has no effect.
		     In this case there will usually be no other arguments.

		     The status is zero if zle was active, else one.

	      -M string
		     As with the -R option, the string will be displayed below
		     the  command  line; unlike the -R option, the string will
		     not be put into the  status  line	but  will  instead  be
		     printed  normally	below the prompt.  This means that the
		     string will still be displayed after the  widget  returns
		     (until it is overwritten by subsequent commands).

	      -U string
		     This  pushes  the characters in the string onto the input
		     stack of ZLE.  After the widget currently	executed  fin‐
		     ishes  ZLE will behave as if the characters in the string
		     were typed by the user.

		     As ZLE uses a stack, if this option  is  used  repeatedly
		     the  last	string pushed onto the stack will be processed
		     first.  However, the characters in each  string  will  be
		     processed	in  the	 order	in  which  they	 appear in the
		     string.

	      -K keymap
		     Selects the keymap named keymap.  An error	 message  will
		     be displayed if there is no such keymap.

		     This  keymap selection affects the interpretation of fol‐
		     lowing keystrokes within this  invocation	of  ZLE.   Any
		     following	invocation  (e.g., the next command line) will
		     start as usual with the `main' keymap selected.

	      -F [ -L ] [ fd [ handler ] ]
		     Only available if your system supports one of the	`poll'
		     or `select' system calls; most modern systems do.

		     Installs handler (the name of a shell function) to handle
		     input from file descriptor fd.  When zle is attempting to
		     read data, it will examine both the terminal and the list
		     of handled fd's.  If data becomes available on a  handled
		     fd,  zle will call handler with the fd which is ready for
		     reading as the only argument.  If	the  handler  produces
		     output  to	 the  terminal, it should call `zle -I' before
		     doing so (see below).  The handler should not attempt  to
		     read  from	 the terminal.	Note that zle makes no attempt
		     to check  whether	this  fd  is  actually	readable  when
		     installing	 the  handler.	 The  user must make their own
		     arrangements for handling the file descriptor when zle is
		     not active.

		     Any  number  of  handlers for any number of readable file
		     descriptors may be installed.  Installing a  handler  for
		     an	 fd  which is already handled causes the existing han‐
		     dler to be replaced.

		     If no handler is given, but an fd is present, any handler
		     for  that fd is removed.  If there is none, an error mes‐
		     sage is printed and status 1 is returned.

		     If no arguments are given, or the -L option is  supplied,
		     a	list  of  handlers  is	printed in a form which can be
		     stored for later execution.

		     An fd (but not a handler) may optionally  be  given  with
		     the  -L  option; in this case, the function will list the
		     handler if any, else silently return status 1.

		     Note that this feature should be used with care.	Activ‐
		     ity  on one of the fd's which is not properly handled can
		     cause the terminal to become unusable.

		     Here is a simple example of using this feature.   A  con‐
		     nection  to  a  remote TCP port is created using the ztcp
		     command; see the description of the zsh/net/tcp module in
		     zshmodules(1).   Then a handler is installed which simply
		     prints out any data which	arrives	 on  this  connection.
		     Note that `select' will indicate that the file descriptor
		     needs handling if the remote side has closed the  connec‐
		     tion; we handle that by testing for a failed read.
			    if ztcp pwspc 2811; then
			      tcpfd=$REPLY
			      handler() {
				zle -I
				local line
				if ! read -r line <&$1; then
				  # select marks this fd if we reach EOF,
				  # so handle this specially.
				  print "[Read on fd $1 failed, removing.]" >&2
				  zle -F $1
				  return 1
				fi
				print -r - $line
			      }
			      zle -F $tcpfd handler
			    fi

	      -I     Unusually,	 this  option  is most useful outside ordinary
		     widget functions, though it may be used within if	normal
		     output  to	 the terminal is required.  It invalidates the
		     current zle display in preparation for output;  typically
		     this  will	 be from a trap function.  It has no effect if
		     zle is not active.	 When a trap exits, the	 shell	checks
		     to	 see if the display needs restoring, hence the follow‐
		     ing will print output in such a way as not to disturb the
		     line being edited:

			    TRAPUSR1() {
				# Invalidate zle display
			      [[ -o zle ]] && zle -I
				# Show output
			      print Hello
			    }

		     In	 general,  the	trap function may need to test whether
		     zle is active before using this method (as shown  in  the
		     example),	since  the  zsh/zle  module  may  not  even be
		     loaded; if it is not, the command can be skipped.

		     It is possible to call `zle -I' several times before con‐
		     trol  is returned to the editor; the display will only be
		     invalidated the first time to minimise disruption.

		     Note that there are normally better ways of  manipulating
		     the  display  from	 within zle widgets; see, for example,
		     `zle -R' above.

		     The returned status is zero if zle was invalidated,  even
		     though  this may have been by a previous call to `zle -I'
		     or by a system notification.  To test if a zle widget may
		     be	 called	 at  this point, execute zle with no arguments
		     and examine the return status.

	      widget [ -n num ] [ -N ] args ...
		     Invoke the specified widget.  This can only be done  when
		     ZLE   is	active;	  normally   this  will	 be  within  a
		     user-defined widget.

		     With the options -n and -N, the current  numerical	 argu‐
		     ment  will	 be  saved and then restored after the call to
		     widget; `-n num' sets the numerical argument  temporarily
		     to	 num,  while  `-N'  sets it to the default, i.e. as if
		     there were none.

		     Any further arguments will be passed to the  widget.   If
		     it	 is  a	shell function, these are passed down as posi‐
		     tional parameters; for builtin widgets it is  up  to  the
		     widget  in	 question  what	 it does with them.  Currently
		     arguments are only handled by the incremental-search com‐
		     mands,  the  history-search-forward and -backward and the
		     corresponding functions prefixed by vi-, and  by  univer‐
		     sal-argument.   No	 error	is flagged if the command does
		     not use the arguments, or only uses some of them.

		     The return status reflects the success or failure of  the
		     operation	carried	 out  by  the  widget,	or  if it is a
		     user-defined widget the return status of the shell	 func‐
		     tion.

		     A	non-zero  return  status causes the shell to beep when
		     the widget exits, unless the BEEP options	was  unset  or
		     the  widget  was  called  via the zle command.  Thus if a
		     user defined widget requires an immediate beep, it should
		     call the beep widget directly.

WIDGETS
       All  actions  in the editor are performed by `widgets'.	A widget's job
       is simply to perform some small action.	 The  ZLE  commands  that  key
       sequences  in keymaps are bound to are in fact widgets.	Widgets can be
       user-defined or built in.

       The standard widgets built in to ZLE are	 listed	 in  Standard  Widgets
       below.	Other  built-in	 widgets  can be defined by other modules (see
       zshmodules(1)).	Each built-in widget has two names: its normal canoni‐
       cal  name,  and	the same name preceded by a `.'.  The `.' name is spe‐
       cial: it can't be rebound to a different widget.	 This makes the widget
       available even when its usual name has been redefined.

       User-defined  widgets  are  defined  using `zle -N', and implemented as
       shell functions.	 When the widget is executed, the corresponding	 shell
       function	 is  executed, and can perform editing (or other) actions.  It
       is recommended that user-defined widgets should not have names starting
       with `.'.

USER-DEFINED WIDGETS
       User-defined widgets, being implemented as shell functions, can execute
       any normal shell command.  They can also	 run  other  widgets  (whether
       built-in	 or user-defined) using the zle builtin command.  The standard
       input of the function is closed to prevent external commands from unin‐
       tentionally  blocking  ZLE by reading from the terminal, but read -k or
       read -q can be used to read characters.	Finally, they can examine  and
       edit  the  ZLE  buffer  being edited by reading and setting the special
       parameters described below.

       These special parameters are always available in widget functions,  but
       are not in any way special outside ZLE.	If they have some normal value
       outside ZLE, that value is temporarily inaccessible,  but  will	return
       when  the widget function exits.	 These special parameters in fact have
       local scope, like parameters created in a function using local.

       Inside completion widgets and traps called while ZLE is	active,	 these
       parameters are available read-only.

       BUFFER (scalar)
	      The  entire  contents  of the edit buffer.  If it is written to,
	      the cursor remains at the same offset, unless that would put  it
	      outside the buffer.

       BUFFERLINES (integer)
	      The  number of screen lines needed for the edit buffer currently
	      displayed on screen (i.e. without any changes to	the  preceding
	      parameters done after the last redisplay); read-only.

       CONTEXT (scalar)
	      The  context  in which zle was called to read a line; read-only.
	      One of the values:
       start  The start of a command line (at prompt PS1).

       cont   A continuation to a command line (at prompt PS2).

       select In a select loop.

       vared  Editing a variable in vared.

       CURSOR (integer)
	      The offset of the cursor, within the edit buffer.	  This	is  in
	      the  range  0  to	 $#BUFFER,  and	 is  by	 definition  equal  to
	      $#LBUFFER.  Attempts to move the cursor outside the buffer  will
	      result  in  the cursor being moved to the appropriate end of the
	      buffer.

       CUTBUFFER (scalar)
	      The last item to be cut using one of the `kill-'	commands;  the
	      string which the next yank would insert in the line.

       HISTNO (integer)
	      The current history number.  Setting this has the same effect as
	      moving up or down in the history to  the	corresponding  history
	      line.  An attempt to set it is ignored if the line is not stored
	      in the history.  Note this is not	 the  same  as	the  parameter
	      HISTCMD, which always gives the number of the history line being
	      added to the main shell's history.  HISTNO refers	 to  the  line
	      being retrieved within zle.

       KEYMAP (scalar)
	      The name of the currently selected keymap; read-only.

       KEYS (scalar)
	      The  keys	 typed	to  invoke  this  widget, as a literal string;
	      read-only.

       killring (array)
	      The array of previously killed items,  with  the	most  recently
	      killed first.  This gives the items that would be retrieved by a
	      yank-pop in the same order.

	      The default size for the kill ring is eight, however the	length
	      may  be changed by normal array operations.  Any empty string in
	      the kill ring is ignored by the yank-pop command, hence the size
	      of  the  array  effectively  sets the maximum length of the kill
	      ring, while the number of non-zero  strings  gives  the  current
	      length, both as seen by the user at the command line.

       LASTSEARCH (scalar)
	      The   last  search  string  used	by  an	interactive  search  ;
	      read-only.

       LASTWIDGET (scalar)
	      The name of the last widget that was executed; read-only.

       LBUFFER (scalar)
	      The part of the buffer that lies to the left of the cursor posi‐
	      tion.   If  it  is  assigned to, only that part of the buffer is
	      replaced, and the cursor remains between the  new	 $LBUFFER  and
	      the old $RBUFFER.

       MARK (integer)
	      Like CURSOR, but for the mark.

       NUMERIC (integer)
	      The  numeric  argument.  If  no numeric argument was given, this
	      parameter is unset. When this is set inside a  widget  function,
	      builtin widgets called with the zle builtin command will use the
	      value assigned. If it is unset inside a widget function, builtin
	      widgets called behave as if no numeric argument was given.

       PENDING (integer)
	      The  number of bytes pending for input, i.e. the number of bytes
	      which have already been typed and can immediately	 be  read.  On
	      systems  where  the  shell  is not able to get this information,
	      this parameter will always have a value of zero.	Read-only.

       PREBUFFER (scalar)
	      In a multi-line input at the secondary  prompt,  this  read-only
	      parameter	 contains the contents of the lines before the one the
	      cursor is currently in.

       PREDISPLAY (scalar)
	      Text to be displayed before the start of the editable text  buf‐
	      fer.   This  does	 not  have to be a complete line; to display a
	      complete line, a newline must  be	 appended  explicitly.	   The
	      text  is reset on each new invocation (but not recursive invoca‐
	      tion) of zle.

       POSTDISPLAY (scalar)
	      Text to be displayed after the end of the editable text  buffer.
	      This  does not have to be a complete line; to display a complete
	      line, a newline must be prepended explicitly.  The text is reset
	      on each new invocation (but not recursive invocation) of zle.

       RBUFFER (scalar)
	      The  part	 of  the  buffer  that lies to the right of the cursor
	      position.	 If it is assigned to, only that part of the buffer is
	      replaced,	 and  the  cursor remains between the old $LBUFFER and
	      the new $RBUFFER.

       WIDGET (scalar)
	      The name of the widget currently being executed; read-only.

       WIDGETFUNC (scalar)
	      The name of the shell function that implements a widget  defined
	      with  either  zle -N or zle -C.  In the former case, this is the
	      second argument to the zle -N command that defined  the  widget,
	      or  the  first argument if there was no second argument.	In the
	      latter case this is the the third argument to the zle -C command
	      that defined the widget.	Read-only.

       WIDGETSTYLE (scalar)
	      Describes	 the  implementation behind the completion widget cur‐
	      rently being executed; the second argument that followed zle  -C
	      when the widget was defined.  This is the name of a builtin com‐
	      pletion widget.  For widgets defined with zle -N this is set  to
	      the empty string.	 Read-only.

   Special Widget
       There  is one user-defined widget which is special to the shell.	 If it
       does not exist, no special action is taken.  The	 environment  provided
       is identical to that for any other editing widget.

       zle-line-init
	      Executed	every  time  the  line editor is started to read a new
	      line of input.  The following example puts the line editor  into
	      vi command mode when it starts up.

		     zle-line-init() { zle -K vicmd; }
		     zle -N zle-line-init

	      (The command inside the function sets the keymap directly; it is
	      equivalent to zle vi-cmd-mode.)

STANDARD WIDGETS
       The following is a list of all the standard widgets, and their  default
       bindings	 in  emacs  mode,  vi  command	mode  and  vi insert mode (the
       `emacs', `vicmd' and `viins' keymaps, respectively).

       Note that cursor keys are bound to movement keys in all three  keymaps;
       the  shell assumes that the cursor keys send the key sequences reported
       by the  terminal-handling  library  (termcap  or	 terminfo).   The  key
       sequences  shown	 in  the  list are those based on the VT100, common on
       many modern terminals, but in fact these are not necessarily bound.  In
       the  case  of  the  viins  keymap,  the initial escape character of the
       sequences serves also to return to the vicmd keymap: whether this  hap‐
       pens is determined by the KEYTIMEOUT parameter, see zshparam(1).

   Movement
       vi-backward-blank-word (unbound) (B) (unbound)
	      Move  backward  one word, where a word is defined as a series of
	      non-blank characters.

       backward-char (^B ESC-[D) (unbound) (unbound)
	      Move backward one character.

       vi-backward-char (unbound) (^H h ^?) (ESC-[D)
	      Move backward one character, without changing lines.

       backward-word (ESC-B ESC-b) (unbound) (unbound)
	      Move to the beginning of the previous word.

       emacs-backward-word
	      Move to the beginning of the previous word.

       vi-backward-word (unbound) (b) (unbound)
	      Move to the beginning of the previous word, vi-style.

       beginning-of-line (^A) (unbound) (unbound)
	      Move to the beginning of the line.  If already at the  beginning
	      of the line, move to the beginning of the previous line, if any.

       vi-beginning-of-line
	      Move to the beginning of the line, without changing lines.

       end-of-line (^E) (unbound) (unbound)
	      Move to the end of the line.  If already at the end of the line,
	      move to the end of the next line, if any.

       vi-end-of-line (unbound) ($) (unbound)
	      Move to the end of the line.  If an argument is  given  to  this
	      command,	the cursor will be moved to the end of the line (argu‐
	      ment - 1) lines down.

       vi-forward-blank-word (unbound) (W) (unbound)
	      Move forward one word, where a word is defined as	 a  series  of
	      non-blank characters.

       vi-forward-blank-word-end (unbound) (E) (unbound)
	      Move  to	the  end of the current word, or, if at the end of the
	      current word, to the end of the  next  word,  where  a  word  is
	      defined as a series of non-blank characters.

       forward-char (^F ESC-[C) (unbound) (unbound)
	      Move forward one character.

       vi-forward-char (unbound) (space l) (ESC-[C)
	      Move forward one character.

       vi-find-next-char (^X^F) (f) (unbound)
	      Read  a character from the keyboard, and move to the next occur‐
	      rence of it in the line.

       vi-find-next-char-skip (unbound) (t) (unbound)
	      Read a character from the keyboard, and  move  to	 the  position
	      just before the next occurrence of it in the line.

       vi-find-prev-char (unbound) (F) (unbound)
	      Read  a  character  from	the keyboard, and move to the previous
	      occurrence of it in the line.

       vi-find-prev-char-skip (unbound) (T) (unbound)
	      Read a character from the keyboard, and  move  to	 the  position
	      just after the previous occurrence of it in the line.

       vi-first-non-blank (unbound) (^) (unbound)
	      Move to the first non-blank character in the line.

       vi-forward-word (unbound) (w) (unbound)
	      Move forward one word, vi-style.

       forward-word (ESC-F ESC-f) (unbound) (unbound)
	      Move  to the beginning of the next word.	The editor's idea of a
	      word is specified with the WORDCHARS parameter.

       emacs-forward-word
	      Move to the end of the next word.

       vi-forward-word-end (unbound) (e) (unbound)
	      Move to the end of the next word.

       vi-goto-column (ESC-|) (|) (unbound)
	      Move to the column specified by the numeric argument.

       vi-goto-mark (unbound) (`) (unbound)
	      Move to the specified mark.

       vi-goto-mark-line (unbound) (') (unbound)
	      Move to beginning of the line containing the specified mark.

       vi-repeat-find (unbound) (;) (unbound)
	      Repeat the last vi-find command.

       vi-rev-repeat-find (unbound) (,) (unbound)
	      Repeat the last vi-find command in the opposite direction.

   History Control
       beginning-of-buffer-or-history (ESC-<) (unbound) (unbound)
	      Move to the beginning of the buffer, or if already  there,  move
	      to the first event in the history list.

       beginning-of-line-hist
	      Move  to the beginning of the line.  If already at the beginning
	      of the buffer, move to the previous history line.

       beginning-of-history
	      Move to the first event in the history list.

       down-line-or-history (^N ESC-[B) (j) (ESC-[B)
	      Move down a line in the buffer, or  if  already  at  the	bottom
	      line, move to the next event in the history list.

       vi-down-line-or-history (unbound) (+) (unbound)
	      Move  down  a  line  in  the buffer, or if already at the bottom
	      line, move to the next event in the history list.	 Then move  to
	      the first non-blank character on the line.

       down-line-or-search
	      Move  down  a  line  in  the buffer, or if already at the bottom
	      line, search forward in the history for a	 line  beginning  with
	      the first word in the buffer.

	      If called from a function by the zle command with arguments, the
	      first argument is taken as  the  string  for  which  to  search,
	      rather than the first word in the buffer.

       down-history (unbound) (^N) (unbound)
	      Move to the next event in the history list.

       history-beginning-search-backward
	      Search  backward	in  the	 history for a line beginning with the
	      current line up to the cursor.  This leaves the  cursor  in  its
	      original position.

       end-of-buffer-or-history (ESC->) (unbound) (unbound)
	      Move  to the end of the buffer, or if already there, move to the
	      last event in the history list.

       end-of-line-hist
	      Move to the end of the line.  If already at the end of the  buf‐
	      fer, move to the next history line.

       end-of-history
	      Move to the last event in the history list.

       vi-fetch-history (unbound) (G) (unbound)
	      Fetch  the history line specified by the numeric argument.  This
	      defaults to the current history line (i.e. the  one  that	 isn't
	      history yet).

       history-incremental-search-backward (^R ^Xr) (unbound) (unbound)
	      Search  backward	incrementally  for  a  specified  string.  The
	      search is case-insensitive if the search string  does  not  have
	      uppercase letters and no numeric argument was given.  The string
	      may begin with `^' to anchor the search to the beginning of  the
	      line.

	      A	 restricted  set  of  editing  functions  is  available in the
	      mini-buffer.  An interrupt signal, as defined by the  stty  set‐
	      ting, will stop the search and go back to the original line.  An
	      undefined key will have the same effect. The supported functions
	      are:	  backward-delete-char,	      vi-backward-delete-char,
	      clear-screen,   redisplay,   quoted-insert,    vi-quoted-insert,
	      accept-and-hold,	accept-and-infer-next-history, accept-line and
	      accept-line-and-down-history.

	      magic-space just inserts a space.	 vi-cmd-mode  toggles  between
	      the  `main' and `vicmd' keymaps; the `main' keymap (insert mode)
	      will be selected initially.  history-incremental-search-backward
	      will get the next occurrence of the contents of the mini-buffer.
	      history-incremental-search-forward  inverts  the	sense  of  the
	      search.  vi-repeat-search and vi-rev-repeat-search are similarly
	      supported.  The direction of the	search	is  indicated  in  the
	      mini-buffer.

	      Any multi-character string that is not bound to one of the above
	      functions will beep and interrupt the search, leaving  the  last
	      found line in the buffer. Any single character that is not bound
	      to   one	 of   the   above   functions,	 or   self-insert   or
	      self-insert-unmeta,  will	 have the same effect but the function
	      will be executed.

	      When called from a widget	 function  by  the  zle	 command,  the
	      incremental  search  commands  can take a string argument.  This
	      will be treated as a string of keys, as  for  arguments  to  the
	      bindkey command, and used as initial input for the command.  Any
	      characters in the string which are  unused  by  the  incremental
	      search will be silently ignored.	For example,

		     zle history-incremental-search-backward forceps

	      will  search  backwards for forceps, leaving the minibuffer con‐
	      taining the string `forceps'.

       history-incremental-search-forward (^S ^Xs) (unbound) (unbound)
	      Search forward incrementally for a specified string.  The search
	      is case-insensitive if the search string does not have uppercase
	      letters and no numeric argument was given.  The string may begin
	      with `^' to anchor the search to the beginning of the line.  The
	      functions available in the mini-buffer are the same as for  his‐
	      tory-incremental-search-backward.

       history-search-backward (ESC-P ESC-p) (unbound) (unbound)
	      Search  backward	in  the	 history for a line beginning with the
	      first word in the buffer.

	      If called from a function by the zle command with arguments, the
	      first  argument  is  taken  as  the  string for which to search,
	      rather than the first word in the buffer.

       vi-history-search-backward (unbound) (/) (unbound)
	      Search backward in the history  for  a  specified	 string.   The
	      string  may begin with `^' to anchor the search to the beginning
	      of the line.

	      A restricted set	of  editing  functions	is  available  in  the
	      mini-buffer.   An	 interrupt signal, as defined by the stty set‐
	      ting,  will stop the search.  The	 functions  available  in  the
	      mini-buffer  are:	 accept-line,  backward-delete-char,  vi-back‐
	      ward-delete-char,	  backward-kill-word,	vi-backward-kill-word,
	      clear-screen, redisplay, quoted-insert and vi-quoted-insert.

	      vi-cmd-mode  is treated the same as accept-line, and magic-space
	      is treated as a space.  Any other character that is not bound to
	      self-insert  or  self-insert-unmeta will beep and be ignored. If
	      the function is called from vi command mode, the bindings of the
	      current insert mode will be used.

	      If called from a function by the zle command with arguments, the
	      first argument is taken as  the  string  for  which  to  search,
	      rather than the first word in the buffer.

       history-search-forward (ESC-N ESC-n) (unbound) (unbound)
	      Search  forward  in  the	history	 for a line beginning with the
	      first word in the buffer.

	      If called from a function by the zle command with arguments, the
	      first  argument  is  taken  as  the  string for which to search,
	      rather than the first word in the buffer.

       vi-history-search-forward (unbound) (?) (unbound)
	      Search forward in the  history  for  a  specified	 string.   The
	      string  may begin with `^' to anchor the search to the beginning
	      of the line. The functions available in the mini-buffer are  the
	      same  as	for  vi-history-search-backward.  Argument handling is
	      also the same as for that command.

       infer-next-history (^X^N) (unbound) (unbound)
	      Search in the history list for a line matching the  current  one
	      and fetch the event following it.

       insert-last-word (ESC-_ ESC-.) (unbound) (unbound)
	      Insert the last word from the previous history event at the cur‐
	      sor position.  If a positive numeric argument is	given,	insert
	      that  word  from	the end of the previous history event.	If the
	      argument is zero or negative insert  that	 word  from  the  left
	      (zero  inserts  the previous command word).  Repeating this com‐
	      mand replaces the word just inserted with the last word from the
	      history  event prior to the one just used; numeric arguments can
	      be used in the same way to pick a word from that event.

	      When called from a shell function invoked	 from  a  user-defined
	      widget,  the command can take one to three arguments.  The first
	      argument specifies a history offset which applies to  successive
	      calls  to	 this widget: if is -1, the default behaviour is used,
	      while if it is 1, successive calls will  move  forwards  through
	      the  history.  The value 0 can be used to indicate that the his‐
	      tory line examined by the previous execution of the command will
	      be  reexamined.	Note  that negative numbers should be preceded
	      with a `--' argument to avoid confusing them with options.

	      If two arguments are given, the second specifies the word on the
	      command  line  in normal array index notation (as a more natural
	      alternative to the prefix argument).  Hence 1 is the first word,
	      and -1 (the default) is the last word.

	      If  a  third  argument is given, its value is ignored, but it is
	      used to signify that the history offset is relative to the  cur‐
	      rent history line, rather than the one remembered after the pre‐
	      vious invocations of insert-last-word.

	      For example, the default behaviour of the command corresponds to

		     zle insert-last-word -- -1 -1

	      while the command

		     zle insert-last-word -- -1 1 -

	      always copies the first word of the line in the history  immedi‐
	      ately  before  the  line being edited.  This has the side effect
	      that later invocations of the widget will be  relative  to  that
	      line.

       vi-repeat-search (unbound) (n) (unbound)
	      Repeat the last vi history search.

       vi-rev-repeat-search (unbound) (N) (unbound)
	      Repeat the last vi history search, but in reverse.

       up-line-or-history (^P ESC-[A) (k) (ESC-[A)
	      Move  up	a  line	 in the buffer, or if already at the top line,
	      move to the previous event in the history list.

       vi-up-line-or-history (unbound) (-) (unbound)
	      Move up a line in the buffer, or if already  at  the  top	 line,
	      move  to	the  previous event in the history list.  Then move to
	      the first non-blank character on the line.

       up-line-or-search
	      Move up a line in the buffer, or if already  at  the  top	 line,
	      search  backward	in  the	 history for a line beginning with the
	      first word in the buffer.

	      If called from a function by the zle command with arguments, the
	      first  argument  is  taken  as  the  string for which to search,
	      rather than the first word in the buffer.

       up-history (unbound) (^P) (unbound)
	      Move to the previous event in the history list.

       history-beginning-search-forward
	      Search forward in the history for a line beginning with the cur‐
	      rent line up to the cursor.  This leaves the cursor in its orig‐
	      inal position.

   Modifying Text
       vi-add-eol (unbound) (A) (unbound)
	      Move to the end of the line and enter insert mode.

       vi-add-next (unbound) (a) (unbound)
	      Enter insert mode after the  current  cursor  position,  without
	      changing lines.

       backward-delete-char (^H ^?) (unbound) (unbound)
	      Delete the character behind the cursor.

       vi-backward-delete-char (unbound) (X) (^H)
	      Delete  the character behind the cursor, without changing lines.
	      If in insert mode, this won't delete past the point where insert
	      mode was last entered.

       backward-delete-word
	      Delete the word behind the cursor.

       backward-kill-line
	      Kill from the beginning of the line to the cursor position.

       backward-kill-word (^W ESC-^H ESC-^?) (unbound) (unbound)
	      Kill the word behind the cursor.

       vi-backward-kill-word (unbound) (unbound) (^W)
	      Kill  the	 word  behind the cursor, without going past the point
	      where insert mode was last entered.

       capitalize-word (ESC-C ESC-c) (unbound) (unbound)
	      Capitalize the current word and move past it.

       vi-change (unbound) (c) (unbound)
	      Read a movement command from the keyboard,  and  kill  from  the
	      cursor  position	to  the	 endpoint of the movement.  Then enter
	      insert mode.  If the command is vi-change,  change  the  current
	      line.

       vi-change-eol (unbound) (C) (unbound)
	      Kill to the end of the line and enter insert mode.

       vi-change-whole-line (unbound) (S) (unbound)
	      Kill the current line and enter insert mode.

       copy-region-as-kill (ESC-W ESC-w) (unbound) (unbound)
	      Copy the area from the cursor to the mark to the kill buffer.

       copy-prev-word (ESC-^_) (unbound) (unbound)
	      Duplicate the word to the left of the cursor.

       copy-prev-shell-word
	      Like  copy-prev-word, but the word is found by using shell pars‐
	      ing, whereas copy-prev-word looks for blanks. This makes a  dif‐
	      ference when the word is quoted and contains spaces.

       vi-delete (unbound) (d) (unbound)
	      Read  a  movement	 command  from the keyboard, and kill from the
	      cursor position to the endpoint of the movement.	If the command
	      is vi-delete, kill the current line.

       delete-char
	      Delete the character under the cursor.

       vi-delete-char (unbound) (x) (unbound)
	      Delete  the  character  under the cursor, without going past the
	      end of the line.

       delete-word
	      Delete the current word.

       down-case-word (ESC-L ESC-l) (unbound) (unbound)
	      Convert the current word to all lowercase and move past it.

       kill-word (ESC-D ESC-d) (unbound) (unbound)
	      Kill the current word.

       gosmacs-transpose-chars
	      Exchange the two characters behind the cursor.

       vi-indent (unbound) (>) (unbound)
	      Indent a number of lines.

       vi-insert (unbound) (i) (unbound)
	      Enter insert mode.

       vi-insert-bol (unbound) (I) (unbound)
	      Move to the first non-blank character  on	 the  line  and	 enter
	      insert mode.

       vi-join (^X^J) (J) (unbound)
	      Join the current line with the next one.

       kill-line (^K) (unbound) (unbound)
	      Kill  from the cursor to the end of the line.  If already on the
	      end of the line, kill the newline character.

       vi-kill-line (unbound) (unbound) (^U)
	      Kill from the cursor back	 to  wherever  insert  mode  was  last
	      entered.

       vi-kill-eol (unbound) (D) (unbound)
	      Kill from the cursor to the end of the line.

       kill-region
	      Kill from the cursor to the mark.

       kill-buffer (^X^K) (unbound) (unbound)
	      Kill the entire buffer.

       kill-whole-line (^U) (unbound) (unbound)
	      Kill the current line.

       vi-match-bracket (^X^B) (%) (unbound)
	      Move to the bracket character (one of {}, () or []) that matches
	      the one under the cursor.	 If the cursor is  not	on  a  bracket
	      character,  move	forward without going past the end of the line
	      to find one, and then go to the matching bracket.

       vi-open-line-above (unbound) (O) (unbound)
	      Open a line above the cursor and enter insert mode.

       vi-open-line-below (unbound) (o) (unbound)
	      Open a line below the cursor and enter insert mode.

       vi-oper-swap-case
	      Read a movement command from the keyboard, and swap the case  of
	      all  characters  from the cursor position to the endpoint of the
	      movement.	 If the movement command  is  vi-oper-swap-case,  swap
	      the case of all characters on the current line.

       overwrite-mode (^X^O) (unbound) (unbound)
	      Toggle between overwrite mode and insert mode.

       vi-put-before (unbound) (P) (unbound)
	      Insert  the  contents  of the kill buffer before the cursor.  If
	      the kill buffer contains a sequence  of  lines  (as  opposed  to
	      characters), paste it above the current line.

       vi-put-after (unbound) (p) (unbound)
	      Insert the contents of the kill buffer after the cursor.	If the
	      kill buffer contains a sequence of lines (as opposed to  charac‐
	      ters), paste it below the current line.

       quoted-insert (^V) (unbound) (unbound)
	      Insert  the  next character typed into the buffer literally.  An
	      interrupt character will not be inserted.

       vi-quoted-insert (unbound) (unbound) (^Q ^V)
	      Display a `^' at the cursor position, and insert the next	 char‐
	      acter  typed  into the buffer literally.	An interrupt character
	      will not be inserted.

       quote-line (ESC-') (unbound) (unbound)
	      Quote the current line; that is, put  a  `''  character  at  the
	      beginning and the end, and convert all `'' characters to `'\'''.

       quote-region (ESC-") (unbound) (unbound)
	      Quote the region from the cursor to the mark.

       vi-replace (unbound) (R) (unbound)
	      Enter overwrite mode.

       vi-repeat-change (unbound) (.) (unbound)
	      Repeat  the last vi mode text modification.  If a count was used
	      with the modification, it is remembered.	If a count is given to
	      this  command,  it overrides the remembered count, and is remem‐
	      bered for future uses of this command.  The cut buffer  specifi‐
	      cation is similarly remembered.

       vi-replace-chars (unbound) (r) (unbound)
	      Replace  the  character  under  the cursor with a character read
	      from the keyboard.

       self-insert (printable characters) (unbound) (printable characters  and
       some control characters)
	      Insert a character into the buffer at the cursor position.

       self-insert-unmeta (ESC-^I ESC-^J ESC-^M) (unbound) (unbound)
	      Insert  a character into the buffer after stripping the meta bit
	      and converting ^M to ^J.

       vi-substitute (unbound) (s) (unbound)
	      Substitute the next character(s).

       vi-swap-case (unbound) (~) (unbound)
	      Swap the case of the character under the cursor  and  move  past
	      it.

       transpose-chars (^T) (unbound) (unbound)
	      Exchange	the two characters to the left of the cursor if at end
	      of line, else exchange the character under the cursor  with  the
	      character to the left.

       transpose-words (ESC-T ESC-t) (unbound) (unbound)
	      Exchange the current word with the one before it.

       vi-unindent (unbound) (<) (unbound)
	      Unindent a number of lines.

       up-case-word (ESC-U ESC-u) (unbound) (unbound)
	      Convert the current word to all caps and move past it.

       yank (^Y) (unbound) (unbound)
	      Insert the contents of the kill buffer at the cursor position.

       yank-pop (ESC-y) (unbound) (unbound)
	      Remove  the text just yanked, rotate the kill-ring, and yank the
	      new top.	Only works following yank or yank-pop.

       vi-yank (unbound) (y) (unbound)
	      Read a movement command from the keyboard, and copy  the	region
	      from  the	 cursor	 position to the endpoint of the movement into
	      the kill buffer.	If the command is vi-yank,  copy  the  current
	      line.

       vi-yank-whole-line (unbound) (Y) (unbound)
	      Copy the current line into the kill buffer.

       vi-yank-eol
	      Copy  the region from the cursor position to the end of the line
	      into the kill buffer.  Arguably, this is what Y should do in vi,
	      but it isn't what it actually does.

   Arguments
       digit-argument (ESC-0..ESC-9) (1-9) (unbound)
	      Start  a	new  numeric argument, or add to the current one.  See
	      also vi-digit-or-beginning-of-line.  This only works if bound to
	      a key sequence ending in a decimal digit.

	      Inside  a	 widget	 function,  a call to this function treats the
	      last key of the key sequence which  called  the  widget  as  the
	      digit.

       neg-argument (ESC--) (unbound) (unbound)
	      Changes the sign of the following argument.

       universal-argument
	      Multiply	the argument of the next command by 4.	Alternatively,
	      if this command is followed by an	 integer  (positive  or	 nega‐
	      tive), use that as the argument for the next command.  Thus dig‐
	      its cannot be repeated using this command.  For example, if this
	      command occurs twice, followed immediately by forward-char, move
	      forward sixteen spaces; if instead it is followed	 by  -2,  then
	      forward-char, move backward two spaces.

	      Inside  a widget function, if passed an argument, i.e. `zle uni‐
	      versal-argument num', the numerical argument will be set to num;
	      this is equivalent to `NUMERIC=num'.

   Completion
       accept-and-menu-complete
	      In  a  menu  completion,	insert the current completion into the
	      buffer, and advance to the next possible completion.

       complete-word
	      Attempt completion on the current word.

       delete-char-or-list (^D) (unbound) (unbound)
	      Delete the character under the cursor.  If the cursor is at  the
	      end of the line, list possible completions for the current word.

       expand-cmd-path
	      Expand the current command to its full pathname.

       expand-or-complete (TAB) (unbound) (TAB)
	      Attempt  shell  expansion	 on  the current word.	If that fails,
	      attempt completion.

       expand-or-complete-prefix
	      Attempt shell expansion on the current word up to cursor.

       expand-history (ESC-space ESC-!) (unbound) (unbound)
	      Perform history expansion on the edit buffer.

       expand-word (^X*) (unbound) (unbound)
	      Attempt shell expansion on the current word.

       list-choices (ESC-^D) (^D =) (^D)
	      List possible completions for the current word.

       list-expand (^Xg ^XG) (^G) (^G)
	      List the expansion of the current word.

       magic-space
	      Perform history expansion and insert a space  into  the  buffer.
	      This is intended to be bound to space.

       menu-complete
	      Like  complete-word,  except  that menu completion is used.  See
	      the MENU_COMPLETE option.

       menu-expand-or-complete
	      Like expand-or-complete, except that menu completion is used.

       reverse-menu-complete
	      Perform menu completion, like menu-complete, except  that	 if  a
	      menu  completion	is  already  in progress, move to the previous
	      completion rather than the next.

       end-of-list
	      When a previous completion displayed a list  below  the  prompt,
	      this widget can be used to move the prompt below the list.

   Miscellaneous
       accept-and-hold (ESC-A ESC-a) (unbound) (unbound)
	      Push  the contents of the buffer on the buffer stack and execute
	      it.

       accept-and-infer-next-history
	      Execute the contents of the buffer.   Then  search  the  history
	      list for a line matching the current one and push the event fol‐
	      lowing onto the buffer stack.

       accept-line (^J ^M) (^J ^M) (^J ^M)
	      Finish editing the buffer.  Normally this causes the  buffer  to
	      be executed as a shell command.

       accept-line-and-down-history (^O) (unbound) (unbound)
	      Execute the current line, and push the next history event on the
	      the buffer stack.

       beep   Beep, unless the BEEP option is unset.

       vi-cmd-mode (^X^V) (unbound) (^[)
	      Enter command mode; that is, select the  `vicmd'	keymap.	  Yes,
	      this is bound by default in emacs mode.

       vi-caps-lock-panic
	      Hang  until  any lowercase key is pressed.  This is for vi users
	      without the mental capacity to keep track of their caps lock key
	      (like the author).

       clear-screen (^L ESC-^L) (^L) (^L)
	      Clear the screen and redraw the prompt.

       describe-key-briefly
	      Reads  a	key  sequence,	then prints the function bound to that
	      sequence.

       exchange-point-and-mark (^X^X) (unbound) (unbound)
	      Exchange the cursor position with the position of the mark.

       execute-named-cmd (ESC-x) (unbound) (unbound)
	      Read the name of an editor command and execute it.  A restricted
	      set  of  editing	functions is available in the mini-buffer.  An
	      interrupt signal, as defined by the stty setting, will abort the
	      function.	  The  allowed	functions  are:	 backward-delete-char,
	      vi-backward-delete-char, clear-screen, redisplay, quoted-insert,
	      vi-quoted-insert,	  backward-kill-word,	vi-backward-kill-word,
	      kill-whole-line, vi-kill-line, backward-kill-line, list-choices,
	      delete-char-or-list,  complete-word, accept-line, expand-or-com‐
	      plete and expand-or-complete-prefix.

	      kill-region kills the last word, and vi-cmd-mode is treated  the
	      same as accept-line.  The space and tab characters, if not bound
	      to one of these functions, will complete the name and then  list
	      the  possibilities  if  the  AUTO_LIST option is set.  Any other
	      character that is not bound to self-insert or self-insert-unmeta
	      will  beep  and  be ignored.  The bindings of the current insert
	      mode will be used.

	      Currently this command may not be redefined or called by name.

       execute-last-named-cmd (ESC-z) (unbound) (unbound)
	      Redo the last function executed with execute-named-cmd.

	      Currently this command may not be redefined or called by name.

       get-line (ESC-G ESC-g) (unbound) (unbound)
	      Pop the top line off the buffer stack and insert it at the  cur‐
	      sor position.

       pound-insert (unbound) (#) (unbound)
	      If  there	 is no # character at the beginning of the buffer, add
	      one to the beginning of each line.  If there is one, remove a  #
	      from each line that has one.  In either case, accept the current
	      line.  The INTERACTIVE_COMMENTS option must be set for  this  to
	      have any usefulness.

       vi-pound-insert
	      If there is no # character at the beginning of the current line,
	      add one.	If there is one, remove it.  The  INTERACTIVE_COMMENTS
	      option must be set for this to have any usefulness.

       push-input
	      Push  the	 entire	 current  multiline  construct onto the buffer
	      stack and return to the top-level (PS1) prompt.  If the  current
	      parser  construct	 is  only  a single line, this is exactly like
	      push-line.  Next time the editor starts up  or  is  popped  with
	      get-line, the construct will be popped off the top of the buffer
	      stack and loaded into the editing buffer.

       push-line (^Q ESC-Q ESC-q) (unbound) (unbound)
	      Push the current buffer onto the buffer stack and clear the buf‐
	      fer.   Next time the editor starts up, the buffer will be popped
	      off the top of the buffer stack and loaded into the editing buf‐
	      fer.

       push-line-or-edit
	      At  the  top-level  (PS1) prompt, equivalent to push-line.  At a
	      secondary (PS2) prompt, move the entire current  multiline  con‐
	      struct  into  the	 editor	 buffer.   The latter is equivalent to
	      push-input followed by get-line.

       recursive-edit
	      Only useful from a user-defined widget.  At this	point  in  the
	      function,	 the  editor regains control until one of the standard
	      widgets which would normally cause zle  to  exit	(typically  an
	      accept-line  caused  by  hitting	the  return  key) is executed.
	      Instead, control returns to the user-defined widget.  The status
	      returned	is  non-zero if the return was caused by an error, but
	      the function still continues executing and hence	may  tidy  up.
	      This makes it safe for the user-defined widget to alter the com‐
	      mand line or key bindings temporarily.

	      The following widget, caps-lock, serves as an example.
		     self-insert-ucase() {
		       LBUFFER+=${(U)KEYS[-1]}
		     }

		     integer stat

		     zle -N self-insert self-insert-ucase
		     zle -A caps-lock save-caps-lock
		     zle -A accept-line caps-lock

		     zle recursive-edit
		     stat=$?

		     zle -A .self-insert self-insert
		     zle -A save-caps-lock caps-lock
		     zle -D save-caps-lock

		     (( stat )) && zle send-break

		     return $stat
	      This causes typed	 letters  to  be  inserted  capitalised	 until
	      either  accept-line  (i.e. typically the return key) is typed or
	      the caps-lock widget is invoked again; the later is  handled  by
	      saving  the  old	definition  of caps-lock as save-caps-lock and
	      then rebinding it to invoke accept-line.	 Note  that  an	 error
	      from  the recursive edit is detected as a non-zero return status
	      and propagated by using the send-break widget.

       redisplay (unbound) (^R) (^R)
	      Redisplays the edit buffer.

       reset-prompt (unbound) (unbound) (unbound)
	      Force the prompts on both the left and right of the screen to be
	      re-expanded,  then  redisplay  the  edit	buffer.	 This reflects
	      changes both to the prompt variables themselves and  changes  in
	      the  expansion  of  the  values (for example, changes in time or
	      directory, or changes to the value of variables referred	to  by
	      the prompt).

	      Otherwise, the prompt is only expanded each time zle starts, and
	      when the display as been interrupted by output from another part
	      of  the shell (such as a job notification) which causes the com‐
	      mand line to be reprinted.

       send-break (^G ESC-^G) (unbound) (unbound)
	      Abort the current editor function,  e.g.	execute-named-command,
	      or  the editor itself, e.g. if you are in vared. Otherwise abort
	      the parsing of the current line.

       run-help (ESC-H ESC-h) (unbound) (unbound)
	      Push the buffer onto the buffer stack, and execute  the  command
	      `run-help	 cmd',	where cmd is the current command.  run-help is
	      normally aliased to man.

       vi-set-buffer (unbound) (") (unbound)
	      Specify a buffer to be used in the following command.  There are
	      35  buffers  that can be specified: the 26 `named' buffers "a to
	      "z and the nine `queued' buffers "1 to "9.   The	named  buffers
	      can also be specified as "A to "Z.

	      When a buffer is specified for a cut command, the text being cut
	      replaces the previous contents of the specified  buffer.	 If  a
	      named buffer is specified using a capital, the newly cut text is
	      appended to the buffer instead of overwriting it.

	      If no buffer is specified for a cut command, "1 is used, and the
	      contents of "1 to "8 are each shifted along one buffer; the con‐
	      tents of "9 is lost.

       vi-set-mark (unbound) (m) (unbound)
	      Set the specified mark at the cursor position.

       set-mark-command (^@) (unbound) (unbound)
	      Set the mark at the cursor position.

       spell-word (ESC-$ ESC-S ESC-s) (unbound) (unbound)
	      Attempt spelling correction on the current word.

       undefined-key
	      This command is executed when a key sequence that is  not	 bound
	      to any command is typed.	By default it beeps.

       undo (^_ ^Xu ^X^U) (unbound) (unbound)
	      Incrementally undo the last text modification.

       redo   Incrementally redo undone text modifications.

       vi-undo-change (unbound) (u) (unbound)
	      Undo  the last text modification.	 If repeated, redo the modifi‐
	      cation.

       what-cursor-position (^X=) (unbound) (unbound)
	      Print the character under the cursor, its code as an octal, dec‐
	      imal  and hexadecimal number, the current cursor position within
	      the buffer and the column of the cursor in the current line.

       where-is
	      Read the name of an editor command and and print the listing  of
	      key sequences that invoke the specified command.

       which-command (ESC-?) (unbound) (unbound)
	      Push  the	 buffer onto the buffer stack, and execute the command
	      `which-command  cmd'.  where  cmd	 is   the   current   command.
	      which-command is normally aliased to whence.

       vi-digit-or-beginning-of-line (unbound) (0) (unbound)
	      If the last command executed was a digit as part of an argument,
	      continue the argument.  Otherwise, execute vi-beginning-of-line.

ZSHCOMPWID(1)							 ZSHCOMPWID(1)

NAME
       zshcompwid - zsh completion widgets

DESCRIPTION
       The shell's programmable completion mechanism can be manipulated in two
       ways;  here the low-level features supporting the newer, function-based
       mechanism are defined.  A complete set  of  shell  functions  based  on
       these  features is described in zshcompsys(1), and users with no inter‐
       est in adding to that system (or, potentially, writing  their  own  ---
       see dictionary entry for `hubris') should skip this section.  The older
       system based on the compctl builtin command  is	described  in  zshcom‐
       pctl(1).

       Completion widgets are defined by the -C option to the zle builtin com‐
       mand provided by the zsh/zle module (see zshzle(1)). For example,

	      zle -C complete expand-or-complete completer

       defines a widget named `complete'.  The second argument is the name  of
       any  of	the  builtin  widgets  that handle completions: complete-word,
       expand-or-complete,	expand-or-complete-prefix,	menu-complete,
       menu-expand-or-complete,	   reverse-menu-complete,   list-choices,   or
       delete-char-or-list.  Note that this will still work even if the widget
       in question has been re-bound.

       When  this  newly  defined  widget  is bound to a key using the bindkey
       builtin command defined in the zsh/zle module (see  zshzle(1)),	typing
       that  key  will	call  the shell function `completer'. This function is
       responsible for generating the  possible	 matches  using	 the  builtins
       described  below.   As  with  other ZLE widgets, the function is called
       with its standard input closed.

       Once the function returns, the completion code takes over control again
       and treats the matches in the same manner as the specified builtin wid‐
       get, in this case expand-or-complete.

SPECIAL PARAMETERS
       Inside completion widgets, and any functions  called  from  them,  some
       parameters  have	 special meaning; outside these functions they are not
       special to the shell in any way.	 These parameters  are	used  to  pass
       information between the completion code and the completion widget. Some
       of the builtin commands and the condition codes use or change the  cur‐
       rent  values  of	 these parameters.  Any existing values will be hidden
       during execution of  completion	widgets;  except  for  compstate,  the
       parameters  are	reset on each function exit (including nested function
       calls from within the completion widget) to the values  they  had  when
       the function was entered.

       CURRENT
	      This is the number of the current word, i.e. the word the cursor
	      is currently on in the words array.  Note	 that  this  value  is
	      only correct if the ksharrays option is not set.

       IPREFIX
	      Initially	 this will be set to the empty string.	This parameter
	      functions like PREFIX; it contains a string which	 precedes  the
	      one in PREFIX and is not considered part of the list of matches.
	      Typically, a string is transferred from the beginning of	PREFIX
	      to the end of IPREFIX, for example:

		     IPREFIX=${PREFIX%%\=*}=
		     PREFIX=${PREFIX#*=}

	      causes  the  part	 of  the  prefix up to and including the first
	      equal sign not to be treated as part of a matched string.	  This
	      can be done automatically by the compset builtin, see below.

       ISUFFIX
	      As  IPREFIX, but for a suffix that should not be considered part
	      of the matches; note that the ISUFFIX string follows the	SUFFIX
	      string.

       PREFIX Initially	 this will be set to the part of the current word from
	      the beginning of the word up to the position of the  cursor;  it
	      may be altered to give a common prefix for all matches.

       QIPREFIX
	      This parameter is read-only and contains the quoted string up to
	      the word being completed.	 E.g.  when  completing	 `"foo',  this
	      parameter contains the double quote. If the -q option of compset
	      is used (see below), and the original string was `"foo bar' with
	      the cursor on the `bar', this parameter contains `"foo '.

       QISUFFIX
	      Like QIPREFIX, but containing the suffix.

       SUFFIX Initially	 this will be set to the part of the current word from
	      the cursor position to the end; it may be altered to give a com‐
	      mon  suffix  for all matches.  It is most useful when the option
	      COMPLETE_IN_WORD is set, as otherwise the whole word on the com‐
	      mand line is treated as a prefix.

       compstate
	      This  is	an associative array with various keys and values that
	      the completion code uses to exchange information with  the  com‐
	      pletion widget.  The keys are:

	      all_quotes
		     The  -q option of the compset builtin command (see below)
		     allows a quoted string to be broken into separate	words;
		     if the cursor is on one of those words, that word will be
		     completed, possibly invoking  `compset  -q'  recursively.
		     With  this key it is possible to test the types of quoted
		     strings which are currently broken	 into  parts  in  this
		     fashion.  Its value contains one character for each quot‐
		     ing level.	 The characters are a single quote or a double
		     quote  for	 strings  quoted  with	these characters and a
		     backslash for strings not starting with a	quote  charac‐
		     ter.  The first character in the value always corresponds
		     to the innermost quoting level.

	      context
		     This will be set by the completion code  to  the  overall
		     context in which completion is attempted. Possible values
		     are:

		     array_value
			    when completing  inside  the  value	 of  an	 array
			    parameter assignment; in this case the words array
			    contains the words inside the parentheses.

		     brace_parameter
			    when completing the	 name  of  a  parameter	 in  a
			    parameter expansion beginning with ${.

		     assign_parameter
			    when  completing  the  name	 of  a	parameter in a
			    parameter assignment.

		     command
			    when completing for a normal  command  (either  in
			    command  position  or  for an argument of the com‐
			    mand).

		     condition
			    when completing  inside  a	`[[...]]'  conditional
			    expression;	 in this case the words array contains
			    only the words inside the conditional expression.

		     math   when completing in a mathematical environment such
			    as a `((...))' construct.

		     parameter
			    when  completing  the  name	 of  a	parameter in a
			    parameter expansion beginning with $ but not ${.

		     redirect
			    when completing after a redirection operator.

		     subscript
			    when completing inside a parameter subscript.

		     value  when completing the value of a  parameter  assign‐
			    ment.

	      exact  Controls  the behaviour when the REC_EXACT option is set.
		     It will be set to accept  if  an  exact  match  would  be
		     accepted, and will be unset otherwise.

		     If it was set when at least one match equal to the string
		     on the line was generated, the match is accepted.

	      exact_string
		     The string of an exact match if one was found,  otherwise
		     unset.

	      ignored
		     The  number  of  words  that  were	 ignored  because they
		     matched one of the patterns given with the -F  option  to
		     the compadd builtin command.

	      insert This  controls  the  manner  in which a match is inserted
		     into the command line.  On entry to the widget  function,
		     if	 it is unset the command line is not to be changed; if
		     set to unambiguous, any prefix common to all  matches  is
		     to	 be inserted; if set to automenu-unambiguous, the com‐
		     mon prefix is to be inserted and the next	invocation  of
		     the completion code may start menu completion (due to the
		     AUTO_MENU option being set); if set to menu  or  automenu
		     menu completion will be started for the matches currently
		     generated (in the latter case this	 will  happen  because
		     the  AUTO_MENU  is	 set).	The value may also contain the
		     string `tab' when the completion code would normally  not
		     really do completion, but only insert the TAB character.

		     On	 exit  it may be set to any of the values above (where
		     setting it to the empty string is the same	 as  unsetting
		     it), or to a number, in which case the match whose number
		     is given will be inserted into the command	 line.	 Nega‐
		     tive  numbers  count  backward  from the last match (with
		     `-1' selecting the last match)  and  out-of-range	values
		     are  wrapped  around, so that a value of zero selects the
		     last match and a value one more than the maximum  selects
		     the  first. Unless the value of this key ends in a space,
		     the match is inserted as in a menu completion, i.e. with‐
		     out automatically appending a space.

		     Both menu and automenu may also specify the the number of
		     the match to insert, given after a colon.	 For  example,
		     `menu:2'  says  to	 start menu completion, beginning with
		     the second match.

		     Note that a value containing the  substring  `tab'	 makes
		     the  matches  generated  be  ignored  and only the TAB be
		     inserted.

		     Finally, it may also be  set  to  all,  which  makes  all
		     matches generated be inserted into the line.

	      insert_positions
		     When  the completion system inserts an unambiguous string
		     into the line, there may be multiple places where charac‐
		     ters  are missing or where the character inserted differs
		     from at least one match.  The value of this key  contains
		     a colon separated list of all these positions, as indexes
		     into the command line.

	      last_prompt
		     If this is set to a  non-empty  string  for  every	 match
		     added,  the  completion code will move the cursor back to
		     the previous prompt after the  list  of  completions  has
		     been displayed.  Initially this is set or unset according
		     to the ALWAYS_LAST_PROMPT option.

	      list   This controls whether or how the list of matches will  be
		     displayed.	  If  it  is unset or empty they will never be
		     listed; if its value begins with list, they  will	always
		     be	 listed; if it begins with autolist or ambiguous, they
		     will be  listed  when  the	 AUTO_LIST  or	LIST_AMBIGUOUS
		     options respectively would normally cause them to be.

		     If	 the  substring force appears in the value, this makes
		     the list be shown even if there is only one  match.  Nor‐
		     mally, the list would be shown only if there are at least
		     two matches.

		     The  value	 contains  the	 substring   packed   if   the
		     LIST_PACKED option is set. If this substring is given for
		     all matches added to a group, this group  will  show  the
		     LIST_PACKED   behavior.   The   same   is	done  for  the
		     LIST_ROWS_FIRST option with the substring rows.

		     Finally, if the value contains the	 string	 explanations,
		     only  the explanation strings, if any, will be listed and
		     if it contains messages, only the	messages  (added  with
		     the -x option of compadd) will be listed.	If it contains
		     both explanations and messages both kinds of  explanation
		     strings  will be listed.  It will be set appropriately on
		     entry to a completion widget and may be changed there.

	      list_lines
		     This gives the number of lines that are needed to display
		     the full list of completions.  Note that to calculate the
		     total number of lines to display you need to add the num‐
		     ber  of  lines needed for the command line to this value,
		     this is available as the value of the BUFFERLINES special
		     parameter.

	      list_max
		     Initially this is set to the value of the LISTMAX parame‐
		     ter.  It may be set to any other value; when  the	widget
		     exits  this  value	 will  be  used in the same way as the
		     value of LISTMAX.

	      nmatches
		     The number of matches generated and accepted by the  com‐
		     pletion code so far.

	      old_insert
		     On	 entry to the widget this will be set to the number of
		     the match of an old list of completions that is currently
		     inserted  into  the  command  line.  If no match has been
		     inserted, this is unset.

		     As with old_list, the value of this key will only be used
		     if	 it is the string keep. If it was set to this value by
		     the widget and there was an old match inserted  into  the
		     command line, this match will be kept and if the value of
		     the insert key specifies that  another  match  should  be
		     inserted, this will be inserted after the old one.

	      old_list
		     This is set to yes if there is still a valid list of com‐
		     pletions from a previous completion at the time the  wid‐
		     get  is  invoked.	 This  will usually be the case if and
		     only if the previous editing operation was	 a  completion
		     widget  or	 one  of the builtin completion functions.  If
		     there is a valid list and it is also currently  shown  on
		     the screen, the value of this key is shown.

		     After the widget has exited the value of this key is only
		     used if it was set to keep.  In this case the  completion
		     code  will	 continue to use this old list.	 If the widget
		     generated new matches, they will not be used.

	      parameter
		     The name of the parameter when completing in a  subscript
		     or in the value of a parameter assignment.

	      pattern_insert
		     Normally  this  is set to menu, which specifies that menu
		     completion will be used whenever a	 set  of  matches  was
		     generated	using  pattern	matching.  If it is set to any
		     other non-empty string by the user and menu completion is
		     not  selected  by	other  option  settings, the code will
		     instead  insert  any  common  prefix  for	the  generated
		     matches as with normal completion.

	      pattern_match
		     Locally controls the behaviour given by the GLOB_COMPLETE
		     option.  Initially it is set to `*' if and	 only  if  the
		     option  is set.  The completion widget may set it to this
		     value, to an empty string (which has the same  effect  as
		     unsetting	it),  or to any other non-empty string.	 If it
		     is non-empty, unquoted metacharacters on the command line
		     will be treated as patterns; if it is `*', then addition‐
		     ally a wildcard `*' is assumed at the cursor position; if
		     it is empty or unset, metacharacters will be treated lit‐
		     erally.

		     Note that the matcher specifications given to the compadd
		     builtin  command  are  not	 used  if  this	 is  set  to a
		     non-empty string.

	      quote  When completing inside quotes, this contains  the	quota‐
		     tion  character  (i.e.  either  a	single quote, a double
		     quote, or a backtick).  Otherwise it is unset.

	      quoting
		     When completing inside single quotes, this is set to  the
		     string  single;  inside double quotes, the string double;
		     inside backticks, the string backtick.  Otherwise	it  is
		     unset.

	      redirect
		     The redirection operator when completing in a redirection
		     position, i.e. one of <, >, etc.

	      restore
		     This is set to auto before a function is  entered,	 which
		     forces  the  special  parameters  mentioned above (words,
		     CURRENT, PREFIX, IPREFIX,	SUFFIX,	 and  ISUFFIX)	to  be
		     restored  to  their  previous  values  when  the function
		     exits.   If a function unsets it or sets it to any	 other
		     string, they will not be restored.

	      to_end Specifies	the  occasions on which the cursor is moved to
		     the end of a string when a match is inserted.   On	 entry
		     to	 a widget function, it may be single if this will hap‐
		     pen when a single unambiguous match was inserted or match
		     if it will happen any time a match is inserted (for exam‐
		     ple, by menu completion; this is likely to be the	effect
		     of the ALWAYS_TO_END option).

		     On	 exit,	it may be set to single as above.  It may also
		     be set to always, or to the empty	string	or  unset;  in
		     those  cases  the	cursor will be moved to the end of the
		     string always or never respectively.  Any other string is
		     treated as match.

	      unambiguous
		     This  key is read-only and will always be set to the com‐
		     mon (unambiguous) prefix the completion code  has	gener‐
		     ated for all matches added so far.

	      unambiguous_cursor
		     This  gives the position the cursor would be placed at if
		     the common prefix in the unambiguous key  were  inserted,
		     relative  to  the	value of that key. The cursor would be
		     placed before the character whose index is given by  this
		     key.

	      unambiguous_positions
		     This contains all positions where characters in the unam‐
		     biguous  string  are  missing  or	where  the   character
		     inserted  differs	from at least one of the matches.  The
		     positions are given as indexes into the string  given  by
		     the value of the unambiguous key.

	      vared  If	 completion  is	 called while editing a line using the
		     vared builtin, the value of this key is set to  the  name
		     of the parameter given as an argument to vared.  This key
		     is only set while a vared command is active.

       words  This array contains the words present on the command  line  cur‐
	      rently being edited.

BUILTIN COMMANDS
       compadd [ -akqQfenUl12C ] [ -F array ]
       [ -P prefix ] [ -S suffix ]
       [ -p hidden-prefix ] [ -s hidden-suffix ]
       [ -i ignored-prefix ] [ -I ignored-suffix ]
       [ -W file-prefix ] [ -d array ]
       [ -J name ] [ -V name ] [ -X explanation ] [ -x message ]
       [ -r remove-chars ] [ -R remove-func ]
       [ -D array ] [ -O array ] [ -A array ]
       [ -E number ]
       [ -M match-spec ] [ -- ] [ words ... ]

	      This  builtin  command  can  be used to add matches directly and
	      control all the information the completion code stores with each
	      possible	match.	The return value is zero if at least one match
	      was added and non-zero if no matches were added.

	      The completion code breaks the string  to	 complete  into	 seven
	      fields in the order:

		     <ipre><apre><hpre><word><hsuf><asuf><isuf>

	      The  first  field	 is  an	 ignored prefix taken from the command
	      line, the contents of the	 IPREFIX  parameter  plus  the	string
	      given  with  the	-i option. With the -U option, only the string
	      from the -i option is used. The field <apre> is an optional pre‐
	      fix  string  given  with	the  -P option.	 The <hpre> field is a
	      string that is considered part of the match but that should  not
	      be shown when listing completions, given with the -p option; for
	      example, functions that do filename generation might  specify  a
	      common  path  prefix  this way.  <word> is the part of the match
	      that should appear in the list of completions, i.e. one  of  the
	      words given at the end of the compadd command line. The suffixes
	      <hsuf>, <asuf> and <isuf> correspond  to	the  prefixes  <hpre>,
	      <apre>  and  <ipre>  and are given by the options -s, -S and -I,
	      respectively.

	      The supported flags are:

	      -P prefix
		     This gives a string  to  be  inserted  before  the	 given
		     words.  The string given is not considered as part of the
		     match and any shell metacharacters	 in  it	 will  not  be
		     quoted when the string is inserted.

	      -S suffix
		     Like  -P,	but  gives  a  string to be inserted after the
		     match.

	      -p hidden-prefix
		     This gives a string that should be inserted into the com‐
		     mand  line before the match but that should not appear in
		     the list of matches. Unless the -U option is given,  this
		     string  must be matched as part of the string on the com‐
		     mand line.

	      -s hidden-suffix
		     Like `-p', but gives a string to insert after the match.

	      -i ignored-prefix
		     This gives a string to insert into the command line  just
		     before  any  string  given with the `-P' option.  Without
		     `-P' the string is inserted before the string given  with
		     `-p' or directly before the match.

	      -I ignored-suffix
		     Like -i, but gives an ignored suffix.

	      -a     With this flag the words are taken as names of arrays and
		     the possible matches are their values.  If only some ele‐
		     ments  of	the arrays are needed, the words may also con‐
		     tain subscripts, as in `foo[2,-1]'.

	      -k     With this flag the words are taken as names  of  associa‐
		     tive  arrays and the possible matches are their keys.  As
		     for -a, the words may  also  contain  subscripts,	as  in
		     `foo[(R)*bar*]'.

	      -d array
		     This  adds	 per-match  display  strings. The array should
		     contain one element per word given. The  completion  code
		     will  then display the first element instead of the first
		     word, and so on. The array may be given as the name of an
		     array  parameter or directly as a space-separated list of
		     words in parentheses.

		     If there are fewer display strings than words, the	 left‐
		     over  words  will be displayed unchanged and if there are
		     more display strings than	words,	the  leftover  display
		     strings will be silently ignored.

	      -l     This  option only has an effect if used together with the
		     -d option. If it is given, the display strings are listed
		     one per line, not arrayed in columns.

	      -J name
		     Gives  the	 name of the group of matches the words should
		     be stored in.

	      -V name
		     Like -J but naming a unsorted group. These are in a  dif‐
		     ferent name space than groups created with the -J flag.

	      -1     If given together with the -V option, makes only consecu‐
		     tive duplicates in the group be removed. If combined with
		     the  -J  option,  this  has  no visible effect. Note that
		     groups with and without this flag are in  different  name
		     spaces.

	      -2     If	 given	together  with	the -J or -V option, makes all
		     duplicates be kept. Again, groups with and	 without  this
		     flag are in different name spaces.

	      -X explanation
		     The  explanation  string will be printed with the list of
		     matches, above the group currently selected.

	      -x message
		     Like -X, but the message will be printed  even  if	 there
		     are no matches in the group.

	      -q     The suffix given with -S will be automatically removed if
		     the next character typed is a blank or  does  not	insert
		     anything, or if the suffix consists of only one character
		     and the next character typed is the same character.

	      -r remove-chars
		     This is a more versatile form of the -q option.  The suf‐
		     fix  given with -S or the slash automatically added after
		     completing directories will be automatically  removed  if
		     the  next	character  typed inserts one of the characters
		     given in the remove-chars.	 This string is	 parsed	 as  a
		     characters	 class and understands the backslash sequences
		     used by the print command.	  For  example,	 `-r  "a-z\t"'
		     removes  the suffix if the next character typed inserts a
		     lowercase character or a TAB, and `-r "^0-9"' removes the
		     suffix if the next character typed inserts anything but a
		     digit. One extra backslash sequence is understood in this
		     string:  `\-' stands for all characters that insert noth‐
		     ing. Thus `-S "=" -q' is  the  same  as  `-S  "="	-r  "=
		     \t\n\-"'.

		     This  option may also be used without the -S option; then
		     any automatically added space will be removed when one of
		     the characters in the list is typed.

	      -R remove-func
		     This  is another form of the -r option. When a suffix has
		     been inserted and the completion accepted,	 the  function
		     remove-func  will	be  called  after  the	next character
		     typed.  It is passed the length of the suffix as an argu‐
		     ment  and	can  use  the  special parameters available in
		     ordinary (non-completion) zle widgets (see zshzle(1))  to
		     analyse and modify the command line.

	      -f     If	 this  flag  is	 given,	 all of the matches built from
		     words are marked as being the names of files.   They  are
		     not required to be actual filenames, but if they are, and
		     the option LIST_TYPES is set, the	characters  describing
		     the  types	 of  the files in the completion lists will be
		     shown. This also forces a slash to be added when the name
		     of a directory is completed.

	      -e     This  flag	 can  be used to tell the completion code that
		     the matches added are parameter  names  for  a  parameter
		     expansion.	  This	will  make  the	 AUTO_PARAM_SLASH  and
		     AUTO_PARAM_KEYS options be used for the matches.

	      -W file-prefix
		     This string is a pathname that will be prepended to  each
		     of	 the  matches  formed by the given words together with
		     any prefix specified by the -p option to form a  complete
		     filename  for  testing.   Hence it is only useful if com‐
		     bined with the -f flag, as the tests will	not  otherwise
		     be performed.

	      -F array
		     Specifies	an  array  containing patterns. Words matching
		     one of these patterns are ignored, i.e. not considered to
		     be possible matches.

		     The array may be the name of an array parameter or a list
		     of literal patterns enclosed in parentheses  and  quoted,
		     as	 in  `-F  "(*?.o  *?.h)"'.  If the name of an array is
		     given, the elements of the array are taken	 as  the  pat‐
		     terns.

	      -Q     This  flag instructs the completion code not to quote any
		     metacharacters in the words when inserting them into  the
		     command line.

	      -M match-spec
		     This  gives local match specifications as described below
		     in the section `Matching Control'.	 This  option  may  be
		     given  more than once. In this case all match-specs given
		     are concatenated with spaces between  them	 to  form  the
		     specification string to use.  Note that they will only be
		     used if the -U option is not given.

	      -n     Specifies that the words added are to be used as possible
		     matches, but are not to appear in the completion listing.

	      -U     If	 this  flag is given, all words given will be accepted
		     and no matching will be done by the completion code. Nor‐
		     mally  this  is  used  in	functions that do the matching
		     themselves.

	      -O array
		     If this option is given, the words are not added  to  the
		     set  of  possible completions.  Instead, matching is done
		     as usual and all of the words  given  as  arguments  that
		     match  the	 string	 on the command line will be stored in
		     the array parameter whose name is given as array.

	      -A array
		     As the -O option, except that instead  of	those  of  the
		     words which match being stored in array, the strings gen‐
		     erated internally by the completion code are stored.  For
		     example,  with a matching specification of `-M "L:|no="',
		     the string `nof' on the command line and the string `foo'
		     as	 one  of  the  words,  this  option  stores the string
		     `nofoo' in the array, whereas the -O  option  stores  the
		     `foo' originally given.

	      -D array
		     As	 with -O, the words are not added to the set of possi‐
		     ble completions.	Instead,  the  completion  code	 tests
		     whether  each  word  in turn matches what is on the line.
		     If the n'th word does not match, the n'th element of  the
		     array  is	removed.  Elements for which the corresponding
		     word is matched are retained.

	      -C     This option adds a special match  which  expands  to  all
		     other  matches  when  inserted  into the line, even those
		     that are added after this option is used.	Together  with
		     the  -d  option  it  is possible to specify a string that
		     should be displayed in the list for this  special	match.
		     If	 no string is given, it will be shown as a string con‐
		     taining the strings that would be inserted for the	 other
		     matches, truncated to the width of the screen.

	      -E     This  option  adds	 number	 empty matches after the words
		     have been added.  An empty match takes up space  in  com‐
		     pletion  listings	but will never be inserted in the line
		     and can't be selected with menu completion or menu selec‐
		     tion.   This  makes  empty	 matches only useful to format
		     completion lists and to make explanatory string be	 shown
		     in	 completion  lists  (since  empty matches can be given
		     display strings with the -d option).  And because all but
		     one  empty string would otherwise be removed, this option
		     implies the -V and -2 options (even  if  an  explicit  -J
		     option is given).

	      -
	      --     This  flag	 ends the list of flags and options. All argu‐
		     ments after it will be taken  as  the  words  to  use  as
		     matches even if they begin with hyphens.

	      Except for the -M flag, if any of these flags is given more than
	      once, the first one (and its argument) will be used.

       compset -p number
       compset -P [ number ] pattern
       compset -s number
       compset -S [ number ] pattern
       compset -n begin [ end ]
       compset -N beg-pat [ end-pat ]
       compset -q
	      This command simplifies modification of the special  parameters,
	      while its return value allows tests on them to be carried out.

	      The options are:

	      -p number
		     If	 the  contents	of the PREFIX parameter is longer than
		     number  characters,  the  first  number  characters   are
		     removed  from  it	and  appended  to  the contents of the
		     IPREFIX parameter.

	      -P [ number ] pattern
		     If the value of the PREFIX parameter begins with anything
		     that  matches the pattern, the matched portion is removed
		     from PREFIX and appended to IPREFIX.

		     Without the optional number, the longest match is	taken,
		     but  if  number  is  given,  anything up to the number'th
		     match is moved.  If the number is negative, the number'th
		     longest  match  is moved. For example, if PREFIX contains
		     the string `a=b=c', then compset -P '*\=' will  move  the
		     string  `a=b=' into the IPREFIX parameter, but compset -P
		     1 '*\=' will move only the string `a='.

	      -s number
		     As -p, but transfer the last number characters  from  the
		     value of SUFFIX to the front of the value of ISUFFIX.

	      -S [ number ] pattern
		     As	 -P, but match the last portion of SUFFIX and transfer
		     the matched portion to the front of the value of ISUFFIX.

	      -n begin [ end ]
		     If the current word position as specified by the  parame‐
		     ter  CURRENT  is greater than or equal to begin, anything
		     up to the begin'th word is removed from the  words	 array
		     and  the value of the parameter CURRENT is decremented by
		     begin.

		     If the optional end is given, the	modification  is  done
		     only  if  the  current word position is also less than or
		     equal to end. In this case, the words from	 position  end
		     onwards are also removed from the words array.

		     Both  begin  and  end  may be negative to count backwards
		     from the last element of the words array.

	      -N beg-pat [ end-pat ]
		     If one of the elements of the words array before the  one
		     at	 the index given by the value of the parameter CURRENT
		     matches the pattern  beg-pat,  all	 elements  up  to  and
		     including	the  matching  one  are removed from the words
		     array and the value of CURRENT is changed to point to the
		     same word in the changed array.

		     If	 the optional pattern end-pat is also given, and there
		     is an element in the words array matching	this  pattern,
		     the  parameters  are  modified  only if the index of this
		     word is higher than the one given by the CURRENT  parame‐
		     ter  (so  that the matching word has to be after the cur‐
		     sor). In this case,  the  words  starting	with  the  one
		     matching  end-pat	are also removed from the words array.
		     If words contains no word matching end-pat,  the  testing
		     and modification is performed as if it were not given.

	      -q     The  word	currently  being  completed is split on spaces
		     into separate words, respecting the usual	shell  quoting
		     conventions.  The resulting words are stored in the words
		     array, and CURRENT, PREFIX, SUFFIX, QIPREFIX, and	QISUF‐
		     FIX  are  modified	 to reflect the word part that is com‐
		     pleted.

	      In all the above cases the return value is zero if the test suc‐
	      ceeded  and the parameters were modified and non-zero otherwise.
	      This allows one to use this builtin in tests such as:

		     if compset -P '*\='; then ...

	      This forces anything up to and including the last equal sign  to
	      be ignored by the completion code.

       compcall [ -TD ]
	      This  allows  the	 use  of  completions defined with the compctl
	      builtin from within completion widgets.	The  list  of  matches
	      will  be	generated as if one of the non-widget completion func‐
	      tion (complete-word, etc.)  had been called,  except  that  only
	      compctls given for specific commands are used. To force the code
	      to try completions defined with the -T option of compctl	and/or
	      the  default  completion	(whether  defined by compctl -D or the
	      builtin default) in the appropriate places,  the	-T  and/or  -D
	      flags can be passed to compcall.

	      The return value can be used to test if a matching compctl defi‐
	      nition was found. It is non-zero if a compctl was found and zero
	      otherwise.

	      Note that this builtin is defined by the zsh/compctl module.

CONDITION CODES
       The  following  additional condition codes for use within the [[ ... ]]
       construct are available in completion widgets.  These work on the  spe‐
       cial  parameters.   All	of  these  tests  can also be performed by the
       compset builtin, but in the case of the condition codes the contents of
       the special parameters are not modified.

       -prefix [ number ] pattern
	      true if the test for the -P option of compset would succeed.

       -suffix [ number ] pattern
	      true if the test for the -S option of compset would succeed.

       -after beg-pat
	      true  if	the  test of the -N option with only the beg-pat given
	      would succeed.

       -between beg-pat end-pat
	      true if the test for the -N option with both patterns would suc‐
	      ceed.

MATCHING CONTROL
       It  is  possible by use of the -M option of the compadd builtin command
       to specify how the characters in the string to be  completed  (referred
       to  here	 as  the  command line) map onto the characters in the list of
       matches produced by the completion code (referred to here as the	 trial
       completions). Note that this is not used if the command line contains a
       glob pattern and the GLOB_COMPLETE option is set or  the	 pattern_match
       of the compstate special association is set to a non-empty string.

       The  match-spec	given  as  the argument to the -M option (see `Builtin
       Commands' above) consists of one or more	 matching  descriptions	 sepa‐
       rated by whitespace.  Each description consists of a letter followed by
       a colon and then the patterns describing which character	 sequences  on
       the  line match which character sequences in the trial completion.  Any
       sequence of characters not handled in this fashion must match  exactly,
       as usual.

       The  forms  of  match-spec understood are as follows. In each case, the
       form with an uppercase initial character	 retains  the  string  already
       typed on the command line as the final result of completion, while with
       a lowercase initial character the string on the command line is changed
       into the corresponding part of the trial completion.

       m:lpat=tpat
       M:lpat=tpat
	      Here, lpat is a pattern that matches on the command line, corre‐
	      sponding to tpat which matches in the trial completion.

       l:lanchor|lpat=tpat
       L:lanchor|lpat=tpat
       l:lanchor||ranchor=tpat
       L:lanchor||ranchor=tpat
       b:lpat=tpat
       B:lpat=tpat
	      These letters are for patterns that are anchored by another pat‐
	      tern  on	the  left side. Matching for lpat and tpat is as for m
	      and M, but the pattern lpat matched on the command line must  be
	      preceded	by  the	 pattern lanchor.  The lanchor can be blank to
	      anchor the match to the start of the command line string; other‐
	      wise  the	 anchor can occur anywhere, but must match in both the
	      command line and trial completion strings.

	      If no lpat is given but a	 ranchor  is,  this  matches  the  gap
	      between  substrings  matched by lanchor and ranchor. Unlike lan‐
	      chor, the ranchor only  needs  to	 match	the  trial  completion
	      string.

	      The  b  and B forms are similar to l and L with an empty anchor,
	      but need to match only the beginning of the trial completion  or
	      the word on the command line, respectively.

       r:lpat|ranchor=tpat
       R:lpat|ranchor=tpat
       r:lanchor||ranchor=tpat
       R:lanchor||ranchor=tpat
       e:lpat=tpat
       E:lpat=tpat
	      As  l, L, b and B, with the difference that the command line and
	      trial completion patterns are anchored on the right side.	  Here
	      an  empty	 ranchor  and the e and E forms force the match to the
	      end of the trial completion or command line string.

       Each lpat, tpat or anchor is either an empty string or  consists	 of  a
       sequence	 of literal characters (which may be quoted with a backslash),
       question marks, character classes, and correspondence classes; ordinary
       shell patterns are not used.  Literal characters match only themselves,
       question marks match any character, and character classes are formed as
       for globbing and match any character in the given set.

       Correspondence classes are defined like character classes, but with two
       differences: they are delimited	by  a  pair  of	 braces,  and  negated
       classes	are  not  allowed,  so	the characters ! and ^ have no special
       meaning directly after the opening brace.  They indicate that  a	 range
       of characters on the line match a range of characters in the trial com‐
       pletion, but (unlike ordinary character classes)	 paired	 according  to
       the  corresponding  position  in the sequence. For example, to make any
       lowercase letter on the line match the corresponding  uppercase	letter
       in  the	trial  completion, you can use `m:{a-z}={A-Z}'.	 More than one
       pair of classes can occur, in which case the first class before	the  =
       corresponds  to	the  first  after it, and so on.  If one side has more
       such classes than the other side, the superfluous classes  behave  like
       normal  character  classes.   In anchor patterns correspondence classes
       also behave like normal character classes.

       The pattern tpat may also be one or two stars, `*' or `**'. This	 means
       that the pattern on the command line can match any number of characters
       in the trial completion. In this case the pattern must be anchored  (on
       either  side); in the case of a single star, the anchor then determines
       how much of the trial completion is to be included --- only the charac‐
       ters  up to the next appearance of the anchor will be matched. With two
       stars, substrings matched by the anchor can be matched, too.

       Examples:

       The keys of the options association defined by the parameter module are
       the  option names in all-lowercase form, without underscores, and with‐
       out the optional no at the beginning even though	 the  builtins	setopt
       and  unsetopt  understand  option  names with uppercase letters, under‐
       scores, and the optional no.  The following alters the  matching	 rules
       so  that	 the  prefix  no and any underscore are ignored when trying to
       match the trial completions generated and uppercase letters on the line
       match the corresponding lowercase letters in the words:

	      compadd -M 'L:|[nN][oO]= M:_= M:{A-Z}={a-z}' - \
		${(k)options}

       The  first  part says that the pattern `[nN][oO]' at the beginning (the
       empty anchor before the pipe symbol) of the string on the line  matches
       the  empty  string  in the list of words generated by completion, so it
       will be ignored if present. The second part does the same for an under‐
       score anywhere in the command line string, and the third part uses cor‐
       respondence classes so that any uppercase letter on  the	 line  matches
       the  corresponding  lowercase letter in the word. The use of the upper‐
       case forms of the specification characters (L and  M)  guarantees  that
       what has already been typed on the command line (in particular the pre‐
       fix no) will not be deleted.

       Note that the use of L in the first part means  that  it	 matches  only
       when  at	 the  beginning	 of both the command line string and the trial
       completion.  I.e.,  the	string	`_NO_f'	 would	not  be	 completed  to
       `_NO_foo', nor would `NONO_f' be completed to `NONO_foo' because of the
       leading underscore or the second `NO' on the line which makes the  pat‐
       tern  fail  even	 though	 they  are otherwise ignored. To fix this, one
       would use `B:[nN][oO]=' instead of the first part. As described	above,
       this  matches  at the beginning of the trial completion, independent of
       other characters or substrings at the beginning	of  the	 command  line
       word which are ignored by the same or other match-specs.

       The second example makes completion case insensitive.  This is just the
       same as in the option example, except here we wish to retain the	 char‐
       acters in the list of completions:

	      compadd -M 'm:{a-z}={A-Z}' ...

       This  makes  lowercase  letters match their uppercase counterparts.  To
       make uppercase letters match the lowercase forms as well:

	      compadd -M 'm:{a-zA-Z}={A-Za-z}' ...

       A nice example for the use of * patterns is  partial  word  completion.
       Sometimes  you  would  like  to	make  strings like `c.s.u' complete to
       strings like `comp.source.unix', i.e. the word on the command line con‐
       sists of multiple parts, separated by a dot in this example, where each
       part should be completed separately --- note, however,  that  the  case
       where  each  part of the word, i.e. `comp', `source' and `unix' in this
       example, is to be completed from separate sets of matches is a  differ‐
       ent  problem  to be solved by the implementation of the completion wid‐
       get.  The example can be handled by:

	      compadd -M 'r:|.=* r:|=*' \
		- comp.sources.unix comp.sources.misc ...

       The first specification says that  lpat	is  the	 empty	string,	 while
       anchor  is  a dot; tpat is *, so this can match anything except for the
       `.' from the anchor in the trial completion word.  So in	 `c.s.u',  the
       matcher	sees `c', followed by the empty string, followed by the anchor
       `.', and likewise for the second dot, and replaces  the	empty  strings
       before  the  anchors,  giving `c[omp].s[ources].u[nix]', where the last
       part of the completion is just as normal.

       With the pattern shown above, the string `c.u' could not	 be  completed
       to  `comp.sources.unix'	because	 the  single  star  means  that no dot
       (matched by the anchor) can be  skipped.	 By  using  two	 stars	as  in
       `r:|.=**',  however,  `c.u'  could be completed to `comp.sources.unix'.
       This also shows that in some cases, especially if the anchor is a  real
       pattern,	 like a character class, the form with two stars may result in
       more matches than one would like.

       The second specification is needed to make this work when the cursor is
       in  the	middle	of  the string on the command line and the option COM‐
       PLETE_IN_WORD is set. In this case the completion code  would  normally
       try  to	match  trial  completions that end with the string as typed so
       far, i.e. it will only insert new characters  at	 the  cursor  position
       rather  then at the end.	 However in our example we would like the code
       to recognise matches which contain extra characters after the string on
       the  line  (the	`nix'  in  the	example).  Hence we say that the empty
       string at the end of the string on the line matches any	characters  at
       the end of the trial completion.

       More generally, the specification

	      compadd -M 'r:|[.,_-]=* r:|=*' ...

       allows one to complete words with abbreviations before any of the char‐
       acters in the square brackets.  For example, to complete	 veryverylong‐
       file.c  rather  than veryverylongheader.h with the above in effect, you
       can just type very.c before attempting completion.

       The specifications with both a left and a right anchor  are  useful  to
       complete	 partial  words	 whose parts are not separated by some special
       character. For example, in some places strings  have  to	 be  completed
       that are formed `LikeThis' (i.e. the separate parts are determined by a
       leading uppercase letter) or maybe one has  to  complete	 strings  with
       trailing	 numbers.  Here	 one  could  use the simple form with only one
       anchor as in:

	      compadd -M 'r:|[A-Z0-9]=* r:|=*' LikeTHIS FooHoo 5foo123 5bar234

       But with this, the string `H' would neither complete to `FooHoo' nor to
       `LikeTHIS' because in each case there is an uppercase letter before the
       `H' and that is matched by the anchor. Likewise, a  `2'	would  not  be
       completed.   In	 both	cases	this   could   be   changed  by	 using
       `r:|[A-Z0-9]=**',  but  then  `H'  completes  to	 both  `LikeTHIS'  and
       `FooHoo'	 and a `2' matches the other strings because characters can be
       inserted before every uppercase letter and digit.  To  avoid  this  one
       would use:

	      compadd -M 'r:[^A-Z0-9]||[A-Z0-9]=** r:|=*' \
		  LikeTHIS FooHoo foo123 bar234

       By  using these two anchors, a `H' matches only uppercase `H's that are
       immediately preceded by something matching the left anchor `[^A-Z0-9]'.
       The  effect is, of course, that `H' matches only the string `FooHoo', a
       `2' matches only `bar234' and so on.

       When using the completion system (see zshcompsys(1)), users can	define
       match specifications that are to be used for specific contexts by using
       the matcher and matcher-list styles. The values for the latter will  be
       used everywhere.

COMPLETION WIDGET EXAMPLE
       The first step is to define the widget:

	      zle -C complete complete-word complete-files

       Then  the  widget  can be bound to a key using the bindkey builtin com‐
       mand:

	      bindkey '^X\t' complete

       After that the shell function complete-files will be invoked after typ‐
       ing  control-X  and TAB. The function should then generate the matches,
       e.g.:

	      complete-files () { compadd - * }

       This function will complete files in the current directory matching the
       current word.

ZSHCOMPSYS(1)							 ZSHCOMPSYS(1)

NAME
       zshcompsys - zsh completion system

DESCRIPTION
       This  describes	the shell code for the new completion system.  It con‐
       sists of various shell functions; those	beginning  `comp'  are	to  be
       called directly, while those beginning `_' are called by the completion
       code.  The shell functions of the second set, which  implement  comple‐
       tion behaviour and may be bound to keystrokes, are referred to as `wid‐
       gets'.

INITIALIZATION
       If the system was installed completely, it should be enough to call the
       shell  function	compinit  from	your initialization file; see the next
       section.	 However, the function compinstall can be run  by  a  user  to
       configure various aspects of the completion system.

       Usually,	 compinstall will insert code into .zshrc, although if that is
       not writable it will save it in another file and tell you  that	file's
       location.   Note that it is up to you to make sure that the lines added
       to .zshrc are actually run; you may, for example, need to move them  to
       an  earlier place in the file if .zshrc usually returns early.  So long
       as you keep them all together (including the comment lines at the start
       and finish), you can rerun compinstall and it will correctly locate and
       modify these lines.  Note, however, that any code you add to this  sec‐
       tion  by	 hand  is likely to be lost if you rerun compinstall, although
       lines using the command `zstyle' should be gracefully handled.

       The new code will take effect next time you start  the  shell,  or  run
       .zshrc  by hand; there is also an option to make them take effect imme‐
       diately.	 However, if compinstall has  removed  definitions,  you  will
       need to restart the shell to see the changes.

       To run compinstall you will need to make sure it is in a directory men‐
       tioned in your fpath parameter, which should already be the case if zsh
       was properly configured as long as your startup files do not remove the
       appropriate  directories	 from  fpath.	Then  it  must	be  autoloaded
       (`autoload  -U compinstall' is recommended).  You can abort the instal‐
       lation any time you are being prompted for information, and your .zshrc
       will  not  be altered at all; changes only take place right at the end,
       where you are specifically asked for confirmation.

   Use of compinit
       This section describes the use of compinit to initialize completion for
       the  current  session when called directly; if you have run compinstall
       it will be called automatically from your .zshrc.

       To initialize the system, the function compinit should be in  a	direc‐
       tory  mentioned	in  the	 fpath	parameter,  and	 should	 be autoloaded
       (`autoload -U  compinit'	 is  recommended),  and	 then  run  simply  as
       `compinit'.   This will define a few utility functions, arrange for all
       the necessary shell functions to be autoloaded, and will then re-define
       all  widgets  that do completion to use the new system.	If you use the
       menu-select widget, which is  part  of  the  zsh/complist  module,  you
       should make sure that that module is loaded before the call to compinit
       so that that widget is also  re-defined.	  If  completion  styles  (see
       below)  are  set	 up  to	 perform  expansion  as	 well as completion by
       default, and the TAB key is bound to expand-or-complete, compinit  will
       rebind  it  to complete-word; this is necessary to use the correct form
       of expansion.

       Should you need to use the original completion commands, you can	 still
       bind  keys  to  the old widgets by putting a `.' in front of the widget
       name, e.g. `.expand-or-complete'.

       To speed up the running of compinit, it can be made to produce a dumped
       configuration  that  will be read in on future invocations; this is the
       default, but can be turned off by calling compinit with the option  -D.
       The  dumped  file  is  .zcompdump  in the same directory as the startup
       files (i.e. $ZDOTDIR or $HOME); alternatively, an  explicit  file  name
       can  be	given  by  `compinit  -d  dumpfile'.   The  next invocation of
       compinit will read the dumped file instead of performing	 a  full  ini‐
       tialization.

       If the number of completion files changes, compinit will recognise this
       and produce a new dump file.  However, if the name of a function or the
       arguments in the first line of a #compdef function (as described below)
       change, it is easiest to delete the dump file by hand so that  compinit
       will  re-create it the next time it is run.  The check performed to see
       if there are new functions can be omitted by giving the option -C.   In
       this  case  the	dump  file  will  only	be  created if there isn't one
       already.

       The dumping is actually done by another	function,  compdump,  but  you
       will  only  need	 to  run this yourself if you change the configuration
       (e.g. using compdef) and then want to dump the new one.	 The  name  of
       the old dumped file will be remembered for this purpose.

       If the parameter _compdir is set, compinit uses it as a directory where
       completion functions can be found; this is only necessary if  they  are
       not already in the function search path.

       For  security  reasons  compinit	 also  checks if the completion system
       would use files not owned by root or by the current user, or  files  in
       directories  that are world- or group-writable or that are not owned by
       root or by the current user.  If such files or directories  are	found,
       compinit	 will  ask if the completion system should really be used.  To
       avoid these tests and make all files found be used without asking,  use
       the  option -u, and to make compinit silently ignore all insecure files
       and directories use the option -i.   This  security  check  is  skipped
       entirely when the -C option is given.

       The  security  check can be retried at any time by running the function
       compaudit.  This is the same check used by compinit,  but  when	it  is
       executed	 directly  any changes to fpath are made local to the function
       so they do not persist.	The directories to be checked may be passed as
       arguments; if none are given, compaudit uses fpath and _compdir to find
       completion system directories, adding missing ones to fpath  as	neces‐
       sary.   To  force a check of exactly the directories currently named in
       fpath, set _compdir to an empty	string	before	calling	 compaudit  or
       compinit.

   Autoloaded files
       The convention for autoloaded functions used in completion is that they
       start with an underscore; as already mentioned, the fpath/FPATH parame‐
       ter  must  contain  the directory in which they are stored.  If zsh was
       properly installed on your system, then fpath/FPATH automatically  con‐
       tains the required directories for the standard functions.

       For  incomplete	installations,	if compinit does not find enough files
       beginning with an underscore (fewer than twenty) in the search path, it
       will  try  to  find more by adding the directory _compdir to the search
       path.  If that directory has a subdirectory named Base, all subdirecto‐
       ries  will be added to the path.	 Furthermore, if the subdirectory Base
       has a subdirectory named Core, compinit will add all subdirectories  of
       the  subdirectories  is to the path: this allows the functions to be in
       the same format as in the zsh source distribution.

       When compinit is	 run,  it  searches  all  such	files  accessible  via
       fpath/FPATH and reads the first line of each of them.  This line should
       contain one of the tags described below.	 Files whose first  line  does
       not  start  with one of these tags are not considered to be part of the
       completion system and will not be treated specially.

       The tags are:

       #compdef names... [ -[pP] patterns... [ -N names... ] ]
	      The file will be made autoloadable and the function  defined  in
	      it will be called when completing names, each of which is either
	      the name of a command whose arguments are to be completed or one
	      of  a number of special contexts in the form -context- described
	      below.

	      Each name may also be of the form `cmd=service'.	When  complet‐
	      ing  the	command	 cmd, the function typically behaves as if the
	      command  (or  special  context)  service	was  being   completed
	      instead.	This provides a way of altering the behaviour of func‐
	      tions that can perform many different completions.  It is imple‐
	      mented  by setting the parameter $service when calling the func‐
	      tion; the function may choose to interpret this how  it  wishes,
	      and simpler functions will probably ignore it.

	      If  the  #compdef line contains one of the options -p or -P, the
	      words following are taken to be patterns.	 The function will  be
	      called  when  completion	is  attempted for a command or context
	      that matches one of the patterns.	 The options  -p  and  -P  are
	      used  to specify patterns to be tried before or after other com‐
	      pletions respectively.  Hence -P may be used to specify  default
	      actions.

	      The option -N is used after a list following -p or -P; it speci‐
	      fies that remaining words no longer define patterns.  It is pos‐
	      sible  to toggle between the three options as many times as nec‐
	      essary.

       #compdef -k style key-sequences...
	      This option creates a widget behaving like  the  builtin	widget
	      style  and  binds	 it  to	 the given key-sequences, if any.  The
	      style must be one of the builtin widgets	that  perform  comple‐
	      tion,  namely complete-word, delete-char-or-list, expand-or-com‐
	      plete, expand-or-complete-prefix,	 list-choices,	menu-complete,
	      menu-expand-or-complete,	 or   reverse-menu-complete.   If  the
	      zsh/complist module is loaded  (see  zshmodules(1))  the	widget
	      menu-select is also available.

	      When one of the key-sequences is typed, the function in the file
	      will be invoked to generate the matches.	Note that a  key  will
	      not  be  re-bound	 if  if	 it already was (that is, was bound to
	      something other than undefined-key).  The widget created has the
	      same  name  as the file and can be bound to any other keys using
	      bindkey as usual.

       #compdef -K widget-name style key-sequences ...
	      This is similar to -k except that only one  key-sequences	 argu‐
	      ment may be given for each widget-name style pair.  However, the
	      entire set of three arguments may be repeated with  a  different
	      set  of arguments.  Note in particular that the widget-name must
	      be distinct in each set.	If it does not	begin  with  `_'  this
	      will  be	added.	The widget-name should not clash with the name
	      of any existing widget: names based on the name of the  function
	      are most useful.	For example,

		     #compdef -K _foo_complete complete-word "^X^C" \
		       _foo_list list-choices "^X^D"

	      (all on one line) defines a widget _foo_complete for completion,
	      bound to `^X^C', and a widget _foo_list for  listing,  bound  to
	      `^X^D'.

       #autoload [ options ]
	      Functions	 with the #autoload tag are marked for autoloading but
	      are not otherwise treated specially.  Typically they are	to  be
	      called from within one of the completion functions.  Any options
	      supplied will be passed to the autoload builtin; a  typical  use
	      is +X to force the function to be loaded immediately.  Note that
	      the -U and -z flags are always added implicitly.

       The # is part of the tag name and no white space is allowed  after  it.
       The  #compdef  tags  use the compdef function described below; the main
       difference is that the name of the function is supplied implicitly.

       The special contexts for which completion functions can be defined are:

       -array-value-
	      The right hand side of an array-assignment (`foo=(...)')

       -brace-parameter-
	      The name of a parameter expansion within braces (`${...}')

       -assign-parameter-
	      The name of a parameter in an assignment, i.e. on the left  hand
	      side of an `='

       -command-
	      A word in command position

       -condition-
	      A word inside a condition (`[[...]]')

       -default-
	      Any word for which no other completion is defined

       -equal-
	      A word beginning with an equals sign

       -first-
	      This  is	tried before any other completion function.  The func‐
	      tion called may set the _compskip parameter to  one  of  various
	      values:  all:  no further completion is attempted; a string con‐
	      taining the substring patterns: no pattern completion  functions
	      will  be	called;	 a string containing default: the function for
	      the `-default-'  context	will  not  be  called,	but  functions
	      defined for commands will

       -math- Inside mathematical contexts, such as `((...))'

       -parameter-
	      The name of a parameter expansion (`$...')

       -redirect-
	      The word after a redirection operator.

       -subscript-
	      The contents of a parameter subscript.

       -tilde-
	      After  an initial tilde (`~'), but before the first slash in the
	      word.

       -value-
	      On the right hand side of an assignment.

       Default implementations are supplied for each of	 these	contexts.   In
       most  cases  the	 context  -context-  is implemented by a corresponding
       function _context, for example the context `-tilde-' and	 the  function
       `_tilde').

       The contexts -redirect- and -value- allow extra context-specific infor‐
       mation.	(Internally, this is handled by the functions for each context
       calling	the function _dispatch.)  The extra information is added sepa‐
       rated by commas.

       For the -redirect- context, the extra information is in the form	 `-re‐
       direct-,op,command',  where  op is the redirection operator and command
       is the name of the command on the line.	If there is no command on  the
       line yet, the command field will be empty.

       For the -value- context, the form is `-value-,name,command', where name
       is the name of the parameter.  In the case of elements of  an  associa‐
       tive  array,  for  example  `assoc=(key	<TAB>',	 name  is  expanded to
       `name-key'.  In certain special	contexts,  such	 as  completing	 after
       `make  CFLAGS=',	 the  command part gives the name of the command, here
       make; otherwise it is empty.

       It is not necessary to define fully specific completions as  the	 func‐
       tions  provided	will  try  to  generate	 completions  by progressively
       replacing the elements with `-default-'.	 For example, when  completing
       after  `foo=<TAB>',  _value will try the names `-value-,foo,' (note the
       empty	      command	       part),	       `-value-,foo,-default-'
       and`-value-,-default-,-default-', in that order, until it finds a func‐
       tion to handle the context.

       As an example:

	      compdef '_files -g "*.log"' '-redirect-,2>,-default-'

       completes files matching `*.log' after `2> <TAB>' for any command  with
       no more specific handler defined.

       Also:

	      compdef _foo -value-,-default-,-default-

       specifies  that	_foo provides completions for the values of parameters
       for which no special function has been defined.	This is	 usually  han‐
       dled by the function _value itself.

       The  same  lookup  rules	 are used when looking up styles (as described
       below); for example

	      zstyle ':completion:*:*:-redirect-,2>,*:*' file-patterns '*.log'

       is another way to make  completion  after  `2>  <TAB>'  complete	 files
       matching `*.log'.

   Functions
       The  following  function	 is  defined  by  compinit  and	 may be called
       directly.

       compdef [ -an ] function names... [ -[pP] patterns... [ -N names... ] ]
       compdef -d names...
       compdef -k [ -an ] function style key-sequences...
       compdef -K [ -an ] function name style key-sequences ...
	      The first form defines the function to call  for	completion  in
	      the given contexts as described for the #compdef tag above.

	      Alternatively,  all  the	arguments  may have the form `cmd=ser‐
	      vice'.   Here  service  should  already  have  been  defined  by
	      `cmd1=service' lines in #compdef files, as described above.  The
	      argument for cmd will be completed in the same way as service.

	      The function argument may alternatively be a  string  containing
	      any  shell  code.	  The  string  will be executed using the eval
	      builtin command to generate completions.	This provides a way of
	      avoiding	having to define a new completion function.  For exam‐
	      ple, to complete files ending in `.h' as arguments to  the  com‐
	      mand foo:

		     compdef '_files -g "*.h"' foo

	      The  option  -n prevents any completions already defined for the
	      command or context from being overwritten.

	      The option -d deletes any completion defined for the command  or
	      contexts listed.

	      The  names  may  also contain -p, -P and -N options as described
	      for the #compdef tag.  The effect on the argument list is	 iden‐
	      tical,  switching	 between  definitions  of  patterns tried ini‐
	      tially, patterns tried finally, and  normal  commands  and  con‐
	      texts.

	      The  parameter $_compskip may be set by any function defined for
	      a pattern context.  If it is set to a value containing the  sub‐
	      string  `patterns' none of the pattern-functions will be called;
	      if it is set to a value containing the substring `all', no other
	      function will be called.

	      The  form	 with  -k  defines  a widget with the same name as the
	      function that will be called for each of the key-sequences; this
	      is  like	the #compdef -k tag.  The function should generate the
	      completions needed and will otherwise behave  like  the  builtin
	      widget  whose  name is given as the style argument.  The widgets
	      usable  for  this	  are:	 complete-word,	  delete-char-or-list,
	      expand-or-complete,   expand-or-complete-prefix,	 list-choices,
	      menu-complete,  menu-expand-or-complete,	and  reverse-menu-com‐
	      plete,  as  well	as  menu-select	 if the zsh/complist module is
	      loaded.  The option -n prevents the key being  bound  if	it  is
	      already to bound to something other than undefined-key.

	      The  form	 with -K is similar and defines multiple widgets based
	      on the same function, each of which requires the	set  of	 three
	      arguments	 name,	style  and key-sequences, where the latter two
	      are as for -k and the first must be a unique widget name	begin‐
	      ning with an underscore.

	      Wherever	applicable, the -a option makes the function autoload‐
	      able, equivalent to autoload -U function.

       The function compdef can be used to associate existing completion func‐
       tions with new commands.	 For example,

	      compdef _pids foo

       uses the function _pids to complete process IDs for the command foo.

       Note  also the _gnu_generic function described below, which can be used
       to complete options for commands that understand the `--help' option.

COMPLETION SYSTEM CONFIGURATION
       This section gives a short overview of how the completion system works,
       and  then  more	detail on how users can configure how and when matches
       are generated.

   Overview
       When completion is attempted somewhere on the command line the  comple‐
       tion  system first works out the context.  This takes account of a num‐
       ber of things including the command word (such as `grep' or `zsh')  and
       options	to which the current word may be an argument (such as the `-o'
       option to zsh which takes a shell option as an argument).

       This context information is condensed into a string consisting of  mul‐
       tiple  fields  separated by colons, referred to simply as `the context'
       in the remainder of the documentation.  This is used to look up styles,
       context-sensitive  options that can be used to configure the completion
       system.	The context used for lookup may vary during the same  call  to
       the completion system.

       The  context  string always consists of the following fields, separated
       by colons and with a leading colon before the first:

       ·      The literal string completion, saying that this style is used by
	      the  completion  system.	 This  distinguishes  the context from
	      those used by, for example, zle widgets and ZFTP functions.

       ·      The function, if completion is called from a named widget rather
	      than  through  the  normal completion system.  Typically this is
	      blank, but it is set by special widgets such as  predict-on  and
	      the  various  functions in the Widget directory of the distribu‐
	      tion to the name of that function, often in an abbreviated form.

       ·      The completer currently active, the name of the function without
	      the  leading underscore.	A `completer' is in overall control of
	      how completion is to be performed; `complete' is	the  simplest,
	      but other completers exist to perform related tasks such as cor‐
	      rection, or to modify the behaviour of a later  completer.   See
	      the section `Control Functions' below for more information.

       ·      The command or a special -context-, just at it appears following
	      the #compdef tag or the compdef function.	 Completion  functions
	      for commands that have sub-commands usually modify this field to
	      contain the name of the command followed by a minus sign and the
	      sub-command.   For  example, the completion function for the cvs
	      command sets this field to cvs-add when completing arguments  to
	      the add subcommand.

       ·      The  argument; this indicates which command line or option argu‐
	      ment we are completing.  For command  arguments  this  generally
	      takes  the  form	argument-n, where n is the number of the argu‐
	      ment, and for arguments to options the form option-opt-n where n
	      is  the  number of the argument to option opt.  However, this is
	      only the case if	the  command  line  is	parsed	with  standard
	      UNIX-style options and arguments, so many completions do not set
	      this.

       ·      The tag.	Tags are used to discriminate  between	the  types  of
	      matches  a completion function can generate in a certain context
	      and are described further below.

       As an example, the context name

	      :completion::complete:dvips:option-o-1:files

       says that normal completion was attempted as the first argument to  the
       option -o of the command dvips:

	      dvips -o ...

       and the completion function will generate filenames.

       Each  type  of  completion the system can perform in a given context is
       described by a `tag', a short descriptive string such as files  in  the
       example	above.	Any completion function may use any tag name it likes,
       but a list of the more common ones is given below.

       Usually completion will be tried by all possible tags in an order given
       by  the completion function.  However, this can be altered by using the
       tag-order style.	 Completion is then restricted to the  list  of	 given
       tags in the given order.

       The  _complete_help  bindable  command  shows all the contexts and tags
       available for completion at a particular point.	This provides an  easy
       way  of	finding	 information  for  tag-order  and other styles.	 It is
       described in the section `Bindable Commands' below.

       Styles determine such things as how the matches	are  generated,	 simi‐
       larly  to  shell options but with much more control.  They can have any
       number of strings as their value.  They are  defined  with  the	zstyle
       builtin command (see zshmodules(1)).

       When  looking  up styles the completion system uses full context names,
       including the tag.  Looking up the value of a style therefore  consists
       of two things:  the context, which may be matched as a pattern, and the
       name of the style itself, which must be given exactly.

       For example, many completion functions can generate matches in a simple
       and  a  verbose	form  and  use	the verbose style to decide which form
       should be used.	To make all such functions use the verbose form, put

	      zstyle ':completion:*' verbose yes

       in a startup file (probably .zshrc).  This gives the verbose style  the
       value  yes  in  every context inside the completion system, unless that
       context has a more specific definition.	It is best to avoid giving the
       context	as  `*' in case the style has some meaning outside the comple‐
       tion system.

       Many such general purpose styles can be configured simply by using  the
       compinstall function.

       A  more specific example of the use of the verbose style is by the com‐
       pletion for the kill builtin.  If the style is set, the	builtin	 lists
       full  job  texts and process command lines; otherwise it shows the bare
       job numbers and PIDs.  To turn the style off for this use only:

	      zstyle ':completion:*:*:kill:*' verbose no

       For even more control, the style can use one  of	 the  tags  `jobs'  or
       `processes'.  To turn off verbose display only for jobs:

	      zstyle ':completion:*:*:kill:*:jobs' verbose no

       The  -e option to zstyle even allows completion function code to appear
       as the argument to a style; this requires  some	understanding  of  the
       internals  of completion functions (see see zshcompwid(1))).  For exam‐
       ple:

	      zstyle -e ':completion:*' completer '
		  if [[ $words[1] = cvs ]]; then
		    reply=(_complete)
		  else
		    reply=(_complete _approximate)
		  fi'

       uses the value `_complete' for the completer style  in  most  contexts,
       but  the value `_complete _approximate' when the first word on the com‐
       mand line is `cvs'.  This is probably more conveniently done by	speci‐
       fying  the style for two different contexts.  This form can be slow and
       should be avoided  for  commonly	 examined  styles  such	 as  menu  and
       list-rows-first.

       Note  that  the	order in which styles are defined does not matter; the
       style mechanism uses the most specific possible match for a  particular
       style to determine the set of values.  More precisely, strings are pre‐
       ferred over patterns (for example, `:completion::complete:foo' is  more
       specific	 than `:completion::complete:*'), and longer patterns are pre‐
       ferred over shorter patterns.

       Style names like those of tags are arbitrary and depend on the  comple‐
       tion  function.	 However,  the following two sections list some of the
       most common tags and styles.

   Standard Tags
       Some of the following are only used when looking up  particular	styles
       and do not refer to a type of match.

       accounts
	      used to look up the users-hosts style

       all-expansions
	      used by the _expand completer when adding the single string con‐
	      taining all possible expansions

       all-files
	      for the names of all files (as distinct from a  particular  sub‐
	      set, see the globbed-files tag).

       arguments
	      for arguments to a command

       arrays for names of array parameters

       association-keys
	      for  keys	 of  associative arrays; used when completing inside a
	      subscript to a parameter of this type

       bookmarks
	      when completing bookmarks (e.g. for URLs and the	zftp  function
	      suite)

       builtins
	      for names of builtin commands

       characters
	      for  single  characters  in  arguments of commands such as stty.
	      Also used when completing character  classes  after  an  opening
	      bracket

       colormapids
	      for X colormap ids

       colors for color names

       commands
	      for  names  of external commands.	 Also used by complex commands
	      such as cvs when completing names subcommands.

       contexts
	      for contexts in arguments to the zstyle builtin command

       corrections
	      used by the _approximate and _correct  completers	 for  possible
	      corrections

       cursors
	      for cursor names used by X programs

       default
	      used  in	some  contexts to provide a way of supplying a default
	      when more specific tags are also valid.  Note that this  tag  is
	      used when only the function field of the context name is set

       descriptions
	      used  when  looking up the value of the format style to generate
	      descriptions for types of matches

       devices
	      for names of device special files

       directories
	      for names of directories

       directory-stack
	      for entries in the directory stack

       displays
	      for X display names

       domains
	      for network domains

       expansions
	      used by the _expand completer for individual words  (as  opposed
	      to  the complete set of expansions) resulting from the expansion
	      of a word on the command line

       extensions
	      for X server extensions

       file-descriptors
	      for numbers of open file descriptors

       files  the generic file-matching tag used by functions completing file‐
	      names

       fonts  for X font names

       fstypes
	      for file system types (e.g. for the mount command)

       functions
	      names  of	 functions --- normally shell functions, although cer‐
	      tain commands may understand other kinds of function

       globbed-files
	      for filenames when the name has been generated by pattern match‐
	      ing

       groups for names of user groups

       history-words
	      for words from the history

       hosts  for hostnames

       indexes
	      for array indexes

       jobs   for jobs (as listed by the `jobs' builtin)

       interfaces
	      for network interfaces

       keymaps
	      for names of zsh keymaps

       keysyms
	      for names of X keysyms

       libraries
	      for names of system libraries

       limits for system limits

       local-directories
	      for  names of directories that are subdirectories of the current
	      working directory when completing arguments of  cd  and  related
	      builtin commands (compare path-directories)

       manuals
	      for names of manual pages

       mailboxes
	      for e-mail folders

       maps   for map names (e.g. NIS maps)

       messages
	      used to look up the format style for messages

       modifiers
	      for names of X modifiers

       modules
	      for modules (e.g. zsh modules)

       my-accounts
	      used to look up the users-hosts style

       named-directories
	      for  named  directories  (you  wouldn't have guessed that, would
	      you?)

       names  for all kinds of names

       newsgroups
	      for USENET groups

       nicknames
	      for nicknames of NIS maps

       options
	      for command options

       original
	      used by the _approximate, _correct and _expand  completers  when
	      offering the original string as a match

       other-accounts
	      used to look up the users-hosts style

       packages
	      for packages (e.g. rpm or installed Debian packages)

       parameters
	      for names of parameters

       path-directories
	      for  names  of  directories  found by searching the cdpath array
	      when completing arguments of cd  and  related  builtin  commands
	      (compare local-directories)

       paths  used  to	look  up  the values of the expand, ambiguous and spe‐
	      cial-dirs styles

       pods   for perl pods (documentation files)

       ports  for communication ports

       prefixes
	      for prefixes (like those of a URL)

       printers
	      for print queue names

       processes
	      for process identifiers

       processes-names
	      used to look up the command style when generating the  names  of
	      processes for killall

       sequences
	      for sequences (e.g. mh sequences)

       sessions
	      for sessions in the zftp function suite

       signals
	      for signal names

       strings
	      for  strings  (e.g.  the	replacement strings for the cd builtin
	      command)

       styles for styles used by the zstyle builtin command

       suffixes
	      for filename extensions

       tags   for tags (e.g. rpm tags)

       targets
	      for makefile targets

       time-zones
	      for time zones (e.g. when setting the TZ parameter)

       types  for types of whatever (e.g. address types for the xhost command)

       urls   used to look up the urls and local styles when completing URLs

       users  for usernames

       values for one of a set of values in certain lists

       variant
	      used by _pick_variant to look up the command to run when	deter‐
	      mining what program is installed for a particular command name.

       visuals
	      for X visuals

       warnings
	      used to look up the format style for warnings

       widgets
	      for zsh widget names

       windows
	      for IDs of X windows

       zsh-options
	      for shell options

   Standard Styles
       Note  that the values of several of these styles represent boolean val‐
       ues.  Any of the strings `true', `on', `yes', and `1' can be  used  for
       the  value  `true' and any of the strings `false', `off', `no', and `0'
       for the value `false'.  The behavior for any other value	 is  undefined
       except  where  explicitly  mentioned.   The default value may be either
       true or false if the style is not set.

       Some of these styles are tested first for  every	 possible  tag	corre‐
       sponding to a type of match, and if no style was found, for the default
       tag.  The most notable styles of this type are  menu,  list-colors  and
       styles	controlling   completion   listing  such  as  list-packed  and
       last-prompt).  When tested for the default tag, only the function field
       of  the	context will be set so that a style using the default tag will
       normally be defined along the lines of:

	      zstyle ':completion:*:default' menu ...

       accept-exact
	      This is tested for the default tag in addition to the tags valid
	      for  the current context.	 If it is set to `true' and any of the
	      trial matches is the same as the string  on  the	command	 line,
	      this match will immediately be accepted (even if it would other‐
	      wise be considered ambiguous).

	      When completing pathnames (where the tag used is	`paths')  this
	      style accepts any number of patterns as the value in addition to
	      the boolean values.  Pathnames matching one  of  these  patterns
	      will  be	accepted immediately even if the command line contains
	      some more partially typed pathname components and these match no
	      file under the directory accepted.

	      This  style  is  also used by the _expand completer to decide if
	      words beginning with a tilde or parameter	 expansion  should  be
	      expanded.	  For example, if there are parameters foo and foobar,
	      the string `$foo' will only be expanded if accept-exact  is  set
	      to  `true';  otherwise  the completion system will be allowed to
	      complete $foo to $foobar. If the style  is  set  to  `continue',
	      _expand  will  add  the  expansion as a match and the completion
	      system will also be allowed to continue.

       add-space
	      This style is used by the _expand completer.  If it is true (the
	      default),	 a  space  will	 be inserted after all words resulting
	      from the expansion, or a slash in the case of  directory	names.
	      If  the  value is `file', the completer will only add a space to
	      names of existing files.	Either a boolean  true	or  the	 value
	      `file' may be combined with `subst', in which case the completer
	      will not add a space to words generated from the expansion of  a
	      substitution of the form `$(...)' or `${...}'.

	      The  _prefix completer uses this style as a simple boolean value
	      to decide if a space should be inserted before the suffix.

       ambiguous
	      This applies when completing non-final  components  of  filename
	      paths,  in  other	 words	those with a trailing slash.  If it is
	      set, the cursor is left after  the  first	 ambiguous  component,
	      even  if	menu completion is in use.  The style is always tested
	      with the paths tag.

       assign-list
	      When completing after an equals sign that is being treated as an
	      assignment,  the	completion  system normally completes only one
	      filename.	 In some cases the value  may be a list	 of  filenames
	      separated	 by colons, as with PATH and similar parameters.  This
	      style can be set to a list of patterns  matching	the  names  of
	      such parameters.

	      The  default  is	to  complete  lists  when the word on the line
	      already contains a colon.

       auto-description
	      If set, this style's value will be used as the  description  for
	      options  that are not described by the completion functions, but
	      that have exactly one argument.  The sequence `%d' in the	 value
	      will  be replaced by the description for this argument.  Depend‐
	      ing on personal preferences, it may be useful to set this	 style
	      to  something  like  `specify: %d'.  Note that this may not work
	      for some commands.

       avoid-completer
	      This is used by the _all_matches	completer  to  decide  if  the
	      string  consisting  of  all  matches should be added to the list
	      currently being generated.  Its value is a list of names of com‐
	      pleters.	If any of these is the name of the completer that gen‐
	      erated the matches in this completion, the string	 will  not  be
	      added.

	      The  default value for this style is `_expand _old_list _correct
	      _approximate', i.e. it  contains	the  completers	 for  which  a
	      string with all matches will almost never be wanted.

       cache-path
	      This  style  defines  the	 path where any cache files containing
	      dumped completion data  are  stored.   It	 defaults  to  `$ZDOT‐
	      DIR/.zcompcache',	 or  `$HOME/.zcompcache'  if  $ZDOTDIR	is not
	      defined.	The completion cache  will  not	 be  used  unless  the
	      use-cache style is set.

       cache-policy
	      This  style  defines the function that will be used to determine
	      whether a cache  needs  rebuilding.   See	 the  section  on  the
	      _cache_invalid function below.

       call-command
	      This style is used in the function for commands such as make and
	      ant where calling the command directly to generate matches  suf‐
	      fers  problems such as being slow or, as in the case of make can
	      potentially causes actions in the makefile to be executed. If it
	      is  set to `true' the command is called to generate matches. The
	      default value of this style is `false'.

       command
	      In many places, completion functions need to call external  com‐
	      mands  to	 generate  the list of completions.  This style can be
	      used to override the command that is called in some such	cases.
	      The  elements of the value are joined with spaces to form a com‐
	      mand line to execute.  The value can also start with  a  hyphen,
	      in  which	 case the usual command will be added to the end; this
	      is most useful for putting `builtin' or `command'	 in  front  to
	      make  sure  the  appropriate version of a command is called, for
	      example to avoid calling a shell function with the same name  as
	      an external command.

	      As an example, the completion function for process IDs uses this
	      style with the processes tag to generate the IDs to complete and
	      the  list	 of  processes	to  display  (if  the verbose style is
	      `true').	The list produced by the command should look like  the
	      output  of the ps command.  The first line is not displayed, but
	      is searched for the string `PID' (or `pid') to find the position
	      of the process IDs in the following lines.  If the line does not
	      contain `PID', the first numbers in each of the other lines  are
	      taken as the process IDs to complete.

	      Note  that  the  completion  function  generally has to call the
	      specified command for each attempt to  generate  the  completion
	      list.   Hence care should be taken to specify only commands that
	      take a short time to run, and in particular to  avoid  any  that
	      may never terminate.

       command-path
	      This  is	a  list	 of directories to search for commands to com‐
	      plete.  The default for this style is the value of  the  special
	      parameter path.

       commands
	      This  is	used  by  the function completing sub-commands for the
	      system initialisation scripts (residing in /etc/init.d or	 some‐
	      where  not too far away from that).  Its values give the default
	      commands to complete for those commands for which the completion
	      function isn't able to find them out automatically.  The default
	      for this style are the two strings `start' and `stop'.

       complete
	      This is used by the _expand_alias function  when	invoked	 as  a
	      bindable	command.  If it set to `true' and the word on the com‐
	      mand line is not the name of an alias, matching alias names will
	      be completed.

       completer
	      The  strings  given as the value of this style provide the names
	      of the completer functions to use. The available completer func‐
	      tions are described in the section `Control Functions' below.

	      Each  string may be either the name of a completer function or a
	      string of the form `function:name'.  In the first case the  com‐
	      pleter  field  of	 the context will contain the name of the com‐
	      pleter without the leading underscore and with all other	under‐
	      scores  replaced by hyphens.  In the second case the function is
	      the name of the completer to call, but the context will  contain
	      the user-defined name in the completer field of the context.  If
	      the name starts with a hyphen, the string for the	 context  will
	      be build from the name of the completer function as in the first
	      case with the name appended to it.  For example:

		     zstyle ':completion:*' completer _complete _complete:-foo

	      Here, completion will call the _complete completer  twice,  once
	      using  `complete' and once using `complete-foo' in the completer
	      field of the context.  Normally, using the same  completer  more
	      than  once  only makes sense when used with the `functions:name'
	      form, because otherwise the context name will be the same in all
	      calls to the completer; possible exceptions to this rule are the
	      _ignored and _prefix completers.

	      The default value for this style is `_complete  _ignored':  only
	      completion  will be done, first using the ignored-patterns style
	      and the $fignore array and then without ignoring matches.

       condition
	      This style is used by the _list completer function to decide  if
	      insertion	 of  matches  should  be  delayed unconditionally. The
	      default is `true'.

       disabled
	      If this is set to `true', the _expand_alias completer and	 bind‐
	      able  command  will  try	to  expand disabled aliases, too.  The
	      default is `false'.

       disable-stat
	      This is used with an empty tag by the _cvs  function  to	decide
	      whether  the zsh/stat module should be used to generate names of
	      modified files in the appropriate places (this is its only use).
	      If the style is set, completion will use the ls command.

       domains
	      A	 list  of names of network domains for completion.  If this is
	      not  set,	 domain	 names	 will	be   taken   from   the	  file
	      /etc/resolv.conf.

       expand This  style is used when completing strings consisting of multi‐
	      ple parts, such as path names.

	      If one of its values is the string `prefix', the partially typed
	      word  from  the line will be expanded as far as possible even if
	      trailing parts cannot be completed.

	      If one of its values is the string `suffix', matching names  for
	      components  after	 the  first  ambiguous one will also be added.
	      This means that the resulting string is the longest  unambiguous
	      string  possible.	 However, menu completion can be used to cycle
	      through all matches.

       fake   This style may be set for any completion context.	 It  specifies
	      additional  strings  that	 will always be completed in that con‐
	      text.  The form of each string is `value:description'; the colon
	      and  description may be omitted, but any literal colons in value
	      must be quoted with a backslash.	Any  description  provided  is
	      shown alongside the value in completion listings.

	      It  is  important to use a sufficiently restrictive context when
	      specifying fake strings.	Note that the  styles  fake-files  and
	      fake-parameters  provide	additional  features  when  completing
	      files or parameters.

       fake-files
	      This style is used when completing files and looked up without a
	      tag.   Its values are of the form `dir:names...'.	 This will add
	      the names (strings separated by spaces) as possible matches when
	      completing  in  the  directory dir, even if no such files really
	      exist.

	      This can be useful on systems that support  special  filesystems
	      whose  top-level	pathnames  can not be listed or generated with
	      glob patterns.  It can also be used for  directories  for	 which
	      one does not have read permission.

       fake-parameters
	      This  is	used  by  the completion function for parameter names.
	      Its values are names of parameters that might not yet be set but
	      should be completed nonetheless.	Each name may also be followed
	      by a colon and a string specifying the  type  of	the  parameter
	      (like  `scalar',	`array'	 or `integer').	 If the type is given,
	      the name will only be completed if parameters of that  type  are
	      required	in the particular context.  Names for which no type is
	      specified will always be completed.

       file-patterns
	      This is used by the standard function for completing  filenames,
	      _files.	If  the	 style	is unset up to three tags are offered,
	      `globbed-files',`directories' and `all-files', depending on  the
	      types of files  expected by the caller of _files.	 The first two
	      (`globbed-files'	and  `directories')   are   normally   offered
	      together to make it easier to complete files in sub-directories.

	      The  file-patterns  style	 provides  alternatives to the default
	      tags, which are not used.	 Its value consists of elements of the
	      form  `pattern:tag';  each string may contain any number of such
	      specifications separated by spaces.

	      The pattern is a pattern that is to be used  to  generate	 file‐
	      names.   Any  occurrence of the sequence `%p' is replaced by any
	      pattern(s) passed by the function calling _files.	 Colons in the
	      pattern  must  be	 preceded  by a backslash to make them distin‐
	      guishable from the colon before the tag.	If more than one  pat‐
	      tern  is	needed, the patterns can be given inside braces, sepa‐
	      rated by commas.

	      The tags of all strings in the value will be offered  by	_files
	      and  used	 when  looking	up other styles.  Any tags in the same
	      word will be offered at the same time and	 before	 later	words.
	      If no `:tag' is given the `files' tag will be used.

	      The  tag	may also be followed by an optional second colon and a
	      description, which will be used for the `%d' in the value of the
	      format style (if that is set) instead of the default description
	      supplied by the completion function.  If the  description	 given
	      here  contains itself a `%d', that is replaced with the descrip‐
	      tion supplied by the completion function.

	      For example, to make the rm command first complete only names of
	      object  files  and  then	the  names of all files if there is no
	      matching object file:

		     zstyle ':completion:*:*:rm:*' file-patterns \
			 '*.o:object-files' '%p:all-files'

	      To alter the default behaviour  of  file	completion  ---	 offer
	      files  matching  a pattern and directories on the first attempt,
	      then all files --- to offer only matching	 files	on  the	 first
	      attempt, then directories, and finally all files:

		     zstyle ':completion:*' file-patterns \
			 '%p:globbed-files' '*(-/):directories' '*:all-files'

	      This  works  even	 where	there  is  no  special pattern: _files
	      matches all files using the pattern `*' at the  first  step  and
	      stops  when it sees this pattern.	 Note also it will never try a
	      pattern more than once for a single completion attempt.

	      During the execution of completion functions, the	 EXTENDED_GLOB
	      option  is  in  effect,  so the characters `#', `~' and `^' have
	      special meanings in the patterns.

       file-sort
	      The standard filename completion function uses this style	 with‐
	      out  a  tag  to  determine  in  which  order the names should be
	      listed; menu completion will cycle  through  them	 in  the  same
	      order.   The  possible values are: `size' to sort by the size of
	      the file; `links' to sort by the number of links	to  the	 file;
	      `modification' (or `time' or `date') to sort by the last modifi‐
	      cation time; `access' to sort  by	 the  last  access  time;  and
	      `inode' (or `change') to sort by the last inode change time.  If
	      the style is set to any other value, or is unset, files will  be
	      sorted alphabetically by name.  If the value contains the string
	      `reverse', sorting is done in the opposite order.

       filter This is used by the LDAP plugin for e-mail address completion to
	      specify  the attributes to match against when filtering entries.
	      So for example, if the style is set to `sn',  matching  is  done
	      against  surnames.   Standard  LDAP  filtering is used so normal
	      completion matching is bypassed.	If this style is not set,  the
	      LDAP  plugin  is	skipped.  You may also need to set the command
	      style to specify how to connect to your LDAP server.

       force-list
	      This forces a list of completions to be shown at any point where
	      listing  is  done, even in cases where the list would usually be
	      suppressed.  For example, normally the list  is  only  shown  if
	      there are at least two different matches.	 By setting this style
	      to `always', the list will always be shown,  even	 if  there  is
	      only  a  single  match  that  will immediately be accepted.  The
	      style may also be set to a number.  In this case the  list  will
	      be  shown	 if there are at least that many matches, even if they
	      would all insert the same string.

	      This style is tested for the default tag as well as for each tag
	      valid  for  the  current	completion.   Hence the listing can be
	      forced only for certain types of match.

       format If this is set for the descriptions tag, its value is used as  a
	      string  to  display  above  matches  in  completion  lists.  The
	      sequence `%d' in this string  will  be  replaced	with  a	 short
	      description  of  what  these  matches are.  This string may also
	      contain the sequences to	specify	 output	 attributes,  such  as
	      `%B', `%S' and `%{...%}'.

	      The  style is tested with each tag valid for the current comple‐
	      tion before it is tested for the descriptions tag.   Hence  dif‐
	      ferent  format  strings  can  be	defined for different types of
	      match.

	      Note  also  that	some  completer	 functions  define  additional
	      `%'-sequences.   These are described for the completer functions
	      that make use of them.

	      Some completion functions display	 messages  that	 may  be  cus‐
	      tomised  by  setting this style for the messages tag.  Here, the
	      `%d' is replaced with a message given by	the  completion	 func‐
	      tion.

	      Finally,	the  format string is looked up with the warnings tag,
	      for use when no matches could be generated at all.  In this case
	      the  `%d' is replaced with the descriptions for the matches that
	      were  expected  separated	 by  spaces.   The  sequence  `%D'  is
	      replaced with the same descriptions separated by newlines.

	      It  is  possible to use printf-style field width specifiers with
	      `%d' and similar escape sequences.  This is handled by the zfor‐
	      mat  builtin  command  from  the	zsh/zutil  module, see zshmod‐
	      ules(1).

       glob   This is used by the _expand completer.  If it is set  to	`true'
	      (the default), globbing will be attempted on the words resulting
	      from a previous substitution (see the substitute style) or  else
	      the original string from the line.

       global If  this	is set to `true' (the default), the _expand_alias com‐
	      pleter and bindable command will try to expand global aliases.

       group-name
	      The completion system can	 group	different  types  of  matches,
	      which  appear in separate lists.	This style can be used to give
	      the names of groups for particular tags.	For example,  in  com‐
	      mand  position  the completion system generates names of builtin
	      and external commands, names of  aliases,	 shell	functions  and
	      parameters  and reserved words as possible completions.  To have
	      the external commands and shell functions listed separately:

		     zstyle ':completion:*:*:-command-:*:commands' group-name commands
		     zstyle ':completion:*:*:-command-:*:functions' group-name functions

	      As a consequence, any match with the same tag will be  displayed
	      in the same group.

	      If  the  name  given is the empty string the name of the tag for
	      the matches will be used as the name of the group.  So, to  have
	      all  different  types  of	 matches displayed separately, one can
	      just set:

		     zstyle ':completion:*' group-name ''

	      All matches for which no group name is defined will be put in  a
	      group named -default-.

       group-order
	      This  style is additional to the group-name style to specify the
	      order for display of the groups defined by that  style  (compare
	      tag-order,  which	 determines  which completions appear at all).
	      The groups named are shown in the given order; any other	groups
	      are shown in the order defined by the completion function.

	      For  example, to have names of builtin commands, shell functions
	      and external commands appear in that order  when	completing  in
	      command position:

		     zstyle ':completion:*:*:-command-:*' group-order \
			    builtins functions commands

       groups A list of names of UNIX groups.  If this is not set, group names
	      are taken from the YP database or the file `/etc/group'.

       hidden If this is set to true, matches for the given context  will  not
	      be listed, although any description for the matches set with the
	      format style will be shown.  If it is set to `all', not even the
	      description will be displayed.

	      Note that the matches will still be completed; they are just not
	      shown in the list.  To avoid having matches considered as possi‐
	      ble  completions	at all, the tag-order style can be modified as
	      described below.

       hosts  A list of names of hosts that should be completed.  If  this  is
	      not set, hostnames are taken from the file `/etc/hosts'.

       hosts-ports
	      This style is used by commands that need or accept hostnames and
	      network ports.  The strings in the value should be of  the  form
	      `host:port'.   Valid  ports  are	determined  by the presence of
	      hostnames; multiple ports for the same host may appear.

       ignore-line
	      This is tested for each tag valid for  the  current  completion.
	      If  it  is  set to `true', none of the words that are already on
	      the line will be considered as possible completions.  If	it  is
	      set  to `current', the word the cursor is on will not be consid‐
	      ered as a possible completion.   The  value  `current-shown'  is
	      similar but only applies if the list of completions is currently
	      shown on the screen.  Finally, if the style is set  to  `other',
	      no  word apart from the current one will be considered as a pos‐
	      sible completion.

	      The values `current' and `current-shown'	are  a	bit  like  the
	      opposite	of  the accept-exact style:  only strings with missing
	      characters will be completed.

	      Note that you almost certainly don't want to set this to	`true'
	      or  `other' for a general context such as `:completion:*'.  This
	      is because it would disallow completion of, for example, options
	      multiple	times  even  if	 the  command  in question accepts the
	      option more than once.

       ignore-parents
	      The style is tested without a tag	 by  the  function  completing
	      pathnames	 in  order to determine whether to ignore the names of
	      directories already mentioned in the current word, or  the  name
	      of the current working directory.	 The value must include one or
	      both of the following strings:

	      parent The name of any directory whose path is already contained
		     in	 the  word  on the line is ignored.  For example, when
		     completing after foo/../, the directory foo will  not  be
		     considered a valid completion.

	      pwd    The  name	of  the	 current working directory will not be
		     completed; hence, for example, completion after ../  will
		     not use the name of the current directory.

	      In addition, the value may include one or both of:

	      ..     Ignore  the  specified  directories only when the word on
		     the line contains the substring `../'.

	      directory
		     Ignore the	 specified  directories	 only  when  names  of
		     directories  are  completed, not when completing names of
		     files.

	      Excluded values act in  a	 similar  fashion  to  values  of  the
	      ignored-patterns style, so they can be restored to consideration
	      by the _ignored completer.

       ignored-patterns
	      A list of patterns; any trial completion	matching  one  of  the
	      patterns will be excluded from consideration.  The _ignored com‐
	      pleter can appear in the	list  of  completers  to  restore  the
	      ignored  matches.	  This	is  a more configurable version of the
	      shell parameter $fignore.

	      Note that the EXTENDED_GLOB option is set during	the  execution
	      of completion functions, so the characters `#', `~' and `^' have
	      special meanings in the patterns.

       insert This style is used  by  the  _all_matches	 completer  to	decide
	      whether  to  insert  the	list  of  all  matches unconditionally
	      instead of adding the list as another match.

       insert-ids
	      When completing process IDs, for example	as  arguments  to  the
	      kill and wait builtins the name of a command may be converted to
	      the appropriate process ID.  A problem arises when  the  process
	      name  typed  is not unique.  By default (or if this style is set
	      explicitly to `menu') the name will be converted immediately  to
	      a	 set  of  possible IDs, and menu completion will be started to
	      cycle through them.

	      If the value of the style is `single', the shell will wait until
	      the user has typed enough to make the command unique before con‐
	      verting the name to an ID; attempts at completion will be unsuc‐
	      cessful  until  that  point.   If the value is any other string,
	      menu completion will be started when the	string	typed  by  the
	      user is longer than the common prefix to the corresponding IDs.

       insert-tab
	      If  this	is  set to `true', the completion system will insert a
	      TAB character (assuming  that  was  used	to  start  completion)
	      instead  of  performing  completion  when	 there is no non-blank
	      character to the left of the cursor.  If it is set  to  `false',
	      completion will be done even there.

	      The  value  may  also contain the substrings `pending' or `pend‐
	      ing=val'.	 In this case, the typed character  will  be  inserted
	      instead  of  staring  completion when there is unprocessed input
	      pending.	If a val is given, completion  will  not  be  done  if
	      there  are  at  least that many characters of unprocessed input.
	      This is often useful when pasting characters  into  a  terminal.
	      Note  however,  that it relies on the $PENDING special parameter
	      from the zsh/zle module being set properly which is not  guaran‐
	      teed on all platforms.

	      The  default value of this style is `true' except for completion
	      within vared builtin command where it is `false'.

       insert-unambiguous
	      This is used by the _match and _approximate  completers.	 These
	      completers  are  often  used with menu completion since the word
	      typed may bear little resemblance to the final completion.  How‐
	      ever,  if	 this  style  is `true', the completer will start menu
	      completion only if it could find no unambiguous  initial	string
	      at least as long as the original string typed by the user.

	      In  the  case of the _approximate completer, the completer field
	      in the context will already have been set to one of  correct-num
	      or  approximate-num, where num is the number of errors that were
	      accepted.

	      In the case of the _match completer, the style may also  be  set
	      to  the  string `pattern'.  Then the pattern on the line is left
	      unchanged if it does not match unambiguously.

       keep-prefix
	      This style is used by the _expand completer.  If it  is  `true',
	      the  completer  will  try to keep a prefix containing a tilde or
	      parameter expansion.  Hence,  for	 example,  the	string	`~/f*'
	      would  be	 expanded  to `~/foo' instead of `/home/user/foo'.  If
	      the style is set to `changed' (the  default),  the  prefix  will
	      only  be	left unchanged if there were other changes between the
	      expanded words and the original word from the command line.  Any
	      other value forces the prefix to be expanded unconditionally.

	      The  behaviour  of  expand  when	this style is true is to cause
	      _expand to give up when a single	expansion  with	 the  restored
	      prefix  is  the  same  as the original; hence any remaining com‐
	      pleters may be called.

       last-prompt
	      This is a more flexible form of the  ALWAYS_LAST_PROMPT  option.
	      If it is true, the completion system will try to return the cur‐
	      sor to the previous command line after displaying	 a  completion
	      list.   It  is tested for all tags valid for the current comple‐
	      tion, then the default tag.  The cursor will be  moved  back  to
	      the  previous  line  if  this  style  is `true' for all types of
	      match.  Note that unlike the ALWAYS_LAST_PROMPT option  this  is
	      independent of the numeric prefix argument.

       list   This  style  is used by the _history_complete_word bindable com‐
	      mand.  If it is set to `true' it has no effect.  If it is set to
	      `false'  matches will not be listed.  This overrides the setting
	      of the options  controlling  listing  behaviour,	in  particular
	      AUTO_LIST.   The	context	 always	 starts with `:completion:his‐
	      tory-words'.

       list-colors
	      If the zsh/complist module is loaded, this style can be used  to
	      set  color  specifications.   This mechanism replaces the use of
	      the ZLS_COLORS and ZLS_COLOURS parameters described in the  sec‐
	      tion  `The zsh/complist Module' in zshmodules(1), but the syntax
	      is the same.

	      If this style is set for the default tag,	 the  strings  in  the
	      value  are  taken	 as  specifications that are to be used every‐
	      where.  If it is set for other tags, the specifications are used
	      only  for matches of the type described by the tag.  For this to
	      work best, the group-name style must be set to an empty string.

	      In addition to setting styles for specific tags, it is also pos‐
	      sible  to use group names specified explicitly by the group-name
	      tag together with the `(group)' syntax allowed by the ZLS_COLORS
	      and ZLS_COLOURS parameters and simply using the default tag.

	      It  is  possible	to use any color specifications already set up
	      for the GNU version of the ls command:

		     zstyle ':completion:*:default' list-colors ${(s.:.)LS_COLORS}

	      The default colors are the same as for the GNU  ls  command  and
	      can  be  obtained	 by setting the style to an empty string (i.e.
	      '').

       list-grouped
	      If this style is `true' (the  default),  the  completion	system
	      will  try	 to  make  certain completion listings more compact by
	      grouping matches.	 For example, options for commands  that  have
	      the  same	 description  (shown  when the verbose style is set to
	      `true') will appear as a single entry.  However, menu  selection
	      can be used to cycle through all the matches.

       list-packed
	      This is tested for each tag valid in the current context as well
	      as the default tag.  If it is set to `true',  the	 corresponding
	      matches  appear  in  listings  as if the LIST_PACKED option were
	      set.  If it is set to `false', they are listed normally.

       list-prompt
	      If this style is set for the default tag, completion lists  that
	      don't  fit on the screen can be scrolled (see the description of
	      the zsh/complist module in zshmodules(1)).  The  value,  if  not
	      the  empty  string,  will be displayed after every screenful and
	      the shell will prompt for a key press; if the style  is  set  to
	      the empty string, a default prompt will be used.

	      The  value may contain the escape sequences: `%l' or `%L', which
	      will be replaced by the number of the last  line	displayed  and
	      the total number of lines; `%m' or `%M', the number of the  last
	      match shown and the total number of matches; and `%p' and	 `%P',
	      `Top'  when  at  the beginning of the list, `Bottom' when at the
	      end and the position shown as a percentage of the	 total	length
	      otherwise.  In each case the form with the uppercase letter will
	      be replaced by a string of fixed width,  padded  to  the	 right
	      with  spaces,  while  the	 lowercase  form will be replaced by a
	      variable width string.  As in other prompt strings,  the	escape
	      sequences	 `%S',	`%s',  `%B', `%b', `%U', `%u' for entering and
	      leaving the display modes standout, bold and underline are  also
	      available,  as  is  the  form  `%{...%}'	for  enclosing	escape
	      sequences which display with zero width.

       list-rows-first
	      This style is tested in the same way as  the  list-packed	 style
	      and  determines whether matches are to be listed in a rows-first
	      fashion as if the LIST_ROWS_FIRST option were set.

       list-suffixes
	      This style is used by the function that completes filenames.  If
	      it  is  true, and completion is attempted on a string containing
	      multiple partially typed pathname components, all ambiguous com‐
	      ponents will be shown.  Otherwise, completion stops at the first
	      ambiguous component.

       list-separator
	      The value of this style is used in completion listing  to	 sepa‐
	      rate  the	 string	 to  complete from a description when possible
	      (e.g. when  completing  options).	  It  defaults	to  `--'  (two
	      hyphens).

       local  This  is for use with functions that complete URLs for which the
	      corresponding files are available directly from the filing  sys‐
	      tem.  Its value should consist of three strings: a hostname, the
	      path to the default web pages for the server, and the  directory
	      name used by a user placing web pages within their home area.

	      For example:

		     zstyle ':completion:*' local toast \
			 /var/http/public/toast public_html

	      Completion  after	 `http://toast/stuff/'	will look for files in
	      the directory  /var/http/public/toast/stuff,   while  completion
	      after  `http://toast/~yousir/' will look for files in the direc‐
	      tory ~yousir/public_html.

       mail-directory
	      If set, zsh will assume that mailbox files can be found  in  the
	      directory specified.  It defaults to `~/Mail'.

       match-original
	      This  is	used  by  the _match completer.	 If it is set to only,
	      _match will try to generate matches without inserting a  `*'  at
	      the  cursor  position.   If set to any other non-empty value, it
	      will first try to generate matches without inserting the `*' and
	      if  that	yields	no  matches,  it  will	try again with the `*'
	      inserted.	 If it is unset or set to the empty  string,  matching
	      will only be performed with the `*' inserted.

       matcher
	      This  style  is tested separately for each tag valid in the cur‐
	      rent context.  Its value is added to  any	 match	specifications
	      given  by	 the  matcher-list  style.   It	 should be in the form
	      described in the section `Matching Control' in zshcompwid(1).

       matcher-list
	      This style can be set to a list of match specifications that are
	      to  be applied everywhere. Match specifications are described in
	      the section `Matching Control' in zshcompwid(1).	The completion
	      system  will  try	 them  one  after  another  for each completer
	      selected.	 For example, to try first simple completion  and,  if
	      that generates no matches, case-insensitive completion:

		     zstyle ':completion:*' matcher-list '' 'm:{a-zA-Z}={A-Za-z}'

	      By  default  each	 specification replaces the previous one; how‐
	      ever, if a specification is prefixed with +, it is added to  the
	      existing list.  Hence it is possible to create increasingly gen‐
	      eral specifications without repetition:

		     zstyle ':completion:*' matcher-list '' '+m{a-Z}={A-Z}' '+m{A-Z}={a-z}'

	      It is possible to create match specifications valid for particu‐
	      lar  completers  by  using  the third field of the context.  For
	      example, to use the completers _complete and  _prefix  but  only
	      allow case-insensitive completion with _complete:

		     zstyle ':completion:*' completer _complete _prefix
		     zstyle ':completion:*:complete:*' matcher-list \
			    '' 'm:{a-zA-Z}={A-Za-z}'

	      User-defined  names,  as	explained for the completer style, are
	      available.  This makes it possible to  try  the  same  completer
	      more  than  once	with different match specifications each time.
	      For example, to try normal completion without a match specifica‐
	      tion,  then  normal  completion  with case-insensitive matching,
	      then correction, and finally partial-word completion:

		     zstyle ':completion:*' completer _complete _correct _complete:foo
		     zstyle ':completion:*:complete:*' matcher-list \
			 '' 'm:{a-zA-Z}={A-Za-z}'
		     zstyle ':completion:*:foo:*' matcher-list \
			 'm:{a-zA-Z}={A-Za-z} r:|[-_./]=* r:|=*'

	      If the style is unset in any context no match  specification  is
	      applied.	 Note  also  that some completers such as _correct and
	      _approximate do not use the match specifications at all,	though
	      these  completers	 will  only  ever  called  once	 even  if  the
	      matcher-list contains more than one element.

	      Where multiple specifications are useful, note that  the	entire
	      completion  is  done for each element of matcher-list, which can
	      quickly reduce the shell's performance.	As  a  rough  rule  of
	      thumb,  one  to  three strings will give acceptable performance.
	      On the other hand, putting multiple space-separated values  into
	      the  same	 string does not have an appreciable impact on perfor‐
	      mance.

       max-errors
	      This is used by the _approximate and  _correct  completer	 func‐
	      tions  to	 determine the maximum number of errors to allow.  The
	      completer will try to generate completions by first allowing one
	      error,  then  two	 errors,  and  so  on, until either a match or
	      matches were found or the maximum number of errors given by this
	      style has been reached.

	      If  the  value for this style contains the string `numeric', the
	      completer function will take any numeric argument as the maximum
	      number of errors allowed. For example, with

		     zstyle ':completion:*:approximate:::' max-errors 2 numeric

	      two errors are allowed if no numeric argument is given, but with
	      a numeric argument of six (as in `ESC-6 TAB'), up to six	errors
	      are  accepted.  Hence with a value of `0 numeric', no correcting
	      completion will be attempted unless a numeric argument is given.

	      If the value contains the string	`not-numeric',	the  completer
	      will  not	 try  to  generate  corrected completions when given a
	      numeric argument, so in this case the  number  given  should  be
	      greater  than zero.  For example, `2 not-numeric' specifies that
	      correcting completion with two errors will usually be performed,
	      but  if  a numeric argument is given, correcting completion will
	      not be performed.

	      The default value for this style is `2 numeric'.

       max-matches-width
	      This style is used to determine the trade off between the	 width
	      of  the  display	used  for matches and the width used for their
	      descriptions when the verbose style is  in  effect.   The	 value
	      gives  the number of display columns to reserve for the matches.
	      The default is half the width of the screen.

	      This has the most impact when  several  matches  have  the  same
	      description  and	so  will  be grouped together.	Increasing the
	      style will allow more matches to be grouped together; decreasing
	      it will allow more of the description to be visible.

       menu   If  this	is  true in the context of any of the tags defined for
	      the current completion menu completion will be used.  The	 value
	      for  a  specific	tag  will  take	 precedence  over that for the
	      `default' tag.

	      If none of the values found in this way is true but at least one
	      is  set  to `auto', the shell behaves as if the AUTO_MENU option
	      is set.

	      If one of the values is explicitly set to false, menu completion
	      will  be	explicitly  turned  off,  overriding the MENU_COMPLETE
	      option and other settings.

	      In the form `yes=num', where `yes' may be any of the true values
	      (`yes', `true', `on' and `1'), menu completion will be turned on
	      if there are at least num matches.  In the form `yes=long', menu
	      completion  will	be  turned  on if the list does not fit on the
	      screen.  This does not activate menu completion  if  the	widget
	      normally	only  lists  completions,  but	menu completion can be
	      activated in that case with  the	value  `yes=long-list'	(Typi‐
	      cally, the value `select=long-list' described later is more use‐
	      ful as it provides control over scrolling.)

	      Similarly, with any of the `false' values (as in `no=10'),  menu
	      completion will not be used if there are num or more matches.

	      The value of this widget also controls menu selection, as imple‐
	      mented by the zsh/complist module.   The	following  values  may
	      appear either alongside or instead of the values above.

	      If  the  value contains the string `select', menu selection will
	      be started unconditionally.

	      In the form `select=num', menu selection will only be started if
	      there are at least num matches.  If the values for more than one
	      tag provide a number, the smallest number is taken.

	      Menu selection can be turned off explicitly by defining a	 value
	      containing the string`no-select'.

	      It  is also possible to start menu selection only if the list of
	      matches  does  not  fit  on  the	screen	by  using  the	 value
	      `select=long'.  To start menu selection even if the current wid‐
	      get only performs listing, use the value `select=long-list'.

	      To turn on menu completion or menu selection when a there are  a
	      certain number of matches or the list of matches does not fit on
	      the screen, both of `yes=' and `select='	may  be	 given	twice,
	      once with a number and once with `long' or `long-list'.

	      Finally,	it  is	possible to activate two special modes of menu
	      selection.  The word `interactive' in the value causes  interac‐
	      tive  mode  to  be  entered  immediately	when menu selection is
	      started; see the description of the zsh/complist module in  zsh‐
	      modules(1).RE  for a description of interactive mode.  Including
	      the string `search' does the same for incremental	 search	 mode.
	      To  select  backward  incremental	 search,  include  the	string
	      `search-backward'.  )

	      muttrc If set, gives the	location  of  the  mutt	 configuration
		     file.  It defaults to `~/.muttrc'.

	      numbers
		     This  is  used  with  the jobs tag.  If it is `true', the
		     shell will complete job numbers instead of	 the  shortest
		     unambiguous prefix of the job command text.  If the value
		     is a number, job numbers will only be used if  that  many
		     words  from  the job descriptions are required to resolve
		     ambiguities.  For example, if the value is	 `1',  strings
		     will only be used if all jobs differ in the first word on
		     their command lines.

	      old-list
		     This is used by the _oldlist completer.  If it is set  to
		     `always',	then  standard	widgets	 which perform listing
		     will retain the current list  of  matches,	 however  they
		     were  generated;  this  can be turned off explicitly with
		     the value	`never',  giving  the  behaviour  without  the
		     _oldlist  completer.  If the style is unset, or any other
		     value, then the existing list of completions is displayed
		     if	 it is not already; otherwise, the standard completion
		     list is generated;	 this  is  the	default	 behaviour  of
		     _oldlist.	 However,  if  there  is  an old list and this
		     style contains the name of the  completer	function  that
		     generated	the  list, then the old list will be used even
		     if it was generated by a widget which does not  do	 list‐
		     ing.

		     For  example,  suppose  you  type	^Xc  to	 use the _cor‐
		     rect_word widget, which generates a list  of  corrections
		     for  the word under the cursor.  Usually, typing ^D would
		     generate a standard list of completions for the  word  on
		     the  command line, and show that.	With _oldlist, it will
		     instead show the list of corrections already generated.

		     As another example consider the  _match  completer:  with
		     the  insert-unambiguous  style  set  to `true' it inserts
		     only a common prefix string, if there is  any.   However,
		     this  may	remove	parts of the original pattern, so that
		     further completion could produce more matches than on the
		     first  attempt.  By using the _oldlist completer and set‐
		     ting this style to _match, the list of matches  generated
		     on the first attempt will be used again.

	      old-matches
		     This  is  used by the _all_matches completer to decide if
		     an old list of matches should  be	used  if  one  exists.
		     This  is  selected	 by one of the `true' values or by the
		     string `only'.  If the value is `only', _all_matches will
		     only  use	an  old	 list and won't have any effect on the
		     list of matches currently being generated.

		     If this style is set it is generally unwise to  call  the
		     _all_matches completer unconditionally.  One possible use
		     is for either this style or the  completer	 style	to  be
		     defined  with  the	 -e option to zstyle to make the style
		     conditional.

	      old-menu
		     This is used by the _oldlist completer.  It controls  how
		     menu  completion  behaves	when  a completion has already
		     been inserted and the user types  a  standard  completion
		     key  such	as  TAB.  The default behaviour of _oldlist is
		     that menu completion always continues with	 the  existing
		     list  of  completions.   If this style is set to `false',
		     however, a new completion is started if the old list  was
		     generated	by a different completion command; this is the
		     behaviour without the _oldlist completer.

		     For example, suppose you type ^Xc to generate a  list  of
		     corrections, and menu completion is started in one of the
		     usual ways.  Usually, or with this style  set  to	false,
		     typing  TAB  at this point would start trying to complete
		     the line as it now appears.  With	_oldlist,  it  instead
		     continues to cycle through the list of corrections.

	      original
		     This  is used by the _approximate and _correct completers
		     to decide if the original string should  be  added	 as  a
		     possible  completion.   Normally,	this  is  done only if
		     there are at least two possible corrections, but if  this
		     style  is	set  to `true', it is always added.  Note that
		     the style will be examined with the  completer  field  in
		     the  context  name set to correct-num or approximate-num,
		     where num is the number of errors that were accepted.

	      packageset
		     This style is  used  when	completing  arguments  of  the
		     Debian  `dpkg'  program.  It contains an override for the
		     default package set for a given context.  For example,

			    zstyle ':completion:*:complete:dpkg:option--status-1:*' \
					   packageset avail

		     causes available packages,	 rather	 than  only  installed
		     packages, to be completed for `dpkg --status'.

	      path   The  function  that completes color names uses this style
		     with the colors tag.  The value should be the pathname of
		     a	file  containing  color	 names in the format of an X11
		     rgb.txt file.  If the style is not set but this  file  is
		     found  in	one  of	 various standard locations it will be
		     used as the default.

	      pine-directory
		     If set, specifies the directory containing	 PINE  mailbox
		     files.  It defaults to `~/mail'.

	      ports  A	list of Internet service names (network ports) to com‐
		     plete.  If this is not set, service names are taken  from
		     the file `/etc/services'.

	      prefix-hidden
		     This is used for certain completions which share a common
		     prefix,  for  example  command  options  beginning	  with
		     dashes.  If it is `true', the prefix will not be shown in
		     the list of matches.

		     The default value for this style is `false'.

	      prefix-needed
		     This, too, is used for matches with a common prefix.   If
		     it	 is  set to `true' this common prefix must be typed by
		     the user to generate the matches.	In the case of command
		     options,  this  means  that the initial `-', `+', or `--'
		     must be typed explicitly before option names will be com‐
		     pleted.

		     The default value for this style is `true'.

	      preserve-prefix
		     This style is used when completing path names.  Its value
		     should be a pattern matching an  initial  prefix  of  the
		     word  to complete that should be left unchanged under all
		     circumstances.  For example, on some  Unices  an  initial
		     `//'  (double  slash) has a special meaning; setting this
		     style to the string `//' will preserve  it.   As  another
		     example,  setting	this style to `?:/' under Cygwin would
		     allow completion after `a:/...' and so on.

	      range  This is used by the  _history  completer  and  the	 _his‐
		     tory_complete_word bindable command to decide which words
		     should be completed.

		     If it is a singe number, only the last N words  from  the
		     history will be completed.

		     If	 it is a range of the form `max:slice', the last slice
		     words will be completed; then if that yields no  matches,
		     the  slice	 words	before	those will be tried and so on.
		     This process stops either when at	least  one  match  was
		     been found, or max words have been tried.

		     The  default is to complete all words from the history at
		     once.

	      regular
		     This style is used by  the	 _expand_alias	completer  and
		     bindable  command.	 If set to `true' (the default), regu‐
		     lar aliases will be expanded but only  in	command	 posi‐
		     tion.   If	 it  is	 set  to `false', regular aliases will
		     never be expanded.	  If it is set	to  `always',  regular
		     aliases will be expanded even if not in command position.

	      remote-access
		     If	 set to false, certain commands will be prevented from
		     making Internet connections to retrieve  remote  informa‐
		     tion.  This includes the completion for the CVS command.

		     It	 is  not always possible to know if connections are in
		     fact to a remote site, so some may be prevented  unneces‐
		     sarily.

	      remove-all-dups
		     The _history_complete_word bindable command and the _his‐
		     tory completer  use  this	to  decide  if	all  duplicate
		     matches  should  be removed, rather than just consecutive
		     duplicates.

	      select-prompt
		     If this is set for the default tag,  its  value  will  be
		     displayed	during	menu  selection	 (see  the  menu style
		     above) when the completion	 list  does  not  fit  on  the
		     screen   as  a  whole.   The  same	 escapes  as  for  the
		     list-prompt style are understood, except that the numbers
		     refer  to	the  match  or line the mark is on.  A default
		     prompt is used when the value is the empty string.

	      select-scroll
		     This style is tested for the default tag  and  determines
		     how a completion list is scrolled during a menu selection
		     (see the menu style above) when the completion list  does
		     not  fit  on  the screen as a whole.  If the value is `0'
		     (zero), the list is scrolled by half-screenfuls; if it is
		     a	positive  integer,  the	 list is scrolled by the given
		     number of lines; if it is a negative number, the list  is
		     scrolled  by  a screenful minus the absolute value of the
		     given number of lines.  The default is to scroll by  sin‐
		     gle lines.

	      separate-sections
		     This  style  is used with the manuals tag when completing
		     names of manual pages.  If it is `true', entries for dif‐
		     ferent  sections  are added separately using tag names of
		     the form `manual.X', where X is the section number.  When
		     the  group-name  style is also in effect, pages from dif‐
		     ferent sections will appear separately.   This  style  is
		     also  used similarly with the words style when completing
		     words for the dict command. It allows words from  differ‐
		     ent  dictionary  databases	 to  be added separately.  The
		     default for this style is `false'.

	      show-completer
		     Tested whenever a new completer is tried.	If it is true,
		     the  completion  system outputs a progress message in the
		     listing area showing what completer is being tried.   The
		     message  will  be	overwritten by any output when comple‐
		     tions are found and is removed after completion  is  fin‐
		     ished.

	      single-ignored
		     This is used by the _ignored completer when there is only
		     one match.	 If its value is `show', the single match will
		     be	 displayed  but not inserted.  If the value is `menu',
		     then the single match and the original  string  are  both
		     added  as	matches and menu completion is started, making
		     it easy to select either of them.

	      sort   Many completion widgets call _description at  some	 point
		     which  decides  whether  the  matches are added sorted or
		     unsorted (often indirectly via  _wanted  or  _requested).
		     This style can be set explicitly to one of the usual true
		     or false values as an override.  If it is not set for the
		     context,  the standard behaviour of the calling widget is
		     used.

		     The style	is  tested  first  against  the	 full  context
		     including	the  tag, and if that fails to produce a value
		     against the context without the tag.

		     If	 the  calling  widget  explicitly  requests   unsorted
		     matches,  this is usually honoured.  However, the default
		     (unsorted) behaviour of completion for the	 command  his‐
		     tory may be overridden by setting the style to true.

		     In	 the  _expand  completer,  if it is set to `true', the
		     expansions generated will always be sorted.  If it is set
		     to	 `menu', then the expansions are only sorted when they
		     are offered as single strings but not in the string  con‐
		     taining all possible expansions.

	      special-dirs
		     Normally, the completion code will not produce the direc‐
		     tory names `.' and `..' as possible completions.  If this
		     style  is set to `true', it will add both `.' and `..' as
		     possible completions; if it is set	 to  `..',  only  `..'
		     will be added.

		     The  following example sets special-dirs to `..' when the
		     current prefix is empty, is a  single  `.',  or  consists
		     only of a path beginning with `../'.  Otherwise the value
		     is `false'.

			    zstyle -e ':completion:*' special-dirs \
			       '[[ $PREFIX = (../)#(|.|..) ]] && reply=(..)'

	      squeeze-slashes
		     If set to `true', sequences of slashes in filename	 paths
		     (for  example  in `foo//bar') will be treated as a single
		     slash.  This is the usual behaviour of UNIX paths.	  How‐
		     ever,  by default the file completion function behaves as
		     if there were a `*' between the slashes.

	      stop   If set to	`true',	 the  _history_complete_word  bindable
		     command will stop once when reaching the beginning or end
		     of the  history.	Invoking  _history_complete_word  will
		     then  wrap around to the opposite end of the history.  If
		     this style is set to `false' (the default), _history_com‐
		     plete_word will loop immediately as in a menu completion.

	      strip-comments
		     If set to `true', this style causes non-essential comment
		     text to be removed from completion matches.  Currently it
		     is	 only  used  when completing e-mail addresses where it
		     removes any display name from the addresses, cutting them
		     down to plain user@host form.

	      subst-globs-only
		     This  is  used by the _expand completer.  If it is set to
		     `true', the expansion will only be used  if  it  resulted
		     from globbing; hence, if expansions resulted from the use
		     of the substitute style described below, but  these  were
		     not  further  changed by globbing, the expansions will be
		     rejected.

		     The default for this style is `false'.

	      substitute
		     This boolean style controls whether the _expand completer
		     will  first try to expand all substitutions in the string
		     (such as `$(...)' and `${...}').

		     The default is `true'.

	      suffix This is used by the _expand completer if the word	starts
		     with a tilde or contains a parameter expansion.  If it is
		     set to `true', the word  will  only  be  expanded	if  it
		     doesn't  have  a  suffix,	i.e.  if  it is something like
		     `~foo' or	`$foo'	rather	than  `~foo/'  or  `$foo/bar',
		     unless  that  suffix  itself contains characters eligible
		     for expansion.  The default for this style is `true'.

	      tag-order
		     This provides a mechanism for sorting how the tags avail‐
		     able in a particular context will be used.

		     The  values  for  the  style  are sets of space-separated
		     lists of tags.  The tags in each value will be  tried  at
		     the  same	time;  if no match is found, the next value is
		     used.  (See the file-patterns style for an	 exception  to
		     this behavior.)

		     For example:

			    zstyle ':completion:*:complete:-command-:*' tag-order \
				'commands functions'

		     specifies	that  completion  in  command  position	 first
		     offers external commands and shell functions.   Remaining
		     tags will be tried if no completions are found.

		     In	 addition  to  tag names, each string in the value may
		     take one of the following forms:

		     -	    If any value consists of only a hyphen, then  only
			    the	 tags specified in the other values are gener‐
			    ated.  Normally all tags not  explicitly  selected
			    are	 tried last if the specified tags fail to gen‐
			    erate any matches.	This means that a single value
			    consisting	only of a single hyphen turns off com‐
			    pletion.

		     ! tags...
			    A string starting with an exclamation mark	speci‐
			    fies  names	 of tags that are not to be used.  The
			    effect is the same as if all other	possible  tags
			    for the context had been listed.

		     tag:label ...
			    Here, tag is one of the standard tags and label is
			    an arbitrary name.	Matches are generated as  nor‐
			    mal but the name label is used in contexts instead
			    of tag.  This is not useful in words starting with
			    !.

			    If	the  label  starts  with  a hyphen, the tag is
			    prepended to the label to form the name  used  for
			    lookup.   This  can be used to make the completion
			    system try a certain tag more than once, supplying
			    different  style  settings	for  each attempt; see
			    below for an example.

		     tag:label:description
			    As before, but description will replace  the  `%d'
			    in	the  value  of the format style instead of the
			    default description	 supplied  by  the  completion
			    function.	Spaces	in  the	 description  must  be
			    quoted with a  backslash.	A  `%d'	 appearing  in
			    description is replaced with the description given
			    by the completion function.

		     In any of the forms above the tag may  be	a  pattern  or
		     several  patterns	in the form `{pat1,pat2...}'.  In this
		     case all matching tags will be used except for any	 given
		     explicitly in the same string.

		     One  use  of  these  features is to try one tag more than
		     once, setting other styles differently on	each  attempt,
		     but  still	 to  use  all the other tags without having to
		     repeat them all.  For  example,  to  make	completion  of
		     function names in command position ignore all the comple‐
		     tion functions starting with an underscore the first time
		     completion is tried:

			    zstyle ':completion:*:*:-command-:*' tag-order \
				'functions:-non-comp *' functions
			    zstyle ':completion:*:functions-non-comp' ignored-patterns '_*'

		     On	 the  first  attempt, all tags will be offered but the
		     functions tag will	 be  replaced  by  functions-non-comp.
		     The ignored-patterns style is set for this tag to exclude
		     functions starting with an underscore.  If there  are  no
		     matches,  the second value of the tag-order style is used
		     which completes functions using  the  default  tag,  this
		     time presumably including all function names.

		     The  matches  for	one  tag  can  be split into different
		     groups.  For example:

			    zstyle ':completion:*' tag-order \
				'options:-long:long\ options
				 options:-short:short\ options
				 options:-single-letter:single\ letter\ options'

			    zstyle ':completion:*:options-long' ignored-patterns '[-+](|-|[^-]*)'
			    zstyle ':completion:*:options-short' ignored-patterns '--*' '[-+]?'
			    zstyle ':completion:*:options-single-letter' ignored-patterns '???*'

		     With the group-names style set,  options  beginning  with
		     `--', options beginning with a single `-' or `+' but con‐
		     taining multiple characters,  and	single-letter  options
		     will  be  displayed  in  separate	groups	with different
		     descriptions.

		     Another use of patterns is to try multiple match specifi‐
		     cations one after another.	 The matcher-list style offers
		     something similar, but it is tested  very	early  in  the
		     completion	 system and hence can't be set for single com‐
		     mands nor for more specific contexts.  Here is how to try
		     normal completion without any match specification and, if
		     that generates no matches, try again  with	 case-insensi‐
		     tive matching, restricting the effect to arguments of the
		     command foo:

			    zstyle ':completion:*:*:foo:*' tag-order '*' '*:-case'
			    zstyle ':completion:*-case' matcher 'm:{a-z}={A-Z}'

		     First, all the tags offered when completing after foo are
		     tried  using  the	normal tag name.  If that generates no
		     matches, the second value of  tag-order  is  used,	 which
		     tries all tags again except that this time each has -case
		     appended to its name for lookup of	 styles.   Hence  this
		     time the value for the matcher style from the second call
		     to zstyle in the  example	is  used  to  make  completion
		     case-insensitive.

		     It is possible to use the -e option of the zstyle builtin
		     command to specify conditions for the use	of  particular
		     tags.  For example:

			    zstyle -e '*:-command-:*' tag-order '
				if [[ -n $PREFIX$SUFFIX ]]; then
				  reply=( )
				else
				  reply=( - )
				fi'

		     Completion	 in command position will be attempted only if
		     the string typed so far is not  empty.   This  is	tested
		     using  the PREFIX special parameter; see zshcompwid for a
		     description of parameters which are special  inside  com‐
		     pletion  widgets.	 Setting  reply to an empty array pro‐
		     vides the default behaviour of trying all tags  at	 once;
		     setting  it to an array containing only a hyphen disables
		     the use of all tags and hence of all completions.

		     If no tag-order style has been defined for a context, the
		     strings   `(|*-)argument-*	  (|*-)option-*	  values'  and
		     `options' plus all tags offered by the  completion	 func‐
		     tion  will be used to provide a sensible default behavior
		     that causes arguments (whether normal  command  arguments
		     or	 arguments  of	options) to be completed before option
		     names for most commands.

	      urls   This is used together with the the urls tag by  functions
		     completing URLs.

		     If	 the value consists of more than one string, or if the
		     only string does  not  name  a  file  or  directory,  the
		     strings are used as the URLs to complete.

		     If	 the  value contains only one string which is the name
		     of a normal file the URLs are taken from that file (where
		     the URLs may be separated by white space or newlines).

		     Finally,  if  the only string in the value names a direc‐
		     tory, the directory hierarchy rooted  at  this  directory
		     gives the completions.  The top level directory should be
		     the file access method, such as `http', `ftp', `bookmark'
		     and  so  on.  In many cases the next level of directories
		     will be a filename.  The directory hierarchy can  descend
		     as deep as necessary.

		     For example,

			    zstyle ':completion:*' urls ~/.urls
			    mkdir -p ~/.urls/ftp/ftp.zsh.org/pub/development

		     allows  completion	 of  all  the  components  of  the URL
		     ftp://ftp.zsh.org/pub/development after suitable commands
		     such as `netscape' or `lynx'.  Note, however, that access
		     methods and files are completed  separately,  so  if  the
		     hosts  style is set hosts can be completed without refer‐
		     ence to the urls style.

		     See the description in the function _urls itself for more
		     information (e.g. `more $^fpath/_urls(N)').

	      use-cache
		     If this is set, the completion caching layer is activated
		     for any completions which use it (via  the	 _store_cache,
		     _retrieve_cache,	and  _cache_invalid  functions).   The
		     directory containing the cache files can be changed  with
		     the cache-path style.

	      use-compctl
		     If	 this  style is set to a string not equal to false, 0,
		     no, and off, the completion system may use any completion
		     specifications  defined with the compctl builtin command.
		     If the style is unset, this is done only if the  zsh/com‐
		     pctl  module  is loaded.  The string may also contain the
		     substring `first' to use completions defined  with	 `com‐
		     pctl  -T', and the substring `default' to use the comple‐
		     tion defined with `compctl -D'.

		     Note that this is only intended to smooth the  transition
		     from  compctl to the new completion system and may disap‐
		     pear in the future.

		     Note also that the definitions from compctl will only  be
		     used  if there is no specific completion function for the
		     command in question.  For example, if there is a function
		     _foo  to  complete	 arguments to the command foo, compctl
		     will never be invoked for foo.  However, the compctl ver‐
		     sion will be tried if foo only uses default completion.

	      use-perl
		     Various  parts  of the function system use awk to extract
		     words from files or command output	 as  this  universally
		     available.	  However, many versions of awk have arbitrary
		     limits on the size of input.  If this style is set,  perl
		     will  be  used instead.  This is almost always preferable
		     if perl is available on your system.

		     Currently this is only used in  completions  for  `make',
		     but  it  may  be extended depending on authorial frustra‐
		     tion.

	      users  This may be set to a list of usernames to	be  completed.
		     If	 it is not set or the string on the line doesn't match
		     any of the strings in this list, all  usernames  will  be
		     completed.

	      users-hosts
		     The   values   of	this  style  should  be	 of  the  form
		     `user@host' or `user:host'. It is used for commands  that
		     need  pairs  of user- and hostnames.  These commands will
		     complete usernames	 from  this  style  (only),  and  will
		     restrict  subsequent  hostname completion to hosts paired
		     with that user in one of the values of the style.

		     It is possible to group values for sets of commands which
		     allow  a  remote  login, such as rlogin and ssh, by using
		     the my-accounts tag.  Similarly, values for sets of  com‐
		     mands  which  usually refer to the accounts of other peo‐
		     ple, such as talk and finger, can be grouped by using the
		     other-accounts tag.  More ambivalent commands may use the
		     accounts tag.

	      users-hosts-ports
		     Like users-hosts but used for commands  like  telnet  and
		     containing strings of the form `user@host:port'.

	      verbose
		     If	 set,  as  it is by default, the completion listing is
		     more verbose.  In particular many commands show  descrip‐
		     tions for options if this style is `true'.

	      word   This  is  used by the _list completer, which prevents the
		     insertion	of  completions	 until	a  second   completion
		     attempt when the line has not changed.  The normal way of
		     finding out if the line has changed  is  to  compare  its
		     entire contents between the two occasions.	 If this style
		     is true, the comparison is instead performed only on  the
		     current  word.   Hence  if	 completion  is	 performed  on
		     another word with the same contents, completion will  not
		     be delayed.

CONTROL FUNCTIONS
       The initialization script compinit redefines all the widgets which per‐
       form completion to call the supplied  widget  function  _main_complete.
       This function acts as a wrapper calling the so-called `completer' func‐
       tions that generate matches.  If _main_complete is  called  with	 argu‐
       ments, these are taken as the names of completer functions to be called
       in the order given.  If no arguments are given, the set of functions to
       try is taken from the completer style.  For example, to use normal com‐
       pletion and correction if that doesn't generate any matches:

	      zstyle ':completion:*' completer _complete _correct

       after calling compinit. The default value for this style is  `_complete
       _ignored',  i.e. normally only ordinary completion is tried, first with
       the effect of the ignored-patterns style	 and  then  without  it.   The
       _main_complete  function	 uses  the return value of the completer func‐
       tions to decide if other completers should be called.   If  the	return
       value  is  zero,	 no  other completers are tried and the _main_complete
       function returns.

       If the first argument to _main_complete is a single hyphen,  the	 argu‐
       ments  will  not	 be taken as names of completers.  Instead, the second
       argument gives a name to use in the completer field of the context  and
       the other arguments give a command name and arguments to call to gener‐
       ate the matches.

       The following completer functions are contained	in  the	 distribution,
       although	 users may write their own.  Note that in contexts the leading
       underscore is stripped, for example basic completion  is	 performed  in
       the context `:completion::complete:...'.

       _all_matches
	      This  completer  can  be	used to add a string consisting of all
	      other matches.  As it influences later completers it must appear
	      as  the first completer in the list.  The list of all matches is
	      affected by the avoid-completer and old-matches styles described
	      above.

	      It may be useful to use the _generic function described below to
	      bind _all_matches to its own keystroke, for example:

		     zle -C all-matches complete-word _generic
		     bindkey '^Xa' all-matches
		     zstyle ':completion:all-matches:*' old-matches only
		     zstyle ':completion:all-matches::::' completer _all_matches

       _approximate
	      This is similar to the basic _complete completer but allows  the
	      completions  to  undergo	corrections.   The  maximum  number of
	      errors can  be  specified	 by  the  max-errors  style;  see  the
	      description of approximate matching in zshexpn(1) for how errors
	      are counted.  Normally this completer will only be  tried	 after
	      the normal _complete completer:

		     zstyle ':completion:*' completer _complete _approximate

	      This  will give correcting completion if and only if normal com‐
	      pletion yields no possible completions.  When corrected  comple‐
	      tions  are found, the completer will normally start menu comple‐
	      tion allowing you to cycle through these strings.

	      This completer uses the tags corrections and original when  gen‐
	      erating  the  possible corrections and the original string.  The
	      format style for the former may contain the additional sequences
	      `%e'  and	 `%o'  which  will be replaced by the number of errors
	      accepted to generate the corrections and	the  original  string,
	      respectively.

	      The  completer  progressively  increases	the  number  of errors
	      allowed up to the limit by the max-errors style, hence if a com‐
	      pletion  is found with one error, no completions with two errors
	      will be shown, and so on.	 It modifies the completer name in the
	      context  to  indicate  the  number of errors being tried: on the
	      first try the completer field contains `approximate-1',  on  the
	      second try `approximate-2', and so on.

	      When _approximate is called from another function, the number of
	      errors to accept may be passed with the -a option.  The argument
	      is  in  the  same	 format	 as  the  max-errors style, all in one
	      string.

	      Note that this completer (and the _correct  completer  mentioned
	      below)  can  be quite expensive to call, especially when a large
	      number of errors are allowed.  One way to avoid this is  to  set
	      up  the  completer  style	 using the -e option to zstyle so that
	      some completers are only used when  completion  is  attempted  a
	      second time on the same string, e.g.:

		     zstyle -e ':completion:*' completer '
		       if [[ $_last_try != "$HISTNO$BUFFER$CURSOR" ]]; then
			 _last_try="$HISTNO$BUFFER$CURSOR"
			 reply=(_complete _match _prefix)
		       else
			 reply=(_ignored _correct _approximate)
		       fi'

	      This uses the HISTNO parameter and the BUFFER and CURSOR special
	      parameters that are available inside zle and completion  widgets
	      to  find	out  if the command line hasn't changed since the last
	      time completion was tried.  Only then are the _ignored, _correct
	      and _approximate completers called.

       _complete
	      This  completer  generates  all  possible	 completions in a con‐
	      text-sensitive manner, i.e. using the settings defined with  the
	      compdef function explained above and the current settings of all
	      special parameters.  This gives the normal completion behaviour.

	      To complete arguments of commands, _complete  uses  the  utility
	      function	_normal,  which is in turn responsible for finding the
	      particular function; it is described below.  Various contexts of
	      the  form -context- are handled specifically. These are all men‐
	      tioned above as possible arguments to the #compdef tag.

	      Before trying to find a function for a specific  context,	 _com‐
	      plete  checks  if	 the  parameter	 `compcontext' is set. Setting
	      `compcontext' allows the	usual  completion  dispatching	to  be
	      overridden  which	 is  useful  in places such as a function that
	      uses vared for input. If it is set to an array, the elements are
	      taken  to	 be the possible matches which will be completed using
	      the tag `values' and the description `value'. If it is set to an
	      associative array, the keys are used as the possible completions
	      and the values (if non-empty) are used as descriptions  for  the
	      matches.	If `compcontext' is set to a string containing colons,
	      it should be of the form `tag:descr:action'.  In this  case  the
	      tag and descr give the tag and description to use and the action
	      indicates what should be completed in one of the forms  accepted
	      by the _arguments utility function described below.

	      Finally, if `compcontext' is set to a string without colons, the
	      value is taken as the name of the context to use and  the	 func‐
	      tion defined for that context will be called.  For this purpose,
	      there is a special context named -command-line-  that  completes
	      whole command lines (commands and their arguments).  This is not
	      used by the completion system itself but is nonetheless  handled
	      when explicitly called.

       _correct
	      Generate corrections, but not completions, for the current word;
	      this is similar to _approximate but will not allow any number of
	      extra  characters	 at  the  cursor  as that completer does.  The
	      effect is similar to spell-checking.  It is based	 on  _approxi‐
	      mate, but the completer field in the context name is correct.

	      For example, with:

		     zstyle ':completion:::::' completer _complete _correct _approximate
		     zstyle ':completion:*:correct:::' max-errors 2 not-numeric
		     zstyle ':completion:*:approximate:::' max-errors 3 numeric

	      correction  will accept up to two errors.	 If a numeric argument
	      is given, correction will not be performed, but correcting  com‐
	      pletion  will be, and will accept as many errors as given by the
	      numeric argument.	 Without a numeric argument, first  correction
	      and then correcting completion will be tried, with the first one
	      accepting two errors and the second one accepting three errors.

	      When _correct is called as a function, the number of  errors  to
	      accept may be given following the -a option.  The argument is in
	      the same form a values to the accept style, all in one string.

	      This completer function is  intended  to	be  used  without  the
	      _approximate  completer  or,  as in the example, just before it.
	      Using it after  the  _approximate	 completer  is	useless	 since
	      _approximate will at least generate the corrected strings gener‐
	      ated by the _correct completer -- and probably more.

       _expand
	      This completer function does not really perform completion,  but
	      instead  checks  if the word on the command line is eligible for
	      expansion and, if it is, gives detailed control  over  how  this
	      expansion	 is  done.   For this to happen, the completion system
	      needs to be invoked with complete-word,  not  expand-or-complete
	      (the  default  binding for TAB), as otherwise the string will be
	      expanded by the shell's internal mechanism before the completion
	      system  is  started.   Note also this completer should be called
	      before the _complete completer function.

	      The tags used when generating expansions are all-expansions  for
	      the  string  containing all possible expansions, expansions when
	      adding the possible expansions as single	matches	 and  original
	      when  adding  the	 original  string from the line.  The order in
	      which these strings are generated, if at all, can be  controlled
	      by the group-order and tag-order styles, as usual.

	      The format string for all-expansions and for expansions may con‐
	      tain the sequence `%o' which will be replaced  by	 the  original
	      string from the line.

	      The  kind	 of expansion to be tried is controlled by the substi‐
	      tute, glob and subst-globs-only styles.

	      It is also possible to call _expand as a function, in which case
	      the different modes may be selected with options: -s for substi‐
	      tute, -g for glob and -o for subst-globs-only.

       _expand_alias
	      If the word the cursor is on is an alias, it is expanded and  no
	      other  completers are called.  The types of aliases which are to
	      be expanded can be controlled with the  styles  regular,	global
	      and disabled.

	      This function is also a bindable command, see the section `Bind‐
	      able Commands' below.

       _history
	      Complete words from the shell's  command	 history.   This  com‐
	      pleter can be controlled by the remove-all-dups, and sort styles
	      as for the _history_complete_word bindable command, see the sec‐
	      tion  `Bindable Commands' below and the section `Completion Sys‐
	      tem Configuration' above.

       _ignored
	      The ignored-patterns style can be set  to	 a  list  of  patterns
	      which  are  compared against possible completions; matching ones
	      are removed.  With this completer those  matches	can  be	 rein‐
	      stated, as if no ignored-patterns style were set.	 The completer
	      actually generates its own list of matches; which completers are
	      invoked  is  determined  in the same way as for the _prefix com‐
	      pleter.  The single-ignored style is also available as described
	      above.

       _list  This  completer  allows  the  insertion of matches to be delayed
	      until completion is attempted a second time without the word  on
	      the  line being changed.	On the first attempt, only the list of
	      matches will be shown.  It is affected by the  styles  condition
	      and  word,  see  the  section  `Completion System Configuration'
	      above.

       _match This completer is intended to be used after the  _complete  com‐
	      pleter.  It behaves similarly but the string on the command line
	      may be a pattern to match against trial completions.  This gives
	      the effect of the GLOB_COMPLETE option.

	      Normally completion will be performed by taking the pattern from
	      the line, inserting a `*' at the cursor position	and  comparing
	      the  resulting  pattern with the possible completions generated.
	      This can be modified with	 the  match-original  style  described
	      above.

	      The  generated  matches  will  be	 offered  in a menu completion
	      unless the insert-unambiguous style is set to  `true';  see  the
	      description above for other options for this style.

	      Note that matcher specifications defined globally or used by the
	      completion functions (the styles matcher-list and matcher)  will
	      not be used.

       _menu  This  completer  was  written as simple example function to show
	      how menu completion can be enabled in shell  code.  However,  it
	      has  the notable effect of disabling menu selection which can be
	      useful with _generic based widgets. It should  be	 used  as  the
	      first  completer	in the list.  Note that this is independent of
	      the setting of the MENU_COMPLETE option and does not  work  with
	      the other menu completion widgets such as reverse-menu-complete,
	      or accept-and-menu-complete.

       _oldlist
	      This completer controls  how  the	 standard  completion  widgets
	      behave  when  there is an existing list of completions which may
	      have been generated  by  a  special  completion  (i.e.  a	 sepa‐
	      rately-bound  completion	command).  It allows the ordinary com‐
	      pletion keys to continue to use the  list	 of  completions  thus
	      generated,  instead  of producing a new list of ordinary contex‐
	      tual completions.	 It should appear in the  list	of  completers
	      before  any  of the widgets which generate matches.  It uses two
	      styles: old-list and old-menu, see the section `Completion  Sys‐
	      tem Configuration' above.

       _prefix
	      This  completer  can  be	used to try completion with the suffix
	      (everything after the cursor) ignored.  In other words, the suf‐
	      fix  will	 not be considered to be part of the word to complete.
	      The effect is similar to the expand-or-complete-prefix command.

	      The completer style is used to decide which other completers are
	      to  be  called to generate matches.  If this style is unset, the
	      list of completers set  for  the	current	 context  is  used  --
	      except,  of  course, the _prefix completer itself.  Furthermore,
	      if this completer appears more than once in  the	list  of  com‐
	      pleters  only  those  completers	not  already tried by the last
	      invocation of _prefix will be called.

	      For example, consider this global completer style:

		     zstyle ':completion:*' completer \
			 _complete _prefix _correct _prefix:foo

	      Here, the _prefix completer tries normal completion but ignoring
	      the  suffix.   If that doesn't generate any matches, and neither
	      does the call to the _correct completer after it,	 _prefix  will
	      be called a second time and, now only trying correction with the
	      suffix ignored.  On the second invocation the completer part  of
	      the context appears as `foo'.

	      To use _prefix as the last resort and try only normal completion
	      when it is invoked:

		     zstyle ':completion:*' completer _complete ... _prefix
		     zstyle ':completion::prefix:*' completer _complete

	      The add-space style is also respected.  If it is set  to	`true'
	      then  _prefix  will insert a space between the matches generated
	      (if any) and the suffix.

	      Note that this completer is only useful if the  COMPLETE_IN_WORD
	      option is set; otherwise, the cursor will be moved to the end of
	      the current word before the completion code is called and	 hence
	      there will be no suffix.

       bashcompinit
	      This  function  provides	compatibility with bash's programmable
	      completion system.  When run it will define the functions, comp‐
	      gen  and complete which correspond to the bash builtins with the
	      same names.  It will then be possible to use completion specifi‐
	      cations and functions written for bash.

BINDABLE COMMANDS
       In  addition  to	 the context-dependent completions provided, which are
       expected to work in an intuitively obvious way, there are a few widgets
       implementing  special  behaviour which can be bound separately to keys.
       The following is a list of these and their default bindings.

       _bash_completions
	      This function is used by two  widgets,  _bash_complete-word  and
	      _bash_list-choices.   It	exists	to  provide compatibility with
	      completion bindings in bash.  The last character of the  binding
	      determines  what is completed: `!', command names; `$', environ‐
	      ment variables; `@', host	 names;	 `/',  file  names;  `~'  user
	      names.   In bash, the binding preceded by `\e' gives completion,
	      and preceded by `^X' lists options.  As some of  these  bindings
	      clash with standard zsh bindings, only `\e~' and `^X~' are bound
	      by default.  To add the rest, the following should be  added  to
	      .zshrc after compinit has been run:

		     for key in '!' '$' '@' '/' '~'; do
		       bindkey "\e$key" _bash_complete-word
		       bindkey "^X$key" _bash_list-choices
		     done

	      This  includes  the  bindings  for `~' in case they were already
	      bound to something else; the completion code does	 not  override
	      user bindings.

       _correct_filename (^XC)
	      Correct  the filename path at the cursor position.  Allows up to
	      six errors in the name.  Can also be called with an argument  to
	      correct a filename path, independently of zle; the correction is
	      printed on standard output.

       _correct_word (^Xc)
	      Performs correction of the current argument using the usual con‐
	      textual  completions as possible choices. This stores the string
	      `correct-word' in the function field of  the  context  name  and
	      then calls the _correct completer.

       _expand_alias (^Xa)
	      This  function can be used as a completer and as a bindable com‐
	      mand.  It expands the word the cursor is on if it is  an	alias.
	      The  types  of  alias expanded can be controlled with the styles
	      regular, global and disabled.

	      When used as a bindable command there is one additional  feature
	      that  can	 be  selected by setting the complete style to `true'.
	      In this case,  if	 the  word  is	not  the  name	of  an	alias,
	      _expand_alias  tries  to	complete the word to a full alias name
	      without expanding it.  It leaves the cursor directly  after  the
	      completed	 word  so  that	 invoking _expand_alias once more will
	      expand the now-complete alias name.

       _expand_word (^Xe)
	      Performs expansion on the current word:  equivalent to the stan‐
	      dard  expand-word	 command,  but	using  the  _expand completer.
	      Before calling it, the function field of the context is  set  to
	      `expand-word'.

       _generic
	      This  function  is  not  defined	as  a  widget and not bound by
	      default.	However, it can be used to define a  widget  and  will
	      then  store  the name of the widget in the function field of the
	      context and call the completion system.  This allows custom com‐
	      pletion  widgets	with  their  own  set  of style settings to be
	      defined easily.  For example, to define a widget	that  performs
	      normal completion and starts menu selection:

		     zle -C foo complete-word _generic
		     bindkey '...' foo
		     zstyle ':completion:foo:*' menu yes select=1

       _history_complete_word (\e/)
	      Complete	words  from the shell's command history. This uses the
	      list, remove-all-dups, sort, and stop styles.

       _most_recent_file (^Xm)
	      Complete the name of the most recently  modified	file  matching
	      the  pattern on the command line (which may be blank).  If given
	      a numeric argument N, complete the Nth  most  recently  modified
	      file.  Note the completion, if any, is always unique.

       _next_tags (^Xn)
	      This command alters the set of matches used to that for the next
	      tag, or set of tags, either as given by the tag-order  style  or
	      as  set  by default; these matches would otherwise not be avail‐
	      able.  Successive invocations of the command cycle  through  all
	      possible sets of tags.

       _read_comp (^X^R)
	      Prompt the user for a string, and use that to perform completion
	      on the current  word.   There  are  two  possibilities  for  the
	      string.	First,	it  can	 be  a set of words beginning `_', for
	      example `_files -/', in which case the function with  any	 argu‐
	      ments  will  be called to generate the completions.  Unambiguous
	      parts of the function name will be completed automatically (nor‐
	      mal  completion is not available at this point) until a space is
	      typed.

	      Second, any other string will be passed as a set of arguments to
	      compadd and should hence be an expression specifying what should
	      be completed.

	      A very restricted set of	editing	 commands  is  available  when
	      reading  the  string:  `DEL' and `^H' delete the last character;
	      `^U' deletes the line, and `^C' and  `^G'	 abort	the  function,
	      while  `RET'  accepts  the  completion.  Note the string is used
	      verbatim as a command line,  so  arguments  must	be  quoted  in
	      accordance with standard shell rules.

	      Once  a  string  has been read, the next call to _read_comp will
	      use the existing string instead of reading a new one.  To	 force
	      a	 new  string  to be read, call _read_comp with a numeric argu‐
	      ment.

       _complete_debug (^X?)
	      This widget performs ordinary completion, but captures in a tem‐
	      porary  file  a trace of the shell commands executed by the com‐
	      pletion system.  Each completion attempt gets its own  file.   A
	      command  to  view	 each of these files is pushed onto the editor
	      buffer stack.

       _complete_help (^Xh)
	      This widget displays information about the  context  names,  the
	      tags,  and  the completion functions used when completing at the
	      current cursor position. If given a numeric argument other  than
	      1 (as in `ESC-2 ^Xh'), then the styles used and the contexts for
	      which they are used will be shown, too.

	      Note that the information about styles  may  be  incomplete;  it
	      depends  on  the information available from the completion func‐
	      tions called, which in turn is  determined  by  the  user's  own
	      styles and other settings.

       _complete_tag (^Xt)
	      This  widget completes symbol tags created by the etags or ctags
	      programmes (note there is no connection with the completion sys‐
	      tem's  tags) stored in a file TAGS, in the format used by etags,
	      or tags, in the format created by ctags.	It will look  back  up
	      the  path	 hierarchy for the first occurrence of either file; if
	      both exist, the file TAGS is preferred.	You  can  specify  the
	      full path to a TAGS or tags file by setting the parameter $TAGS‐
	      FILE or $tagsfile respectively.	The  corresponding  completion
	      tags used are etags and vtags, after emacs and vi respectively.

UTILITY FUNCTIONS
       Descriptions follow for utility functions that may be useful when writ‐
       ing completion functions.  If functions are  installed  in  subdirecto‐
       ries,  most of these reside in the Base subdirectory.  Like the example
       functions for commands in the distribution, the utility functions  gen‐
       erating	matches	 all  follow  the convention of returning zero if they
       generated completions and non-zero if no matching completions could  be
       added.

       Two  more  features  are	 offered  by the _main_complete function.  The
       arrays compprefuncs and comppostfuncs may contain  names	 of  functions
       that  are  to be called immediately before or after completion has been
       tried.  A function will only be called once unless it explicitly	 rein‐
       serts itself into the array.

       _all_labels [ -x ] [ -12VJ ] tag name descr [ command args ... ]
	      This  is	a  convenient  interface  to  the _next_label function
	      below, implementing the loop shown in the	 _next_label  example.
	      The  command  and	 its  arguments	 are  called  to  generate the
	      matches.	The options stored in the parameter name will automat‐
	      ically  be  inserted  into the args passed to the command.  Nor‐
	      mally, they are put directly after the command, but  if  one  of
	      the  args	 is a single hyphen, they are inserted directly before
	      that.  If the hyphen is the last argument, it  will  be  removed
	      from  the	 argument  list	 before	 the  command is called.  This
	      allows _all_labels to be used in	almost	all  cases  where  the
	      matches can be generated by a single call to the compadd builtin
	      command or by a call to one of the utility functions.

	      For example:

		     local expl
		     ...
		     if _requested foo; then
		       ...
		       _all_labels foo expl '...' compadd ... - $matches
		     fi

	      Will complete the strings from the matches parameter, using com‐
	      padd  with  additional  options  which will take precedence over
	      those generated by _all_labels.

       _alternative [ -C name ] spec ...
	      This function is useful in simple cases where multiple tags  are
	      available.   Essentially	it  implements	a  loop	 like  the one
	      described for the _tags function below.

	      The tags to use and the action to perform if a tag is  requested
	      are   described	using	the  specs  which  are	of  the	 form:
	      `tag:descr:action'.  The tags are offered using _tags and if the
	      tag is requested, the action is executed with the given descrip‐
	      tion descr.  The actions are those accepted  by  the  _arguments
	      function	(described  below), excluding the `->state' and `=...'
	      forms.

	      For example, the action may be a simple function call:

		     _alternative \
			 'users:user:_users' \
			 'hosts:host:_hosts'

	      offers usernames and hostnames as possible matches, generated by
	      the _users and _hosts functions respectively.

	      Like  _arguments, this functions uses _all_labels to execute the
	      actions, which will loop over all sets of	 tags.	 Special  han‐
	      dling  is only required if there is an additional valid tag, for
	      example inside a function called from _alternative.

	      Like _tags this function supports the -C option to give  a  dif‐
	      ferent name for the argument context field.

       _arguments [ -swWACRS ] [ -O name ] [ -M matchspec ] [ : ] spec ...
	      This  function  can be used to give a complete specification for
	      completion for a command whose arguments	follow	standard  UNIX
	      option  and  argument  conventions.  The following forms specify
	      individual sets of options and arguments;	 to  avoid  ambiguity,
	      these  may be separated from the options to _arguments itself by
	      a single colon.

	      n:message:action
	      n::message:action
		     This describes the n'th  normal  argument.	  The  message
		     will  be  printed	above  the  matches  generated and the
		     action indicates what can be completed in	this  position
		     (see  below).  If there are two colons before the message
		     the argument is optional.	If the message	contains  only
		     white  space,  nothing  will be printed above the matches
		     unless the action adds an explanation string itself.

	      :message:action
	      ::message:action
		     Similar, but describes the next argument, whatever number
		     that  happens  to	be.  If all arguments are specified in
		     this form in the correct order the numbers	 are  unneces‐
		     sary.

	      *:message:action
	      *::message:action
	      *:::message:action
		     This  describes  how  arguments (usually non-option argu‐
		     ments, those not beginning with - or +) are  to  be  com‐
		     pleted  when neither of the first two forms was provided.
		     Any number of arguments can be completed in this fashion.

		     With two colons before the	 message,  the	words  special
		     array  and	 the CURRENT special parameter are modified to
		     refer only to the normal arguments	 when  the  action  is
		     executed or evaluated.  With three colons before the mes‐
		     sage they are modified to refer only to the normal	 argu‐
		     ments covered by this description.

	      optspec
	      optspec:...
		     This  describes  an option.  The colon indicates handling
		     for one or more arguments to the option;  if  it  is  not
		     present, the option is assumed to take no arguments.

		     By default, options are multi-character name, one `-word'
		     per option.  With -s, options may be  single  characters,
		     with more than one option per word, although words start‐
		     ing with two hyphens, such as `--prefix', are still  con‐
		     sidered  complete	option	names.	 This  is suitable for
		     standard GNU options.

		     The  combination  of  -s  with  -w	 allows	 single-letter
		     options  to  be  combined in a single word even if one or
		     more of the options take arguments.  For example,	if  -a
		     takes  an	argument,  with no -s `-ab' is considered as a
		     single (unhandled) option; with -s -ab is an option  with
		     the  argument  `b';  with	both -s and -w, -ab may be the
		     option -a and the	option(-b)  with  arguments  still  to
		     come.

		     The option -W takes this a stage further:	it is possible
		     to complete single-letter options even after an  argument
		     that occurs in the same word.  However, it depends on the
		     action performed whether options will really be completed
		     at	 this point.  For more control, use a utility function
		     like _guard as part of the action.

		     The following forms are available for  the	 initial  opt‐
		     spec, whether or not the option has arguments.

		     *optspec
			    Here  optspec is one of the remaining forms below.
			    This  indicates  the  following  optspec  may   be
			    repeated.	Otherwise  if the corresponding option
			    is already present on the command line to the left
			    of the cursor it will not be offered again.

		     -optname
		     +optname
			    In	the  simplest  form  the  optspec  is just the
			    option name beginning with a minus or a plus sign,
			    such as `-foo'.  The first argument for the option
			    (if any) must follow as a separate	word  directly
			    after the option.

			    Either  of `-+optname' and `+-optname' can be used
			    to specify that -optname  and  +optname  are  both
			    valid.

			    In all the remaining forms, the leading `-' may be
			    replaced by or paired with `+' in this way.

		     -optname-
			    The	 first	argument  of  the  option  must	  come
			    directly  after  the option name in the same word.
			    For example, `-foo-:...' specifies that  the  com‐
			    pleted   option   and   argument  will  look  like
			    `-fooarg'.

		     -optname+
			    The first argument may  appear  immediately	 after
			    optname in the same word, or may appear as a sepa‐
			    rate  word	after  the   option.	For   example,
			    `-foo+:...'	 specifies  that  the completed option
			    and argument will look like	 either	 `-fooarg'  or
			    `-foo arg'.

		     -optname=
			    The	 argument  may	appear as the next word, or in
			    same word as the option name provided that	it  is
			    separated  from  it by an equals sign, for example
			    `-foo=arg' or `-foo arg'.

		     -optname=-
			    The argument to the option must  appear  after  an
			    equals sign in the same word, and may not be given
			    in the next argument.

		     optspec[explanation]
			    An explanation string may be appended  to  any  of
			    the	 preceding forms of optspec by enclosing it in
			    brackets, as in `-q[query operation]'.

			    The verbose style is used to  decide  whether  the
			    explanation	 strings are displayed with the option
			    in a completion listing.

			    If no bracketed explanation string	is  given  but
			    the	 auto-description  style  is  set and only one
			    argument is described for this optspec, the	 value
			    of	the style is displayed, with any appearance of
			    the sequence `%d' in it replaced by the message of
			    the	 first	optarg	that  follows the optspec; see
			    below.

	      It is possible for options with a literal `+' or `=' to  appear,
	      but that character must be quoted, for example `-\+'.

	      Each  optarg following an optspec must take one of the following
	      forms:

	      :message:action
	      ::message:action
		     An argument to the option; message and action are treated
		     as	 for ordinary arguments.  In the first form, the argu‐
		     ment is mandatory, and in the second form it is optional.

		     This group may be repeated for options which take	multi‐
		     ple  arguments.   In  other words, :message1:action1:mes‐
		     sage2:action2 specifies that the option takes  two	 argu‐
		     ments.

	      :*pattern:message:action
	      :*pattern::message:action
	      :*pattern:::message:action
		     This  describes multiple arguments.  Only the last optarg
		     for an option taking multiple arguments may be  given  in
		     this  form.  If the pattern is empty (i.e., :*:), all the
		     remaining words on	 the  line  are	 to  be	 completed  as
		     described by the action; otherwise, all the words up to a
		     word matching the pattern are to be completed  using  the
		     action.

		     Multiple  colons are treated as for the `*:...' forms for
		     ordinary arguments:  when the message is preceded by  two
		     colons,  the  words special array and the CURRENT special
		     parameter are modified during the execution or evaluation
		     of	 the  action  to  refer	 only  to  the words after the
		     option.  When preceded by three colons, they are modified
		     to refer only to the words covered by this description.

       Any literal colon in an optname, message, or action must be preceded by
       a backslash, `\:'.

       Each of the forms above may be preceded by a  list  in  parentheses  of
       option  names and argument numbers.  If the given option is on the com‐
       mand line, the options and arguments indicated in parentheses will  not
       be  offered.   For  example,  `(-two  -three  1)-one:...' completes the
       option `-one'; if this appears on the command line,  the	 options  -two
       and  -three and the first ordinary argument will not be completed after
       it.  `(-foo):...' specifies an ordinary argument completion; -foo  will
       not be completed if that argument is already present.

       Other items may appear in the list of excluded options to indicate var‐
       ious other items that should not be applied when the current specifica‐
       tion is matched: a single star (*) for the rest arguments (i.e. a spec‐
       ification  of  the  form	 `*:...');  a  colon  (:)   for	  all	normal
       (non-option-)  arguments;  and a hyphen (-) for all options.  For exam‐
       ple, if `(*)' appears before an option and the option  appears  on  the
       command line, the list of remaining arguments (those shown in the above
       table beginning with `*:') will not be completed.

       To aid in reuse of specifications, it is possible to precede any of the
       forms  above  with  `!';	 then  the  form  will no longer be completed,
       although if the option or argument appears on  the  command  line  they
       will be skipped as normal.  The main use for this is when the arguments
       are given by an array, and _arguments is	 called	 repeatedly  for  more
       specific	 contexts:  on	the first call `_arguments $global_options' is
       used, and on subsequent calls `_arguments !$^global_options'.

       In each of the forms above the action determines how completions should
       be generated.  Except for the `->string' form below, the action will be
       executed by calling the _all_labels function to process all tag labels.
       No special handling of tags is needed unless a function call introduces
       a new one.

       The forms for action are as follows.

	 (single unquoted space)
	      This is useful where an argument is required but it is not  pos‐
	      sible or desirable to generate matches for it.  The message will
	      be displayed but no completions listed.  Note that even in  this
	      case  the colon at the end of the message is needed; it may only
	      be omitted when neither a message nor an action is given.

       (item1 item2 ...)
	      One of a list of possible matches, for example:

		     :foo:(foo bar baz)

       ((item1\:desc1 ...))
	      Similar to the above, but with descriptions  for	each  possible
	      match.  Note the backslash before the colon.  For example,

		     :foo:((a\:bar b\:baz))

	      The  matches  will be listed together with their descriptions if
	      the description style is set with the values tag in the context.

       ->string
	      In this form, _arguments processes the arguments and options and
	      then returns control to the calling function with parameters set
	      to indicate the state of processing; the calling	function  then
	      makes  its  own  arrangements  for  generating completions.  For
	      example, functions that implement a state machine can  use  this
	      type of action.

	      Where  _arguments	 encounters  a	`->string',  it will strip all
	      leading and trailing whitespace from string and  set  the	 array
	      state  to	 the  set of all stringss for which an action is to be
	      performed.

	      By default and in common with all other well behaved  completion
	      functions, _arguments returns zero if it was able to add matches
	      and non-zero otherwise. However, if  the	-R  option  is	given,
	      _arguments  will instead return a status of 300 to indicate that
	      $state is to be handled.

	      In addition to $state, _arguments also sets the  global  parame‐
	      ters  `context',	`line'	and `opt_args' as described below, and
	      does not reset any changes made to the special  parameters  such
	      as PREFIX and words.  This gives the calling function the choice
	      of resetting these parameters or propagating changes in them.

	      A function calling _arguments with at least one action  contain‐
	      ing a `->string' therefore must declare appropriate local param‐
	      eters:

		     local context state line
		     typeset -A opt_args

	      to avoid _arguments from altering the global environment.

       {eval-string}
	      A string in braces  is  evaluated	 as  shell  code  to  generate
	      matches.	If the eval-string itself does not begin with an open‐
	      ing parenthesis or brace it is split into separate words	before
	      execution.

       = action
	      If  the  action  starts  with `= ' (an equals sign followed by a
	      space), _arguments will insert  the  contents  of	 the  argument
	      field  of	 the  current  context as the new first element in the
	      words special array and increment the value of the CURRENT  spe‐
	      cial  parameter.	 This has the effect of inserting a dummy word
	      onto the completion command line while not changing the point at
	      which completion is taking place.

	      This is most useful with one of the specifiers that restrict the
	      words on the command line on which the action is to operate (the
	      two-  and	 three-colon forms above).  One particular use is when
	      an action itself causes _arguments on a restricted range; it  is
	      necessary	 to  use  this	trick to insert an appropriate command
	      name into the range for the second call to _arguments to be able
	      to parse the line.

	word...
       word...
	      This  covers  all	 forms	other than those above.	 If the action
	      starts with a space, the remaining list of words will be invoked
	      unchanged.

	      Otherwise	 it  will  be  invoked	with some extra strings placed
	      after the first word; these are to be passed down as options  to
	      the  compadd  builtin.   They ensure that the state specified by
	      _arguments, in particular the descriptions of options and	 argu‐
	      ments,  is  correctly  passed  to the completion command.	 These
	      additional arguments are taken from the array parameter  `expl';
	      this will be set up before executing the action and hence may be
	      referred to inside it, typically in an  expansion	 of  the  form
	      `$expl[@]' which preserves empty elements of the array.

       During  the  performance	 of the action the array `line' will be set to
       the command name and normal arguments from the command line,  i.e.  the
       words  from the command line excluding all options and their arguments.
       Options are stored in the  associative  array  `opt_args'  with	option
       names as keys and their arguments as the values.	 For options that have
       more than one argument these are given  as  one	string,	 separated  by
       colons.	 All  colons in the original arguments are preceded with back‐
       slashes.

       The parameter `context' is set when returning to the  calling  function
       to  perform an action of the form `->string'.  It is set to an array of
       elements corresponding to the elements of $state.  Each	element	 is  a
       suitable name for the argument field of the context: either a string of
       the form `option-opt-n' for the n'th argument of the option -opt, or  a
       string  of  the	form  `argument-n'  for the n'th argument.  For `rest'
       arguments, that is those in the list at the end not  handled  by	 posi‐
       tion,  n	 is the string `rest'.	For example, when completing the argu‐
       ment of the -o option, the name is `option-o-1', while for  the	second
       normal (non-option-) argument it is `argument-2'.

       Furthermore,  during  the  evaluation of the action the context name in
       the curcontext parameter is altered to append the same string  that  is
       stored in the context parameter.

       It  is  possible to specify multiple sets of options and arguments with
       the sets separated by single hyphens.  The  specifications  before  the
       first  hyphen (if any) are shared by all the remaining sets.  The first
       word in every other set provides a name for the set which may appear in
       exclusion  lists	 in  specifications, either alone or before one of the
       possible values described above.	 In  the  second  case	a  `-'	should
       appear between this name and the remainder.

       For example:

	      _arguments \
		  -a \
		- set1 \
		  -c \
		- set2 \
		  -d \
		  ':arg:(x2 y2)'

       This defines two sets.  When the command line contains the option `-c',
       the `-d' option and the argument will not be considered	possible  com‐
       pletions.   When	 it contains `-d' or an argument, the option `-c' will
       not be considered.  However, after `-a' both sets will still be consid‐
       ered valid.

       If the name given for one of the mutually exclusive sets is of the form
       `(name)' then only one value from each set will ever be completed; more
       formally, all specifications are mutually exclusive to all other speci‐
       fications in the same set.  This is useful for defining	multiple  sets
       of  options  which  are mutually exclusive and in which the options are
       aliases for each other.	For example:

	      _arguments \
		  -a -b \
		- '(compress)' \
		  {-c,--compress}'[compress]' \
		- '(uncompress)' \
		  {-d,--decompress}'[decompress]'

       As the completion code has to parse the	command	 line  separately  for
       each  set  this	form  of argument is slow and should only be used when
       necessary.  A useful alternative is often an option specification  with
       rest-arguments  (as  in `-foo:*:...'); here the option -foo swallows up
       all remaining arguments as described by the optarg definitions.

       The options -S and -A are available to simplify the specifications  for
       commands with standard option parsing.  With -S, no option will be com‐
       pleted after a `--' appearing on its own on  the	 line;	this  argument
       will otherwise be ignored; hence in the line

	      foobar -a -- -b

       the  `-a'  is  considered an option but the `-b' is considered an argu‐
       ment, while the `--' is considered to be neither.

       With -A, no options will be completed after the first non-option	 argu‐
       ment  on	 the  line.  The -A must be followed by a pattern matching all
       strings which are not to be taken as arguments.	For example,  to  make
       _arguments stop completing options after the first normal argument, but
       ignoring all strings starting with  a  hyphen  even  if	they  are  not
       described by one of the optspecs, the form is `-A "-*"'.

       The option `-O name' specifies the name of an array whose elements will
       be passed as arguments to functions called  to  execute	actions.   For
       example,	 this can be used to pass the same set of options for the com‐
       padd builtin to all actions.

       The option `-M spec' sets a match specification to  use	to  completion
       option  names  and  values.   It	 must appear before the first argument
       specification.  The default is `r:|[_-]=* r:|=*': this  allows  partial
       word  completion after `_' and `-', for example `-f-b' can be completed
       to `-foo-bar'.

       The option -C tells _arguments to modify the curcontext	parameter  for
       an  action  of the form `->state'.  This is the standard parameter used
       to keep track of the current context.  Here it  (and  not  the  context
       array)  should  be  made local to the calling function to avoid passing
       back the modified value and should be initialised to the current	 value
       at the start of the function:

	      local curcontext="$curcontext"

       This is useful where it is not possible for multiple states to be valid
       together.

       The option `--' allows _arguments to work out the names of long options
       that  support  the  `--help'  option which is standard in many GNU com‐
       mands.  The command word is called with the argument `--help'  and  the
       output examined for option names.  Clearly, it can be dangerous to pass
       this to commands which may not support this option as the behaviour  of
       the command is unspecified.

       In addition to options, `_arguments --' will try to deduce the types of
       arguments available for options when the form `--opt=val' is valid.  It
       is  also	 possible  to  provide hints by examining the help text of the
       command and adding specifiers  of  the  form  `pattern:message:action';
       note  that  normal  _arguments specifiers are not used.	The pattern is
       matched against the help text for an option, and if it matches the mes‐
       sage  and  action are used as for other argument specifiers.  For exam‐
       ple:

	      _arguments -- '*\*:toggle:(yes no)' \
			    '*=FILE*:file:_files' \
			    '*=DIR*:directory:_files -/' \
			    '*=PATH*:directory:_files -/'

       Here, `yes' and `no' will be completed as the argument of options whose
       description  ends  in  a star; file names will be completed for options
       that contain the substring `=FILE' in the description; and  directories
       will  be	 completed  for	 options  whose description contains `=DIR' or
       `=PATH'.	 The last three are in fact the default and  so	 need  not  be
       given  explicitly, although it is possible to override the use of these
       patterns.  A typical help text which uses this feature is:

		-C, --directory=DIR	     change to directory DIR

       so that the above specifications will cause directories to be completed
       after `--directory', though not after `-C'.

       Note  also that _arguments tries to find out automatically if the argu‐
       ment for an option is optional.	This can be  specified	explicitly  by
       doubling the colon before the message.

       If  the	pattern	 ends in `(-)', this will removed from the pattern and
       the action will be used only directly after the `=', not	 in  the  next
       word.  This is the behaviour of a normal specification defined with the
       form `=-'.

       The `_arguments --' can be followed by the option `-i patterns' to give
       patterns	 for  options which are not to be completed.  The patterns can
       be given as the name of an array parameter or  as  a  literal  list  in
       parentheses.  For example,

	      _arguments -- -i \
		  "(--(en|dis)able-FEATURE*)"

       will  cause  completion	to  ignore  the options `--enable-FEATURE' and
       `--disable-FEATURE' (this example is useful with GNU configure).

       The `_arguments --' form can also be followed by the option  `-s	 pair'
       to  describe  option  aliases.	Each  pair consists of a pattern and a
       replacement.  For example, some configure-scripts describe options only
       as  `--enable-foo',  but also accept `--disable-foo'.  To allow comple‐
       tion of the second form:

	      _arguments -- -s "(#--enable- --disable-)"

       Here is a more general example of the use of _arguments:

	      _arguments '-l+:left border:' \
			 '-format:paper size:(letter A4)' \
			 '*-copy:output file:_files::resolution:(300 600)' \
			 ':postscript file:_files -g \*.\(ps\|eps\)' \
			 '*:page number:'

       This describes three options: `-l', `-format', and `-copy'.  The	 first
       takes  one  argument described as `left border' for which no completion
       will be offered because of the empty action.   Its  argument  may  come
       directly	 after	the  `-l'  or  it may be given as the next word on the
       line.

       The `-format' option takes one argument in the next word, described  as
       `paper  size' for which only the strings `letter' and `A4' will be com‐
       pleted.

       The `-copy' option may appear more than once on the  command  line  and
       takes two arguments.  The first is mandatory and will be completed as a
       filename.  The second is optional (because of the second	 colon	before
       the  description	 `resolution')	and will be completed from the strings
       `300' and `600'.

       The last two descriptions say what should be  completed	as  arguments.
       The first describes the first argument as a `postscript file' and makes
       files ending in `ps' or `eps' be completed.  The last description gives
       all  other  arguments the description `page numbers' but does not offer
       completions.

       _cache_invalid cache_identifier
	      This function returns status zero if the completions cache  cor‐
	      responding  to  the given cache identifier needs rebuilding.  It
	      determines this by looking up the	 cache-policy  style  for  the
	      current  context.	  This should provide a function name which is
	      run with the full path to the relevant cache file	 as  the  only
	      argument.

	      Example:

		     _example_caching_policy () {
			 # rebuild if cache is more than a week old
			 oldp=( "$1"(Nmw+1) )
			 (( $#oldp ))
		     }

       _call_function return name [ args ... ]
	      If a function name exists, it is called with the arguments args.
	      The return argument gives the name of a parameter in  which  the
	      return  status  from  the function name; if return is empty or a
	      single hyphen it is ignored.

	      The return value of _call_function itself is zero if  the	 func‐
	      tion name exists and was called and non-zero otherwise.

       _call_program tag string ...
	      This  function provides a mechanism for the user to override the
	      use of an external command.  It looks up the command style  with
	      the supplied tag.	 If the style is set, its value is used as the
	      command to execute.  The strings from the call to _call_program,
	      or  from	the style if set, are concatenated with spaces between
	      them and the resulting string is evaluated.  The return value is
	      the return value of the command called.

       _combination [ -s pattern ] tag style spec ... field opts ...
	      This  function  is used to complete combinations of values,  for
	      example pairs of hostnames and usernames.	  The  style  argument
	      gives  the  style	 which defines the pairs; it is looked up in a
	      context with the tag specified.

	      The style name consists of field names separated by hyphens, for
	      example  `users-hosts-ports'.   For  each	 field	for a value is
	      already known, a spec of the form `field=pattern' is given.  For
	      example,	if the command line so far specifies a user `pws', the
	      argument `users=pws' should appear.

	      The next argument with no equals sign is taken as	 the  name  of
	      the  field for which completions should be generated (presumably
	      not one of the fields for which the value is known).

	      The matches generated will be taken from the value of the style.
	      These should contain the possible values for the combinations in
	      the appropriate  order  (users,  hosts,  ports  in  the  example
	      above).	The  different	fields	the  values  for the different
	      fields are separated by colons.  This can be  altered  with  the
	      option  -s to _combination which specifies a pattern.  Typically
	      this is a character class, as for example	 `-s  "[:@]"'  in  the
	      case  of the users-hosts style.	 Each `field=pattern' specifi‐
	      cation restricts the completions which apply to elements of  the
	      style with appropriately matching fields.

	      If no style with the given name is defined for the given tag, or
	      if none of the strings in style's value match,  but  a  function
	      name of the required field preceded by an underscore is defined,
	      that function will be called to generate the matches.  For exam‐
	      ple,  if there is no `users-hosts-ports' or no matching hostname
	      when a host is required, the function  `_hosts'  will  automati‐
	      cally be called.

	      If  the  same  name is used for more than one field, in both the
	      `field=pattern' and the argument that  gives  the	 name  of  the
	      field  to	 be  completed, the number of the field (starting with
	      one) may be given after the fieldname, separated from  it	 by  a
	      colon.

	      All  arguments  after the required field name are passed to com‐
	      padd when generating matches from the style  value,  or  to  the
	      functions for the fields if they are called.

       _describe [ -oO | -t tag ] descr name1 [ name2 ] opts ... -- ...
	      This  function associates completions with descriptions.	Multi‐
	      ple groups separated by -- can  be  supplied,  potentially  with
	      different completion options opts.

	      The  descr  is taken as a string to display above the matches if
	      the format style for the descriptions tag is set.	 This is  fol‐
	      lowed  by one or two names of arrays followed by options to pass
	      to compadd.  The first array contains the	 possible  completions
	      with  their  descriptions	 in the form `completion:description'.
	      If a second array is given, it should have the  same  number  of
	      elements	as  the first; in this case the corresponding elements
	      are added as possible  completions  instead  of  the  completion
	      strings  from  the first array.  The completion list will retain
	      the descriptions from the first array.  Finally, a set  of  com‐
	      pletion options can appear.

	      If  the  option  `-o'  appears  before  the  first argument, the
	      matches added will be treated as names of command options	 (N.B.
	      not  shell  options),  typically following a `-', `--' or `+' on
	      the command line.	 In this case _describe uses  the  prefix-hid‐
	      den, prefix-needed and verbose styles to find out if the strings
	      should be added as completions and if the descriptions should be
	      shown.   Without the `-o' option, only the verbose style is used
	      to decide how descriptions are shown.  If `-O' is	 used  instead
	      of  `-O',	 command  options are completed as above but _describe
	      will not handle the prefix-needed style.

	      With the -t option a tag can be specified.  The default is `val‐
	      ues' or, if the -o option is given, `options'.

	      If  selected  by	the  list-grouped style, strings with the same
	      description will appear together in the list.

	      _describe uses the _all_labels function to generate the matches,
	      so it does not need to appear inside a loop over tag labels.

       _description [ -x ] [ -12VJ ] tag name descr [ spec ... ]
	      This function is not to be confused with the previous one; it is
	      used as a helper function for creating options to	 compadd.   It
	      is  buried  inside many of the higher level completion functions
	      and so often does not need to be called directly.

	      The styles listed below are tested in the current context	 using
	      the  given  tag.	The resulting options for compadd are put into
	      the array named name (this is  traditionally  `expl',  but  this
	      convention  is  not  enforced).	The description for the corre‐
	      sponding set of matches is passed to the function in descr.

	      The styles tested are: format, hidden, matcher, ignored-patterns
	      and  group-name.	The format style is first tested for the given
	      tag and then for the descriptions tag if	no  value  was	found,
	      while  the  remainder  are  only tested for the tag given as the
	      first argument.  The function also calls _setup which tests some
	      more styles.

	      The  string  returned by the format style (if any) will be modi‐
	      fied so that the sequence `%d' is replaced by the descr given as
	      the  third argument without any leading or trailing white space.
	      If, after removing the white  space,  the	 descr	is  the	 empty
	      string,  the  format  style will not be used and the options put
	      into the name array will not contain an explanation string to be
	      displayed above the matches.

	      If  _description	is  called with more than three arguments, the
	      additional specs should be of the form `char:str'.  These supply
	      escape sequence replacements for the format style: every appear‐
	      ance of `%char' will be replaced by string.

	      If the -x option is given, the description  will	be  passed  to
	      compadd  using  the  -x  option instead of the default -X.  This
	      means that the description will be displayed even if  there  are
	      no corresponding matches.

	      The  options  placed  in	the  array  name  take	account of the
	      group-name style, so matches are	placed	in  a  separate	 group
	      where necessary.	The group normally has its elements sorted (by
	      passing the option -J to compadd), but  if  an  option  starting
	      with  `-V',  `-J', `-1', or `-2' is passed to _description, that
	      option will be included in the array.  Hence it is possible  for
	      the  completion  group to be unsorted by giving the option `-V',
	      `-1V', or `-2V'.

	      In most cases, the function will be used like this:

		     local expl
		     _description files expl file
		     compadd "$expl[@]" - "$files[@]"

	      Note the use of the parameter expl, the hyphen, and the list  of
	      matches.	Almost all calls to compadd within the completion sys‐
	      tem use a	 similar  format;  this	 ensures  that	user-specified
	      styles are correctly passed down to the builtins which implement
	      the internals of completion.

       _dispatch context string ...
	      This sets the current context to context and looks  for  comple‐
	      tion  functions  to  handle  this context by hunting through the
	      list of command names or special contexts	 (as  described	 above
	      for compdef) given as string ....	 The first completion function
	      to be defined for one of the contexts in the  list  is  used  to
	      generate	matches.   Typically,  the last string is -default- to
	      cause the function for default completion to be used as a	 fall‐
	      back.

	      The  function  sets  the	parameter $service to the string being
	      tried, and sets the context/command field (the  fourth)  of  the
	      $curcontext  parameter  to  the context given as the first argu‐
	      ment.

       _files The function _files calls _path_files with all the arguments  it
	      was  passed  except for -g and -/.  The use of these two options
	      depends on the setting of the  file-patterns style.

	      This function  accepts  the  full	 set  of  options  allowed  by
	      _path_files, described below.

       _gnu_generic
	      This function is a simple wrapper around the _arguments function
	      described above.	It can be used to determine automatically  the
	      long  options  understood	 by  commands that produce a list when
	      passed the option `--help'.  It is intended  to  be  used	 as  a
	      top-level completion function in its own right.  For example, to
	      enable option completion for the commands foo and bar, use

		     compdef _gnu_generic foo bar

	      after the call to compinit.

	      The completion system as supplied is conservative in its use  of
	      this  function,  since  it  is  important to be sure the command
	      understands the option `-'-help'.

       _guard [ options ] pattern descr
	      This function is intended to be used in the action for the spec‐
	      ifications  passed  to  _arguments  and  similar	functions.  It
	      returns immediately with a non-zero return value if  the	string
	      to  be  completed	 does  not  match the pattern.	If the pattern
	      matches, the descr is displayed; the function then returns  zero
	      if the word to complete is not empty, non-zero otherwise.

	      The  pattern may be preceded by any of the options understood by
	      compadd that are passed down from _description, namely  -M,  -J,
	      -V,  -1,	-2,  -n,  -F  and  -X.	 All  of these options will be
	      ignored.	This fits in conveniently  with	 the  argument-passing
	      conventions of actions for _arguments.

	      As  an  example,	consider  a  command taking the options -n and
	      -none, where -n must be followed by a numeric value in the  same
	      word.  By using:

		     _arguments '-n-: :_guard "[0-9]#" "numeric value"' '-none'

	      _arguments  can  be  made	 to  both display the message `numeric
	      value' and complete options after `-n<TAB>'.   If	 the  `-n'  is
	      already  followed	 by  one or more digits (the pattern passed to
	      _guard) only the message will be displayed; if the `-n' is  fol‐
	      lowed by another character, only options are completed.

       _message [ -r12 ] [ -VJ group ] descr
       _message -e [ tag ] descr
	      The  descr  is used in the same way as the third argument to the
	      _description function, except that  the  resulting  string  will
	      always  be shown whether or not matches were generated.  This is
	      useful for displaying a help message in places where no  comple‐
	      tions can be generated.

	      The  format  style  is  examined with the messages tag to find a
	      message; the usual tag, descriptions, is used only if the	 style
	      is not set with the former.

	      If  the -r option is given, no style is used; the descr is taken
	      literally as the string to display.  This is  most  useful  when
	      the descr comes from a pre-processed argument list which already
	      contains an expanded description.

	      The -12VJ options and the group are passed to compadd and	 hence
	      determine the group the message string is added to.

	      The second form gives a description for completions with the tag
	      tag to be shown even if there are no matches for that tag.   The
	      tag can be omitted and if so the tag is taken from the parameter
	      $curtag; this is maintained by the completion system and	so  is
	      usually correct.

       _multi_parts sep array
	      The  argument  sep  is  a separator character.  The array may be
	      either the name of an array parameter or a literal array in  the
	      form  `(foo  bar)',  a  parenthesised list of words separated by
	      whitespace.  The possible completions are the strings  from  the
	      array.   However,	 each chunk delimited by sep will be completed
	      separately.  For example, the _tar function uses `_multi_parts /
	      patharray'  to  complete partial file paths from the given array
	      of complete file paths.

	      The -i option causes _multi_parts to insert a unique match  even
	      if  that	requires  multiple separators to be inserted.  This is
	      not usually the expected behaviour with filenames,  but  certain
	      other types of completion, for example those with a fixed set of
	      possibilities, may be more suited to this form.

	      Like other utility functions, this function  accepts  the	 `-V',
	      `-J',  `-1',  `-2',  `-n',  `-f',	 `-X', `-M', `-P', `-S', `-r',
	      `-R', and `-q' options and passes them to the compadd builtin.

       _next_label [ -x ] [ -12VJ ] tag name descr [ options ... ]
	      This function is used to implement the loop over	different  tag
	      labels for a particular tag as described above for the tag-order
	      style.  On each call it checks to see if there are any more  tag
	      labels;  if there is it returns status zero, otherwise non-zero.
	      As this function requires a current  tag	to  be	set,  it  must
	      always follow a call to _tags or _requested.

	      The  -x12VJ  options and the first three arguments are passed to
	      the _description function.  Where appropriate the	 tag  will  be
	      replaced	by a tag label in this call.  Any description given in
	      the  tag-order  style  is	 preferred  to	the  descr  passed  to
	      _next_label.

	      The options given after the descr are set in the parameter given
	      by name, and hence are to be passed to compadd or whatever func‐
	      tion is called to add the matches.

	      Here  is	a  typical  use of this function for the tag foo.  The
	      call to _requested determines if tag foo is required at all; the
	      loop  over _next_label handles any labels defined for the tag in
	      the tag-order style.

		     local expl ret=1
		     ...
		     if _requested foo; then
		       ...
		       while _next_label foo expl '...'; do
			 compadd "$expl[@]" ... && ret=0
		       done
		       ...
		     fi
		     return ret

       _normal
	      This is the standard function called to handle  completion  out‐
	      side  any	 special -context-.  It is called both to complete the
	      command word and also the arguments for a command.  In the  sec‐
	      ond  case,  _normal looks for a special completion for that com‐
	      mand, and if there is  none  it  uses  the  completion  for  the
	      -default- context.

	      A	 second	 use is to reexamine the command line specified by the
	      $words array and the $CURRENT parameter after  those  have  been
	      modified.	  For  example,	 the  function _precommand, which com‐
	      pletes after pre-command specifiers such as nohup,  removes  the
	      first  word from the words array, decrements the CURRENT parame‐
	      ter, then calls _normal again.  The effect is  that  `nohup  cmd
	      ...'  is treated in the same way as `cmd ...'.

	      If  the command name matches one of the patterns given by one of
	      the options -p or -P to compdef,	the  corresponding  completion
	      function	is called and then the parameter _compskip is checked.
	      If it is set completion is terminated at that point even	if  no
	      matches  have  been  found.   This  is the same effect as in the
	      -first- context.

       _options
	      This can be used to complete the names  of  shell	 options.   It
	      provides	a  matcher  specification that ignores a leading `no',
	      ignores underscores and allows upper-case letters to match their
	      lower-case   counterparts	  (for	 example,   `glob',  `noglob',
	      `NO_GLOB' are all completed).  Any arguments are	propagated  to
	      the compadd builtin.

       _options_set and _options_unset
	      These  functions	complete  only	set or unset options, with the
	      same matching specification used in the _options function.

	      Note that you need to uncomment a few lines  in  the  _main_com‐
	      plete  function for these functions to work properly.  The lines
	      in question are used to store  the  option  settings  in	effect
	      before  the completion widget locally sets the options it needs.
	      Hence these functions are not generally used by  the  completion
	      system.

       _parameters
	      This is used to complete the names of shell parameters.

	      The  option  `-g	pattern'  limits  the completion to parameters
	      whose type matches the pattern.  The type of a parameter is that
	      shown by `print ${(t)param}', hence judicious use of `*' in pat‐
	      tern is probably necessary.

	      All other arguments are passed to the compadd builtin.

       _path_files
	      This function is used throughout the completion system  to  com‐
	      plete  filenames.	  It  allows completion of partial paths.  For
	      example,	the  string   `/u/i/s/sig'   may   be	completed   to
	      `/usr/include/sys/signal.h'.

	      The options accepted by both _path_files and _files are:

	      -f     Complete all filenames.  This is the default.

	      -/     Specifies that only directories should be completed.

	      -g pattern
		     Specifies	that only files matching the pattern should be
		     completed.

	      -W paths
		     Specifies path prefixes that are to be prepended  to  the
		     string  from  the	command line to generate the filenames
		     but that should not be inserted as completions nor	 shown
		     in	 completion  listings.	Here, paths may be the name of
		     an array parameter, a literal list of paths  enclosed  in
		     parentheses or an absolute pathname.

	      -F ignored-files
		     This  behaves as for the corresponding option to the com‐
		     padd builtin.  It gives direct control over  which	 file‐
		     names  should  be ignored.	 If the option is not present,
		     the ignored-patterns style is used.

	      Both _path_files and _files also accept  the  following  options
	      which are passed to compadd: `-J', `-V', `-1', `-2', `-n', `-X',
	      `-M', `-P', `-S', `-q', `-r', and `-R'.

	      Finally, the  _path_files	 function   uses  the  styles  expand,
	      ambiguous,  special-dirs,	 list-suffixes and file-sort described
	      above.

       _pick_variant [ -c command ] [ -r name ] label=pattern ... label [ args
       ... ]
	      This  function is used to resolve situations where a single com‐
	      mand name requires  more	than  one  type	 of  handling,	either
	      because  it has more than one variant or because there is a name
	      clash between two different commands.

	      The command to run is taken from the first element of the	 array
	      words  unless this is overridden by the option -c.  This command
	      is run and its output is compared with  a	 series	 of  patterns.
	      Arguments	 to  be	 passed to the command can be specified at the
	      end after all the other arguments.  The patterns to try in order
	      are given by the arguments label=pattern; if the output of `com‐
	      mand args ...' contains pattern, then label is selected  as  the
	      label  for  the command variant.	If none of the patterns match,
	      the final command label is selected and status 1 is returned.

	      If the `-r name' is given, the label picked  is  stored  in  the
	      parameter named name.

	      The  results  are	 also  cached  in the _cmd_variant associative
	      array indexed by the name of the command run.

       _regex_arguments name spec ...
	      This function generates a completion function name which matches
	      the  specifications  spec	 ...,  a set of regular expressions as
	      described below.	After running _regex_arguments,	 the  function
	      name  should be called at the appropriate point.	The pattern to
	      be matched is given by the contents of the words array up to the
	      current cursor position joined together with null characters; no
	      quotation is applied.

	      The arguments are grouped as sets of alternatives	 separated  by
	      `|',  which  are	tried  one  after the other until one matches.
	      Each alternative consists of a one or more specifications	 which
	      are  tried  left	to  right,  with  each	pattern	 matched being
	      stripped in turn from the command line being tested,  until  all
	      of  the  group  succeeds or until one fails; in the latter case,
	      the next alternative is tried.  This structure can  be  repeated
	      to  arbitrary depth by using parentheses; matching proceeds from
	      inside to outside.

	      A special procedure is applied  if  no  test  succeeds  but  the
	      remaining command line string contains no null character (imply‐
	      ing the remaining word is the one for which completions  are  to
	      be  generated).	The  completion	 target	 is  restricted to the
	      remaining word and any actions for  the  corresponding  patterns
	      are  executed.   In this case, nothing is stripped from the com‐
	      mand line string.	 The order of evaluation of the actions can be
	      determined by the tag-order style; the various formats supported
	      by _alternative can be used in action.  The descr	 is  used  for
	      setting up the array parameter expl.

	      Specification  arguments	take  one of following forms, in which
	      metacharacters such as `(', `)', `#' and `|' should be quoted.

	      /pattern/ [%lookahead%] [-guard] [:tag:descr:action]
		     This is a single primitive component.  The function tests
		     whether  the  combined  pattern  `(#b)((#B)pattern)looka‐
		     head*' matches the command line string.  If  so,  `guard'
		     is	 evaluated and its return status is examined to deter‐
		     mine if the test has succeeded.  The pattern string  `[]'
		     is	 guaranteed  never  to	match.	 The  lookahead is not
		     stripped from the command line before the next pattern is
		     examined.

	      /pattern/+ [%lookahead%] [-guard] [:tag:descr:action]
		     This  is  similar to `/pattern/ ...' but the left part of
		     the command line string (i.e. the part already matched by
		     previous patterns) is also considered part of the comple‐
		     tion target.

	      /pattern/- [%lookahead%] [-guard] [:tag:descr:action]
		     This is similar to `/pattern/ ...' but the actions of the
		     current  and previously matched patterns are ignored even
		     if the following `pattern' matches the empty string.

	      ( spec )
		     Parentheses may be used to groups specs; note each paren‐
		     thesis is a single argument to _regex_arguments.

	      spec # This allows any number of repetitions of spec.

	      spec spec
		     The  two  specs  are to be matched one after the other as
		     described above.

	      spec | spec
		     Either of the two specs can be matched.

       _requested [ -x ] [ -12VJ ] tag [ name descr [ command args ... ] ]
	      This function is called to decide whether a tag  already	regis‐
	      tered  by	 a call to _tags (see below) has been requested by the
	      user and hence  completion  should  be  performed	 for  it.   It
	      returns  status zero if the tag is requested and non-zero other‐
	      wise.  The function is typically used as part  of	 a  loop  over
	      different tags as follows:

		     _tags foo bar baz
		     while _tags; do
		       if _requested foo; then
			 ... # perform completion for foo
		       fi
		       ... # test the tags bar and baz in the same way
		       ... # exit loop if matches were generated
		     done

	      Note  that  the  test  for whether matches were generated is not
	      performed until the end of the _tags loop.  This is so that  the
	      user  can set the tag-order style to specify a set of tags to be
	      completed at the same time.

	      If name and descr are given, _requested calls  the  _description
	      function	with  these arguments together with the options passed
	      to _requested.

	      If command is given, the _all_labels  function  will  be	called
	      immediately with the same arguments.  In simple cases this makes
	      it possible to perform the test for the tag and the matching  in
	      one go.  For example:

		     local expl ret=1
		     _tags foo bar baz
		     while _tags; do
		       _requested foo expl 'description' \
			   compadd foobar foobaz && ret=0
		       ...
		       (( ret )) || break
		     done

	      If  the command is not compadd, it must nevertheless be prepared
	      to handle the same options.

       _retrieve_cache cache_identifier
	      This function retrieves completion  information  from  the  file
	      given  by	 cache_identifier,  stored in a directory specified by
	      the cache-path  style  which  defaults  to  ~/.zcompcache.   The
	      return  value is zero if retrieval was successful.  It will only
	      attempt retrieval if the use-cache style is set, so you can call
	      this  function without worrying about whether the user wanted to
	      use the caching layer.

	      See _store_cache below for more details.

       _sep_parts
	      This function is passed alternating  arrays  and	separators  as
	      arguments.   The arrays specify completions for parts of strings
	      to be separated by the separators.  The arrays may be the	 names
	      of  array	 parameters  or a quoted list of words in parentheses.
	      For  example,  with  the	array  `hosts=(ftp  news)'  the	  call
	      `_sep_parts  '(foo  bar)' @ hosts' will complete the string  `f'
	      to `foo' and the string `b@n' to `bar@news'.

	      This function accepts the	 compadd  options  `-V',  `-J',	 `-1',
	      `-2',  `-n',  `-X',  `-M',  `-P', `-S', `-r', `-R', and `-q' and
	      passes them on to the compadd builtin used to add the matches.

       _setup tag [ group ]
	      This function sets up the special parameters used by the comple‐
	      tion  system  appropriately for the tag given as the first argu‐
	      ment.    It   uses   the	 styles	  list-colors,	  list-packed,
	      list-rows-first, last-prompt, accept-exact, menu and force-list.

	      The  optional  group supplies the name of the group in which the
	      matches will be placed.  If it is not given, the tag is used  as
	      the group name.

	      This  function  is  called  automatically	 from _description and
	      hence is not normally called explicitly.

       _store_cache cache_identifier params ...
	      This function, together with _retrieve_cache and _cache_invalid,
	      implements  a  caching layer which can be used in any completion
	      function.	 Data obtained by  costly  operations  are  stored  in
	      parameters; this function then dumps the values of those parame‐
	      ters to a file.  The data can then  be  retrieved	 quickly  from
	      that  file  via  _retrieve_cache, even in different instances of
	      the shell.

	      The cache_identifier specifies the file which the data should be
	      dumped  to.   The file is stored in a directory specified by the
	      cache-path style which defaults to ~/.zcompcache.	 The remaining
	      params arguments are the parameters to dump to the file.

	      The  return  value is zero if storage was successful.  The func‐
	      tion will only attempt storage if the use-cache style is set, so
	      you  can	call  this function without worrying about whether the
	      user wanted to use the caching layer.

	      The completion function may avoid calling	 _retrieve_cache  when
	      it  already  has	the  completion	 data available as parameters.
	      However, in that case it should  call  _cache_invalid  to	 check
	      whether  the  data  in the parameters and in the cache are still
	      valid.

	      See the _perl_modules completion function for a  simple  example
	      of the usage of the caching layer.

       _tags [ [ -C name ] tags ... ]
	      If  called  with	arguments,  these are taken to be the names of
	      tags valid for completions in the current context.   These  tags
	      are stored internally and sorted by using the tag-order style.

	      Next, _tags is called repeatedly without arguments from the same
	      completion function.  This successively selects the first,  sec‐
	      ond,  etc.  set of tags requested by the user.  The return value
	      is zero if at least one of the tags is  requested	 and  non-zero
	      otherwise.   To  test  if	 a  particular tag is to be tried, the
	      _requested function should be called (see above).

	      If `-C name' is given, name is temporarily stored in  the	 argu‐
	      ment  field (the fifth) of the context in the curcontext parame‐
	      ter during the call to _tags; the field  is  restored  on	 exit.
	      This  allows _tags to use a more specific context without having
	      to change and reset the curcontext parameter (which has the same
	      effect).

       _values [ -O name ] [ -s sep ] [ -S sep ] [ -wC ] desc spec ...
	      This  is	used to complete arbitrary keywords (values) and their
	      arguments, or lists of such combinations.

	      If the first argument is the option `-O name', it will  be  used
	      in  the same way as by the _arguments function.  In other words,
	      the elements of the name array will be passed  to	 compadd  when
	      executing an action.

	      If the first argument (or the first argument after `-O name') is
	      `-s', the next argument is used as the character that  separates
	      multiple	values.	  This	character is automatically added after
	      each value in an auto-removable fashion (see below); all	values
	      completed by `_values -s' appear in the same word on the command
	      line, unlike completion using _arguments.	 If this option is not
	      present, only a single value will be completed per word.

	      Normally,	 _values  will	only use the current word to determine
	      which values are already present on the command line  and	 hence
	      are not to be completed again.  If the -w option is given, other
	      arguments are examined as well.

	      The first non-option argument is used as a string to print as  a
	      description before listing the values.

	      All other arguments describe the possible values and their argu‐
	      ments in the same format used for the description of options  by
	      the  _arguments  function (see above).  The only differences are
	      that no minus or plus sign is required at the beginning,	values
	      can  have	 only  one argument, and the forms of action beginning
	      with an equal sign are not supported.

	      The character separating a value from its argument  can  be  set
	      using  the  option -S (like -s, followed by the character to use
	      as the separator in the next argument).  By default  the	equals
	      sign will be used as the separator between values and arguments.

	      Example:

		     _values -s , 'description' \
			     '*foo[bar]' \
			     '(two)*one[number]:first count:' \
			     'two[another number]::second count:(1 2 3)'

	      This  describes  three possible values: `foo', `one', and `two'.
	      The first is described as	 `bar',	 takes	no  argument  and  may
	      appear more than once.  The second is described as `number', may
	      appear  more  than  once,	 and  takes  one  mandatory   argument
	      described	 as  `first count'; no action is specified, so it will
	      not be completed.	 The `(two)' at the beginning says that if the
	      value  `one'  is	on the line, the value `two' will no longer be
	      considered a  possible  completion.   Finally,  the  last	 value
	      (`two')  is  described as `another number' and takes an optional
	      argument described as `second count' for which  the  completions
	      (to  appear  after  an  `=') are `1', `2', and `3'.  The _values
	      function will complete lists of these values separated  by  com‐
	      mas.

	      Like  _arguments, this function temporarily adds another context
	      name component to the arguments element (the fifth) of the  cur‐
	      rent context while executing the action.	Here this name is just
	      the name of the value for which the argument is completed.

	      The style verbose is used to decide if the descriptions for  the
	      values (but not those for the arguments) should be printed.

	      The  associative	array  val_args	 is  used to report values and
	      their arguments; this works similarly to the  opt_args  associa‐
	      tive array used by _arguments.  Hence the function calling _val‐
	      ues should declare the local parameters state, line, context and
	      val_args:

		     local context state line
		     typeset -A val_args

	      when using an action of the form `->string'.  With this function
	      the context parameter will be set to the name of the value whose
	      argument is to be completed.

	      Note  also  that _values normally adds the character used as the
	      separator between values as an auto-removable suffix (similar to
	      a	 `/'  after a directory).  However, this is not possible for a
	      `->string' action as the matches for the argument are  generated
	      by  the  calling	function.  To get the usual behaviour, the the
	      calling function can add the separator x as a suffix by  passing
	      the options `-qS x' either directly or indirectly to compadd.

	      The option -C is treated in the same way as it is by _arguments.
	      In that case the	parameter  curcontext  should  be  made	 local
	      instead of context (as described above).

       _wanted [ -x ] [ -C name ]  [ -12VJ ] tag name descr command args ...
	      In  many	contexts,  completion can only generate one particular
	      set of matches, usually corresponding to a single tag.  However,
	      it  is  still  necessary	to  decide  whether  the user requires
	      matches of this type.  This function is useful in such a case.

	      The arguments to _wanted are the same as	those  to  _requested,
	      i.e.  arguments  to be passed to _description.  However, in this
	      case the command is not optional;	 all the processing  of	 tags,
	      including the loop over both tags and tag labels and the genera‐
	      tion of matches, is carried out automatically by _wanted.

	      Hence to offer only one tag and immediately add the  correspond‐
	      ing matches with the given description:

		     _wanted tag expl 'description' \
			 compadd matches...

	      Note that, as for _requested, the command must be able to accept
	      options to be passed down to compadd.

	      Like _tags this function supports the -C option to give  a  dif‐
	      ferent  name  for the argument context field.  The -x option has
	      the same meaning as for _description.

COMPLETION DIRECTORIES
       In the source distribution, the files are contained in  various	subdi‐
       rectories of the Completion directory.  They may have been installed in
       the same structure, or into one single function directory.  The follow‐
       ing  is	a  description	of  the	 files found in the original directory
       structure.  If you wish to alter an installed file, you	will  need  to
       copy  it to some directory which appears earlier in your fpath than the
       standard directory where it appears.

       Base   The core functions and special completion widgets	 automatically
	      bound  to	 keys.	 You will certainly need most of these, though
	      will probably not need to alter them.  Many of these  are	 docu‐
	      mented above.

       Zsh    Functions for completing arguments of shell builtin commands and
	      utility functions for this.  Some of  these  are	also  used  by
	      functions from the Unix directory.

       Unix   Functions	 for  completing  arguments  of	 external commands and
	      suites of commands.  They may need modifying  for	 your  system,
	      although in many cases some attempt is made to decide which ver‐
	      sion of a command is present.  For example, completion  for  the
	      mount  command  tries  to determine the system it is running on,
	      while completion for many other utilities try to decide  whether
	      the  GNU version of the command is in use, and hence whether the
	      --help option is supported.

       X, AIX, BSD, ...
	      Completion and utility function for commands available  only  on
	      some  systems.   These  are not arranged hierarchically, so, for
	      example, both the Linux and Debian directories, as well as the X
	      directory, may be useful on your system.

ZSHCOMPCTL(1)							 ZSHCOMPCTL(1)

NAME
       zshcompctl - zsh programmable completion

DESCRIPTION
       This  version  of zsh has two ways of performing completion of words on
       the command line.  New users of the shell may prefer to use  the	 newer
       and more powerful system based on shell functions; this is described in
       zshcompsys(1), and the basic shell  mechanisms  which  support  it  are
       described in zshcompwid(1).  This manual entry describes the older com‐
       pctl command.
       compctl [ -CDT ] options [ command ... ]
       compctl [ -CDT ] options [ -x pattern options - ... -- ] [ + options  [
       -x ... -- ] ... [+] ] [ command ... ]
       compctl -M match-specs ...
       compctl -L [ -CDTM ] [ command ... ]
       compctl + command ...

       Control	the editor's completion behavior according to the supplied set
       of options.  Various editing commands, notably expand-or-complete-word,
       usually	bound  to  tab,	 will  attempt to complete a word typed by the
       user, while others, notably delete-char-or-list, usually bound to ^D in
       EMACS editing mode, list the possibilities; compctl controls what those
       possibilities are.  They may for example be filenames (the most	common
       case,  and  hence  the  default),  shell	 variables,  or	 words	from a
       user-specified list.

COMMAND FLAGS
       Completion of the arguments of a command may be different for each com‐
       mand  or may use the default.  The behavior when completing the command
       word itself may also be separately specified.  These correspond to  the
       following flags and arguments, all of which (except for -L) may be com‐
       bined with any combination of the options described subsequently in the
       section `Option Flags':

       command ...
	      controls completion for the named commands, which must be listed
	      last on the command line.	 If completion is attempted for a com‐
	      mand  with a pathname containing slashes and no completion defi‐
	      nition is found, the search is retried with  the	last  pathname
	      component.  If  the command starts with a =, completion is tried
	      with the pathname of the command.

	      Any of the command strings may be patterns of the form  normally
	      used for filename generation.  These should be be quoted to pro‐
	      tect them from immediate	expansion;  for	 example  the  command
	      string  'foo*'  arranges for completion of the words of any com‐
	      mand beginning with foo.	When completion is attempted, all pat‐
	      tern completions are tried in the reverse order of their defini‐
	      tion until one matches.  By default, completion then proceeds as
	      normal, i.e. the shell will try to generate more matches for the
	      specific command on the command line; this can be overridden  by
	      including -tn in the flags for the pattern completion.

	      Note that aliases are expanded before the command name is deter‐
	      mined unless the COMPLETE_ALIASES option is set.	 Commands  may
	      not be combined with the -C, -D or -T flags.

       -C     controls	completion  when the command word itself is being com‐
	      pleted.  If no compctl -C command has been issued,  the names of
	      any  executable  command (whether in the path or specific to the
	      shell, such as aliases or functions) are completed.

       -D     controls default completion behavior for the arguments  of  com‐
	      mands  not assigned any special behavior.	 If no compctl -D com‐
	      mand has been issued, filenames are completed.

       -T     supplies completion flags to be used before any other processing
	      is  done,	 even  before processing for compctls defined for spe‐
	      cific commands.  This is especially useful  when	combined  with
	      extended completion (the -x flag, see the section `Extended Com‐
	      pletion' below).	Using this flag you can define default	behav‐
	      ior  which  will apply to all commands without exception, or you
	      can alter the standard behavior for all commands.	 For  example,
	      if  your	access to the user database is too slow and/or it con‐
	      tains too many users (so that completion after `~' is  too  slow
	      to be usable), you can use

		     compctl -T -x 's[~] C[0,[^/]#]' -k friends -S/ -tn

	      to  complete  the strings in the array friends after a `~'.  The
	      C[...] argument is necessary so that this form  of  ~-completion
	      is not tried after the directory name is finished.

       -L     lists  the existing completion behavior in a manner suitable for
	      putting into a start-up script; the  existing  behavior  is  not
	      changed.	 Any  combination  of  the above forms, or the -M flag
	      (which must follow the -L flag), may be specified, otherwise all
	      defined  completions  are	 listed.  Any other flags supplied are
	      ignored.

       no argument
	      If no argument is given, compctl lists all  defined  completions
	      in an abbreviated form;  with a list of options, all completions
	      with those flags set  (not  counting  extended  completion)  are
	      listed.

       If  the	+  flag is alone and followed immediately by the command list,
       the completion behavior for all the commands in the list	 is  reset  to
       the  default.   In  other  words,  completion will subsequently use the
       options specified by the -D flag.

       The form with -M as the first and only option defines  global  matching
       specifications (see zshcompwid). The match specifications given will be
       used for every completion attempt (only when using  compctl,  not  with
       the new completion system) and are tried in the order in which they are
       defined until one generates at least one match. E.g.:

	      compctl -M '' 'm:{a-zA-Z}={A-Za-z}'

       This will first try completion without any global match	specifications
       (the  empty  string)  and,  if that generates no matches, will try case
       insensitive completion.

OPTION FLAGS
       [ -fcFBdeaRGovNAIOPZEnbjrzu/12 ]
       [ -k array ] [ -g globstring ] [ -s subststring ]
       [ -K function ]
       [ -Q ] [ -P prefix ] [ -S suffix ]
       [ -W file-prefix ] [ -H num pattern ]
       [ -q ] [ -X explanation ] [ -Y explanation ]
       [ -y func-or-var ] [ -l cmd ] [ -h cmd ] [ -U ]
       [ -t continue ] [ -J name ] [ -V name ]
       [ -M match-spec ]

       The remaining options specify the type of command arguments to look for
       during  completion.   Any  combination of these flags may be specified;
       the result is a sorted list of all the possibilities.  The options  are
       as follows.

   Simple Flags
       These produce completion lists made up by the shell itself:

       -f     Filenames and filesystem paths.

       -/     Just filesystem paths.

       -c     Command  names, including aliases, shell functions, builtins and
	      reserved words.

       -F     Function names.

       -B     Names of builtin commands.

       -m     Names of external commands.

       -w     Reserved words.

       -a     Alias names.

       -R     Names of regular (non-global) aliases.

       -G     Names of global aliases.

       -d     This can be combined with -F, -B, -w, -a, -R and -G to get names
	      of disabled functions, builtins, reserved words or aliases.

       -e     This  option (to show enabled commands) is in effect by default,
	      but may be combined with -d; -de in combination with -F, -B, -w,
	      -a,  -R  and  -G	will  complete	names  of functions, builtins,
	      reserved words or aliases whether or not they are disabled.

       -o     Names of shell options (see zshoptions(1)).

       -v     Names of any variable defined in the shell.

       -N     Names of scalar (non-array) parameters.

       -A     Array names.

       -I     Names of integer variables.

       -O     Names of read-only variables.

       -p     Names of parameters used by the shell (including special parame‐
	      ters).

       -Z     Names of shell special parameters.

       -E     Names of environment variables.

       -n     Named directories.

       -b     Key binding names.

       -j     Job  names:   the	 first	word of the job leader's command line.
	      This is useful with the kill builtin.

       -r     Names of running jobs.

       -z     Names of suspended jobs.

       -u     User names.

   Flags with Arguments
       These have user supplied arguments to determine how the list of comple‐
       tions is to be made up:

       -k array
	      Names  taken from the elements of $array (note that the `$' does
	      not appear on the command line).	 Alternatively,	 the  argument
	      array itself may be a set of space- or comma-separated values in
	      parentheses, in which any delimiter may be escaped with a	 back‐
	      slash; in this case the argument should be quoted.  For example,

		     compctl -k "(cputime filesize datasize stacksize
				 coredumpsize resident descriptors)" limit

       -g globstring
	      The globstring is expanded using filename globbing; it should be
	      quoted to protect it from	 immediate  expansion.	The  resulting
	      filenames	 are  taken  as	 the possible completions.  Use `*(/)'
	      instead of `*/' for directories.	The fignore special  parameter
	      is  not  applied	to the resulting files.	 More than one pattern
	      may be given separated by blanks. (Note that brace expansion  is
	      not  part	 of  globbing.	 Use the syntax `(either|or)' to match
	      alternatives.)

       -s subststring
	      The subststring is split into words and  these  words  are  than
	      expanded	using all shell expansion mechanisms (see zshexpn(1)).
	      The resulting words are taken as possible completions.  The fig‐
	      nore  special  parameter	is not applied to the resulting files.
	      Note that -g is faster for filenames.

       -K function
	      Call the given function to get the completions.  Unless the name
	      starts with an underscore, the function is passed two arguments:
	      the prefix and the suffix of the word on which completion is  to
	      be  attempted, in other words those characters before the cursor
	      position, and those from the cursor position onwards.  The whole
	      command  line  can  be  accessed with the -c and -l flags of the
	      read builtin. The function should set the variable reply	to  an
	      array  containing	 the completions (one completion per element);
	      note that reply should not be made local to the function.	  From
	      such a function the command line can be accessed with the -c and
	      -l flags to the read builtin.  For example,

		     function whoson { reply=(`users`); }
		     compctl -K whoson talk

	      completes only logged-on users after `talk'.  Note that `whoson'
	      must return an array, so `reply=`users`' would be incorrect.

       -H num pattern
	      The  possible  completions  are  taken from the last num history
	      lines.  Only words matching pattern are taken.  If num  is  zero
	      or  negative the whole history is searched and if pattern is the
	      empty string all words are taken (as with `*').  A  typical  use
	      is

		     compctl -D -f + -H 0 ''

	      which  forces  completion to look back in the history list for a
	      word if no filename matches.

   Control Flags
       These do not directly specify types of name to be completed, but manip‐
       ulate the options that do:

       -Q     This  instructs the shell not to quote any metacharacters in the
	      possible completions.  Normally the results of a completion  are
	      inserted into the command line with any metacharacters quoted so
	      that they are interpreted as normal characters.  This is	appro‐
	      priate for filenames and ordinary strings.  However, for special
	      effects, such as inserting a backquoted expression from  a  com‐
	      pletion  array (-k) so that the expression will not be evaluated
	      until the complete line is executed, this option must be used.

       -P prefix
	      The prefix is inserted just before  the  completed  string;  any
	      initial  part already typed will be completed and the whole pre‐
	      fix ignored for completion purposes.  For example,

		     compctl -j -P "%" kill

	      inserts a `%' after the kill  command  and  then	completes  job
	      names.

       -S suffix
	      When a completion is found the suffix is inserted after the com‐
	      pleted string.  In the case of menu  completion  the  suffix  is
	      inserted	immediately, but it is still possible to cycle through
	      the list of completions by repeatedly hitting the same key.

       -W file-prefix
	      With directory file-prefix:  for command,	 file,	directory  and
	      globbing completion (options -c, -f, -/, -g), the file prefix is
	      implicitly added in front of the completion.  For example,

		     compctl -/ -W ~/Mail maildirs

	      completes any subdirectories to any depth beneath the  directory
	      ~/Mail,  although	 that  prefix  does  not appear on the command
	      line.  The file-prefix may also be of the form accepted  by  the
	      -k  flag,	 i.e. the name of an array or a literal list in paren‐
	      thesis. In this case all the directories in  the	list  will  be
	      searched for possible completions.

       -q     If used with a suffix as specified by the -S option, this causes
	      the suffix to be removed if the next character typed is a	 blank
	      or  does	not  insert anything or if the suffix consists of only
	      one character and the next character typed is the	 same  charac‐
	      ter;  this  the same rule used for the AUTO_REMOVE_SLASH option.
	      The option is most useful for  list  separators  (comma,	colon,
	      etc.).

       -l cmd This  option  restricts the range of command line words that are
	      considered to  be	 arguments.   If  combined  with  one  of  the
	      extended	completion  patterns  `p[...]',	 `r[...]', or `R[...]'
	      (see the section	`Extended  Completion'	below)	the  range  is
	      restricted  to the range of arguments specified in the brackets.
	      Completion is then performed as if these had been given as argu‐
	      ments  to the cmd supplied with the option. If the cmd string is
	      empty the first word in the range is instead taken as  the  com‐
	      mand  name,  and	command name completion performed on the first
	      word in the range.  For example,

		     compctl -x 'r[-exec,;]' -l '' -- find

	      completes arguments between `-exec' and the  following  `;'  (or
	      the  end	of  the command line if there is no such string) as if
	      they were a separate command line.

       -h cmd Normally zsh completes quoted strings  as	 a  whole.  With  this
	      option,  completion can be done separately on different parts of
	      such strings. It works like the -l option but makes the  comple‐
	      tion  code  work on the parts of the current word that are sepa‐
	      rated by spaces. These parts are completed as if they were argu‐
	      ments  to	 the  given cmd. If cmd is the empty string, the first
	      part is completed as a command name, as with -l.

       -U     Use the whole list of possible completions, whether or not  they
	      actually	match the word on the command line.  The word typed so
	      far will be deleted.  This is most useful with a function (given
	      by  the  -K option) which can examine the word components passed
	      to it (or via the read builtin's -c and -l flags)	 and  use  its
	      own criteria to decide what matches.  If there is no completion,
	      the original word is retained.  Since the produced possible com‐
	      pletions	seldom	have interesting common prefixes and suffixes,
	      menu completion is started immediately if AUTO_MENU is  set  and
	      this flag is used.

       -y func-or-var
	      The  list	 provided  by  func-or-var is displayed instead of the
	      list of completions whenever a listing is required;  the	actual
	      completions to be inserted are not affected.  It can be provided
	      in two ways. Firstly, if func-or-var begins with a $ it  defines
	      a	 variable,  or	if it begins with a left parenthesis a literal
	      array, which contains the list.  A variable may have been set by
	      a call to a function using the -K option.	 Otherwise it contains
	      the name of a function which will	 be  executed  to  create  the
	      list.   The  function  will  be  passed  as an argument list all
	      matching completions, including prefixes and  suffixes  expanded
	      in  full, and should set the array reply to the result.  In both
	      cases, the display list will only be retrieved after a  complete
	      list of matches has been created.

	      Note that the returned list does not have to correspond, even in
	      length, to the original set of matches, and may be passed	 as  a
	      scalar instead of an array.  No special formatting of characters
	      is performed on the output in this case; in particular, newlines
	      are  printed  literally  and if they appear output in columns is
	      suppressed.

       -X explanation
	      Print explanation when trying completion on the current  set  of
	      options.	A  `%n'	 in  this  string is replaced by the number of
	      matches that were added for this explanation string.  The expla‐
	      nation  only  appears  if	 completion was tried and there was no
	      unique match, or when listing completions.  Explanation  strings
	      will  be listed together with the matches of the group specified
	      together with the -X option (using the -J or -V option). If  the
	      same  explanation	 string	 is  given to multiple -X options, the
	      string appears only once (for each  group)  and  the  number  of
	      matches  shown  for  the `%n' is the total number of all matches
	      for each of these uses. In any case, the explanation string will
	      only  be	shown  if  there  was at least one match added for the
	      explanation string.

	      The sequences  %B,  %b,  %S,  %s,	 %U,  and  %u  specify	output
	      attributes  (bold,  standout,  and underline) and %{...%} can be
	      used to include literal escape sequences as in prompts.

       -Y explanation
	      Identical to -X, except that  the	 explanation  first  undergoes
	      expansion	 following  the	 usual	rules  for  strings  in double
	      quotes.  The expansion will be carried out after	any  functions
	      are  called for the -K or -y options, allowing them to set vari‐
	      ables.

       -t continue
	      The continue-string contains a character	that  specifies	 which
	      set of completion flags should be used next.  It is useful:

	      (i)  With -T, or when trying a list of pattern completions, when
	      compctl would usually continue with  ordinary  processing	 after
	      finding matches; this can be suppressed with `-tn'.

	      (ii)  With  a  list of alternatives separated by +, when compctl
	      would normally stop  when	 one  of  the  alternatives  generates
	      matches.	 It  can be forced to consider the next set of comple‐
	      tions by adding `-t+' to the flags of the alternative before the
	      `+'.

	      (iii)  In	 an extended completion list (see below), when compctl
	      would normally continue until a  set  of	conditions  succeeded,
	      then use only the immediately following flags.  With `-t-', com‐
	      pctl will continue trying extended completions  after  the  next
	      `-';  with  `-tx'	 it  will  attempt completion with the default
	      flags, in other words those before the `-x'.

       -J name
	      This gives the name of the group the matches  should  be	placed
	      in. Groups are listed and sorted separately; likewise, menu com‐
	      pletion will offer the matches in the groups  in	the  order  in
	      which  the  groups  were defined. If no group name is explicitly
	      given, the matches are stored in	a  group  named	 default.  The
	      first  time  a group name is encountered, a group with that name
	      is created. After that all matches with the same group name  are
	      stored in that group.

	      This  can	 be useful with non-exclusive alternative completions.
	      For example, in

		     compctl -f -J files -t+ + -v -J variables foo

	      both files and variables are possible completions,  as  the  -t+
	      forces  both  sets  of alternatives before and after the + to be
	      considered at once.  Because of the  -J  options,	 however,  all
	      files are listed before all variables.

       -V name
	      Like  -J,	 but  matches  within  the group will not be sorted in
	      listings nor in menu completion. These unsorted groups are in  a
	      different	 name space from the sorted ones, so groups defined as
	      -J files and -V files are distinct.

       -1     If given together with the -V  option,  makes  only  consecutive
	      duplicates  in  the  group be removed. Note that groups with and
	      without this flag are in different name spaces.

       -2     If given together with the -J or -V option, makes all duplicates
	      be kept. Again, groups with and without this flag are in differ‐
	      ent name spaces.

       -M match-spec
	      This defines additional  matching	 control  specifications  that
	      should  be  used	only  when testing words for the list of flags
	      this flag appears in. The format of  the	match-spec  string  is
	      described in zshcompwid.

ALTERNATIVE COMPLETION
       compctl [ -CDT ] options + options [ + ... ] [ + ] command ...

       The  form  with	`+' specifies alternative options. Completion is tried
       with the options before the first `+'. If this produces no matches com‐
       pletion	is  tried with the flags after the `+' and so on. If there are
       no flags after the last `+' and a match has not been found up  to  that
       point, default completion is tried.  If the list of flags contains a -t
       with a + character, the next list of flags is used even if the  current
       list produced matches.

EXTENDED COMPLETION
       compctl [ -CDT ] options -x pattern options - ... --
		[ command ... ]
       compctl [ -CDT ] options [ -x pattern options - ... -- ]
		[ + options [ -x ... -- ] ... [+] ] [ command ... ]

       The  form  with	`-x'  specifies	 extended  completion for the commands
       given; as shown, it may be combined with alternative  completion	 using
       `+'.  Each pattern is examined in turn; when a match is found, the cor‐
       responding options, as described in the section `Option	Flags'	above,
       are  used to generate possible completions.  If no pattern matches, the
       options given before the -x are used.

       Note that each pattern should be supplied  as  a	 single	 argument  and
       should be quoted to prevent expansion of metacharacters by the shell.

       A  pattern  is built of sub-patterns separated by commas; it matches if
       at least one of these sub-patterns matches  (they  are  `or'ed).	 These
       sub-patterns  are  in  turn composed of other sub-patterns separated by
       white spaces which match if all of the  sub-patterns  match  (they  are
       `and'ed).  An element of the sub-patterns is of the form `c[...][...]',
       where the pairs of brackets may be repeated as often as necessary,  and
       matches	if  any	 of the sets of brackets match (an `or').  The example
       below makes this clearer.

       The elements may be any of the following:

       s[string]...
	      Matches if the current word on the command line starts with  one
	      of the strings given in brackets.	 The string is not removed and
	      is not part of the completion.

       S[string]...
	      Like s[string] except that the string is part of the completion.

       p[from,to]...
	      Matches if the number of the current word is between one of  the
	      from  and	 to pairs inclusive. The comma and to are optional; to
	      defaults to the same value as from.  The numbers	may  be	 nega‐
	      tive: -n refers to the n'th last word on the line.

       c[offset,string]...
	      Matches if the string matches the word offset by offset from the
	      current word position.  Usually offset will be negative.

       C[offset,pattern]...
	      Like c but using pattern matching instead.

       w[index,string]...
	      Matches if the word in position index is	equal  to  the	corre‐
	      sponding	string.	  Note	that  the word count is made after any
	      alias expansion.

       W[index,pattern]...
	      Like w but using pattern matching instead.

       n[index,string]...
	      Matches if the current word contains string.  Anything up to and
	      including the indexth occurrence of this string will not be con‐
	      sidered part of the completion, but the rest will.  index may be
	      negative	to  count from the end: in most cases, index will be 1
	      or -1.  For example,

		     compctl -s '`users`' -x 'n[1,@]' -k hosts -- talk

	      will usually complete usernames, but if you insert  an  @	 after
	      the  name,  names from the array hosts (assumed to contain host‐
	      names, though you must make the array  yourself)	will  be  com‐
	      pleted.  Other commands such as rcp can be handled similarly.

       N[index,string]...
	      Like  n  except  that  the  string  will be taken as a character
	      class.  Anything up to and including the indexth	occurrence  of
	      any  of  the characters in string will not be considered part of
	      the completion.

       m[min,max]...
	      Matches if the total number of words lies between	 min  and  max
	      inclusive.

       r[str1,str2]...
	      Matches  if  the	cursor	is  after a word with prefix str1.  If
	      there is also a word with prefix str2 on the command line	 after
	      the  one matched by str1 it matches only if the cursor is before
	      this word. If the comma and str2 are omitted, it matches if  the
	      cursor is after a word with prefix str1.

       R[str1,str2]...
	      Like r but using pattern matching instead.

       q[str]...
	      Matches  the  word currently being completed is in single quotes
	      and the str begins with the letter `s', or if completion is done
	      in  double quotes and str starts with the letter `d', or if com‐
	      pletion is done in backticks and str starts with a `b'.

EXAMPLE
	      compctl -u -x 's[+] c[-1,-f],s[-f+]' \
		-g '~/Mail/*(:t)' - 's[-f],c[-1,-f]' -f -- mail

       This is to be interpreted as follows:

       If the current command is mail, then

	      if ((the current word begins with + and the previous word is -f)
	      or (the current word begins with -f+)), then complete the
	      non-directory part (the `:t' glob modifier) of files in the directory
	      ~/Mail; else

	      if the current word begins with -f or the previous word was -f, then
	      complete any file; else

	      complete user names.

ZSHMODULES(1)							 ZSHMODULES(1)

NAME
       zshmodules - zsh loadable modules

DESCRIPTION
       Some optional parts of zsh are in modules, separate from	 the  core  of
       the  shell.   Each  of  these  modules may be linked in to the shell at
       build time, or can be dynamically linked while the shell is running  if
       the  installation  supports this feature.  The modules that are bundled
       with the zsh distribution are:

       zsh/cap
	      Builtins for manipulating POSIX.1e (POSIX.6) capability  (privi‐
	      lege) sets.

       zsh/clone
	      A builtin that can clone a running shell onto another terminal.

       zsh/compctl
	      The compctl builtin for controlling completion.

       zsh/complete
	      The basic completion code.

       zsh/complist
	      Completion listing extensions.

       zsh/computil
	      A	 module	 with  utility	builtins needed for the shell function
	      based completion system.

       zsh/datetime
	      Some date/time commands and parameters.

       zsh/deltochar
	      A ZLE function duplicating EMACS' zap-to-char.

       zsh/example
	      An example of how to write a module.

       zsh/files
	      Some basic file manipulation commands as builtins.

       zsh/mapfile
	      Access to external files via a special associative array.

       zsh/mathfunc
	      Standard scientific functions for use  in	 mathematical  evalua‐
	      tions.

       zsh/parameter
	      Access to internal hash tables via special associative arrays.

       zsh/pcre
	      Interface to the PCRE library.

       zsh/sched
	      A	 builtin  that	provides a timed execution facility within the
	      shell.

       zsh/net/socket
	      Manipulation of Unix domain sockets

       zsh/stat
	      A builtin command interface to the stat system call.

       zsh/system
	      A builtin interface to various low-level system features.

       zsh/net/tcp
	      Manipulation of TCP sockets

       zsh/termcap
	      Interface to the termcap database.

       zsh/terminfo
	      Interface to the terminfo database.

       zsh/zftp
	      A builtin FTP client.

       zsh/zle
	      The Zsh Line Editor, including the bindkey and vared builtins.

       zsh/zleparameter
	      Access to internals of the Zsh Line Editor via parameters.

       zsh/zprof
	      A module allowing profiling for shell functions.

       zsh/zpty
	      A builtin for starting a command in a pseudo-terminal.

       zsh/zselect
	      Block and return when file descriptors are ready.

       zsh/zutil
	      Some utility builtins, e.g. the one for supporting configuration
	      via styles.

THE ZSH/CAP MODULE
       The zsh/cap module is used for manipulating POSIX.1e (POSIX.6) capabil‐
       ity sets.  If the operating system does not support this interface, the
       builtins	 defined by this module will do nothing.  The builtins in this
       module are:

       cap [ capabilities ]
	      Change the shell's process  capability  sets  to	the  specified
	      capabilities,  otherwise	display	 the shell's current capabili‐
	      ties.

       getcap filename ...
	      This is a built-in implementation of the POSIX standard utility.
	      It displays the capability sets on each specified filename.

       setcap capabilities filename ...
	      This is a built-in implementation of the POSIX standard utility.
	      It sets the capability sets on each specified  filename  to  the
	      specified capabilities.

THE ZSH/CLONE MODULE
       The zsh/clone module makes available one builtin command:

       clone tty
	      Creates  a forked instance of the current shell, attached to the
	      specified tty.  In the new shell, the PID, PPID and TTY  special
	      parameters  are changed appropriately.  $! is set to zero in the
	      new shell, and to the new shell's PID in the original shell.

	      The return value of the builtin is zero in both shells  if  suc‐
	      cessful, and non-zero on error.

	      The  target  of  clone  should be an unused terminal, such as an
	      unused virtual console or a virtual terminal created by

	      xterm -e sh -c 'trap : INT QUIT TSTP; tty;  while	 :;  do	 sleep
	      100000000; done'

	      Some  words  of  explanation are warranted about this long xterm
	      command line: when doing clone on a pseudo-terminal, some	 other
	      session  ("session"  meant  as  a unix session group, or SID) is
	      already owning the terminal. Hence the cloned zsh cannot acquire
	      the pseudo-terminal as a controlling tty. That means two things:

	      the  job	control	 signals  will	go  to the sh-started-by-xterm
	      process
		    group (that's why we disable INT QUIT and TSTP with	 trap;
	      otherwise
		    the while loop could get suspended or killed)

	      the cloned shell will have job control disabled, and the job
		    control keys (control-C, control-\ and control-Z) will not
	      work.

	      This does not apply when cloning to an unused vc.

	      Cloning to an used (and unprepared) terminal will result in  two
	      processes	 reading  simultaneously  from the same terminal, with
	      input bytes going randomly to either process.

	      clone is mostly useful  as  a  shell  built-in  replacement  for
	      openvt.

THE ZSH/COMPCTL MODULE
       The  zsh/compctl	 module makes available two builtin commands. compctl,
       is the old, deprecated way to control completions for ZLE.  See zshcom‐
       pctl(1).	   The	 other	builtin	 command,  compcall  can  be  used  in
       user-defined completion widgets, see zshcompwid(1).

THE ZSH/COMPLETE MODULE
       The zsh/complete module makes available several builtin commands	 which
       can be used in user-defined completion widgets, see zshcompwid(1).

THE ZSH/COMPLIST MODULE
       The zsh/complist module offers three extensions to completion listings:
       the ability to highlight matches in such a list, the ability to	scroll
       through long lists and a different style of menu completion.

   Colored completion listings
       Whenever one of the parameters ZLS_COLORS or ZLS_COLOURS is set and the
       zsh/complist module is loaded or	 linked	 into  the  shell,  completion
       lists will be colored.  Note, however, that complist will not automati‐
       cally be loaded if it is not linked in:	on systems with dynamic	 load‐
       ing, `zmodload zsh/complist' is required.

       The  parameters	ZLS_COLORS  and	 ZLS_COLOURS  describe how matches are
       highlighted.  To turn on highlighting an empty value suffices, in which
       case  all  the  default values given below will be used.	 The format of
       the value of these parameters is the same as used by the GNU version of
       the  ls	command:  a colon-separated list of specifications of the form
       `name=value'.  The name may be one of the following  strings,  most  of
       which specify file types for which the value will be used.  The strings
       and their default values are:

       no 0   for normal text (i.e. when displaying  something	other  than  a
	      matched file)

       fi 0   for regular files

       di 32  for directories

       ln 36  for symbolic links

       pi 31  for named pipes (FIFOs)

       so 33  for sockets

       bd 44;37
	      for block devices

       cd 44;37
	      for character devices

       ex 35  for executable files

       mi none
	      for a non-existent file (default is the value defined for fi)

       lc \e[ for the left code (see below)

       rc m   for the right code

       tc 0   for  the character indicating the file type  printed after file‐
	      names if the LIST_TYPES option is set

       sp 0   for the spaces printed after matches to align the next column

       ec none
	      for the end code

       Apart from these strings, the name may also be an asterisk  (`*')  fol‐
       lowed by any string. The value given for such a string will be used for
       all files whose name ends with the string.  The name  may  also	be  an
       equals sign (`=') followed by a pattern.	 The value given for this pat‐
       tern will be used for all matches (not just  filenames)	whose  display
       string  are matched by the pattern.  Definitions for both of these take
       precedence over the values defined for file types and the form with the
       leading	asterisk takes precedence over the form with the leading equal
       sign.

       The last form also allows different parts of the displayed  strings  to
       be  colored  differently.   For this, the pattern has to use the `(#b)'
       globbing flag and pairs of parentheses surrounding  the	parts  of  the
       strings that are to be colored differently.  In this case the value may
       consist of more than one color code  separated  by  equal  signs.   The
       first  code  will  be  used for all parts for which no explicit code is
       specified and the following codes will be used for the parts matched by
       the  sub-patterns  in  parentheses.   For  example,  the	 specification
       `=(#b)(?)*(?)=0=3=7' will be used for all matches which	are  at	 least
       two  characters long and will use the code `3' for the first character,
       `7' for the last character and `0' for the rest.

       All three forms of name may be preceded by a  pattern  in  parentheses.
       If  this	 is  given,  the value will be used only for matches in groups
       whose names are matched by the pattern given in the  parentheses.   For
       example,	 `(g*)m*=43'  highlights  all  matches	beginning  with `m' in
       groups whose names  begin with `g' using the color code `43'.  In  case
       of the `lc', `rc', and `ec' codes, the group pattern is ignored.

       Note also that all patterns are tried in the order in which they appear
       in the parameter value until the first one matches which is then used.

       When printing a match, the code prints the value of lc, the  value  for
       the  file-type or the last matching specification with a `*', the value
       of rc, the string to display for the match itself, and then  the	 value
       of  ec  if that is defined or the values of lc, no, and rc if ec is not
       defined.

       The default values are ISO 6429 (ANSI) compliant and  can  be  used  on
       vt100 compatible terminals such as xterms.  On monochrome terminals the
       default values will have no visible effect.  The colors	function  from
       the  contribution  can be used to get associative arrays containing the
       codes for ANSI terminals (see the section `Other Functions' in  zshcon‐
       trib(1)).   For	example,  after	 loading  colors, one could use `$col‐
       ors[red]'  to  get  the	code  for  foreground  color  red  and	`$col‐
       ors[bg-green]' for the code for background color green.

       If  the completion system invoked by compinit is used, these parameters
       should not be set directly because the  system  controls	 them  itself.
       Instead, the list-colors style should be used (see the section `Comple‐
       tion System Configuration' in zshcompsys(1)).

   Scrolling in completion listings
       To enable scrolling through a completion list, the LISTPROMPT parameter
       must  be set.  Its value will be used as the prompt; if it is the empty
       string, a default prompt will be used.  The value may  contain  escapes
       of  the	form  `%x'.   It  supports the escapes `%B', `%b', `%S', `%s',
       `%U', `%u' and `%{...%}' used also in shell prompts as  well  as	 three
       pairs of additional sequences: a `%l' or `%L' is replaced by the number
       of the last line shown and the total number of lines in the form	 `num‐
       ber/total';  a  `%m'  or	 `%M'  is replaced with the number of the last
       match shown and the total number	 of  matches;  and  `%p'  or  `%P'  is
       replaced	 with  `Top', `Bottom' or the position of the first line shown
       in percent of the total number of  lines,  respectively.	  In  each  of
       these  cases the form with the uppercase letter will be replaced with a
       string of fixed width, padded to the right with spaces, while the  low‐
       ercase form will not be padded.

       If the parameter LISTPROMPT is set, the completion code will not ask if
       the list should be shown.  Instead it immediately starts displaying the
       list,  stopping	after  the  first screenful, showing the prompt at the
       bottom, waiting for a  keypress	after  temporarily  switching  to  the
       listscroll  keymap.   Some  of the zle functions have a special meaning
       while scrolling lists:

       send-break
	      stops listing discarding the key pressed

       accept-line, down-history, down-line-or-history
       down-line-or-search, vi-down-line-or-history
	      scrolls forward one line

       complete-word, menu-complete, expand-or-complete
       expand-or-complete-prefix, menu-complete-or-expand
	      scrolls forward one screenful

       Every other character stops listing and immediately processes  the  key
       as  usual.   Any key that is not bound in the listscroll keymap or that
       is bound	 to  undefined-key  is	looked	up  in	the  keymap  currently
       selected.

       As for the ZLS_COLORS and ZLS_COLOURS parameters, LISTPROMPT should not
       be set directly when using the shell function based completion  system.
       Instead, the list-prompt style should be used.

   Menu selection
       The  zsh/complist  module also offers an alternative style of selecting
       matches from a list, called menu selection, which can be	 used  if  the
       shell is set up to return to the last prompt after showing a completion
       list (see the ALWAYS_LAST_PROMPT option in zshoptions(1)).  It  can  be
       invoked	directly  by  the  widget  menu-select	defined by the module.
       Alternatively, the parameter MENUSELECT can be set to an integer, which
       gives  the  minimum  number of matches that must be present before menu
       selection is automatically turned on.  This second method requires that
       menu  completion	 be  started,  either  directly	 from a widget such as
       menu-complete, or due to one of the options MENU_COMPLETE or  AUTO_MENU
       being  set.  If MENUSELECT is set, but is 0, 1 or empty, menu selection
       will always be started during an ambiguous menu completion.

       When using the completion system based on shell functions, the  MENUSE‐
       LECT  parameter should not be used (like the ZLS_COLORS and ZLS_COLOURS
       parameters described above).  Instead, the menu style  should  be  used
       with the select=... keyword.

       After  menu  selection is started, the matches will be listed. If there
       are more matches than fit on the screen, only the  first	 screenful  is
       shown.	The  matches  to  insert into the command line can be selected
       from this list.	In the list one match is highlighted using  the	 value
       for ma from the ZLS_COLORS or ZLS_COLOURS parameter.  The default value
       for this is `7' which forces the selected match to be highlighted using
       standout	 mode  on  a vt100-compatible terminal.	 If neither ZLS_COLORS
       nor ZLS_COLOURS is set, the same terminal control sequence as  for  the
       `%S' escape in prompts is used.

       If  there  are  more  matches  than fit on the screen and the parameter
       MENUPROMPT is set, its value will be shown below the matches.  It  sup‐
       ports  the  same	 escape sequences as LISTPROMPT, but the number of the
       match or line shown will be that of the one where the mark  is  placed.
       If its value is the empty string, a default prompt will be used.

       The  MENUSCROLL	parameter  can	be  used  to  specify  how the list is
       scrolled.  If the parameter is unset, this is done line by line, if  it
       is  set to `0' (zero), the list will scroll half the number of lines of
       the screen.  If the value is positive, it gives the number of lines  to
       scroll  and  if it is negative, the list will be scrolled the number of
       lines of the screen minus the (absolute) value.

       As for the ZLS_COLORS, ZLS_COLOURS and LISTPROMPT  parameters,  neither
       MENUPROMPT  nor	MENUSCROLL should be set directly when using the shell
       function based  completion  system.   Instead,  the  select-prompt  and
       select-scroll styles should be used.

       The completion code sometimes decides not to show all of the matches in
       the list.  These hidden matches are either matches for which  the  com‐
       pletion	function  which	 added them explicitly requested that they not
       appear in the list (using the -n option of the compadd builtin command)
       or  they	 are  matches  which  duplicate	 a  string already in the list
       (because they differ only in things like prefixes or suffixes that  are
       not  displayed).	  In  the  list used for menu selection, however, even
       these matches are shown so that it is  possible	to  select  them.   To
       highlight such matches the hi and du capabilities in the ZLS_COLORS and
       ZLS_COLOURS parameters are supported for hidden matches	of  the	 first
       and second kind, respectively.

       Selecting matches is done by moving the mark around using the zle move‐
       ment functions.	When not all matches can be shown on the screen at the
       same  time,  the	 list will scroll up and down when crossing the top or
       bottom line.  The following zle functions have special  meaning	during
       menu selection:

       accept-line
	      accepts the current match and leaves menu selection

       send-break
	      leaves  menu selection and restores the previous contents of the
	      command line

       redisplay, clear-screen
	      execute their normal function without leaving menu selection

       accept-and-hold, accept-and-menu-complete
	      accept the  currently  inserted  match  and  continue  selection
	      allowing to select the next match to insert into the line

       accept-and-infer-next-history
	      accepts  the  current  match and then tries completion with menu
	      selection again;	in the case of files this allows one to select
	      a directory and immediately attempt to complete files in it;  if
	      there are no matches, a message is shown and one can use undo to
	      go  back	to  completion	on the previous level, every other key
	      leaves menu selection (including the other zle  functions	 which
	      are otherwise special during menu selection)

       undo   removes matches inserted during the menu selection by one of the
	      three functions before

       down-history, down-line-or-history
       vi-down-line-or-history,	 down-line-or-search
	      moves the mark one line down

       up-history, up-line-or-history
       vi-up-line-or-history, up-line-or-search
	      moves the mark one line up

       forward-char, vi-forward-char
	      moves the mark one column right

       backward-char, vi-backward-char
	      moves the mark one column left

       forward-word, vi-forward-word
       vi-forward-word-end, emacs-forward-word
	      moves the mark one screenful down

       backward-word, vi-backward-word, emacs-backward-word
	      moves the mark one screenful up

       vi-forward-blank-word, vi-forward-blank-word-end
	      moves the mark to the first line of the next group of matches

       vi-backward-blank-word
	      moves the mark to the last line of the previous group of matches

       beginning-of-history
	      moves the mark to the first line

       end-of-history
	      moves the mark to the last line

       beginning-of-buffer-or-history, beginning-of-line
       beginning-of-line-hist, vi-beginning-of-line
	      moves the mark to the leftmost column

       end-of-buffer-or-history, end-of-line
       end-of-line-hist, vi-end-of-line
	      moves the mark to the rightmost column

       complete-word, menu-complete, expand-or-complete
       expand-or-complete-prefix, menu-expand-or-complete
	      moves the mark to the next match

       reverse-menu-complete
	      moves the mark to the previous match

       vi-insert
	      this toggles between normal and interactive mode; in interactive
	      mode the keys bound to self-insert and self-insert-unmeta insert
	      into the command line as in  normal  editing  mode  but  without
	      leaving menu selection; after each character completion is tried
	      again and the list changes to contain only the new matches;  the
	      completion  widgets  make	 the  longest  unambiguous  string  be
	      inserted in the command line and undo  and  backward-delete-char
	      go back to the previous set of matches

       history-incremental-search-forward,
	      history-incremental-search-backward   this   starts  incremental
	      searches in the list of completions  displayed;  in  this	 mode,
	      accept-line  only	 leaves	 incremental search, going back to the
	      normal menu selection mode

       All movement functions wrap around at the edges; any other zle function
       not  listed  leaves  menu  selection and executes that function.	 It is
       possible to make widgets in the above list do the  same	by  using  the
       form  of	 the  widget  with  a  `.'  in front.  For example, the widget
       `.accept-line' has the effect of leaving menu selection	and  accepting
       the entire command line.

       During  this  selection the widget uses the keymap menuselect.  Any key
       that is not defined in this keymap or that is bound to undefined-key is
       looked  up  in  the  keymap currently selected.	This is used to ensure
       that the most important keys used during selection (namely  the	cursor
       keys,  return,  and  TAB) have sensible defaults.  However, keys in the
       menuselect keymap can be modified directly using	 the  bindkey  builtin
       command	(see zshmodules(1)). For example, to make the return key leave
       menu selection without accepting the match currently selected one could
       call

	      bindkey -M menuselect '^M' send-break

       after loading the zsh/complist module.

THE ZSH/COMPUTIL MODULE
       The  zsh/computil module adds several builtin commands that are used by
       some of the completion functions in  the	 completion  system  based  on
       shell  functions	 (see  zshcompsys(1)  ).   Except  for compquote these
       builtin commands are very specialised and  thus	not  very  interesting
       when  writing your own completion functions.  In summary, these builtin
       commands are:

       comparguments
	      This is used by the _arguments function to do the	 argument  and
	      command  line parsing.  Like compdescribe it has an option -i to
	      do the parsing and initialize some internal  state  and  various
	      options to access the state information to decide what should be
	      completed.

       compdescribe
	      This is used by the _describe function to build the displays for
	      the  matches and to get the strings to add as matches with their
	      options.	On the first call one of the options -i or  -I	should
	      be  supplied  as the first argument.  In the first case, display
	      strings without the descriptions will be generated, in the  sec‐
	      ond  case,  the  string  used to separate the matches from their
	      descriptions must be  given  as  the  second  argument  and  the
	      descriptions  (if	 any)  will be shown.  All other arguments are
	      like the definition arguments to _describe itself.

	      Once compdescribe has been called with either the -i or  the  -I
	      option,  it  can be repeatedly called with the -g option and the
	      names of five arrays as its arguments.  This will	 step  through
	      the different sets of matches and store the options in the first
	      array, the strings with descriptions in the second, the  matches
	      for  these in the third, the strings without descriptions in the
	      fourth, and the matches for them in the fifth array.  These  are
	      then  directly given to compadd to register the matches with the
	      completion code.

       compfiles
	      Used by the _path_files function to optimize  complex  recursive
	      filename generation (globbing).  It does three things.  With the
	      -p and -P options it builds the glob patterns to use,  including
	      the  paths  already  handled and trying to optimize the patterns
	      with respect to the prefix and suffix  from  the	line  and  the
	      match  specification  currently  used.   The  -i option does the
	      directory tests for the ignore-parents style and the  -r	option
	      tests  if	 a  component for some of the matches are equal to the
	      string on the line and removes all  other	 matches  if  that  is
	      true.

       compgroups
	      Used  by	the  _tags  function to implement the internals of the
	      group-order style.  This only takes its arguments	 as  names  of
	      completion  groups and creates the groups for it (all six types:
	      sorted and unsorted,  both  without  removing  duplicates,  with
	      removing	all  duplicates	 and  with removing consecutive dupli‐
	      cates).

       compquote [ -p ] names ...
	      There may be reasons to write completion functions that have  to
	      add the matches using the -Q option to compadd and perform quot‐
	      ing themselves.  Instead of interpreting the first character  of
	      the  all_quotes  key  of	the  compstate special association and
	      using the q flag for parameter  expansions,  one	can  use  this
	      builtin command.	The arguments are the names of scalar or array
	      parameters and the values of  these  parameters  are  quoted  as
	      needed  for  the	innermost  quoting level.  If the -p option is
	      given, quoting is done as if there is  some  prefix  before  the
	      values  of the parameters, so that a leading equal sign will not
	      be quoted.

	      The return value is non-zero in case of an error and zero other‐
	      wise.

       comptags
       comptry
	      These implement the internals of the tags mechanism.

       compvalues
	      Like comparguments, but for the _values function.

THE ZSH/DATETIME MODULE
       The zsh/datetime module makes available one builtin command:

       strftime [ -s scalar ] format epochtime
	      Output the date denoted by epochtime in the format specified.

	      If  -s  scalar  is  given,  assign the date to scalar instead of
	      printing it.

       The zsh/datetime module makes available one parameter:

       EPOCHSECONDS
	      An integer value representing the number of  seconds  since  the
	      epoch.

THE ZSH/DELTOCHAR MODULE
       The zsh/deltochar module makes available two ZLE functions:

       delete-to-char
	      Read  a  character from the keyboard, and delete from the cursor
	      position up to and including the next (or, with repeat count  n,
	      the  nth)	 instance  of  that character.	Negative repeat counts
	      mean delete backwards.

       zap-to-char
	      This behaves like delete-to-char, except that the	 final	occur‐
	      rence of the character itself is not deleted.

THE ZSH/EXAMPLE MODULE
       The zsh/example module makes available one builtin command:

       example [ -flags ] [ args ... ]
	      Displays the flags and arguments it is invoked with.

       The  purpose  of the module is to serve as an example of how to write a
       module.

THE ZSH/FILES MODULE
       The  zsh/files  module  makes  some  standard  commands	available   as
       builtins:

       chgrp [ -Rs ] group filename ...
	      Changes  group  of files specified.  This is equivalent to chown
	      with a user-spec argument of `:group'.

       chown [ -Rs ] user-spec filename ...
	      Changes ownership and group of files specified.

	      The user-spec can be in four forms:

	      user   change owner to user; do not change group
	      user:: change owner to user; do not change group
	      user:  change owner to user;  change  group  to  user's  primary
		     group
	      user:group
		     change owner to user; change group to group
	      :group do not change owner; change group to group

	      In each case, the `:' may instead be a `.'.  The rule is that if
	      there is a `:' then the separator is `:', otherwise if there  is
	      a	 `.'  then the separator is `.', otherwise there is no separa‐
	      tor.

	      Each of user and group may be either a username (or group	 name,
	      as appropriate) or a decimal user ID (group ID).	Interpretation
	      as a name takes precedence, if there is an all-numeric  username
	      (or group name).

	      The  -R option causes chown to recursively descend into directo‐
	      ries, changing the ownership of all files in the directory after
	      changing the ownership of the directory itself.

	      The  -s  option  is  a zsh extension to chown functionality.  It
	      enables paranoid behaviour, intended to avoid security  problems
	      involving	 a chown being tricked into affecting files other than
	      the ones intended.  It will refuse to follow symbolic links,  so
	      that  (for  example) ``chown luser /tmp/foo/passwd'' can't acci‐
	      dentally chown /etc/passwd if /tmp/foo happens to be a  link  to
	      /etc.  It will also check where it is after leaving directories,
	      so that a recursive chown of a deep directory tree can't end  up
	      recursively chowning /usr as a result of directories being moved
	      up the tree.

       ln [ -dfis ] filename dest
       ln [ -dfis ] filename ... dir
	      Creates hard (or, with -s, symbolic) links.  In the first	 form,
	      the specified destination is created, as a link to the specified
	      filename.	 In the second form, each of the filenames is taken in
	      turn,  and  linked to a pathname in the specified directory that
	      has the same last pathname component.

	      Normally, ln will not attempt to create hard links  to  directo‐
	      ries.   This check can be overridden using the -d option.	 Typi‐
	      cally only the super-user can actually succeed in creating  hard
	      links  to directories.  This does not apply to symbolic links in
	      any case.

	      By default, existing files cannot be replaced by links.  The  -i
	      option  causes  the  user to be queried about replacing existing
	      files.  The -f option  causes  existing  files  to  be  silently
	      deleted, without querying.  -f takes precedence.

       mkdir [ -p ] [ -m mode ] dir ...
	      Creates  directories.   With  the -p option, non-existing parent
	      directories are first created if necessary, and there will be no
	      complaint if the directory already exists.  The -m option can be
	      used to specify (in octal) a set of  file	 permissions  for  the
	      created  directories, otherwise mode 777 modified by the current
	      umask (see umask(2)) is used.

       mv [ -fi ] filename dest
       mv [ -fi ] filename ... dir
	      Moves files.  In the first form, the specified filename is moved
	      to  the  specified destination.  In the second form, each of the
	      filenames is taken in turn, and moved to a pathname in the spec‐
	      ified directory that has the same last pathname component.

	      By  default,  the user will be queried before replacing any file
	      that the user cannot  write  to,	but  writable  files  will  be
	      silently	removed.   The -i option causes the user to be queried
	      about replacing any existing files.  The -f  option  causes  any
	      existing	files  to  be  silently deleted, without querying.  -f
	      takes precedence.

	      Note that this mv will not move files across devices.   Histori‐
	      cal  versions  of	 mv,  when actual renaming is impossible, fall
	      back on  copying	and  removing  files;  if  this	 behaviour  is
	      desired,	use  cp	 and rm manually.  This may change in a future
	      version.

       rm [ -dfirs ] filename ...
	      Removes files and directories specified.

	      Normally, rm will not remove directories	(except	 with  the  -r
	      option).	 The  -d  option causes rm to try removing directories
	      with unlink (see unlink(2)), the same  method  used  for	files.
	      Typically	 only the super-user can actually succeed in unlinking
	      directories in this way.	-d takes precedence over -r.

	      By default, the user will be queried before  removing  any  file
	      that  the	 user  cannot  write  to,  but	writable files will be
	      silently removed.	 The -i option causes the user to  be  queried
	      about  removing  any  files.   The  -f option causes files to be
	      silently deleted, without querying,  and	suppresses  all	 error
	      indications.  -f takes precedence.

	      The -r option causes rm to recursively descend into directories,
	      deleting all files in the directory before removing  the	direc‐
	      tory with the rmdir system call (see rmdir(2)).

	      The  -s  option  is  a  zsh  extension  to rm functionality.  It
	      enables paranoid behaviour, intended to  avoid  common  security
	      problems	involving  a  root-run	rm being tricked into removing
	      files other than the ones intended.  It will  refuse  to	follow
	      symbolic	links,	so  that  (for example) ``rm /tmp/foo/passwd''
	      can't accidentally remove /etc/passwd if /tmp/foo happens to  be
	      a	 link  to  /etc.  It will also check where it is after leaving
	      directories, so that a recursive removal	of  a  deep  directory
	      tree  can't  end	up  recursively	 removing  /usr as a result of
	      directories being moved up the tree.

       rmdir dir ...
	      Removes empty directories specified.

       sync   Calls the system call of the  same  name	(see  sync(2)),	 which
	      flushes  dirty  buffers to disk.	It might return before the I/O
	      has actually been completed.

THE ZSH/MAPFILE MODULE
       The zsh/mapfile module provides one special associative array parameter
       of the same name.

       mapfile
	      This  associative	 array	takes  as keys the names of files; the
	      resulting value is the  content  of  the	file.	The  value  is
	      treated  identically  to any other text coming from a parameter.
	      The value may also be assigned to, in which  case	 the  file  in
	      question	is  written (whether or not it originally existed); or
	      an element may be unset, which will delete the file in question.
	      For  example, `vared mapfile[myfile]' works as expected, editing
	      the file `myfile'.

	      When the array is accessed as a whole, the keys are the names of
	      files  in	 the  current  directory, and the values are empty (to
	      save a huge overhead in memory).	 Thus  ${(k)mapfile}  has  the
	      same  affect  as	the  glob operator *(D), since files beginning
	      with a dot are not special.  Care must be taken with expressions
	      such  as	rm  ${(k)mapfile}, which will delete every file in the
	      current directory without the usual `rm *' test.

	      The parameter mapfile may be made read-only; in that case, files
	      referenced may not be written or deleted.

   Limitations
       Although	 reading  and  writing	of the file in question is efficiently
       handled, zsh's internal memory management may be	 arbitrarily  baroque.
       Thus  it should not automatically be assumed that use of mapfile repre‐
       sents a gain in efficiency over use of other mechanisms.	 Note in  par‐
       ticular	that  the whole contents of the file will always reside physi‐
       cally in memory when accessed (possibly multiple times, due to standard
       parameter substitution operations).  In particular, this means handling
       of sufficiently long files (greater than the machine's swap  space,  or
       than the range of the pointer type) will be incorrect.

       No  errors  are	printed	 or  flagged  for non-existent, unreadable, or
       unwritable files, as the parameter mechanism is too low	in  the	 shell
       execution hierarchy to make this convenient.

       It  is  unfortunate that the mechanism for loading modules does not yet
       allow the user to specify the name of the shell parameter to  be	 given
       the special behaviour.

THE ZSH/MATHFUNC MODULE
       The  zsh/mathfunc  module  provides standard mathematical functions for
       use when evaluating mathematical formulae.  The syntax agrees with nor‐
       mal C and FORTRAN conventions, for example,

	      (( f = sin(0.3) ))

       assigns the sine of 0.3 to the parameter f.

       Most  functions	take  floating	point  arguments and return a floating
       point value.  However, any necessary conversions	 from  or  to  integer
       type  will  be  performed  automatically by the shell.  Apart from atan
       with a second argument and the abs, int and float functions, all	 func‐
       tions  behave as noted in the manual page for the corresponding C func‐
       tion, except that any arguments out of range for the function in	 ques‐
       tion will be detected by the shell and an error reported.

       The  following  functions  take a single floating point argument: acos,
       acosh, asin, asinh, atan, atanh, cbrt, ceil, cos, cosh, erf, erfc, exp,
       expm1,  fabs,  floor,  gamma,  j0, j1, lgamma, log, log10, log1p, logb,
       sin, sinh, sqrt, tan, tanh, y0, y1.  The atan function  can  optionally
       take  a	second	argument, in which case it behaves like the C function
       atan2.  The ilogb function takes a single floating point argument,  but
       returns an integer.

       The  function signgam takes no arguments, and returns an integer, which
       is the C variable of the same name, as  described  in  gamma(3).	  Note
       that  it	 is therefore only useful immediately after a call to gamma or
       lgamma.	Note also that `signgam()' and `signgam' are distinct  expres‐
       sions.

       The  following  functions  take two floating point arguments: copysign,
       fmod, hypot, nextafter.

       The following take an integer first argument and a floating point  sec‐
       ond argument: jn, yn.

       The  following take a floating point first argument and an integer sec‐
       ond argument: ldexp, scalb.

       The function abs does not convert the type of its single	 argument;  it
       returns	the  absolute  value  of  either a floating point number or an
       integer.	 The functions float and int convert their  arguments  into  a
       floating point or integer value (by truncation) respectively.

       Note  that  the C pow function is available in ordinary math evaluation
       as the `**' operator and is not provided here.

       The function rand48 is available if your system's mathematical  library
       has the function erand48(3).  It returns a pseudo-random floating point
       number between 0 and 1.	It takes a single string optional argument.

       If the argument is not present, the random number seed  is  initialised
       by  three calls to the rand(3) function --- this produces the same ran‐
       dom numbers as the next three values of $RANDOM.

       If the argument is present, it gives the name  of  a  scalar  parameter
       where  the  current  random  number  seed will be stored.  On the first
       call, the value must contain at least twelve  hexadecimal  digits  (the
       remainder of the string is ignored), or the seed will be initialised in
       the same manner as for a call to rand48 with no	argument.   Subsequent
       calls  to  rand48(param)	 will  then maintain the seed in the parameter
       param as a string of twelve hexadecimal digits, with no base signifier.
       The  random  number  sequences  for different parameters are completely
       independent, and are also independent from that used by calls to rand48
       with no argument.

       For example, consider

	      print $(( rand48(seed) ))
	      print $(( rand48() ))
	      print $(( rand48(seed) ))

       Assuming	 $seed	does  not  exist,  it will be initialised by the first
       call.  In the second call, the default seed is initialised; note,  how‐
       ever,  that  because of the properties of rand() there is a correlation
       between the seeds used for the two initialisations, so for more	secure
       uses,  you  should  generate  your  own	12-byte	 seed.	The third call
       returns to the same sequence of random numbers used in the first	 call,
       unaffected by the intervening rand48().

THE ZSH/PARAMETER MODULE
       The  zsh/parameter  module  gives  access  to some of the internal hash
       tables used by the shell by defining some special parameters.

       options
	      The keys for this associative array are the names of the options
	      that  can	 be  set  and  unset  using  the  setopt  and unsetopt
	      builtins. The value of each key is either the string on  if  the
	      option  is  currently  set,  or  the string off if the option is
	      unset.  Setting a key to one of these strings is like setting or
	      unsetting	 the  option,  respectively.  Unsetting	 a key in this
	      array is like setting it to the value off.

       commands
	      This array gives access to the command hash table. The keys  are
	      the  names of external commands, the values are the pathnames of
	      the files that would be  executed	 when  the  command  would  be
	      invoked. Setting a key in this array defines a new entry in this
	      table in the same way as with the hash builtin. Unsetting a  key
	      as  in  `unset  "commands[foo]"' removes the entry for the given
	      key from the command hash table.

       functions
	      This associative array maps names of enabled functions to	 their
	      definitions.  Setting  a	key  in it is like defining a function
	      with the name given by the key and the body given by the	value.
	      Unsetting a key removes the definition for the function named by
	      the key.

       dis_functions
	      Like functions but for disabled functions.

       builtins
	      This associative array gives information about the builtin  com‐
	      mands  currently	enabled. The keys are the names of the builtin
	      commands and the values are either `undefined' for builtin  com‐
	      mands that will automatically be loaded from a module if invoked
	      or `defined' for builtin commands that are already loaded.

       dis_builtins
	      Like builtins but for disabled builtin commands.

       reswords
	      This array contains the enabled reserved words.

       dis_reswords
	      Like reswords but for disabled reserved words.

       aliases
	      This maps the names of the regular aliases currently enabled  to
	      their expansions.

       dis_aliases
	      Like aliases but for disabled regular aliases.

       galiases
	      Like aliases, but for global aliases.

       dis_galiases
	      Like galiases but for disabled global aliases.

       saliases
	      Like raliases, but for suffix aliases.

       dis_saliases
	      Like saliases but for disabled suffix aliases.

       parameters
	      The  keys in this associative array are the names of the parame‐
	      ters currently defined. The values are  strings  describing  the
	      type  of the parameter, in the same format used by the t parame‐
	      ter flag, see zshexpn(1) .  Setting or unsetting	keys  in  this
	      array is not possible.

       modules
	      An  associative array giving information about modules. The keys
	      are  the	names  of  the	modules	 loaded,  registered   to   be
	      autoloaded,  or  aliased.	 The  value says which state the named
	      module is in and is one of the strings  `loaded',	 `autoloaded',
	      or  `alias:name',	 where	name is the name the module is aliased
	      to.

	      Setting or unsetting keys in this array is not possible.

       dirstack
	      A normal array holding the elements of the directory stack. Note
	      that  the	 output	 of the dirs builtin command includes one more
	      directory, the current working directory.

       history
	      This associative array maps history event numbers	 to  the  full
	      history lines.

       historywords
	      A special array containing the words stored in the history.

       jobdirs
	      This  associative array maps job numbers to the directories from
	      which the job was started (which may not be the  current	direc‐
	      tory of the job).

       jobtexts
	      This associative array maps job numbers to the texts of the com‐
	      mand lines that were used to start the jobs.

       jobstates
	      This associative array gives information about the states of the
	      jobs  currently known. The keys are the job numbers and the val‐
	      ues are strings of the form  `job-state:mark:pid=state...'.  The
	      job-state	 gives the state the whole job is currently in, one of
	      `running', `suspended', or `done'. The mark is `+' for the  cur‐
	      rent  job, `-' for the previous job and empty otherwise. This is
	      followed by one `pid=state' for every process in	the  job.  The
	      pids are, of course, the process IDs and the state describes the
	      state of that process.

       nameddirs
	      This associative array maps the names of	named  directories  to
	      the pathnames they stand for.

       userdirs
	      This associative array maps user names to the pathnames of their
	      home directories.

       funcstack
	      This array contains the names of the functions  currently	 being
	      executed.	 The  first  element is the name of the function using
	      the parameter.

THE ZSH/PCRE MODULE
       The zsh/pcre module makes some commands available as builtins:

       pcre_compile [ -aimx ] PCRE
	      Compiles a perl-compatible regular expression.

	      Option -a will force the pattern to be anchored.	Option -i will
	      compile  a  case-insensitive  pattern.  Option -m will compile a
	      multi-line pattern; that is, ^ and $ will match newlines	within
	      the  pattern.   Option  -x  will	compile	 an  extended pattern,
	      wherein whitespace and # comments are ignored.

       pcre_study
	      Studies the previously-compiled PCRE which may result in	faster
	      matching.

       pcre_match [ -a arr ] string
	      Returns  successfully  if string matches the previously-compiled
	      PCRE.

	      If  the  expression  captures  substrings	 within	  parentheses,
	      pcre_match will set the array $match to those substrings, unless
	      the -a option is given, in which case it will set the array arr.

       The zsh/pcre module makes available the following test condition:
       expr -pcre-match pcre
	      Matches a string against a perl-compatible regular expression.

	      For example,

	      [[ "$text" -pcre-match ^d+$ ]] && print text  variable  contains
	      only "d's".

THE ZSH/SCHED MODULE
       The zsh/sched module makes available one builtin command:

       sched [+]hh:mm command ...
       sched [ -item ]
	      Make an entry in the scheduled list of commands to execute.  The
	      time may be specified in either absolute or relative time.  With
	      no  arguments,  prints the list of scheduled commands.  With the
	      argument `-item', removes the given item from the list.

THE ZSH/NET/SOCKET MODULE
       The zsh/net/socket module makes available one builtin command:

       zsocket [ -altv ] [ -d fd ] [ args ]
	      zsocket is implemented as a builtin to allow full use  of	 shell
	      command line editing, file I/O, and job control mechanisms.

   Outbound Connections
       zsocket [ -v ] [ -d fd ] filename
	      Open a new Unix domain connection to filename.  The shell param‐
	      eter REPLY will be set to the file  descriptor  associated  with
	      that  connection.	  Currently,  only stream connections are sup‐
	      ported.

	      If -d is specified, its argument will be	taken  as  the	target
	      file descriptor for the connection.

	      In order to elicit more verbose output, use -v.

   Inbound Connections
       zsocket -l [ -v ] [ -d fd ] filename
	      zsocket  -l will open a socket listening on filename.  The shell
	      parameter REPLY will be set to the  file	descriptor  associated
	      with that listener.

	      If  -d  is  specified,  its argument will be taken as the target
	      file descriptor for the connection.

	      In order to elicit more verbose output, use -v.

       zsocket -a [ -tv ] [ -d targetfd ] listenfd
	      zsocket -a will accept an	 incoming  connection  to  the	socket
	      associated with listenfd.	 The shell parameter REPLY will be set
	      to the file descriptor associated with the inbound connection.

	      If -d is specified, its argument will be	taken  as  the	target
	      file descriptor for the connection.

	      If  -t  is specified, zsocket will return if no incoming connec‐
	      tion is pending.	Otherwise it will wait for one.

	      In order to elicit more verbose output, use -v.

THE ZSH/STAT MODULE
       The zsh/stat module makes available one builtin command:

       stat [ -gnNolLtTrs ] [ -f fd ] [ -H hash ] [ -A array ] [ -F  fmt  ]  [
       +element ] [ file ... ]
	      The  command  acts  as  a front end to the stat system call (see
	      stat(2)).	 If the stat call fails, the appropriate system	 error
	      message  printed and status 1 is returned.  The fields of struct
	      stat give information about the files provided as	 arguments  to
	      the command.  In addition to those available from the stat call,
	      an extra element `link' is provided.  These elements are:

	      device The number of the device on which the file resides.

	      inode  The unique number of the file  on	this  device  (`inode'
		     number).

	      mode   The mode of the file; that is, the file's type and access
		     permissions.  With the -s option, this will  be  returned
		     as a string corresponding to the first column in the dis‐
		     play of the ls -l command.

	      nlink  The number of hard links to the file.

	      uid    The user ID of the	 owner	of  the	 file.	 With  the  -s
		     option, this is displayed as a user name.

	      gid    The  group	 ID  of the file.  With the -s option, this is
		     displayed as a group name.

	      rdev   The raw device number.  This is only useful  for  special
		     devices.

	      size   The size of the file in bytes.

	      atime
	      mtime
	      ctime  The  last	access, modification and inode change times of
		     the file, respectively, as the number  of	seconds	 since
		     midnight  GMT  on 1st January, 1970.  With the -s option,
		     these are printed as strings for the local time zone; the
		     format can be altered with the -F option, and with the -g
		     option the times are in GMT.

	      blksize
		     The number of bytes in one allocation block on the device
		     on which the file resides.

	      block  The number of disk blocks used by the file.

	      link   If	 the  file  is	a link and the -L option is in effect,
		     this contains the name of the file linked	to,  otherwise
		     it	 is  empty.   Note  that  if  this element is selected
		     (``stat +link'') then  the	 -L  option  is	 automatically
		     used.

	      A	 particular element may be selected by including its name pre‐
	      ceded by a `+' in the option list; only one element is  allowed.
	      The  element may be shortened to any unique set of leading char‐
	      acters.  Otherwise, all elements will be shown for all files.

	      Options:

	      -A array
		     Instead of displaying the	results	 on  standard  output,
		     assign  them  to  an  array,  one struct stat element per
		     array element for each file in order.  In this case  nei‐
		     ther  the	name  of the element nor the name of the files
		     appears in array unless the -t or -n options were	given,
		     respectively.   If	 -t is given, the element name appears
		     as a prefix to the appropriate array element;  if	-n  is
		     given,  the file name appears as a separate array element
		     preceding all the others.	Other formatting  options  are
		     respected.

	      -H hash
		     Similar  to  -A,  but  instead assign the values to hash.
		     The keys are the elements listed above.  If the -n option
		     is	 provided then the name of the file is included in the
		     hash with key name.

	      -f fd  Use the file on  file  descriptor	fd  instead  of	 named
		     files; no list of file names is allowed in this case.

	      -F fmt Supplies a strftime (see strftime(3)) string for the for‐
		     matting of the time elements.  The -s option is implied.

	      -g     Show the time elements in the  GMT	 time  zone.   The  -s
		     option is implied.

	      -l     List  the	names of the type elements (to standard output
		     or an  array  as  appropriate)  and  return  immediately;
		     options other than -A and arguments are ignored.

	      -L     Perform an lstat (see lstat(2)) rather than a stat system
		     call.  In this case, if the file is a  link,  information
		     about  the	 link  itself  rather  than the target file is
		     returned.	This option is required to make the link  ele‐
		     ment useful.

	      -n     Always  show  the names of files.	Usually these are only
		     shown when output is to standard output and there is more
		     than one file in the list.

	      -N     Never show the names of files.

	      -o     If a raw file mode is printed, show it in octal, which is
		     more useful for human consumption	than  the  default  of
		     decimal.	A  leading  zero will be printed in this case.
		     Note that this does not affect whether a raw or formatted
		     file  mode is shown, which is controlled by the -r and -s
		     options, nor whether a mode is shown at all.

	      -r     Print raw data (the default format) alongside string data
		     (the  -s  format); the string data appears in parentheses
		     after the raw data.

	      -s     Print mode, uid, gid  and	the  three  time  elements  as
		     strings  instead  of numbers.  In each case the format is
		     like that of ls -l.

	      -t     Always show the type names for  the  elements  of	struct
		     stat.   Usually  these  are  only shown when output is to
		     standard  output  and  no	individual  element  has  been
		     selected.

	      -T     Never show the type names of the struct stat elements.

THE ZSH/SYSTEM MODULE
       The  zsh/system	module	makes  available  three builtin commands and a
       parameter.

BUILTINS
       syserror [ -e errvar ] [ -p prefix ] [ errno | errname ]
	      This command prints out the error message associated with errno,
	      a system error number, followed by a newline to standard error.

	      Instead of the error number, a name errname, for example ENOENT,
	      may be used.  The set of names is the same as  the  contents  of
	      the array errnos, see below.

	      If  the  string  prefix  is given, it is printed in front of the
	      error message, with no intervening space.

	      If errvar is supplied, the entire message, without a newline, is
	      assigned to the parameter names errvar and nothing is output.

	      A	 return	 value	of  0  indicates  the message was successfully
	      printed (although it may not be useful if the error  number  was
	      out  of  the  system's  range), a return value of 1 indicates an
	      error in the parameters, and a return value of 2	indicates  the
	      error name was not recognised (no message is printed for this).

       sysread [ -c countvar ] [ -i infd ] [ -o outfd ]
	 [ -s bufsize ] [ -t timeout ] [ param ]
	      Perform  a single system read from file descriptor infd, or zero
	      if that is not given.  The result of the read is stored in param
	      or REPLY if that is not given.  If countvar is given, the number
	      of bytes read is assigned to the parameter named by countvar.

	      The maximum number of bytes read is bufsize or 8192 if  that  is
	      not  given, however the command returns as soon as any number of
	      bytes was successfully read.

	      If timeout is given, it specifies a timeout  in  seconds,	 which
	      may be zero to poll the file descriptor.	This is handled by the
	      poll system call if available, otherwise the select system  call
	      if available.

	      If  outfd	 is  given,  an attempt is made to write all the bytes
	      just read to the file descriptor outfd.  If this fails,  because
	      of a system error other than EINTR or because of an internal zsh
	      error during an interrupt, the bytes read but  not  written  are
	      stored  in  the parameter named by param if supplied (no default
	      is used in this case), and the number  of	 bytes	read  but  not
	      written  is stored in the parameter named by countvar if that is
	      supplied.	 If it was successful, countvar contains the full num‐
	      ber of bytes transferred, as usual, and param is not set.

	      The  error EINTR (interrupted system call) is handled internally
	      so that shell interrupts are transparent	to  the	 caller.   Any
	      other error causes a return.

	      The possible return values are
	      0	     At	 least	one byte of data was successfully read and, if
		     appropriate, written.

	      1	     There was an error in  the	 parameters  to	 the  command.
		     This  is the only error for which a message is printed to
		     standard error.

	      2	     There was an error on the read, or on polling  the	 input
		     file descriptor for a timeout.  The parameter ERRNO gives
		     the error.

	      3	     Data were successfully read, but there was an error writ‐
		     ing them to outfd.	 The parameter ERRNO gives the error.

	      4	     The  attempt  to  read timed out.	Note this does not set
		     ERRNO as this is not a system error.

	      5	     No system error occurred, but zero bytes were read.  This
		     usually  indicates	 end  of file.	The parameters are set
		     according to the  usual  rules;  no  write	 to  outfd  is
		     attempted.

       syswrite [ -c countvar ] [ -o outfd ] data
	      The  data	 (a  single  string  of bytes) are written to the file
	      descriptor outfd, or 1 if that is not  given,  using  the	 write
	      system call.  Multiple write operations may be used if the first
	      does not write all the data.

	      If countvar is given, the number of byte written	is  stored  in
	      the parameter named by countvar; this may not be the full length
	      of data if an error occurred.

	      The error EINTR (interrupted system call) is handled  internally
	      by  retrying;  otherwise	an error causes the command to return.
	      For example, if the file descriptor is set to non-blocking  out‐
	      put,  an	error EAGAIN (on some systems, EWOULDBLOCK) may result
	      in the command returning early.

	      The return status may be 0 for success, 1 for an	error  in  the
	      parameters  to  the  command, or 2 for an error on the write; no
	      error message is printed in the last  case,  but	the  parameter
	      ERRNO will reflect the error that occurred.

PARAMETERS
       errnos A	 readonly  array of the names of errors defined on the system.
	      These are typically macros defined in C by including the	system
	      header  file  errno.h.   The  index  of  each name (assuming the
	      option KSH_ARRAYS is unset) corresponds  to  the	error  number.
	      Error numbers num before the last known error which have no name
	      are given the name Enum in the array.

	      Note that aliases for errors are not handled; only the canonical
	      name is used.

THE ZSH/NET/TCP MODULE
       The zsh/net/tcp module makes available one builtin command:

       ztcp [ -acflLtv ] [ -d fd ] [ args ]
	      ztcp is implemented as a builtin to allow full use of shell com‐
	      mand line editing, file I/O, and job control mechanisms.

	      If ztcp is run with no options, it will output the  contents  of
	      its session table.

	      If  it  is  run with only the option -L, it will output the con‐
	      tents of the session table in a format  suitable	for  automatic
	      parsing.	 The option is ignored if given with a command to open
	      or close a session.  The output consists of a set of lines,  one
	      per session, each containing the following elements separated by
	      spaces:

	      File descriptor
		     The file descriptor in use for the connection.  For  nor‐
		     mal  inbound (I) and outbound (O) connections this may be
		     read and written by the usual shell mechanisms.  However,
		     it should only be close with `ztcp -c'.

	      Connection type
		     A letter indicating how the session was created:

		     Z	    A session created with the zftp command.

		     L	    A connection opened for listening with `ztcp -l'.

		     I	    An inbound connection accepted with `ztcp -a'.

		     O	    An	outbound  connection  created  with `ztcp host
			    ...'.

	      The local host
		     This is usually set to an	all-zero  IP  address  as  the
		     address of the localhost is irrelevant.

	      The local port
		     This  is  likely  to be zero unless the connection is for
		     listening.

	      The remote host
		     This is the fully qualified domain name of the  peer,  if
		     available,	 else  an  IP  address.	  It is an all-zero IP
		     address for a session opened for listening.

	      The remote port
		     This is zero for a connection opened for listening.

   Outbound Connections
       ztcp [ -v ] [ -d fd ] host [ port ]
	      Open a new TCP connection to host.  If the port is  omitted,  it
	      will  default  to	 port 23.  The connection will be added to the
	      session table and the shell parameter REPLY will be set  to  the
	      file descriptor associated with that connection.

	      If  -d  is  specified,  its argument will be taken as the target
	      file descriptor for the connection.

	      In order to elicit more verbose output, use -v.

   Inbound Connections
       ztcp -l [ -v ] [ -d fd ] port
	      ztcp -l will open a socket listening on TCP  port.   The	socket
	      will be added to the session table and the shell parameter REPLY
	      will be set to the file descriptor  associated  with  that  lis‐
	      tener.

	      If  -d  is  specified,  its argument will be taken as the target
	      file descriptor for the connection.

	      In order to elicit more verbose output, use -v.

       ztcp -a [ -tv ] [ -d targetfd ] listenfd
	      ztcp -a will accept an incoming connection to the	 port  associ‐
	      ated with listenfd.  The connection will be added to the session
	      table and the shell parameter REPLY will	be  set	 to  the  file
	      descriptor associated with the inbound connection.

	      If  -d  is  specified,  its argument will be taken as the target
	      file descriptor for the connection.

	      If -t is specified, ztcp will return if no  incoming  connection
	      is pending.  Otherwise it will wait for one.

	      In order to elicit more verbose output, use -v.

   Closing Connections
       ztcp -cf [ -v ] [ fd ]
       ztcp -c [ -v ] [ fd ]
	      ztcp  -c	will  close the socket associated with fd.  The socket
	      will be removed from the session table.  If fd is not specified,
	      ztcp will close everything in the session table.

	      Normally, sockets registered by zftp (see zshmodules(1) ) cannot
	      be closed this way.  In order to force such a socket closed, use
	      -f.

	      In order to elicit more verbose output, use -v.

   Example
       Here  is	 how  to create a TCP connection between two instances of zsh.
       We need to pick an unassigned port; here we  use	 the  randomly	chosen
       5123.

       On host1,
	      zmodload zsh/net/tcp
	      ztcp -l 5123
	      listenfd=$REPLY
	      ztcp -a $listenfd
	      fd=$REPLY
       The  second from last command blocks until there is an incoming connec‐
       tion.

       Now create a connection from host2 (which may, of course, be  the  same
       machine):
	      zmodload zsh/net/tcp
	      ztcp host1 5123
	      fd=$REPLY

       Now  on	each  host,  $fd contains a file descriptor for talking to the
       other.  For example, on host1:
	      print This is a message >&$fd
       and on host2:
	      read -r line <&$fd; print -r - $line
       prints `This is a message'.

       To tidy up, on host1:
	      ztcp -c $listenfd
	      ztcp -c $fd
       and on host2
	      ztcp -c $fd

THE ZSH/TERMCAP MODULE
       The zsh/termcap module makes available one builtin command:

       echotc cap [ arg ... ]
	      Output the termcap value corresponding to	 the  capability  cap,
	      with optional arguments.

       The zsh/termcap module makes available one parameter:

       termcap
	      An associative array that maps termcap capability codes to their
	      values.

THE ZSH/TERMINFO MODULE
       The zsh/terminfo module makes available one builtin command:

       echoti cap [ arg ]
	      Output the terminfo value corresponding to the  capability  cap,
	      instantiated with arg if applicable.

       The zsh/terminfo module makes available one parameter:

       terminfo
	      An  associative  array  that  maps  terminfo capability names to
	      their values.

THE ZSH/ZFTP MODULE
       The zsh/zftp module makes available one builtin command:

       zftp subcommand [ args ]
	      The zsh/zftp module is a client for FTP  (file  transfer	proto‐
	      col).  It is implemented as a builtin to allow full use of shell
	      command line editing, file  I/O,	and  job  control  mechanisms.
	      Often, users will access it via shell functions providing a more
	      powerful interface; a set is provided with the zsh  distribution
	      and is described in zshzftpsys(1).  However, the zftp command is
	      entirely usable in its own right.

	      All commands consist of the command name zftp  followed  by  the
	      name  of a subcommand.  These are listed below.  The return sta‐
	      tus of each subcommand is supposed to  reflect  the  success  or
	      failure of the remote operation.	See a description of the vari‐
	      able ZFTP_VERBOSE for more information on how responses from the
	      server may be printed.

   Subcommands
       open host[:port] [ user [ password [ account ] ] ]
	      Open  a  new  FTP	 session  to  host, which may be the name of a
	      TCP/IP connected host or an IP number in the standard dot	 nota‐
	      tion.   If the argument is in the form host:port, open a connec‐
	      tion to TCP port port instead of the standard FTP port 21.  This
	      may  be the name of a TCP service or a number:  see the descrip‐
	      tion of ZFTP_PORT below for more information.

	      If IPv6 addresses in colon format are used, the host  should  be
	      surrounded  by quoted square brackets to distinguish it from the
	      port, for example '[fe80::203:baff:fe02:8b56]'.  For consistency
	      this is allowed with all forms of host.

	      Remaining	 arguments  are	 passed to the login subcommand.  Note
	      that if no arguments beyond host are  supplied,  open  will  not
	      automatically  call login.  If no arguments at all are supplied,
	      open will use the parameters set by the params subcommand.

	      After  a	successful  open,  the	shell	variables   ZFTP_HOST,
	      ZFTP_PORT,  ZFTP_IP  and	ZFTP_SYSTEM  are available; see `Vari‐
	      ables' below.

       login [ name [ password [ account ] ] ]
       user [ name [ password [ account ] ] ]
	      Login the user name with parameters password and	account.   Any
	      of the parameters can be omitted, and will be read from standard
	      input if needed (name is always needed).	If standard input is a
	      terminal,	 a  prompt  for	 each  one will be printed on standard
	      error and password will not be echoed.  If any of the parameters
	      are not used, a warning message is printed.

	      After   a	 successful  login,  the  shell	 variables  ZFTP_USER,
	      ZFTP_ACCOUNT and ZFTP_PWD are available; see `Variables' below.

	      This command may be re-issued when a user is already logged  in,
	      and the server will first be reinitialized for a new user.

       params [ host [ user [ password [ account ] ] ] ]
       params -
	      Store  the  given	 parameters  for  a later open command with no
	      arguments.  Only those given on the command line will be	remem‐
	      bered.   If no arguments are given, the parameters currently set
	      are printed, although the password will  appear  as  a  line  of
	      stars;  the  return value is one if no parameters were set, zero
	      otherwise.

	      Any of the parameters may be specified as a `?', which may  need
	      to  be quoted to protect it from shell expansion.	 In this case,
	      the appropriate parameter will be read from stdin	 as  with  the
	      login  subcommand,  including  special handling of password.  If
	      the `?' is followed by a string, that is used as the prompt  for
	      reading the parameter instead of the default message (any neces‐
	      sary punctuation and whitespace should be included at the end of
	      the  prompt).   The  first letter of the parameter (only) may be
	      quoted with a `\'; hence an argument "\\$word"  guarantees  that
	      the string from the shell parameter $word will be treated liter‐
	      ally, whether or not it begins with a `?'.

	      If instead a single `-' is given, the  existing  parameters,  if
	      any,  are deleted.  In that case, calling open with no arguments
	      will cause an error.

	      The list of parameters is not deleted after a close, however  it
	      will be deleted if the zsh/zftp module is unloaded.

	      For example,

		     zftp params ftp.elsewhere.xx juser '?Password for juser: '

	      will store the host ftp.elsewhere.xx and the user juser and then
	      prompt the user for the corresponding password  with  the	 given
	      prompt.

       test   Test  the	 connection;  if  the  server has reported that it has
	      closed the connection (maybe due to a timeout), return status 2;
	      if  no  connection was open anyway, return status 1; else return
	      status 0.	 The test subcommand is silent,	 apart	from  messages
	      printed by the $ZFTP_VERBOSE mechanism, or error messages if the
	      connection closes.  There is no network overhead for this test.

	      The test is only supported on systems with either the  select(2)
	      or poll(2) system calls; otherwise the message `not supported on
	      this system' is printed instead.

	      The test subcommand will automatically be called at the start of
	      any  other  subcommand for the current session when a connection
	      is open.

       cd directory
	      Change the remote directory to directory.	 Also alters the shell
	      variable ZFTP_PWD.

       cdup   Change  the  remote directory to the one higher in the directory
	      tree.  Note that cd .. will also work correctly on non-UNIX sys‐
	      tems.

       dir [ args... ]
	      Give  a (verbose) listing of the remote directory.  The args are
	      passed directly to the server. The command's behaviour is imple‐
	      mentation	 dependent, but a UNIX server will typically interpret
	      args as arguments to the ls command and with no arguments return
	      the  result of `ls -l'. The directory is listed to standard out‐
	      put.

       ls [ args ]
	      Give a (short) listing of the remote directory.  With  no	 args,
	      produces a raw list of the files in the directory, one per line.
	      Otherwise, up to vagaries of the server implementation,  behaves
	      similar to dir.

       type [ type ]
	      Change  the  type for the transfer to type, or print the current
	      type if type is absent.  The allowed values are `A' (ASCII), `I'
	      (Image, i.e. binary), or `B' (a synonym for `I').

	      The FTP default for a transfer is ASCII.	However, if zftp finds
	      that the remote host is a UNIX machine with 8-bit byes, it  will
	      automatically  switch  to	 using	binary for file transfers upon
	      open.  This can subsequently be overridden.

	      The transfer type is only passed to the remote host when a  data
	      connection  is  established;  this  command  involves no network
	      overhead.

       ascii  The same as type A.

       binary The same as type I.

       mode [ S | B ]
	      Set the mode type to stream (S) or block (B).   Stream  mode  is
	      the default; block mode is not widely supported.

       remote files...
       local [ files... ]
	      Print the size and last modification time of the remote or local
	      files.  If there is more than one item on the list, the name  of
	      the  file	 is printed first.  The first number is the file size,
	      the second is the last modification time of the file in the for‐
	      mat  CCYYMMDDhhmmSS  consisting of year, month, date, hour, min‐
	      utes and seconds in GMT.	Note that this format,	including  the
	      length, is guaranteed, so that time strings can be directly com‐
	      pared via the [[ builtin's < and > operators, even if  they  are
	      too long to be represented as integers.

	      Not  all servers support the commands for retrieving this infor‐
	      mation.  In that case, the remote command will print nothing and
	      return status 2, compared with status 1 for a file not found.

	      The  local  command  (but	 not remote) may be used with no argu‐
	      ments, in which case the information comes from  examining  file
	      descriptor zero.	This is the same file as seen by a put command
	      with no further redirection.

       get file [...]
	      Retrieve all files from the server, concatenating them and send‐
	      ing them to standard output.

       put file [...]
	      For  each file, read a file from standard input and send that to
	      the remote host with the given name.

       append file [...]
	      As put, but if the remote file already exists, data is  appended
	      to it instead of overwriting it.

       getat file point
       putat file point
       appendat file point
	      Versions of get, put and append which will start the transfer at
	      the given point in the remote file.  This is useful for  append‐
	      ing  to an incomplete local file.	 However, note that this abil‐
	      ity is not universally supported by servers (and	is  not	 quite
	      the behaviour specified by the standard).

       delete file [...]
	      Delete the list of files on the server.

       mkdir directory
	      Create a new directory directory on the server.

       rmdir directory
	      Delete the directory directory  on the server.

       rename old-name new-name
	      Rename file old-name to new-name on the server.

       site args...
	      Send  a  host-specific command to the server.  You will probably
	      only need this if instructed by the server to use it.

       quote args...
	      Send the raw FTP command sequence to the server.	You should  be
	      familiar	with  the  FTP command set as defined in RFC959 before
	      doing this.  Useful commands may include STAT  and  HELP.	  Note
	      also  the	 mechanism for returning messages as described for the
	      variable ZFTP_VERBOSE below, in  particular  that	 all  messages
	      from the control connection are sent to standard error.

       close
       quit   Close the current data connection.  This unsets the shell param‐
	      eters ZFTP_HOST,	ZFTP_PORT,  ZFTP_IP,  ZFTP_SYSTEM,  ZFTP_USER,
	      ZFTP_ACCOUNT, ZFTP_PWD, ZFTP_TYPE and ZFTP_MODE.

       session [ sessname ]
	      Allows  multiple	FTP  sessions to be used at once.  The name of
	      the session is an arbitrary string of  characters;  the  default
	      session  is called `default'.  If this command is called without
	      an argument, it will list all  the  current  sessions;  with  an
	      argument,	 it  will either switch to the existing session called
	      sessname, or create a new session of that name.

	      Each session remembers the status of the connection, the set  of
	      connection-specific  shell parameters (the same set as are unset
	      when a connection closes, as given in the description of close),
	      and  any	user  parameters specified with the params subcommand.
	      Changing to a previous session restores those  values;  changing
	      to a new session initialises them in the same way as if zftp had
	      just been loaded.	 The name of the current session is  given  by
	      the parameter ZFTP_SESSION.

       rmsession [ sessname ]
	      Delete a session; if a name is not given, the current session is
	      deleted.	If the current session is deleted, the earliest exist‐
	      ing  session becomes the new current session, otherwise the cur‐
	      rent session is not changed.  If the session  being  deleted  is
	      the  only	 one,  a  new  session called `default' is created and
	      becomes the current session; note that this  is  a  new  session
	      even  if	the session being deleted is also called `default'. It
	      is recommended that sessions not	be  deleted  while  background
	      commands which use zftp are still active.

   Parameters
       The  following  shell  parameters  are used by zftp.  Currently none of
       them are special.

       ZFTP_TMOUT
	      Integer.	The time in seconds to wait for a network operation to
	      complete before returning an error.  If this is not set when the
	      module is loaded, it will be given  the  default	value  60.   A
	      value  of	 zero  turns off timeouts.  If a timeout occurs on the
	      control connection it will be closed.  Use  a  larger  value  if
	      this occurs too frequently.

       ZFTP_IP
	      Readonly.	 The IP address of the current connection in dot nota‐
	      tion.

       ZFTP_HOST
	      Readonly.	 The hostname of the current remote  server.   If  the
	      host  was	 opened	 as  an	 IP  number,  ZFTP_HOST	 contains that
	      instead; this saves the overhead for a name lookup, as  IP  num‐
	      bers are most commonly used when a nameserver is unavailable.

       ZFTP_PORT
	      Readonly.	  The  number of the remote TCP port to which the con‐
	      nection is open (even if the port was originally specified as  a
	      named service).  Usually this is the standard FTP port, 21.

	      In  the unlikely event that your system does not have the appro‐
	      priate conversion functions, this appears in network byte order.
	      If  your	system is little-endian, the port then consists of two
	      swapped bytes and the standard port will be  reported  as	 5376.
	      In  that	case, numeric ports passed to zftp open will also need
	      to be in this format.

       ZFTP_SYSTEM
	      Readonly.	 The system type string	 returned  by  the  server  in
	      response to an FTP SYST request.	The most interesting case is a
	      string beginning "UNIX Type: L8", which ensures maximum compati‐
	      bility with a local UNIX host.

       ZFTP_TYPE
	      Readonly.	  The  type to be used for data transfers , either `A'
	      or `I'.	Use the type subcommand to change this.

       ZFTP_USER
	      Readonly.	 The username currently logged in, if any.

       ZFTP_ACCOUNT
	      Readonly.	 The account name of the current user, if  any.	  Most
	      servers do not require an account name.

       ZFTP_PWD
	      Readonly.	 The current directory on the server.

       ZFTP_CODE
	      Readonly.	  The  three digit code of the last FTP reply from the
	      server as a string.  This can still be read after the connection
	      is closed, and is not changed when the current session changes.

       ZFTP_REPLY
	      Readonly.	  The  last line of the last reply sent by the server.
	      This can still be read after the connection is  closed,  and  is
	      not changed when the current session changes.

       ZFTP_SESSION
	      Readonly.	 The name of the current FTP session; see the descrip‐
	      tion of the session subcommand.

       ZFTP_PREFS
	      A string of preferences for altering aspects  of	zftp's	behav‐
	      iour.  Each preference is a single character.  The following are
	      defined:

	      P	     Passive:  attempt to make the remote server initiate data
		     transfers.	 This is slightly more efficient than sendport
		     mode.  If the letter S occurs later in the	 string,  zftp
		     will use sendport mode if passive mode is not available.

	      S	     Sendport:	 initiate  transfers  by the FTP PORT command.
		     If this occurs before any P in the string,	 passive  mode
		     will never be attempted.

	      D	     Dumb:   use  only the bare minimum of FTP commands.  This
		     prevents the  variables  ZFTP_SYSTEM  and	ZFTP_PWD  from
		     being set, and will mean all connections default to ASCII
		     type.  It may prevent ZFTP_SIZE from being set  during  a
		     transfer  if  the	server	does  not send it anyway (many
		     servers do).

	      If ZFTP_PREFS is not set when zftp is loaded, it will be set  to
	      a default of `PS', i.e. use passive mode if available, otherwise
	      fall back to sendport mode.

       ZFTP_VERBOSE
	      A string of digits between 0 and 5 inclusive,  specifying	 which
	      responses	 from  the server should be printed.  All responses go
	      to standard error.  If any of the numbers 1 to 5 appear  in  the
	      string, raw responses from the server with reply codes beginning
	      with that digit will be printed to standard  error.   The	 first
	      digit of the three digit reply code is defined by RFC959 to cor‐
	      respond to:

	      1.     A positive preliminary reply.

	      2.     A positive completion reply.

	      3.     A positive intermediate reply.

	      4.     A transient negative completion reply.

	      5.     A permanent negative completion reply.

	      It should be noted that, for unknown reasons, the reply `Service
	      not  available',	which  forces  termination of a connection, is
	      classified as 421, i.e.  `transient  negative',  an  interesting
	      interpretation of the word `transient'.

	      The  code 0 is special:  it indicates that all but the last line
	      of multiline replies read from the server	 will  be  printed  to
	      standard	error  in  a processed format.	By convention, servers
	      use this mechanism for sending information for the user to read.
	      The  appropriate	reply  code,  if it matches the same response,
	      takes priority.

	      If ZFTP_VERBOSE is not set when zftp is loaded, it will  be  set
	      to  the  default value 450, i.e., messages destined for the user
	      and all errors will be printed.  A  null	string	is  valid  and
	      specifies that no messages should be printed.

   Functions
       zftp_chpwd
	      If this function is set by the user, it is called every time the
	      directory changes on the server, including when a user is logged
	      in, or when a connection is closed.  In the last case, $ZFTP_PWD
	      will be unset; otherwise it will reflect the new directory.

       zftp_progress
	      If this function is set by the user, it will be called during  a
	      get,  put or append operation each time sufficient data has been
	      received from the host.  During a get, the data is sent to stan‐
	      dard  output,  so it is vital that this function should write to
	      standard error or directly to the terminal, not to standard out‐
	      put.

	      When  it	is  called  with a transfer in progress, the following
	      additional shell parameters are set:

	      ZFTP_FILE
		     The name of the remote file being transferred from or to.

	      ZFTP_TRANSFER
		     A G for a get operation and a P for a put operation.

	      ZFTP_SIZE
		     The total size of the complete  file  being  transferred:
		     the  same	as  the first value provided by the remote and
		     local subcommands for a particular file.  If  the	server
		     cannot   supply  this  value  for	a  remote  file	 being
		     retrieved, it will not be set.  If input is from  a  pipe
		     the  value	 may  be  incorrect and correspond simply to a
		     full pipe buffer.

	      ZFTP_COUNT
		     The amount of data so far transferred; a  number  between
		     zero  and	$ZFTP_SIZE,  if	 that  is set.	This number is
		     always available.

	      The function is initially called with ZFTP_TRANSFER  set	appro‐
	      priately and ZFTP_COUNT set to zero.  After the transfer is fin‐
	      ished,  the  function  will  be  called  one  more   time	  with
	      ZFTP_TRANSFER set to GF or PF, in case it wishes to tidy up.  It
	      is  otherwise  never  called  twice  with	 the  same  value   of
	      ZFTP_COUNT.

	      Sometimes	 the progress meter may cause disruption.  It is up to
	      the user to decide whether the function should be defined and to
	      use unfunction when necessary.

   Problems
       A  connection may not be opened in the left hand side of a pipe as this
       occurs in a subshell and the file information is	 not  updated  in  the
       main shell.  In the case of type or mode changes or closing the connec‐
       tion in a subshell, the information is returned but variables  are  not
       updated until the next call to zftp.  Other status changes in subshells
       will not be reflected by changes to the variables (but should be other‐
       wise harmless).

       Deleting	 sessions while a zftp command is active in the background can
       have unexpected effects, even if it does	 not  use  the	session	 being
       deleted.	  This	is because all shell subprocesses share information on
       the state of all connections, and deleting a session changes the order‐
       ing of that information.

       On  some operating systems, the control connection is not valid after a
       fork(), so that operations in subshells, on the left  hand  side	 of  a
       pipeline,  or  in  the  background are not possible, as they should be.
       This is presumably a bug in the operating system.

THE ZSH/ZLE MODULE
       The zsh/zle module contains the Zsh Line Editor.	 See zshzle(1).

THE ZSH/ZLEPARAMETER MODULE
       The zsh/zleparameter module defines two special parameters that can  be
       used  to	 access	 internal information of the Zsh Line Editor (see zsh‐
       zle(1)).

       keymaps
	      This array contains the names of the keymaps currently defined.

       widgets
	      This associative array contains one entry	 per  widget  defined.
	      The  name	 of the widget is the key and the value gives informa‐
	      tion about the widget. It is either  the	string	`builtin'  for
	      builtin	widgets,   a   string  of  the	form  `user:name'  for
	      user-defined widgets, where name is the name of the shell	 func‐
	      tion  implementing  the  widget,	or  it is a string of the form
	      `completion:type:name', for completion widgets. In the last case
	      type  is	the  name of the builtin widgets the completion widget
	      imitates in its behavior and name is the name of the shell func‐
	      tion implementing the completion widget.

THE ZSH/ZPROF MODULE
       When  loaded, the zsh/zprof causes shell functions to be profiled.  The
       profiling results can be obtained with the zprof builtin	 command  made
       available  by this module.  There is no way to turn profiling off other
       than unloading the module.

       zprof [ -c ]
	      Without the -c option, zprof lists profiling results to standard
	      output.	The  format  is	 comparable  to	 that of commands like
	      gprof.

	      At the top there is a summary listing all	 functions  that  were
	      called  at  least	 once.	 This  summary is sorted in decreasing
	      order of the amount of time spent in each.   The	lines  contain
	      the  number  of  the  function  in order, which is used in other
	      parts of the list in suffixes of the form `[num]'.RE,  then  the
	      number  of  calls	 made to the function.	The next three columns
	      list the time in milliseconds spent  in  the  function  and  its
	      descendents, the average time in milliseconds spent in the func‐
	      tion and its descendents per call and  the  percentage  of  time
	      spent  in	 all  shell  functions	used  in this function and its
	      descendents.  The following three columns give the same informa‐
	      tion,  but  counting only the time spent in the function itself.
	      The final column shows the name of the function.

	      After the summary, detailed  information	about  every  function
	      that  was	 invoked  is listed, sorted in decreasing order of the
	      amount of time spent in each function and its descendents.  Each
	      of these entries consists of descriptions for the functions that
	      called the function described,  the  function  itself,  and  the
	      functions	 that  were  called  from it.  The description for the
	      function itself has the same format as in the summary (and shows
	      the same information).  The other lines don't show the number of
	      the function at the beginning  and  have	their  function	 named
	      indented	to  make it easier to distinguish the line showing the
	      function described in the section from the surrounding lines.

	      The information shown in this case is almost the same as in  the
	      summary,	but only refers to the call hierarchy being displayed.
	      For example, for a calling function the column showing the total
	      running  time lists the time spent in the described function and
	      its descendents only for the times when it was called from  that
	      particular  calling  function.  Likewise, for a called function,
	      this columns lists the total time spent in the  called  function
	      and  its	descendents only for the times when it was called from
	      the function described.

	      Also in this case, the column showing the number of calls	 to  a
	      function also shows a slash and then the total number of invoca‐
	      tions made to the called function.

	      As long as the zsh/zprof module is  loaded,  profiling  will  be
	      done  and multiple invocations of the zprof builtin command will
	      show the times and numbers of calls since the module was loaded.
	      With  the	 -c  option,  the zprof builtin command will reset its
	      internal counters and will not show the listing.	)

THE ZSH/ZPTY MODULE
       The zsh/zpty module offers one builtin:

       zpty [ -e ] [ -b ] name [ arg ... ]
	      The  arguments  following	 name  are  concatenated  with	spaces
	      between,	then  executed	as a command, as if passed to the eval
	      builtin.	The command runs under a newly assigned	 pseudo-termi‐
	      nal; this is useful for running commands non-interactively which
	      expect an interactive environment.  The name is not part of  the
	      command,	but is used to refer to this command in later calls to
	      zpty.

	      With the -e option, the pseudo-terminal is set up so that	 input
	      characters are echoed.

	      With the -b option, input to and output from the pseudo-terminal
	      are made non-blocking.

       zpty -d [ names ... ]
	      The second form, with the -d option, is used to delete  commands
	      previously  started,  by supplying a list of their names.	 If no
	      names are given, all commands are deleted.  Deleting  a  command
	      causes the HUP signal to be sent to the corresponding process.

       zpty -w [ -n ] name [ strings ... ]
	      The  -w option can be used to send the to command name the given
	      strings as input (separated by spaces).  If the -n option is not
	      given, a newline is added at the end.

	      If  no strings are provided, the standard input is copied to the
	      pseudo-terminal; this may stop before copying the full input  if
	      the pseudo-terminal is non-blocking.

	      Note  that the command under the pseudo-terminal sees this input
	      as if it were typed, so beware when sending special  tty	driver
	      characters such as word-erase, line-kill, and end-of-file.

       zpty -r [ -t ] name [ param [ pattern ] ]
	      The  -r  option  can  be	used to read the output of the command
	      name.  With only a name argument, the output read is  copied  to
	      the  standard  output.  Unless the pseudo-terminal is non-block‐
	      ing, copying continues until the command under the pseudo-termi‐
	      nal  exits; when non-blocking, only as much output as is immedi‐
	      ately available is copied.  The return value is zero if any out‐
	      put is copied.

	      When  also  given a param argument, at most one line is read and
	      stored in the parameter named param.  Less than a full line  may
	      be  read	if  the	 pseudo-terminal  is non-blocking.  The return
	      value is zero if at least one character is stored in param.

	      If a pattern is given as well, output is read  until  the	 whole
	      string  read matches the pattern, even in the non-blocking case.
	      The return value is zero if the string read matches the pattern,
	      or  if  the  command has exited but at least one character could
	      still be read.  As of this writing, a maximum of one megabyte of
	      output  can  be  consumed	 this  way; if a full megabyte is read
	      without matching the pattern, the return value is non-zero.

	      In all cases, the return value is non-zero if nothing  could  be
	      read, and is 2 if this is because the command has finished.

	      If  the  -r  option  is  combined with the -t option, zpty tests
	      whether output is available before trying to read.  If no output
	      is available, zpty immediately returns the value 1.

       zpty -t name
	      The  -t option without the -r option can be used to test whether
	      the command name is still running.  It returns a zero  value  if
	      the command is running and a non-zero value otherwise.

       zpty [ -L ]
	      The  last	 form, without any arguments, is used to list the com‐
	      mands currently defined.	If the -L option  is  given,  this  is
	      done in the form of calls to the zpty builtin.

THE ZSH/ZSELECT MODULE
       The zsh/zselect module makes available one builtin command:

       zselect [ -rwe -t timeout -a array ] [ fd ... ]
	      The  zselect builtin is a front-end to the `select' system call,
	      which blocks until a file descriptor is  ready  for  reading  or
	      writing,	or  has	 an error condition, with an optional timeout.
	      If this is not available on your system, the command  prints  an
	      error  message and returns status 2 (normal errors return status
	      1).  For more information, see your  systems  documentation  for
	      select(3).   Note	 there is no connection with the shell builtin
	      of the same name.

	      Arguments	 and  options  may  be	intermingled  in  any	order.
	      Non-option arguments are file descriptors, which must be decimal
	      integers.	 By default, file descriptors are  to  be  tested  for
	      reading,	i.e.  zselect will return when data is available to be
	      read from the file descriptor, or more precisely,	 when  a  read
	      operation	 from the file descriptor will not block.  After a -r,
	      -w and -e, the given file descriptors are to be tested for read‐
	      ing,  writing,  or error conditions.  These options and an arbi‐
	      trary list of file descriptors may be given in any order.

	      (The presence of an `error condition' is not well defined in the
	      documentation  for  many	implementations	 of  the select system
	      call.  According to recent versions of the POSIX	specification,
	      it  is really an exception condition, of which the only standard
	      example is out-of-band data received on a socket.	 So zsh	 users
	      are unlikely to find the -e option useful.)

	      The  option  `-t timeout' specifies a timeout in hundredths of a
	      second.  This may be zero, in which case	the  file  descriptors
	      will  simply  be polled and zselect will return immediately.  It
	      is possible to call zselect  with	 no  file  descriptors	and  a
	      non-zero	timeout	 for  use  as  a finer-grained replacement for
	      `sleep'; not, however, the return status is always 1 for a time‐
	      out.

	      The  option  `-a	array'	indicates  that array should be set to
	      indicate the file descriptor(s) which are ready.	If the	option
	      is  not  given,  the  array reply will be used for this purpose.
	      The array will contain a string similar  to  the	arguments  for
	      zselect.	For example,

		     zselect -t 0 -r 0 -w 1

	      might return immediately with status 0 and $reply containing `-r
	      0 -w 1' to show that both file descriptors  are  ready  for  the
	      requested operations.

	      The option `-A assoc' indicates that the associative array assoc
	      should be set to	indicate  the  file  descriptor(s)  which  are
	      ready.   This  option overrides the option -a, nor will reply be
	      modified.	 The keys of assoc are the file descriptors,  and  the
	      corresponding values are any of the characters `rwe' to indicate
	      the condition.

	      The command returns 0 if some file  descriptors  are  ready  for
	      reading.	 If  the  operation  timed  out, or a timeout of 0 was
	      given and no file descriptors were ready, or there was an error,
	      it  returns status 1 and the array will not be set (nor modified
	      in any way).  If there was an error in the select operation  the
	      appropriate error message is printed.

THE ZSH/ZUTIL MODULE
       The zsh/zutil module only adds some builtins:

       zstyle [ -L ]
       zstyle [ -e | - | -- ] pattern style strings ...
       zstyle -d [ pattern [ styles ... ] ]
       zstyle -g name [ pattern [ style ] ]
       zstyle -abs context style name [ sep ]
       zstyle -Tt context style [ strings ...]
       zstyle -m context style pattern
	      This  builtin  command  is  used	to  define  and lookup styles.
	      Styles are pairs of names and values, where the  values  consist
	      of  any  number  of strings.  They are stored together with pat‐
	      terns and lookup is done by giving a string,  called  the	 `con‐
	      text', which is compared to the patterns.	 The definition stored
	      for the first matching pattern will be returned.

	      For ordering of comparisons, patterns  are  searched  from  most
	      specific	to  least specific, and patterns that are equally spe‐
	      cific keep the order in which they were defined.	A  pattern  is
	      considered  to be more specific than another if it contains more
	      components (substrings separated by colons) or if	 the  patterns
	      for  the	components are more specific, where simple strings are
	      considered to be more specific than patterns  and	 complex  pat‐
	      terns are considered to be more specific than the pattern `*'.

	      The  first form (without arguments) lists the definitions in the
	      order zstyle will test them. If the -L option is given,  listing
	      is done in the form of calls to zstyle.  Forms with arguments:

	      zstyle [ - | -- | -e ] pattern style strings ...
		     Defines  the given style for the pattern with the strings
		     as the value.  If the -e option  is  given,  the  strings
		     will  be  concatenated  (separated	 by  spaces)  and  the
		     resulting string will be evaluated (in the same way as it
		     is	 done  by  the eval builtin command) when the style is
		     looked up.	 In this case the parameter  `reply'  must  be
		     assigned  to  set	the strings returned after the evalua‐
		     tion.  Before evaluating the value, reply is  unset,  and
		     if	 it  is still unset after the evaluation, the style is
		     treated as if it were not set.

	      zstyle -d [ pattern [ styles ... ] ]
		     Delete style definitions. Without arguments  all  defini‐
		     tions  are	 deleted,  with	 a pattern all definitions for
		     that pattern are deleted and if  any  styles  are	given,
		     then only those styles are deleted for the pattern.

	      zstyle -g name [ pattern [ style ] ]
		     Retrieve a style definition. The name is used as the name
		     of an array in which the results are stored. Without  any
		     further  arguments,  all  patterns	 defined are returned.
		     With a pattern the styles defined for  that  pattern  are
		     returned  and  with both a pattern and a style, the value
		     strings of that combination is returned.

	      The other forms can be used to look up or test patterns.

	      zstyle -s context style name [ sep ]
		     The parameter name is set	to  the	 value	of  the	 style
		     interpreted  as  a string.	 If the value contains several
		     strings they are concatenated with spaces	(or  with  the
		     sep string if that is given) between them.

	      zstyle -b context style name
		     The  value	 is  stored  in name as a boolean, i.e. as the
		     string `yes' if the value has only one  string  and  that
		     string is equal to one of `yes', `true', `on', or `1'. If
		     the value is any  other  string  or  has  more  than  one
		     string, the parameter is set to `no'.

	      zstyle -a context style name
		     The  value	 is  stored  in	 name  as an array. If name is
		     declared as an associative array,	the first, third, etc.
		     strings  are  used	 as the keys and the other strings are
		     used as the values.

	      zstyle -t context style [ strings ...]
	      zstyle -T context style [ strings ...]
		     Test the value of	a  style,  i.e.	 the  -t  option  only
		     returns  a	 status	 (sets	$?).   Without any strings the
		     return status is zero if the  style  is  defined  for  at
		     least  one	 matching  pattern, has only one string in its
		     value, and that is equal to one of `true', `yes', `on' or
		     `1'.  If  any strings are given the status is zero if and
		     only if at least one of the strings is equal to at	 least
		     one  of  the  strings  in	the value. If the style is not
		     defined, the status is 2.

		     The -T option tests the values of the style like -t,  but
		     it	 returns  zero	(rather	 than  2)  if the style is not
		     defined for any matching pattern.

	      zstyle -m context style pattern
		     Match a value. Returns status zero if the pattern matches
		     at least one of the strings in the value.

       zformat -f param format specs ...
       zformat -a array sep specs ...
	      This  builtin  provides  two  different forms of formatting. The
	      first form is selected with the -f option. In this case the for‐
	      mat string will be modified by replacing sequences starting with
	      a percent sign in it with strings from  the  specs.   Each  spec
	      should  be  of  the  form	 `char:string'	which will cause every
	      appearance of the sequence `%char' in format to be  replaced  by
	      the  string.  The `%' sequence may also contain optional minimum
	      and maximum field width specifications between the `%'  and  the
	      `char'  in the form `%min.maxc', i.e. the minimum field width is
	      given first and if the maximum field width is used, it has to be
	      preceded	by  a dot.  Specifying a minimum field width makes the
	      result be padded with spaces to  the  right  if  the  string  is
	      shorter  than  the  requested width.  Padding to the left can be
	      achieved by giving a negative minimum field width.  If a maximum
	      field  width  is	specified,  the string will be truncated after
	      that many characters.  After all `%'  sequences  for  the	 given
	      specs have been processed, the resulting string is stored in the
	      parameter param.

	      The %-escapes also understand ternary expressions	 in  the  form
	      used  by	prompts.  The % is followed by a `(' and then an ordi‐
	      nary format specifier character as described above.   There  may
	      be a set of digits either before or after the `('; these specify
	      a test number, which defaults to	zero.	Negative  numbers  are
	      also allowed.  An arbitrary delimiter character follows the for‐
	      mat specifier, which is followed by a piece of `true' text,  the
	      delimiter	 character again, a piece of `false' text, and a clos‐
	      ing parenthesis.	The complete expression (without  the  digits)
	      thus  looks like `%(X.text1.text2)', except that the `.' charac‐
	      ter is arbitrary.	 The value given for the format	 specifier  in
	      the  char:string	expressions  is	 evaluated  as	a mathematical
	      expression, and compared with the test number.  If they are  the
	      same,  text1 is output, else text2 is output.  A parenthesis may
	      be escaped in text2 as %).  Either of text1 or text2 may contain
	      nested %-escapes.

	      For example:

		     zformat -f REPLY "The answer is '%3(c.yes.no)'." c:3

	      outputs  "The answer is 'yes'." to REPLY since the value for the
	      format specifier c is 3, agreeing with the digit argument to the
	      ternary expression.

	      The  second  form, using the -a option, can be used for aligning
	      strings.	Here, the specs are of	the  form  `left:right'	 where
	      `left'  and  `right'  are	 arbitrary strings.  These strings are
	      modified by replacing the colons by the sep string  and  padding
	      the  left	 strings  with	spaces	to  the	 right so that the sep
	      strings in the result (and hence the right strings  after	 them)
	      are  all	aligned	 if  the strings are printed below each other.
	      All strings without a colon are left unchanged and  all  strings
	      with  an empty right string have the trailing colon removed.  In
	      both cases the lengths of the strings are not used to  determine
	      how  the other strings are to be aligned.	 The resulting strings
	      are stored in the array.

       zregexparse
	      This implements some internals of the _regex_arguments function.

       zparseopts [ -D ] [ -K ] [ -E ] [ -a array ] [ -A assoc ] specs
	      This builtin simplifies the parsing  of  options	in  positional
	      parameters,  i.e.	 the  set of arguments given by $*.  Each spec
	      describes one option and must be of the form `opt[=array]'.   If
	      an option described by opt is found in the positional parameters
	      it is copied into the array specified with the -a option; if the
	      optional	`=array'  is  given,  it  is  instead copied into that
	      array.

	      Note that it is an error to give any spec	 without  an  `=array'
	      unless one of the -a or -A options is used.

	      Unless the -E option is given, parsing stops at the first string
	      that isn't described by one of the specs.	 Even with -E, parsing
	      always stops at a positional parameter equal to `-' or `--'.

	      The  opt	description  must be one of the following.  Any of the
	      special characters can appear in the option name provided it  is
	      preceded by a backslash.

	      name
	      name+  The  name	is  the name of the option without the leading
		     `-'.  To specify a GNU-style  long	 option,  one  of  the
		     usual two leading `-' must be included in name; for exam‐
		     ple, a `--file'  option  is  represented  by  a  name  of
		     `-file'.

		     If	 a  `+'	 appears after name, the option is appended to
		     array each time it is found in the positional parameters;
		     without the `+' only the last occurrence of the option is
		     preserved.

		     If one of these forms is used, the option takes no	 argu‐
		     ment,  so	parsing stops if the next positional parameter
		     does not also begin with `-' (unless  the	-E  option  is
		     used).

	      name:
	      name:-
	      name:: If one or two colons are given, the option takes an argu‐
		     ment; with one colon, the argument is mandatory and  with
		     two  colons  it is optional.  The argument is appended to
		     the array after the option itself.

		     An optional argument is put into the same	array  element
		     as the option name (note that this makes empty strings as
		     arguments indistinguishable).  A  mandatory  argument  is
		     added as a separate element unless the `:-' form is used,
		     in which case the argument is put into the same element.

		     A `+' as described above may appear between the name  and
		     the first colon.

       The options of zparseopts itself are:

       -a array
	      As  described  above,  this  names the default array in which to
	      store the recognised options.

       -A assoc
	      If this is given, the options and their values are also put into
	      an associative array with the option names as keys and the argu‐
	      ments (if any) as the values.

       -D     If this option is given, all options found are removed from  the
	      positional parameters of the calling shell or shell function, up
	      to but not including any not described by the  specs.   This  is
	      similar to using the shift builtin.

       -K     With  this  option,  the	arrays	specified  with	 the -a and -A
	      options and with the `=array' forms are kept unchanged when none
	      of  the  specs  for  them	 is  used.   This allows assignment of
	      default values to them before calling zparseopts.

       -E     This changes the parsing rules to not stop at the	 first	string
	      that  isn't  described  by  one of the specs.  It can be used to
	      test for or (if used together with -D) extract options and their
	      arguments,  ignoring all other options and arguments that may be
	      in the positional parameters.

       For example,

	      set -- -a -bx -c y -cz baz -cend
	      zparseopts a=foo b:=bar c+:=bar

       will have the effect of

	      foo=(-a)
	      bar=(-b x -c y -c z)

       The arguments from `baz' on will not be used.

       As an example for the -E option, consider:

	      set -- -a x -b y -c z arg1 arg2
	      zparseopts -E -D b:=bar

       will have the effect of

	      bar=(-b y)
	      set -- -a x -c z arg1 arg2

       I.e., the option -b and its arguments are  taken	 from  the  positional
       parameters and put into the array bar.

ZSHTCPSYS(1)							  ZSHTCPSYS(1)

NAME
       zshtcpsys - zsh tcp system

DESCRIPTION
       A  module  zsh/net/tcp  is  provided to provide network I/O over TCP/IP
       from within the shell; see its description  in  zshmodules(1)  .	  This
       manual  page  describes	a  function suite based on the module.	If the
       module is installed, the functions are usually installed	 at  the  same
       time,  in  which	 case  they  will  be available for autoloading in the
       default function search path.  In addition to the  zsh/net/tcp  module,
       the  zsh/zselect	 module	 is  used to implement timeouts on read opera‐
       tions.  For troubleshooting tips, consult the corresponding advice  for
       the zftp functions described in zshftpsys(1) .

       There  are  functions  corresponding  to the basic I/O operations open,
       close, read and send, named  tcp_open  etc.,  as	 well  as  a  function
       tcp_expect  for pattern match analysis of data read as input.  The sys‐
       tem makes it easy to receive data from and send data to multiple	 named
       sessions	 at once.  In addition, it can be linked with the shell's line
       editor in such a way that input data is automatically shown at the ter‐
       minal.	Other  facilities  available  including logging, filtering and
       configurable output prompts.

       To use the system where	it  is	available,  it	should	be  enough  to
       `autoload  -U tcp_open' and run tcp_open as documented below to start a
       session.	 The tcp_open function will autoload the remaining functions.

TCP USER FUNCTIONS
   Basic I/O
       tcp_open [-qz] host port [ sess ]
       tcp_open [-qz] [ -s sess | -l sess,... ] ...
       tcp_open [-qz] [-a fd | -f fd ] [ sess ]
	      Open a new session.  In the first and simplest form, open a  TCP
	      connection to host host at port port; numeric and symbolic forms
	      are understood for both.

	      If sess is given, this becomes the name of the session which can
	      be used to refer to multiple different TCP connections.  If sess
	      is not given, the function will  invent  a  numeric  name	 value
	      (note  this  is not the same as the file descriptor to which the
	      session is attached).  It is recommended that session names  not
	      include  `funny'	characters,  where  funny  characters  are not
	      well-defined but	certainly  do  not  include  alphanumerics  or
	      underscores, and certainly do include whitespace.

	      In  the second case, one or more sessions to be opened are given
	      by name.	A  single  session  name  is  given  after  -s	and  a
	      comma-separated  list  after -l; both options may be repeated as
	      many times as necessary.	The host and port are  read  from  the
	      file .ztcp_sessions in the same directory as the user's zsh ini‐
	      tialisation files, i.e. usually the home directory, but $ZDOTDIR
	      if  that	is set.	 The file consists of lines each giving a ses‐
	      sion name and the corresponding host and	port,  in  that	 order
	      (note  the  session  name	 comes	first, not last), separated by
	      whitespace.

	      The third form allows passive and fake TCP connections.  If  the
	      option  -a  is  used, its argument is a file descriptor open for
	      listening for connections.  No function front-end is provided to
	      open  such  a file descriptor, but a call to `ztcp -l port' will
	      create one with the file	descriptor  stored  in	the  parameter
	      $REPLY.	The listening port can be closed with `ztcp -c fd'.  A
	      call to `tcp_open -a fd' will block until a remote  TCP  connec‐
	      tion  is	made  to  port on the local machine.  At this point, a
	      session is created in the usual way  and	is  largely  indistin‐
	      guishable	 from  an  active  connection  created with one of the
	      first two forms.

	      If the option -f is used, its  argument  is  a  file  descriptor
	      which  is	 used  directly as if it were a TCP session.  How well
	      the remainder of the TCP function system copes with this depends
	      on what actually underlies this file descriptor.	A regular file
	      is likely to be unusable; a FIFO (pipe) of some sort  will  work
	      better,  but  note  that it is not a good idea for two different
	      sessions to attempt to read from the same FIFO at once.

	      If the option -q is given with any of the three forms,  tcp_open
	      will  not	 print informational messages, although it will in any
	      case exit with an appropriate status.

	      If the line editor (zle) is in use, which is typically the  case
	      if  the shell is interactive, tcp_open installs a handler inside
	      zle which will check for new data at the same time as it	checks
	      for keyboard input.  This is convenient as the shell consumes no
	      CPU time while waiting; the test is performed by	the  operating
	      system.	Giving	the  option -z to any of the forms of tcp_open
	      prevents the handler from being installed, so data must be  read
	      explicitly.   Note, however, this is not necessary for executing
	      complete sets of send and read commands from a function, as  zle
	      is not active at this point.  Generally speaking, the handler is
	      only active when the shell is waiting for	 input	at  a  command
	      prompt or in the vared builtin.  The option has no effect if zle
	      is not active; `[[ -o zle]]' will test for this.

	      The first session to be opened becomes the current  session  and
	      subsequent calls to tcp_open do not change it.  The current ses‐
	      sion is stored in the parameter $TCP_SESS; see  below  for  more
	      detail about the parameters used by the system.

       tcp_close [-qn] [ -a | -l sess,... | sess ... ]
	      Close  the  named	 sessions,  or	the current session if none is
	      given, or all open sessions if -a is given.  The options -l  and
	      -s  are both handled for consistency with tcp_open, although the
	      latter is redundant.

	      If the session being closed is the  current  one,	 $TCP_SESS  is
	      unset,  leaving no current session, even if there are other ses‐
	      sions still open.

	      If the session was opened with tcp_open -f, the file  descriptor
	      is  closed  so  long  as	it  is	in the range 0 to 9 accessible
	      directly from the command line.  If the option -n is  given,  no
	      attempt  will  be	 made  to close file descriptors in this case.
	      The -n option is not used for genuine  ztcp  session;  the  file
	      descriptors are always closed with the session.

	      If  the  option  -q  is given, no informational messages will be
	      printed.

       tcp_read [-bdq] [ -t TO ] [ -T TO ]
	   [ -a | -u fd ... | -l sess,... | -s sess ...]
	      Perform a read operation on the current session, or on a list of
	      sessions	if  any	 are given with -u, -l or -s, or all open ses‐
	      sions if the option -a is given.	 Any  of  the  -u,  -l	or  -s
	      options may be repeated or mixed together.  The -u option speci‐
	      fies a file descriptor directly (only those managed by this sys‐
	      tem are useful), the other two specify sessions as described for
	      tcp_open above.

	      The function checks for new data available on all	 the  sessions
	      listed.	Unless the -b option is given, it will not block wait‐
	      ing for new data.	 Any one line of data from any of  the	avail‐
	      able  sessions  will be read, stored in the parameter $TCP_LINE,
	      and displayed to standard output unless $TCP_SILENT  contains  a
	      non-empty	 string.   When	 printed to standard output the string
	      $TCP_PROMPT will be shown at the start of the line; the  default
	      form  for this includes the name of the session being read.  See
	      below for more information on these parameters.  In  this	 mode,
	      tcp_read	can  be	 called	 repeatedly  until it returns status 2
	      which indicates all pending input from  all  specified  sessions
	      has been handled.

	      With the option -b, equivalent to an infinite timeout, the func‐
	      tion will block until a line is available to read	 from  one  of
	      the   specified  sessions.   However,  only  a  single  line  is
	      returned.

	      The option  -d  indicates	 that  all  pending  input  should  be
	      drained.	 In  this  case tcp_read may process multiple lines in
	      the manner given above; only the last is	stored	in  $TCP_LINE,
	      but the complete set is stored in the array $tcp_lines.  This is
	      cleared at the start of each call to tcp_read.

	      The options -t and -T specify a timeout in seconds, which may be
	      a	 floating  point  number  for increased accuracy.  With -t the
	      timeout is applied before each line read.	 With -T, the  timeout
	      applies  to  the	overall operation, possibly including multiple
	      read operations if  the  option  -d  is  present;	 without  this
	      option, there is no distinction between -t and -T.

	      The  function  does not print informational messages, but if the
	      option -q is given, no error message is printed for a  non-exis‐
	      tent session.

	      A return value of 2 indicates a timeout or no data to read.  Any
	      other non-zero return value indicates some error condition.

	      See tcp_log for how to control where data is sent by tcp_read.

       tcp_send [-nq] [ -s sess | -l sess,... ] data ...
       tcp_send [-nq] -a data ...
	      Send the supplied data strings to all the specified sessions  in
	      turn.  The underlying operation differs little from a `print -r'
	      to the session's file descriptor, although it attempts  to  pre‐
	      vent  the	 shell	from  dying  owing  to	a SIGPIPE caused by an
	      attempt to write to a defunct session.

	      The option -n prevents tcp_send from putting a  newline  at  the
	      end of the data strings.

	      The remaining options all behave as for tcp_read.

	      The data arguments are not further processed once they have been
	      passed to tcp_send; they are simply passed down to print -r.

	      If the parameter $TCP_OUTPUT is a non-empty string  and  logging
	      is  enabled then the data sent to each session will be echoed to
	      the log file(s) with $TCP_OUTPUT	in  front  where  appropriate,
	      much in the manner of $TCP_PROMPT.

   Session Management
       tcp_alias [-q] alias=sess ...
       tcp_alias [-q] [ alias ] ...
       tcp_alias -d [-q] alias ...
	      This function is not particularly well tested.

	      The  first  form	creates an alias for a session name; alias can
	      then be used to refer to the existing  session  sess.   As  many
	      aliases may be listed as required.

	      The  second  form lists any aliases specified, or all aliases if
	      none.

	      The third form deletes all the aliases listed.   The  underlying
	      sessions are not affected.

	      The  option  -q  suppresses  an  inconsistently chosen subset of
	      error messages.

       tcp_log [-asc] [ -n | -N ] [ logfile ]
	      With an argument logfile, all future input from tcp_read will be
	      logged  to  the  named  file.  Unless -a (append) is given, this
	      file will first be truncated or created empty.   With  no	 argu‐
	      ments, show the current status of logging.

	      With  the option -s, per-session logging is enabled.  Input from
	      tcp_read is output to the file logfile.sess.  As the session  is
	      automatically  discriminated  by	the filename, the contents are
	      raw  (no	$TCP_PROMPT).	The  option   -a  applies  as	above.
	      Per-session  logging and logging of all data in one file are not
	      mutually exclusive.

	      The option -c closes all logging, both complete and  per-session
	      logs.

	      The options -n and -N respectively turn off or restore output of
	      data read by tcp_read to standard output;	 hence	`tcp_log  -cn'
	      turns off all output by tcp_read.

	      The  function  is	 purely	 a convenient front end to setting the
	      parameters  $TCP_LOG,  $TCP_LOG_SESS,  $TCP_SILENT,  which   are
	      described below.

       tcp_rename old new
	      Rename  session  old  to	session	 new.	The  old  name becomes
	      invalid.

       tcp_sess [ sess [ command  ... ] ]
	      With no arguments, list all the  open  sessions  and  associated
	      file  descriptors.   The	current session is marked with a star.
	      For  use	in  functions,	direct	access	 to   the   parameters
	      $tcp_by_name,  $tcp_by_fd	 and $TCP_SESS is probably more conve‐
	      nient; see below.

	      With a sess argument, set the current session to sess.  This  is
	      equivalent to changing $TCP_SESS directly.

	      With  additional	arguments, temporarily set the current session
	      while executing the string command ....  The first  argument  is
	      re-evaluated  so	as  to	expand aliases etc., but the remaining
	      arguments are passed through as the  appear  to  tcp_sess.   The
	      original session is restored when tcp_sess exits.

   Advanced I/O
       tcp_command send-options ... send-arguments ...
	      This  is	a convenient front-end to tcp_send.  All arguments are
	      passed to tcp_send, then the function pauses waiting  for	 data.
	      While data is arriving at least every $TCP_TIMEOUT (default 0.3)
	      seconds, data is handled and printed out according to  the  cur‐
	      rent settings.  Status 0 is always returned.

	      This  is	generally  only useful for interactive use, to prevent
	      the display becoming fragmented by output returned from the con‐
	      nection.	 Within a programme or function it is generally better
	      to handle reading data by a more explicit method.

       tcp_expect [ -q ] [ -p var ] [ -t  to | -T TO]
	   [ -a | -s sess ... | -l sess,... ] pattern ...
	      Wait for input matching any of the given patterns	 from  any  of
	      the  specified  sessions.	  Input is ignored until an input line
	      matches one of the given patterns; at this point status zero  is
	      returned, the matching line is stored in $TCP_LINE, and the full
	      set of lines read during the call to tcp_expect is stored in the
	      array $tcp_expect_lines.

	      Sessions	are specified in the same way as tcp_read: the default
	      is to use the current session, otherwise the sessions  specified
	      by -a, -s, or -l are used.

	      Each  pattern  is a standard zsh extended-globbing pattern; note
	      that it needs to be quoted to avoid it  being  expanded  immedi‐
	      ately  by	 filename generation.  It must match the full line, so
	      to match a substring there must be a `*' at the start  and  end.
	      The  line	 matched  against  includes  the  $TCP_PROMPT added by
	      tcp_read.	 It is possible to include the globbing flags `#b'  or
	      `#m'  in	the  patterns  to make backreferences available in the
	      parameters $MATCH, $match, etc., as described in	the  base  zsh
	      documentation on pattern matching.

	      Unlike tcp_read, the default behaviour of tcp_expect is to block
	      indefinitely until the required input is	found.	 This  can  be
	      modified	by  specifying a timeout with -t or -T; these function
	      as in  tcp_read,	specifying  a  per-read	 or  overall  timeout,
	      respectively,  in	 seconds, as an integer or floating-point num‐
	      ber.  As tcp_read, the function returns status 2	if  a  timeout
	      occurs.

	      The  function  returns  as soon as any one of the patterns given
	      match.  If the caller  needs  to	know  which  of	 the  patterns
	      matched,	the  option -p var can be used; on return, $var is set
	      to the number of the pattern using ordinary zsh  indexing,  i.e.
	      the  first  is 1, and so on.  Note the absence of a `$' in front
	      of var.  To avoid	 clashes,  the	parameter  cannot  begin  with
	      `_expect'.

	      The option -q is passed directly down to tcp_read.

	      As  all  input  is  done via tcp_read, all the usual rules about
	      output of lines read apply.  One exception is that the parameter
	      $tcp_lines  will	only  reflect  the  line  actually  matched by
	      tcp_expect; use $tcp_expect_lines for the full set of lines read
	      during the function call.

       tcp_proxy
	      This  is a simple-minded function to accept a TCP connection and
	      execute  a  command  with	 I/O  redirected  to  the  connection.
	      Extreme  caution should be taken as there is no security whatso‐
	      ever and this can leave your computer open to the	 world.	  Ide‐
	      ally, it should only be used behind a firewall.

	      The first argument is a TCP port on which the function will lis‐
	      ten.

	      The remaining arguments give a command and its arguments to exe‐
	      cute  with  standard  input,  standard output and standard error
	      redirected to the file descriptor on which the TCP  session  has
	      been  accepted.	If  no command is given, a new zsh is started.
	      This gives everyone  on  your  network  direct  access  to  your
	      account, which in many cases will be a bad thing.

	      The  command  is	run  in	 the background, so tcp_proxy can then
	      accept new connections.  It continues to accept new  connections
	      until interrupted.

       tcp_spam [-ertv] [ -a | -s  sess | -l sess,... ] cmd ...
	      Execute  `cmd ...' for each session in turn.  Note this executes
	      the command and arguments; it does not send the command line  as
	      data unless the -t (transmit) option is given.

	      The sessions may be selected explicitly with the standard -a, -s
	      or -l options, or may be chosen  implicitly.   If	 none  of  the
	      three  options  is  given	 the  rules  are:  first, if the array
	      $tcp_spam_list is set, this is taken as the  list	 of  sessions,
	      otherwise all sessions are taken.	 Second, any sessions given in
	      the array $tcp_no_spam_list are removed from the	list  of  ses‐
	      sions.

	      Normally,	 any  sessions added by the `-a' flag or when all ses‐
	      sions are chosen implicitly are  spammed	in  alphabetic	order;
	      sessions	given  by  the	$tcp_spam_list array or on the command
	      line are spammed in the order given.  The -r flag	 reverses  the
	      order however it was arrived it.

	      The  -v  flag specifies that a $TCP_PROMPT will be output before
	      each session.  This is output after any modification to TCP_SESS
	      by   the	user-defined  tcp_on_spam  function  described	below.
	      (Obviously that function is able to generate its own output.)

	      If the option -e is present, the line given as cmd ...  is  exe‐
	      cuted  using  eval, otherwise it is executed without any further
	      processing.

       tcp_talk
	      This is a fairly simple-minded attempt to	 force	input  to  the
	      line editor to go straight to the default TCP_SESSION.

	      An  escape  string,  $TCP_TALK_ESCAPE,  default  `:', is used to
	      allow access to normal shell operation.  If it is on its own  at
	      the  start of the line, or followed only by whitespace, the line
	      editor returns to normal operation.  Otherwise, the  string  and
	      any  following  whitespace  are skipped and the remainder of the
	      line executed as shell input without any change of the line edi‐
	      tor's operating mode.

	      The current implementation is somewhat deficient in terms of use
	      of the command history.  For this reason, many users will prefer
	      to use some form of alternative approach for sending data easily
	      to the current session.  One simple approach is  to  alias  some
	      special character (such as `%') to `tcp_command --'.

       tcp_wait
	      The  sole	 argument is an integer or floating point number which
	      gives the seconds to delay.  The shell will do nothing for  that
	      period  except  wait  for	 input	on all TCP sessions by calling
	      tcp_read -a.  This is similar to the  interactive	 behaviour  at
	      the command prompt when zle handlers are installed.

   `One-shot' file transfer
       tcp_point port
       tcp_shoot host port
	      This  pair  of functions provide a simple way to transfer a file
	      between two hosts within the shell.  Note,  however,  that  bulk
	      data  transfer is currently done using cat.  tcp_point reads any
	      data arriving at port and sends it to standard output; tcp_shoot
	      connects	to  port  on  host  and sends its standard input.  Any
	      unused port may be used; the standard mechanism  for  picking  a
	      port  is to think of a random four-digit number above 1024 until
	      one works.

	      To transfer a file from  host  woodcock  to  host	 springes,  on
	      springes:

		     tcp_point 8091 >output_file

	      and on woodcock:

		     tcp_shoot springes 8091 <input_file

	      As  these	 two functions do not require tcp_open to set up a TCP
	      connection first, they may need to be autoloaded separately.

TCP USER-DEFINED FUNCTIONS
       Certain functions, if defined by the user, will be called by the	 func‐
       tion  system  in certain contexts.  This facility depends on the module
       zsh/parameter, which is usually available in interactive shells as  the
       completion  system  depends  on	it.   None  of	the  functions need be
       defined; they simply provide convenient hooks when necessary.

       Typically, these are called after the requested action has been	taken,
       so that the various parameters will reflect the new state.

       tcp_on_alias alias fd
	      When  an alias is defined, this function will be called with two
	      arguments: the name of the alias, and the file descriptor of the
	      corresponding session.

       tcp_on_close sess fd
	      This  is	called with the name of a session being closed and the
	      file descriptor which corresponded to that session.   Both  will
	      be invalid by the time the function is called.

       tcp_on_open sess fd
	      This  is	called	after  a new session has been defined with the
	      session name and file descriptor as arguments.

       tcp_on_rename oldsess fd newsess
	      This is called after a session has been renamed with  the	 three
	      arguments old session name, file descriptor, new session name.

       tcp_on_spam sess command ...
	      This is called once for each session spammed, just before a com‐
	      mand is executed for a session by tcp_spam.  The	arguments  are
	      the  session  name  followed by the command list to be executed.
	      If tcp_spam was called with the option  -t,  the	first  command
	      will be tcp_send.

	      This  function  is  called after $TCP_SESS is set to reflect the
	      session to be spammed, but before any use of it is made.	 Hence
	      it is possible to alter the value of $TCP_SESS within this func‐
	      tion.  For example, the  session	arguments  to  tcp_spam	 could
	      include  extra  information  to be stripped off and processed in
	      tcp_on_spam.

	      If the function sets the parameter $REPLY to `done', the command
	      line  is not executed; in addition, no prompt is printed for the
	      -v option to tcp_spam.

       tcp_on_unalias alias fd
	      This is called with the name of an alias and  the	 corresponding
	      session's file descriptor after an alias has been deleted.

TCP UTILITY FUNCTIONS
       The  following  functions  are used by the TCP function system but will
       rarely if ever need to be called directly.

       tcp_fd_handler
	      This is the function installed by tcp_open  for  handling	 input
	      from  within the line editor, if that is required.  It is in the
	      format documented for the builtin `zle -F' in zshzle(1) .

	      While active, the function sets the parameter TCP_HANDLER_ACTIVE
	      to 1.  This allows shell code called internally (for example, by
	      setting tcp_on_read) to tell if is being called when  the	 shell
	      is otherwise idle at the editor prompt.

       tcp_output [ -q ] -P prompt -F fd -S sess
	      This  function  is  used for both logging and handling output to
	      standard output, from within tcp_read  and  (if  $TCP_OUTPUT  is
	      set) tcp_send.

	      The  prompt  to use is specified by -P; the default is the empty
	      string.  It can contain:
	      %c     Expands to 1 if the session is the current session,  oth‐
		     erwise   0.    Used   with	 ternary  expresions  such  as
		     `%(c.-.+)' to output `+' for the current session and  `-'
		     otherwise.

	      %f     Replaced by the session's file descriptor.

	      %s     Replaced by the session name.

	      %%     Replaced by a single `%'.

	      The  option  -q suppresses output to standard output, but not to
	      any log files which are configured.

	      The -S and -F options are used to pass in the session  name  and
	      file descriptor for possible replacement in the prompt.

TCP USER PARAMETERS
       Parameters  follow  the	usual  convention  that	 uppercase is used for
       scalars and integers, while lowercase is used for normal	 and  associa‐
       tive  array.  It is always safe for user code to read these parameters.
       Some parameters may also be set; these are  noted  explicitly.	Others
       are  included  in this group as they are set by the function system for
       the user's benefit, i.e. setting them is typically not  useful  but  is
       benign.

       It  is  often  also useful to make settable parameters local to a func‐
       tion.  For example, `local TCP_SILENT=1' specifies that data read  dur‐
       ing  the	 function call will not be printed to standard output, regard‐
       less  of	 the  setting  outside	 the   function.    Likewise,	`local
       TCP_SESS=sess'  sets  a	session	 for  the  duration of a function, and
       `local TCP_PROMPT=' specifies that no prompt is used for	 input	during
       the function.

       tcp_expect_lines
	      Array.	The  set  of  lines  read  during  the	last  call  to
	      tcp_expect, including the last ($TCP_LINE).

       tcp_filter
	      Array. May be set directly.  A set of extended globbing patterns
	      which,  if  matched in tcp_output, will cause the line not to be
	      printed to standard output.  The patterns should be  defined  as
	      described	 for  the  arguments to tcp_expect.  Output of line to
	      log files is not affected.

       TCP_HANDLER_ACTIVE
	      Scalar.  Set to 1 within tcp_fd_handler to indicate to functions
	      called  recursively  that they have been called during an editor
	      session.	Otherwise unset.

       TCP_LINE
	      The last line read by tcp_read, and hence also tcp_expect.

       TCP_LINE_FD
	      The   file   descriptor	from   which   $TCP_LINE   was	 read.
	      ${tcp_by_fd[$TCP_LINE_FD]}  will	give the corresponding session
	      name.

       tcp_lines
	      Array. The set of lines read during the last call	 to  tcp_read,
	      including the last ($TCP_LINE).

       TCP_LOG
	      May  be set directly, although it is also controlled by tcp_log.
	      The name of a file to which output from  all  sessions  will  be
	      sent.   The output is proceeded by the usual $TCP_PROMPT.	 If it
	      is not an absolute path name, it will follow the user's  current
	      directory.

       TCP_LOG_SESS
	      May  be set directly, although it is also controlled by tcp_log.
	      The prefix for a set of files to which output from each  session
	      separately    will    be	  sent;	   the	  full	 filename   is
	      ${TCP_LOG_SESS}.sess.  Output to each file is raw; no prompt  is
	      added.   If  it is not an absolute path name, it will follow the
	      user's current directory.

       tcp_no_spam_list
	      Array.  May be set directly.  See tcp_spam for how this is used.

       TCP_OUTPUT
	      May be set directly.  If a non-empty string, any data sent to  a
	      session  by  tcp_send  will be logged.  This parameter gives the
	      prompt to be used in a file specified by $TCP_LOG but not	 in  a
	      file  generated  from  $TCP_LOG_SESS.  The prompt string has the
	      same format as TCP_PROMPT and the same rules for its use apply.

       TCP_PROMPT
	      May be set directly.  Used  as  the  prefix  for	data  read  by
	      tcp_read	which is printed to standard output or to the log file
	      given by $TCP_LOG, if any.  Any `%s', `%f' or `%%' occurring  in
	      the string will be replaced by the name of the session, the ses‐
	      sion's underlying file descriptor,  or  a	 single	 `%',  respec‐
	      tively.	The  expression `%c' expands to 1 if the session being
	      read is the current session, else 0;  this  is  most  useful  in
	      ternary  expressions such as `%(c.-.+)' which outputs `+' if the
	      session is the current one, else `-'.

       TCP_READ_DEBUG
	      May be set directly.  If this has non-zero length, tcp_read will
	      give some limited diagnostics about data being read.

       TCP_SECONDS_START
	      This value is created and initialised to zero by tcp_open.

	      The  functions  tcp_read	and tcp_expect use the shell's SECONDS
	      parameter for their own timing purposes.	If that	 parameter  is
	      not  of floating point type on entry to one of the functions, it
	      will create a local parameter SECONDS which  is  floating	 point
	      and set the parameter TCP_SECONDS_START to the previous value of
	      $SECONDS.	 If the parameter is already  floating	point,	it  is
	      used without a local copy being created and TCP_SECONDS_START is
	      not set.	As the global value is zero, the shell elapsed time is
	      guaranteed to be the sum of $SECONDS and $TCP_SECONDS_START.

	      This  can	 be  avoided by setting SECONDS globally to a floating
	      point value using `typeset -F SECONDS'; then the	TCP  functions
	      will  never make a local copy and never set TCP_SECONDS_START to
	      a non-zero value.

       TCP_SESS
	      May be set directly.  The current session; must refer to one  of
	      the sessions established by tcp_open.

       TCP_SILENT
	      May  be set directly, although it is also controlled by tcp_log.
	      If of non-zero length, data read by tcp_read will not be written
	      to standard output, though may still be written to a log file.

       tcp_spam_list
	      Array.   May  be set directly.  See the description of the func‐
	      tion tcp_spam for how this is used.

       TCP_TALK_ESCAPE
	      May be set  directly.   See  the	description  of	 the  function
	      tcp_talk for how this is used.

       TCP_TIMEOUT
	      May  be  set directly.  Currently this is only used by the func‐
	      tion tcp_command, see above.

TCP USER-DEFINED PARAMETERS
       The following parameters are not set by the function system, but have a
       special effect if set by the user.

       tcp_on_read
	      This should be an associative array; if it is not, the behaviour
	      is undefined.  Each key is the name of a shell function or other
	      command,	and  the corresponding value is a shell pattern (using
	      EXTENDED_GLOB).  Every line read from a TCP session directly  or
	      indirectly   using   tcp_read  (which  includes  lines  read  by
	      tcp_expect) is  compared	against	 the  pattern.	 If  the  line
	      matches,	the  command given in the key is called with two argu‐
	      ments: the name of the session from which the line was read, and
	      the line itself.

	      If  any function called to handle a line returns a non-zero sta‐
	      tus, the line is not output.  Thus a  tcp_on_read	 handler  con‐
	      taining  only the instruction `return 1' can be used to suppress
	      output of particular lines  (see,	 however,  tcp_filter  above).
	      However,	the  line  is  still stored in TCP_LINE and tcp_lines;
	      this occurs after all tcp_on_read processing.

TCP UTILITY PARAMETERS
       These parameters are controlled by the function	system;	 they  may  be
       read directly, but should not usually be set by user code.

       tcp_aliases
	      Associative  array.   The	 keys are the names of sessions estab‐
	      lished with tcp_open; each value is a  space-separated  list  of
	      aliases which refer to that session.

       tcp_by_fd
	      Associative  array.  The keys are session file descriptors; each
	      value is the name of that session.

       tcp_by_name
	      Associative array.  The keys are the  names  of  sessions;  each
	      value is the file descriptor associated with that session.

TCP EXAMPLES
       Here is a trivial example using a remote calculator.

       TO  create a calculator server on port 7337 (see the dc manual page for
       quite how infuriating the underlying command is):

	      tcp_proxy 7337 dc

       To connect to this from the same host with a session also named `dc':

	      tcp_open localhost 7337 dc

       To send a command to the remote session and wait a short while for out‐
       put (assuming dc is the current session):

	      tcp_command 2 4 + p

       To close the session:

	      tcp_close

       The  tcp_proxy  needs  to  be killed to be stopped.  Note this will not
       usually kill any connections which have already been accepted, and also
       that the port is not immediately available for reuse.

       The  following  chunk  of  code	puts  a list of sessions into an xterm
       header, with the current session followed by a star.

	      print -n "\033]2;TCP:" ${(k)tcp_by_name:/$TCP_SESS/$TCP_SESS\*} "\a"

TCP BUGS
       The function tcp_read uses the shell's normal read  builtin.   As  this
       reads a complete line at once, data arriving without a terminating new‐
       line can cause the function to block indefinitely.

       Though the function suite works well for interactive use and  for  data
       arriving	 in  small amounts, the performance when large amounts of data
       are being exchanged is likely to be extremely poor.

ZSHZFTPSYS(1)							 ZSHZFTPSYS(1)

NAME
       zshzftpsys - zftp function front-end

DESCRIPTION
       This describes the set of shell functions supplied with the source dis‐
       tribution  as an interface to the zftp builtin command, allowing you to
       perform FTP operations from the shell command line or within  functions
       or scripts.  The interface is similar to a traditional FTP client (e.g.
       the ftp command itself, see ftp(1)), but as it is entirely done	within
       the  shell  all the familiar completion, editing and globbing features,
       and so on, are present, and macros are particularly simple to write  as
       they are just ordinary shell functions.

       The  prerequisite  is  that  the	 zftp command, as described in zshmod‐
       ules(1) , must be available in the version of  zsh  installed  at  your
       site.   If the shell is configured to load new commands at run time, it
       probably is: typing `zmodload zsh/zftp' will make sure  (if  that  runs
       silently, it has worked).  If this is not the case, it is possible zftp
       was linked into the shell anyway: to test this, type `which  zftp'  and
       if  zftp	 is  available	you will get the message `zftp: shell built-in
       command'.

       Commands given directly with zftp builtin may be	 interspersed  between
       the  functions  in  this suite; in a few cases, using zftp directly may
       cause some of the status information  stored  in	 shell	parameters  to
       become  invalid.	  Note	in particular the description of the variables
       $ZFTP_TMOUT, $ZFTP_PREFS and $ZFTP_VERBOSE for zftp.

INSTALLATION
       You should make sure all the functions from the	Functions/Zftp	direc‐
       tory  of the source distribution are available; they all begin with the
       two letters `zf'.  They may already have been installed on your system;
       otherwise,  you	will  need  to find them and copy them.	 The directory
       should appear as one of the elements of the $fpath array	 (this	should
       already	be the case if they were installed), and at least the function
       zfinit should be autoloaded; it will autoload the  rest.	  Finally,  to
       initialize  the use of the system you need to call the zfinit function.
       The following code in your .zshrc will arrange  for  this;  assume  the
       functions are stored in the directory ~/myfns:

	      fpath=(~/myfns $fpath)
	      autoload -U zfinit
	      zfinit

       Note  that zfinit assumes you are using the zmodload method to load the
       zftp command.  If it is already built into the shell, change zfinit  to
       zfinit  -n.  It is helpful (though not essential) if the call to zfinit
       appears after any code to initialize the new  completion	 system,  else
       unnecessary compctl commands will be given.

FUNCTIONS
       The sequence of operations in performing a file transfer is essentially
       the same as that in a standard FTP client.  Note that, due to  a	 quirk
       of the shell's getopts builtin, for those functions that handle options
       you must use `--' rather than `-' to ensure the remaining arguments are
       treated literally (a single `-' is treated as an argument).

   Opening a connection
       zfparams [ host [ user [ password ... ] ] ]
	      Set  or  show  the  parameters for a future zfopen with no argu‐
	      ments.  If no arguments are given, the  current  parameters  are
	      displayed	 (the  password will be shown as a line of asterisks).
	      If a host is given, and either the user or password is not, they
	      will  be	prompted for; also, any parameter given as `?' will be
	      prompted for, and if the `?' is followed by a string, that  will
	      be  used	as  the prompt.	 As zfopen calls zfparams to store the
	      parameters, this usually need not be called directly.

	      A single argument `-' will delete the stored  parameters.	  This
	      will  also cause the memory of the last directory (and so on) on
	      the other host to be deleted.

       zfopen [ -1 ] [ host [ user [ password [ account ] ] ] ]
	      If host is present, open a connection to that host  under	 user‐
	      name  user  with	password  password (and, on the rare occasions
	      when it is necessary, account account).  If a necessary  parame‐
	      ter is missing or given as `?' it will be prompted for.  If host
	      is not present, use a previously stored set of parameters.

	      If the command was successful, and the  terminal	is  compatible
	      with  xterm  or  is  sun-cmd, a summary will appear in the title
	      bar, giving the local host:directory and the remote  host:direc‐
	      tory;  this  is  handled	by  the function zftp_chpwd, described
	      below.

	      Normally, the host, user and password  are  internally  recorded
	      for  later  re-opening, either by a zfopen with no arguments, or
	      automatically (see below).  With the option `-1', no information
	      is  stored.  Also, if an open command with arguments failed, the
	      parameters will not be retained  (and  any  previous  parameters
	      will  also  be  deleted).	  A zfopen on its own, or a zfopen -1,
	      never alters the stored parameters.

	      Both zfopen and zfanon (but not zfparams) understand URLs of the
	      form  ftp://host/path... as meaning to connect to the host, then
	      change directory to path (which  must  be	 a  directory,	not  a
	      file).   The `ftp://' can be omitted; the trailing `/' is enough
	      to trigger recognition of the path.  Note	 prefixes  other  than
	      `ftp:'  are  not	recognized,  and that all characters after the
	      first slash beyond host are significant in path.

       zfanon [ -1 ] host
	      Open a connection host for anonymous FTP.	 The username used  is
	      `anonymous'.   The  password  (which  will be reported the first
	      time) is generated as user@host; this  is	 then  stored  in  the
	      shell parameter $EMAIL_ADDR which can alternatively be set manu‐
	      ally to a suitable string.

   Directory management
       zfcd [ dir ]
       zfcd -
       zfcd old new
	      Change the current directory on  the  remote  server:   this  is
	      implemented  to  have  many of the features of the shell builtin
	      cd.

	      In the first form with dir present, change to the directory dir.
	      The  command `zfcd ..' is treated specially, so is guaranteed to
	      work on non-UNIX servers (note this  is  handled	internally  by
	      zftp).  If dir is omitted, has the effect of `zfcd ~'.

	      The second form changes to the directory previously current.

	      The  third  form	attempts  to  change  the current directory by
	      replacing the first occurrence of the string old with the string
	      new in the current directory.

	      Note that in this command, and indeed anywhere a remote filename
	      is expected, the string which on the local host  corresponds  to
	      `~' is converted back to a `~' before being passed to the remote
	      machine.	This is convenient because of  the  way	 expansion  is
	      performed	 on  the  command  line before zfcd receives a string.
	      For example, suppose the command is  `zfcd  ~/foo'.   The	 shell
	      will    expand   this   to   a   full   path   such   as	 `zfcd
	      /home/user2/pws/foo'.  At this stage, zfcd recognises  the  ini‐
	      tial path as corresponding to `~' and will send the directory to
	      the remote host as ~/foo, so that the `~' will  be  expanded  by
	      the  server  to  the correct remote host directory.  Other named
	      directories of the form `~name' are not treated in this fashion.

       zfhere Change directory on the remote server to the  one	 corresponding
	      to  the current local directory, with special handling of `~' as
	      in zfcd.	 For  example,	if  the	 current  local	 directory  is
	      ~/foo/bar, then zfhere performs the effect of `zfcd ~/foo/bar'.

       zfdir [ -rfd ] [ - ] [ dir-options ] [ dir ]
	      Produce a long directory listing.	 The arguments dir-options and
	      dir are passed directly to the server and their effect is imple‐
	      mentation	 dependent,  but specifying a particular remote direc‐
	      tory dir is usually possible.  The output is  passed  through  a
	      pager  given  by	the  environment variable $PAGER, or `more' if
	      that is not set.

	      The directory is usually cached for re-use.  In fact, two caches
	      are  maintained.	One is for use when there is no dir-options or
	      dir, i.e. a full listing of the current remote directory; it  is
	      flushed when the current remote directory changes.  The other is
	      kept for repeated use of zfdir  with  the	 same  arguments;  for
	      example,	repeated use of `zfdir /pub/gnu' will only require the
	      directory to be retrieved on  the	 first	call.	Alternatively,
	      this  cache  can	be  re-viewed with the -r option.  As relative
	      directories will confuse zfdir, the -f option  can  be  used  to
	      force  the  cache	 to be flushed before the directory is listed.
	      The option -d will delete both caches without showing  a	direc‐
	      tory listing; it will also delete the cache of file names in the
	      current remote directory, if any.

       zfls [ ls-options ] [ dir ]
	      List files on the remote server.	With no arguments,  this  will
	      produce  a  simple  list	of  file  names for the current remote
	      directory.  Any arguments are passed directly to the server.  No
	      pager and no caching is used.

   Status commands
       zftype [ type ]
	      With no arguments, show the type of data to be transferred, usu‐
	      ally ASCII or binary.  With an argument, change  the  type:  the
	      types  `A' or `ASCII' for ASCII data and `B' or `BINARY', `I' or
	      `IMAGE' for binary data are understood case-insensitively.

       zfstat [ -v ]
	      Show the status of the current or last connection,  as  well  as
	      the  status  of  some  of	 zftp's status variables.  With the -v
	      option, a more verbose  listing  is  produced  by	 querying  the
	      server for its version of events, too.

   Retrieving files
       The  commands  for  retrieving  files all take at least two options. -G
       suppresses remote filename expansion which would otherwise be performed
       (see  below  for	 a more detailed description of that).	-t attempts to
       set the modification time of the local file to that of the remote file:
       this  requires  version	5 of perl, see the description of the function
       zfrtime below for more information.

       zfget [ -Gtc ] file1 ...
	      Retrieve all the listed files file1 ... one at a time  from  the
	      remote  server.	If  a  file  contains  a `/', the full name is
	      passed to the remote server, but	the  file  is  stored  locally
	      under  the  name	given  by  the	part after the final `/'.  The
	      option -c (cat) forces all files to be sent as a	single	stream
	      to standard output; in this case the -t option has no effect.

       zfuget [ -Gvst ] file1 ...
	      As  zfget,  but  only  retrieve  files  where the version on the
	      remote server is newer (has a later modification time), or where
	      the  local file does not exist.  If the remote file is older but
	      the files have different sizes, or if the sizes are the same but
	      the  remote  file	 is  newer,  the user will usually be queried.
	      With the option -s, the command runs silently  and  will	always
	      retrieve the file in either of those two cases.  With the option
	      -v, the command prints more information about the files while it
	      is working out whether or not to transfer them.

       zfcget [ -Gt ] file1 ...
	      As  zfget,  but if any of the local files exists, and is shorter
	      than the corresponding remote file, the command assumes that  it
	      is  the result of a partially completed transfer and attempts to
	      transfer the rest of the file.  This is useful on a poor connec‐
	      tion which keeps failing.

	      Note  that  this	requires a commonly implemented, but non-stan‐
	      dard, version of the FTP protocol, so is not guaranteed to  work
	      on all servers.

       zfgcp [ -Gt ] remote-file local-file
       zfgcp [ -Gt ] rfile1 ... ldir
	      This  retrieves  files  from  the	 remote	 server with arguments
	      behaving similarly to the cp command.

	      In the first form, copy remote-file from the server to the local
	      file local-file.

	      In  the  second  form, copy all the remote files rfile1 ... into
	      the local directory ldir retaining  the  same  basenames.	  This
	      assumes UNIX directory semantics.

   Sending files
       zfput [ -r ] file1 ...
	      Send  all	 the  file1 ... given separately to the remote server.
	      If a filename contains a `/', the full filename is used  locally
	      to  find	the file, but only the basename is used for the remote
	      file name.

	      With the option -r, if any of the files are directories they are
	      sent  recursively with all their subdirectories, including files
	      beginning with `.'.   This  requires  that  the  remote  machine
	      understand UNIX file semantics, since `/' is used as a directory
	      separator.

       zfuput [ -vs ] file1 ...
	      As zfput, but only send files which are newer than  their	 local
	      equivalents, or if the remote file does not exist.  The logic is
	      the same as for zfuget, but reversed between  local  and	remote
	      files.

       zfcput file1 ...
	      As  zfput,  but if any remote file already exists and is shorter
	      than the local equivalent, assume it is the result of an	incom‐
	      plete  transfer  and  send the rest of the file to append to the
	      existing part.  As the FTP append command is part of  the	 stan‐
	      dard set, this is in principle more likely to work than zfcget.

       zfpcp local-file remote-file
       zfpcp lfile1 ... rdir
	      This  sends  files  to the remote server with arguments behaving
	      similarly to the cp command.

	      With  two	 arguments,  copy  local-file	to   the   server   as
	      remote-file.

	      With  more  than	two arguments, copy all the local files lfile1
	      ... into the existing remote directory rdir retaining  the  same
	      basenames.  This assumes UNIX directory semantics.

	      A	 problem  arises if you attempt to use zfpcp lfile1 rdir, i.e.
	      the second form of copying but with two arguments, as  the  com‐
	      mand  has	 no  simple  way  of  knowing if rdir corresponds to a
	      directory or a filename.	It attempts to resolve this in various
	      ways.   First,  if the rdir argument is `.' or `..' or ends in a
	      slash, it is assumed to be a directory.  Secondly, if the opera‐
	      tion  of	copying to a remote file in the first form failed, and
	      the remote server sends back the expected failure code 553 and a
	      reply  including	the  string  `Is a directory', then zfpcp will
	      retry using the second form.

   Closing the connection
       zfclose
	      Close the connection.

   Session management
       zfsession [ -lvod ] [ sessname ]
	      Allows you to manage multiple FTP sessions at once.  By default,
	      connections  take place in a session called `default'; by giving
	      the command `zfsession sessname' you can	change	to  a  new  or
	      existing	session	 with  a name of your choice.  The new session
	      remembers its own connection, as well as associated shell param‐
	      eters, and also the host/user parameters set by zfparams.	 Hence
	      you can have different sessions set up to connect	 to  different
	      hosts, each remembering the appropriate host, user and password.

	      With no arguments, zfsession prints the name of the current ses‐
	      sion; with the option -l it lists all sessions  which  currently
	      exist,  and  with	 the option -v it gives a verbose list showing
	      the host and directory for each session, where the current  ses‐
	      sion is marked with an asterisk.	With -o, it will switch to the
	      most recent previous session.

	      With -d, the given session (or else the current one) is removed;
	      everything to do with it is completely forgotten.	 If it was the
	      only session, a new session called `default' is created and made
	      current.	 It  is safest not to delete sessions while background
	      commands using zftp are active.

       zftransfer sess1:file1 sess2:file2
	      Transfer files between two sessions; no local copy is made.  The
	      file is read from the session sess1 as file1 and written to ses‐
	      sion sess2 as file file2; file1 and file2 may be relative to the
	      current  directories  of the session.  Either sess1 or sess2 may
	      be omitted (though the colon should be retained if  there	 is  a
	      possibility  of a colon appearing in the file name) and defaults
	      to the current session; file2 may be omitted or may end  with  a
	      slash,  in  which case the basename of file1 will be added.  The
	      sessions sess1 and sess2 must be distinct.

	      The operation is performed using pipes, so it is	required  that
	      the  connections	still be valid in a subshell, which is not the
	      case under versions of some operating systems, presumably due to
	      a system bug.

   Bookmarks
       The two functions zfmark and zfgoto allow you to `bookmark' the present
       location (host, user and directory) of the current FTP  connection  for
       later use.  The file to be used for storing and retrieving bookmarks is
       given by the parameter $ZFTP_BMFILE; if not set when  one  of  the  two
       functions  is  called,  it  will	 be  set to the file .zfbkmarks in the
       directory where your zsh startup files live (usually ~).

       zfmark [ bookmark ]
	      If given an argument, mark the current host, user and  directory
	      under the name bookmark for later use by zfgoto.	If there is no
	      connection open, use the values for the last connection  immedi‐
	      ately  before  it	 was closed; it is an error if there was none.
	      Any existing bookmark under  the	same  name  will  be  silently
	      replaced.

	      If  not  given  an argument, list the existing bookmarks and the
	      points to which they refer in the form user@host:directory; this
	      is  the  format  in  which  they are stored, and the file may be
	      edited directly.

       zfgoto [ -n ] bookmark
	      Return to the location given by bookmark, as previously  set  by
	      zfmark.  If the location has user `ftp' or `anonymous', open the
	      connection with zfanon, so that no password is required.	If the
	      user and host parameters match those stored for the current ses‐
	      sion, if any, those will be  used,  and  again  no  password  is
	      required.	 Otherwise a password will be prompted for.

	      With  the	 option	 -n,  the  bookmark  is taken to be a nickname
	      stored by the ncftp program  in  its  bookmark  file,  which  is
	      assumed  to  be  ~/.ncftp/bookmarks.  The function works identi‐
	      cally in other ways.  Note that there is no mechanism for adding
	      or modifying ncftp bookmarks from the zftp functions.

   Other functions
       Mostly,	these  functions  will	not  be	 called	 directly  (apart from
       zfinit), but are described here for  completeness.   You	 may  wish  to
       alter zftp_chpwd and zftp_progress, in particular.

       zfinit [ -n ]
	      As described above, this is used to initialize the zftp function
	      system.  The -n option should be used if	the  zftp  command  is
	      already built into the shell.

       zfautocheck [ -dn ]
	      This  function is called to implement automatic reopening behav‐
	      iour, as described in  more  detail  below.   The	 options  must
	      appear  in  the  first  argument;	 -n  prevents the command from
	      changing to the old directory, while -d prevents it from setting
	      the  variable  do_close,	which  it otherwise does as a flag for
	      automatically closing the connection after a transfer.  The host
	      and  directory  for  the last session are stored in the variable
	      $zflastsession, but the internal	host/user/password  parameters
	      must also be correctly set.

       zfcd_match prefix suffix
	      This performs matching for completion of remote directory names.
	      If the remote server is UNIX, it will attempt  to	 persuade  the
	      server  to list the remote directory with subdirectories marked,
	      which usually works but is not guaranteed.  On  other  hosts  it
	      simply calls zfget_match and hence completes all files, not just
	      directories.  On some systems, directories  may  not  even  look
	      like filenames.

       zfget_match prefix suffix
	      This  performs  matching for completion of remote filenames.  It
	      caches files for the  current  directory	(only)	in  the	 shell
	      parameter	 $zftp_fcache.	 It is in the form to be called by the
	      -K option of compctl, but also works when	 called	 from  a  wid‐
	      get-style	 completion function with prefix and suffix set appro‐
	      priately.

       zfrglob varname
	      Perform remote globbing, as  describes  in  more	detail	below.
	      varname  is  the name of a variable containing the pattern to be
	      expanded; if there were any matches, the same variable  will  be
	      set to the expanded set of filenames on return.

       zfrtime lfile rfile [ time ]
	      Set  the	local file lfile to have the same modification time as
	      the remote file rfile, or the explicit time time in  FTP	format
	      CCYYMMDDhhmmSS for the GMT timezone.

	      Currently this requires perl version 5 to perform the conversion
	      from GMT to local time.  This is unfortunately difficult	to  do
	      using shell code alone.

       zftp_chpwd
	      This  function  is  called every time a connection is opened, or
	      closed, or the remote directory changes.	 This  version	alters
	      the  title bar of an xterm-compatible or sun-cmd terminal emula‐
	      tor to reflect the local and remote hostnames and current direc‐
	      tories.	It  works  best when combined with the function chpwd.
	      In particular, a function of the form

		     chpwd() {
		       if [[ -n $ZFTP_USER ]]; then
			 zftp_chpwd
		       else
			 # usual chpwd e.g put host:directory in title bar
		       fi
		     }

	      fits in well.

       zftp_progress
	      This function shows the status of the  transfer.	 It  will  not
	      write  anything  unless  the output is going to a terminal; how‐
	      ever, if you transfer files in the background, you  should  turn
	      off  progress  reports  by hand using `zstyle ':zftp:*' progress
	      none'.  Note also that if you alter it, any output  must	be  to
	      standard error, as standard output may be a file being received.
	      The form of the progress meter, or whether it is	used  at  all,
	      can be configured without altering the function, as described in
	      the next section.

       zffcache
	      This is used to implement caching of files in the current direc‐
	      tory for each session separately.	 It is used by zfget_match and
	      zfrglob.

MISCELLANEOUS FEATURES
   Configuration
       Various styles are available using the standard shell style  mechanism,
       described  in  zshmodules(1).  Briefly,	the  command `zstyle ':zftp:*'
       style value ...'.  defines the style to have value value; more than one
       value  may be given, although that is not useful in the cases described
       here.  These values will then be used throughout the zftp function sys‐
       tem.   For more precise control, the first argument, which gives a con‐
       text in which the style applies, can be modified to include a  particu‐
       lar  function,  as  for example `:zftp:zfget': the style will then have
       the given value only in the zfget function.  Values for the same	 style
       in  different  contexts	may be set; the most specific function will be
       used, where strings are held to be more	specific  than	patterns,  and
       longer  patterns	 and  shorter  patterns.  Note that only the top level
       function name, as called by the user, is used; calling of  lower	 level
       functions is transparent to the user.  Hence modifications to the title
       bar in zftp_chpwd use  the  contexts  :zftp:zfopen,  :zftp:zfcd,	 etc.,
       depending  where	 it  was called from.  The following styles are under‐
       stood:

       progress
	      Controls the way that zftp_progress reports on the progress of a
	      transfer.	  If  empty,  unset,  or `none', no progress report is
	      made; if `bar' a growing bar of inverse video is shown; if `per‐
	      cent'  (or  any other string, though this may change in future),
	      the percentage of the file transferred is shown.	The bar	 meter
	      requires	that  the  width  of the terminal be available via the
	      $COLUMNS parameter (normally this is set automatically).	If the
	      size  of	the  file  being transferred is not available, bar and
	      percent meters will simply show the number of bytes  transferred
	      so far.

	      When zfinit is run, if this style is not defined for the context
	      :zftp:*, it will be set to `bar'.

       update Specifies the minimum  time  interval  between  updates  of  the
	      progress	meter  in  seconds.  No update is made unless new data
	      has been received, so the actual time interval is	 limited  only
	      by $ZFTP_TIMEOUT.

	      As  described for progress, zfinit will force this to default to
	      1.

       remote-glob
	      If set to `1', `yes' or `true', filename	generation  (globbing)
	      is performed on the remote machine instead of by zsh itself; see
	      below.

       titlebar
	      If set to `1', `yes' or `true', zftp_chpwd will put  the	remote
	      host  and	 remote directory into the titlebar of terminal emula‐
	      tors such as xterm or sun-cmd that allow this.

	      As described for progress, zfinit will force this to default  to
	      1.

       chpwd  If set to `1' `yes' or `true', zftp_chpwd will call the function
	      chpwd when a connection is closed.  This is useful if the remote
	      host  details were put into the terminal title bar by zftp_chpwd
	      and your usual chpwd also modifies the title bar.

	      When zfinit is run, it will determine whether chpwd  exists  and
	      if  so  it will set the default value for the style to 1 if none
	      exists already.

       Note that there is also an associative array  zfconfig  which  contains
       values  used  by	 the  function system.	This should not be modified or
       overwritten.

   Remote globbing
       The commands for retrieving files usually perform  filename  generation
       (globbing)  on  their  arguments; this can be turned off by passing the
       option -G to each of the commands.  Normally this operates by  retriev‐
       ing a complete list of files for the directory in question, then match‐
       ing these locally against the pattern supplied.	This has the advantage
       that  the  full	range  of  zsh patterns (respecting the setting of the
       option EXTENDED_GLOB) can be used.  However, it means that  the	direc‐
       tory part of a filename will not be expanded and must be given exactly.
       If the remote server does not support  the  UNIX	 directory  semantics,
       directory  handling  is problematic and it is recommended that globbing
       only be used within the current directory.  The list of	files  in  the
       current	directory,  if	retrieved,  will be cached, so that subsequent
       globs in the same  directory  without  an  intervening  zfcd  are  much
       faster.

       If  the	remote-glob style (see above) is set, globbing is instead per‐
       formed on the remote host: the server is asked for a list  of  matching
       files.	This  is  highly  dependent  on how the server is implemented,
       though typically UNIX servers will provide support for basic glob  pat‐
       terns.	This  may in some cases be faster, as it avoids retrieving the
       entire list of directory contents.

   Automatic and temporary reopening
       As described for the zfopen command, a subsequent zfopen with no param‐
       eters  will  reopen the connection to the last host (this includes con‐
       nections made with the zfanon command).	Opened in  this	 fashion,  the
       connection  starts in the default remote directory and will remain open
       until explicitly closed.

       Automatic re-opening is also available.	If a connection	 is  not  cur‐
       rently  open  and  a  command requiring a connection is given, the last
       connection is implicitly reopened.  In this case	 the  directory	 which
       was  current  when  the connection was closed again becomes the current
       directory (unless, of course, the command given changes it).  Automatic
       reopening  will	also  take  place  if  the connection was close by the
       remote server for whatever reason (e.g. a timeout).  It is  not	avail‐
       able if the -1 option to zfopen or zfanon was used.

       Furthermore,  if	 the command issued is a file transfer, the connection
       will be closed after  the  transfer  is	finished,  hence  providing  a
       one-shot mode for transfers.  This does not apply to directory changing
       or listing commands; for example a zfdir may reopen  a  connection  but
       will  leave  it open.  Also, automatic closure will only ever happen in
       the same command as automatic opening, i.e a zfdir directly followed by
       a zfget will never close the connection automatically.

       Information  about the previous connection is given by the zfstat func‐
       tion.  So, for example, if that reports:

	      Session:	      default
	      Not connected.
	      Last session:   ftp.bar.com:/pub/textfiles

       then the command zfget file.txt will attempt to reopen a connection  to
       ftp.bar.com, retrieve the file /pub/textfiles/file.txt, and immediately
       close the connection again.  On the other hand, zfcd ..	will open  the
       connection in the directory /pub and leave it open.

       Note  that  all	the above is local to each session; if you return to a
       previous session, the connection for that session is the one which will
       be reopened.

   Completion
       Completion  of  local and remote files, directories, sessions and book‐
       marks is supported.  The older,	compctl-style  completion  is  defined
       when zfinit is called; support for the new widget-based completion sys‐
       tem is provided in  the	function  Completion/Zsh/Command/_zftp,	 which
       should  be  installed with the other functions of the completion system
       and hence should automatically be available.

ZSHCONTRIB(1)							 ZSHCONTRIB(1)

NAME
       zshcontrib - user contributions to zsh

DESCRIPTION
       The Zsh source distribution includes a number of items  contributed  by
       the  user community.  These are not inherently a part of the shell, and
       some may not be available in every zsh installation.  The most signifi‐
       cant of these are documented here.  For documentation on other contrib‐
       uted items such as shell functions, look for comments in	 the  function
       source files.

UTILITIES
   Accessing On-Line Help
       The key sequence ESC h is normally bound by ZLE to execute the run-help
       widget (see zshzle(1)).	This invokes the  run-help  command  with  the
       command	word from the current input line as its argument.  By default,
       run-help is an alias for the man command, so this often fails when  the
       command	word  is  a  shell  builtin  or	 a  user-defined function.  By
       redefining the run-help alias, one can improve the  on-line  help  pro‐
       vided by the shell.

       The helpfiles utility, found in the Util directory of the distribution,
       is a Perl program that can be used to process the zsh manual to produce
       a  separate  help  file for each shell builtin and for many other shell
       features as well.  The autoloadable run-help function, found  in	 Func‐
       tions/Misc,  searches  for  these  helpfiles and performs several other
       tests to produce the most complete help possible for the command.

       There may already be a directory of help files on your system; look  in
       /usr/share/zsh  or /usr/local/share/zsh and subdirectories below those,
       or ask your system administrator.

       To create your own help files with helpfiles, choose or create a direc‐
       tory where the individual command help files will reside.  For example,
       you might choose ~/zsh_help.  If you unpacked the zsh  distribution  in
       your home directory, you would use the commands:

	      mkdir ~/zsh_help
	      cd ~/zsh_help
	      man zshall | colcrt - | \
	      perl ~/zsh-4.2.6/Util/helpfiles

       Next,  to  use  the  run-help function, you need to add lines something
       like the following to your .zshrc or equivalent startup file:

	      unalias run-help
	      autoload run-help
	      HELPDIR=~/zsh_help

       The HELPDIR parameter tells run-help where to look for the help	files.
       If your system already has a help file directory installed, set HELPDIR
       to the path of that directory instead.

       Note that in order for `autoload run-help' to work, the	run-help  file
       must  be	 in one of the directories named in your fpath array (see zsh‐
       param(1)).  This should already be the case if you have a standard  zsh
       installation;  if  it is not, copy Functions/Misc/run-help to an appro‐
       priate directory.

   Recompiling Functions
       If you frequently edit your zsh functions, or periodically update  your
       zsh  installation  to  track the latest developments, you may find that
       function digests compiled with the zcompile builtin are frequently  out
       of date with respect to the function source files.  This is not usually
       a problem, because zsh always looks for the newest file when loading  a
       function,  but  it may cause slower shell startup and function loading.
       Also, if a digest file is explicitly used as an element of  fpath,  zsh
       won't check whether any of its source files has changed.

       The  zrecompile	autoloadable function, found in Functions/Misc, can be
       used to keep function digests up to date.

       zrecompile [ -qt ] [ name ... ]
       zrecompile [ -qt ] -p args [ -- args ... ]
	      This tries to find *.zwc files and automatically re-compile them
	      if at least one of the original files is newer than the compiled
	      file.  This works only if the names stored in the compiled files
	      are  full	 paths	or are relative to the directory that contains
	      the .zwc file.

	      In the first form, each name is the name of a compiled file or a
	      directory	 containing *.zwc files that should be checked.	 If no
	      arguments are given, the directories and *.zwc  files  in	 fpath
	      are used.

	      When -t is given, no compilation is performed, but a return sta‐
	      tus of zero (true) is set if there are files  that  need	to  be
	      re-compiled  and non-zero (false) otherwise.  The -q option qui‐
	      ets the chatty output that describes what zrecompile is doing.

	      Without the -t option, the return status is zero	if  all	 files
	      that  needed  re-compilation  could  be compiled and non-zero if
	      compilation for at least one of the files failed.

	      If the -p option is given, the args are interpreted  as  one  or
	      more  sets  of  arguments	 for zcompile, separated by `--'.  For
	      example:

		     zrecompile -p \
				-R ~/.zshrc -- \
				-M ~/.zcompdump -- \
				~/zsh/comp.zwc ~/zsh/Completion/*/_*

	      This compiles ~/.zshrc into ~/.zshrc.zwc if that	doesn't	 exist
	      or  if  it  is  older  than  ~/.zshrc. The compiled file will be
	      marked for reading instead of mapping.  The  same	 is  done  for
	      ~/.zcompdump  and	 ~/.zcompdump.zwc,  but	 this compiled file is
	      marked  for  mapping.  The  last	line   re-creates   the	  file
	      ~/zsh/comp.zwc if any of the files matching the given pattern is
	      newer than it.

	      Without the -p  option,  zrecompile  does	 not  create  function
	      digests that do not already exist, nor does it add new functions
	      to the digest.

       The following shell loop is an example of a method for  creating	 func‐
       tion  digests  for  all functions in your fpath, assuming that you have
       write permission to the directories:

	      for ((i=1; i <= $#fpath; ++i)); do
		dir=$fpath[i]
		zwc=${dir:t}.zwc
		if [[ $dir == (.|..) || $dir == (.|..)/* ]]; then
		  continue
		fi
		files=($dir/*(N-.))
		if [[ -w $dir:h && -n $files ]]; then
		  files=(${${(M)files%/*/*}#/})
		  if ( cd $dir:h &&
		       zrecompile -p -U -z $zwc $files ); then
		    fpath[i]=$fpath[i].zwc
		  fi
		fi
	      done

       The -U and -z options are appropriate for functions in the default  zsh
       installation fpath; you may need to use different options for your per‐
       sonal function directories.

       Once the digests have been created and your fpath modified to refer  to
       them,  you can keep them up to date by running zrecompile with no argu‐
       ments.

   Keyboard Definition
       The large number of possible combinations of  keyboards,	 workstations,
       terminals, emulators, and window systems makes it impossible for zsh to
       have built-in key bindings for  every  situation.   The	zkbd  utility,
       found  in  Functions/Misc, can help you quickly create key bindings for
       your configuration.

       Run zkbd either as an autoloaded function, or as a shell script:

	      zsh -f ~/zsh-4.2.6/Functions/Misc/zkbd

       When you run zkbd, it first asks you to enter your  terminal  type;  if
       the  default it offers is correct, just press return.  It then asks you
       to press a number of different keys  to	determine  characteristics  of
       your  keyboard and terminal; zkbd warns you if it finds anything out of
       the ordinary, such as a Delete key that sends neither ^H nor ^?.

       The keystrokes read by zkbd are recorded as a definition for  an	 asso‐
       ciative	array  named  key, written to a file in the subdirectory .zkbd
       within either your HOME or ZDOTDIR directory.  The name of the file  is
       composed	 from  the  TERM,  VENDOR  and	OSTYPE	parameters,  joined by
       hyphens.

       You may read this file into your .zshrc or another  startup  file  with
       the "source" or "." commands, then reference the key parameter in bind‐
       key commands, like this:

	      source ${ZDOTDIR:-$HOME}/.zkbd/$TERM-$VENDOR-$OSTYPE
	      [[ -n ${key[Left]} ]] && bindkey "${key[Left]}" backward-char
	      [[ -n ${key[Right]} ]] && bindkey "${key[Right]}" forward-char
	      # etc.

       Note that in order for `autoload zkbd' to work, the zkdb file  must  be
       in  one of the directories named in your fpath array (see zshparam(1)).
       This should already be the case if you have a  standard	zsh  installa‐
       tion;  if  it is not, copy Functions/Misc/zkbd to an appropriate direc‐
       tory.

   Dumping Shell State
       Occasionally you may encounter what appears to be a bug in  the	shell,
       particularly  if	 you  are using a beta version of zsh or a development
       release.	 Usually it is sufficient to send a description of the problem
       to  one of the zsh mailing lists (see zsh(1)), but sometimes one of the
       zsh developers will need to recreate your environment in order to track
       the problem down.

       The script named reporter, found in the Util directory of the distribu‐
       tion, is provided for this purpose.  (It is also possible  to  autoload
       reporter,  but  reporter	 is  not installed in fpath by default.)  This
       script outputs a detailed dump of the  shell  state,  in	 the  form  of
       another script that can be read with `zsh -f' to recreate that state.

       To  use reporter, read the script into your shell with the `.'  command
       and redirect the output into a file:

	      . ~/zsh-4.2.6/Util/reporter > zsh.report

       You should check the zsh.report file for any sensitive information such
       as  passwords  and delete them by hand before sending the script to the
       developers.  Also, as the output can be voluminous, it's best  to  wait
       for the developers to ask for this information before sending it.

       You  can	 also  use  reporter to dump only a subset of the shell state.
       This is sometimes useful for creating startup files for the first time.
       Most  of	 the output from reporter is far more detailed than usually is
       necessary for a startup file, but the  aliases,	options,  and  zstyles
       states  may  be	useful	because	 they  include	only  changes from the
       defaults.  The bindings state may be useful if you have created any  of
       your own keymaps, because reporter arranges to dump the keymap creation
       commands as well as the bindings for every keymap.

       As is usual with automated tools, if you create	a  startup  file  with
       reporter,  you  should edit the results to remove unnecessary commands.
       Note that if you're using the new completion  system,  you  should  not
       dump  the  functions state to your startup files with reporter; use the
       compdump function instead (see zshcompsys(1)).

       reporter [ state ... ]
	      Print to standard output the indicated  subset  of  the  current
	      shell state.  The state arguments may be one or more of:

	      all    Output everything listed below.
	      aliases
		     Output alias definitions.
	      bindings
		     Output ZLE key maps and bindings.
	      completion
		     Output  old-style	compctl	 commands.   New completion is
		     covered by functions and zstyles.
	      functions
		     Output autoloads and function definitions.
	      limits Output limit commands.
	      options
		     Output setopt commands.
	      styles Same as zstyles.
	      variables
		     Output shell parameter assignments, plus export  commands
		     for any environment variables.
	      zstyles
		     Output zstyle commands.

	      If the state is omitted, all is assumed.

       With the exception of `all', every state can be abbreviated by any pre‐
       fix, even a single letter; thus a is the same as aliases, z is the same
       as zstyles, etc.

PROMPT THEMES
   Installation
       You  should  make  sure	all  the  functions from the Functions/Prompts
       directory of the source distribution are available; they all begin with
       the  string `prompt_' except for the special function`promptinit'.  You
       also need the `colors' function	from  Functions/Misc.	All  of	 these
       functions  may  already have been installed on your system; if not, you
       will need to find them and copy them.  The directory should  appear  as
       one of the elements of the fpath array (this should already be the case
       if they were installed), and at least the function promptinit should be
       autoloaded;  it will autoload the rest.	Finally, to initialize the use
       of the system you need to call the promptinit function.	The  following
       code  in	 your  .zshrc  will arrange for this; assume the functions are
       stored in the directory ~/myfns:

	      fpath=(~/myfns $fpath)
	      autoload -U promptinit
	      promptinit

   Theme Selection
       Use the prompt command to select your preferred	theme.	 This  command
       may  be	added to your .zshrc following the call to promptinit in order
       to start zsh with a theme already selected.

       prompt [ -c | -l ]
       prompt [ -p | -h ] [ theme ... ]
       prompt [ -s ] theme [ arg ... ]
	      Set or examine the prompt theme.	With no options	 and  a	 theme
	      argument,	 the theme with that name is set as the current theme.
	      The available themes are determined at  run  time;  use  the  -l
	      option  to  see  a  list.	 The special theme `random' selects at
	      random one of the available themes and sets your prompt to that.

	      In some cases the theme may be modified by  one  or  more	 argu‐
	      ments, which should be given after the theme name.  See the help
	      for each theme for descriptions of these arguments.

	      Options are:

	      -c     Show the currently selected theme and its parameters,  if
		     any.
	      -l     List all available prompt themes.
	      -p     Preview  the  theme  named	 by theme, or all themes if no
		     theme is given.
	      -h     Show help for the theme named by theme, or for the prompt
		     function if no theme is given.
	      -s     Set theme as the current theme and save state.

       prompt_theme_setup
	      Each available theme has a setup function which is called by the
	      prompt function to install that theme.  This function may define
	      other  functions	as necessary to maintain the prompt, including
	      functions used to preview the prompt or  provide	help  for  its
	      use.   You  should  not  normally	 call a theme's setup function
	      directly.

ZLE FUNCTIONS
   Widgets
       These functions all implement user-defined ZLE widgets (see  zshzle(1))
       which  can  be bound to keystrokes in interactive shells.  To use them,
       your .zshrc should contain lines of the form

	      autoload function
	      zle -N function

       followed by an appropriate bindkey command to  associate	 the  function
       with a key sequence.  Suggested bindings are described below.

       bash-style word functions
	      If  you  are  looking for functions to implement moving over and
	      editing words in the manner of  bash,  where  only  alphanumeric
	      characters are considered word characters, you can use the func‐
	      tions described in the next section.  The	 following  is	suffi‐
	      cient:

		     autoload -U select-word-style
		     select-word-style bash

       forward-word-match, backward-word-match
       kill-word-match, backward-kill-word-match
       transpose-words-match, capitalize-word-match
       up-case-word-match, down-case-word-match
       select-word-style, match-words-by-style
	      The  eight  `-match'  functions are drop-in replacements for the
	      builtin widgets without the suffix.  By default they behave in a
	      similar  way.   However,	by  the use of styles and the function
	      select-word-style, the way words are matched can be altered.

	      The  simplest  way  of  configuring  the	functions  is  to  use
	      select-word-style,  which can either be called as a normal func‐
	      tion with the appropriate argument, or invoked as a user-defined
	      widget  that  will  prompt  for  the first character of the word
	      style to be used.	 The first  time  it  is  invoked,  the	 eight
	      -match  functions	 will  automatically  replace the builtin ver‐
	      sions, so they do not need to be loaded explicitly.

	      The word styles available are as follows.	 Only the first	 char‐
	      acter is examined.

	      bash   Word characters are alphanumeric characters only.

	      normal As	 in  normal  shell  operation:	 word  characters  are
		     alphanumeric characters plus any  characters  present  in
		     the string given by the parameter $WORDCHARS.

	      shell  Words  are	 complete  shell  command  arguments, possibly
		     including complete quoted strings, or any tokens  special
		     to the shell.

	      whitespace
		     Words are any set of characters delimited by whitespace.

	      default
		     Restore the default settings; this is usually the same as
		     `normal'.

	      More control can	be  obtained  using  the  zstyle  command,  as
	      described in zshmodules(1).  Each style is looked up in the con‐
	      text :zle:widget where widget is the name	 of  the  user-defined
	      widget,  not the name of the function implementing it, so in the
	      case of the definitions supplied by select-word-style the appro‐
	      priate  contexts are :zle:forward-word, and so on.  The function
	      select-word-style itself always defines styles for  the  context
	      `:zle:*'	which can be overridden by more specific (longer) pat‐
	      terns as well as explicit contexts.

	      The style word-style specifies the rules to use.	This may  have
	      the following values.

	      normal Use  the  standard	 shell	rules,	i.e. alphanumerics and
		     $WORDCHARS, unless overridden by the styles word-chars or
		     word-class.

	      specified
		     Similar to normal, but only the specified characters, and
		     not also alphanumerics, are considered word characters.

	      unspecified
		     The negation of  specified.   The	given  characters  are
		     those which will not be considered part of a word.

	      shell  Words  are obtained by using the syntactic rules for gen‐
		     erating shell command arguments.	In  addition,  special
		     tokens which are never command arguments such as `()' are
		     also treated as words.

	      whitespace
		     Words are whitespace-delimited strings of characters.

	      The first three of those styles usually use $WORDCHARS, but  the
	      value   in   the	parameter  can	be  overridden	by  the	 style
	      word-chars, which works in exactly the same way  as  $WORDCHARS.
	      In addition, the style word-class uses character class syntax to
	      group characters and takes precedence over  word-chars  if  both
	      are  set.	 The word-class style does not include the surrounding
	      brackets of the character class; for example, `-:[:alnum:]' is a
	      valid  word-class	 to include all alphanumerics plus the charac‐
	      ters `-' and `:'.	 Be careful including  `]',  `^'  and  `-'  as
	      these are special inside character classes.

	      The final style is skip-chars.  This is mostly useful for trans‐
	      pose-words and similar functions.	 If set, it gives a  count  of
	      characters  starting  at	the  cursor position which will not be
	      considered part of the word and are treated as space, regardless
	      of what they actually are.  For example, if

		     zstyle ':zle:transpose-words' skip-chars 1

	      has  been set, and transpose-words-match is called with the cur‐
	      sor on the X of fooXbar, where X can be any character, then  the
	      resulting expression is barXfoo.

	      Here are some examples of use of the styles, actually taken from
	      the simplified interface in select-word-style:

		     zstyle ':zle:*' word-style standard
		     zstyle ':zle:*' word-chars ''

	      Implements bash-style word handling for all widgets,  i.e.  only
	      alphanumerics  are  word	characters;  equivalent to setting the
	      parameter WORDCHARS empty for the given context.

		     style ':zle:*kill*' word-style space

	      Uses space-delimited words for widgets with the word  `kill'  in
	      the  name.   Neither  of the styles word-chars nor word-class is
	      used in this case.

	      The word matching and all the handling  of  zstyle  settings  is
	      actually implemented by the function match-words-by-style.  This
	      can be used to create new	 user-defined  widgets.	  The  calling
	      function	should set the local parameter curcontext to :zle:wid‐
	      get,  create  the	 local	parameter   matched_words   and	  call
	      match-words-by-style    with    no    arguments.	  On   return,
	      matched_words will be set to an array with the elements: (1) the
	      start  of	 the  line  (2)	 the  word  before  the cursor (3) any
	      non-word characters between that word and	 the  cursor  (4)  any
	      non-word	character  at  the  cursor position plus any remaining
	      non-word characters before the next word, including all  charac‐
	      ters  specified by the skip-chars style, (5) the word at or fol‐
	      lowing the cursor (6) any	 non-word  characters  following  that
	      word  (7) the remainder of the line.  Any of the elements may be
	      an empty string; the calling function should test	 for  this  to
	      decide whether it can perform its function.

	      It   is	possible   to	pass   options	 with	arguments   to
	      match-words-by-style to override the use of styles.  The options
	      are:
	      -w     word-style
	      -s     skip-chars
	      -c     word-class
	      -C     word-chars

	      For  example,  match-words-by-style -w shell -c 0 may be used to
	      extract the command argument around the cursor.

       delete-whole-word-match
	      This is another function which works like the  -match  functions
	      described	 immediately  above,  i.e.  using styles to decide the
	      word boundaries.	However, it  is	 not  a	 replacement  for  any
	      existing function.

	      The  basic  behaviour  is	 to delete the word around the cursor.
	      There is no numeric prefix handling; only the single word around
	      the  cursor  is  considered.   If the widget contains the string
	      kill, the removed text will  be  placed  in  the	cutbuffer  for
	      future	yanking.    This   can	 be   obtained	 by   defining
	      kill-whole-word-match as follows:

		     zle -N kill-whole-word-match delete-whole-word-match

	      and then binding the widget kill-whole-word-match.

       copy-earlier-word
	      This widget works like a	combination  of	 insert-last-word  and
	      copy-prev-shell-word.    Repeated	  invocations  of  the	widget
	      retrieve earlier words on the relevant  history  line.   With  a
	      numeric argument N, insert the Nth word from the history line; N
	      may be negative to count from the end of the line.

	      If insert-last-word has been used to retrieve the last word on a
	      previous	history	 line,	repeated invocations will replace that
	      word with earlier words from the same line.

	      Otherwise, the widget applies to words  on  the  line  currently
	      being  edited.   The  widget  style  can	be  set to the name of
	      another widget that should be called to  retrieve	 words.	  This
	      widget must accept the same three arguments as insert-last-word.

       cycle-completion-positions
	      After inserting an unambiguous string into the command line, the
	      new function based completion system  may	 know  about  multiple
	      places  in  this	string	where characters are missing or differ
	      from at least one of the possible matches.  It will  then	 place
	      the cursor on the position it considers to be the most interest‐
	      ing one, i.e. the one where one can disambiguate between as many
	      matches as possible with as little typing as possible.

	      This  widget  allows  the cursor to be easily moved to the other
	      interesting spots.   It  can  be	invoked	 repeatedly  to	 cycle
	      between all positions reported by the completion system.

       edit-command-line
	      Edit the command line using your visual editor, as in ksh.

		     bindkey -M vicmd v edit-command-line

       history-search-end
	      This    function	  implements	the   widgets	history-begin‐
	      ning-search-backward-end	  and	 history-beginning-search-for‐
	      ward-end.	  These commands work by first calling the correspond‐
	      ing builtin widget (see `History Control' in zshzle(1)) and then
	      moving  the  cursor to the end of the line.  The original cursor
	      position is remembered and restored before calling  the  builtin
	      widget  a	 second	 time,	so that the same search is repeated to
	      look farther through the history.

	      Although you autoload only one function, the commands to use  it
	      are slightly different because it implements two widgets.

		     zle -N history-beginning-search-backward-end \
			    history-search-end
		     zle -N history-beginning-search-forward-end \
			    history-search-end
		     bindkey '\e^P' history-beginning-search-backward-end
		     bindkey '\e^N' history-beginning-search-forward-end

       history-pattern-search
	      The  function  history-pattern-search  implements	 widgets which
	      prompt for a pattern with which to search the history  backwards
	      or  forwards.   The  pattern is in the usual zsh format, however
	      the first character may be ^ to anchor the search to  the	 start
	      of  the  line,  and  the	last  character may be $ to anchor the
	      search to the end of the line.  If the search was	 not  anchored
	      to  the  end of the line the cursor is positioned just after the
	      pattern found.

	      The commands to create bindable widgets are similar to those  in
	      the example immediately above:

		     autoload -U history-pattern-search
		     zle -N history-pattern-search-backward history-pattern-search
		     zle -N history-pattern-search-forward history-pattern-search

       up-line-or-beginning-search, down-line-or-beginning-search
	      These   widgets	are   similar	to   the   builtin   functions
	      up-line-or-search and down-line-or-search:  if  in  a  multiline
	      buffer  they  move  up or down within the buffer, otherwise they
	      search for a history line matching  the  start  of  the  current
	      line.   In  this	case,  however,	 they  search for a line which
	      matches the current line up to the current cursor	 position,  in
	      the  manner  of  history-beginning-search-backward and -forward,
	      rather than the first word on the line.

       incarg Typing the keystrokes for this widget with the cursor placed  on
	      or  to  the  left of an integer causes that integer to be incre‐
	      mented by one.  With a numeric prefix argument,  the  number  is
	      incremented  by  the  amount of the argument (decremented if the
	      prefix argument is negative).  The shell parameter incarg may be
	      set to change the default increment to something other than one.

		     bindkey '^X+' incarg

       incremental-complete-word
	      This  allows  incremental	 completion of a word.	After starting
	      this command, a list of completion choices can  be  shown	 after
	      every  character	you type, which you can delete with ^H or DEL.
	      Pressing return accepts the completion so far and returns you to
	      normal  editing  (that  is,  the command line is not immediately
	      executed).  You can hit TAB to do normal completion, ^G to abort
	      back to the state when you started, and ^D to list the matches.

	      This works only with the new function based completion system.

		     bindkey '^Xi' incremental-complete-word

       insert-files
	      This  function  allows  you  type	 a  file  pattern, and see the
	      results of the expansion at each step.  When you hit return, all
	      expansions are inserted into the command line.

		     bindkey '^Xf' insert-files

       narrow-to-region [ -p pre ] [ -P post ]
	   [ -S statepm | -R statepm ] [ -n ] [ start end ])
       narrow-to-region-invisible
	      Narrow  the editable portion of the buffer to the region between
	      the cursor and the mark, which may  be  in  either  order.   The
	      region may not be empty.

	      narrow-to-region may be used as a widget or called as a function
	      from a user-defined widget; by default,  the  text  outside  the
	      editable	area  remains  visible.	 A recursive-edit is performed
	      and the original widening	 status	 is  then  restored.   Various
	      options and arguments are available when it is called as a func‐
	      tion.

	      The options -p pretext and -P posttext may be  used  to  replace
	      the  text	 before	 and after the display for the duration of the
	      function; either or both may be an empty string.

	      If the option -n is also given, pretext or posttext will only be
	      inserted	if  there  is  text before or after the region respec‐
	      tively which will be made invisible.

	      Two numeric arguments may be given which will be used instead of
	      the cursor and mark positions.

	      The  option  -S statepm is used to narrow according to the other
	      options while saving the original state in  the  parameter  with
	      name statepm, while the option -R statepm is used to restore the
	      state from the parameter; note in both cases  the	 name  of  the
	      parameter	 is  required.	 In the second case, other options and
	      arguments are irrelevant.	 When this method is used,  no	recur‐
	      sive-edit	 is  performed;	 the  calling  widget should call this
	      function with the option -S, perform its own editing on the com‐
	      mand  line or pass control to the user via `zle recursive-edit',
	      then call this  function	with  the  option  -R.	 The  argument
	      statepm  must  be	 a  suitable  name  for an ordinary parameter,
	      except that parameters  beginning	 with  the  prefix  _ntr_  are
	      reserved for use within narrow-to-region.	 Typically the parame‐
	      ter will be local to the calling function.

	      narrow-to-region-invisible is a simple widget which  calls  nar‐
	      row-to-region  with arguments which replace any text outside the
	      region with `...'.

	      The display is restored (and the widget returns)	upon  any  zle
	      command  which  would  usually  cause the line to be accepted or
	      aborted.	Hence an additional such command is required to accept
	      or abort the current line.

	      The  return  status  of  both  widgets  is  zero if the line was
	      accepted, else non-zero.

	      Here is a trivial example of a widget using this feature.
		     local state
		     narrow-to-region -p $'Editing restricted region\n' \
		       -P '' -S state
		     zle recursive-edit
		     narrow-to-region -R state

       predict-on
	      This set of functions implements predictive typing using history
	      search.	After  predict-on, typing characters causes the editor
	      to look backward in the history for  the	first  line  beginning
	      with  what  you  have  typed so far.  After predict-off, editing
	      returns to normal for the line found.  In fact, you often	 don't
	      even  need to use predict-off, because if the line doesn't match
	      something in the history, adding a key performs standard comple‐
	      tion,  and  then	inserts	 itself	 if no completions were found.
	      However, editing in the middle of a line is  liable  to  confuse
	      prediction; see the toggle style below.

	      With  the	 function based completion system (which is needed for
	      this), you should be able to type TAB at	almost	any  point  to
	      advance  the  cursor to the next ``interesting'' character posi‐
	      tion (usually the end of the current word, but  sometimes	 some‐
	      where  in the middle of the word).  And of course as soon as the
	      entire line is what you want, you can accept with return,	 with‐
	      out needing to move the cursor to the end first.

	      The first time predict-on is used, it creates several additional
	      widget functions:

	      delete-backward-and-predict
		     Replaces the backward-delete-char	widget.	  You  do  not
		     need to bind this yourself.
	      insert-and-predict
		     Implements predictive typing by replacing the self-insert
		     widget.  You do not need to bind this yourself.
	      predict-off
		     Turns off predictive typing.

	      Although you autoload only the predict-on function, it is neces‐
	      sary to create a keybinding for predict-off as well.

		     zle -N predict-on
		     zle -N predict-off
		     bindkey '^X^Z' predict-on
		     bindkey '^Z' predict-off

       read-from-minibuffer
	      This is most useful when called as a function from inside a wid‐
	      get, but will work correctly as a widget in its own  right.   It
	      prompts  for a value below the current command line; a value may
	      be input using all of  the  standard  zle	 operations  (and  not
	      merely the restricted set available when executing, for example,
	      execute-named-cmd).  The value is then returned to  the  calling
	      function in the parameter $REPLY and the editing buffer restored
	      to its previous state.  If the read was aborted  by  a  keyboard
	      break  (typically	 ^G), the function returns status 1 and $REPLY
	      is not set.

	      If one argument is supplied to the function it  is  taken	 as  a
	      prompt,  otherwise `? ' is used.	If two arguments are supplied,
	      they are the prompt and the initial value of $LBUFFER, and if  a
	      third  argument  is  given  it is the initial value of $RBUFFER.
	      This provides a default value  and  starting  cursor  placement.
	      Upon return the entire buffer is the value of $REPLY.

	      One  option is available: `-k num' specifies that num characters
	      are to be read instead of a whole line.  The line editor is  not
	      invoked  recursively  in this case, so depending on the terminal
	      settings the input may not be visible, and only the  input  keys
	      are  placed  in $REPLY, not the entire buffer.  Note that unlike
	      the read builtin num must be given; there is no default.

	      The name is a slight  misnomer,  as  in  fact  the  shell's  own
	      minibuffer is not used.  Hence it is still possible to call exe‐
	      cuted-named-cmd and similar functions while reading a value.

       replace-string, replace-pattern
	      The function replace-string implements two widgets.  If  defined
	      under the same name as the function, it prompts for two strings;
	      the first (source) string will be replaced by the second	every‐
	      where it occurs in the line editing buffer.

	      If  the  widget name contains the word `pattern', for example by
	      defining the widget using the command  `zle  -N  replace-pattern
	      replace-string',	then the replacement is done by pattern match‐
	      ing.  All zsh extended globbing patterns	can  be	 used  in  the
	      source  string; note that unlike filename generation the pattern
	      does not need to match an entire word, nor  do  glob  qualifiers
	      have  any	 effect.  In addition, the replacement string can con‐
	      tain parameter or command substitutions.	Furthermore, a `&'  in
	      the  replacement string will be replaced with the matched source
	      string, and a backquoted digit `\N' will be replaced by the  Nth
	      parenthesised  expression	 matched.  The form `\{N}' may be used
	      to protect the digit from following digits.

	      For example, starting from the line:

		     print This line contains fan and fond

	      and invoking replace-pattern with the source string `f(?)n'  and
	      the replacment string `c\1r' produces the not very useful line:

		     print This line contains car and cord

	      The  range of the replacement string can be limited by using the
	      narrow-to-region-invisible widget.  One limitation of  the  cur‐
	      rent  version  is	 that  undo  will cycle through changes to the
	      replacement and source strings before  undoing  the  replacement
	      itself.

       smart-insert-last-word
	      This function may replace the insert-last-word widget, like so:

		     zle -N insert-last-word smart-insert-last-word

	      With  a numeric prefix, or when passed command line arguments in
	      a call from another widget, it  behaves  like  insert-last-word,
	      except  that words in comments are ignored when INTERACTIVE_COM‐
	      MENTS is set.

	      Otherwise, the rightmost ``interesting'' word from the  previous
	      command  is  found  and  inserted.   The	default	 definition of
	      ``interesting'' is that the word contains at  least  one	alpha‐
	      betic  character,	 slash,	 or backslash.	This definition may be
	      overridden by use of the match style.  The context used to  look
	      up  the  style  is  the  widget  name, so usually the context is
	      :insert-last-word.  However, you can bind this function to  dif‐
	      ferent widgets to use different patterns:

		     zle -N insert-last-assignment smart-insert-last-word
		     zstyle :insert-last-assignment match '[[:alpha:]][][[:alnum:]]#=*'
		     bindkey '\e=' insert-last-assignment

   Styles
       The  behavior  of several of the above widgets can be controlled by the
       use of the zstyle mechanism.  In particular, widgets that interact with
       the  completion system pass along their context to any completions that
       they invoke.

       break-keys
	      This style is used by the incremental-complete-word widget.  Its
	      value  should  be	 a pattern, and all keys matching this pattern
	      will cause the widget to stop incremental completion without the
	      key  having any further effect. Like all styles used directly by
	      incremental-complete-word, this style is	looked	up  using  the
	      context `:incremental'.

       completer
	      The incremental-complete-word and insert-and-predict widgets set
	      up their top-level context name before calling completion.  This
	      allows  one  to define different sets of completer functions for
	      normal completion and for these widgets.	For  example,  to  use
	      completion,  approximation and correction for normal completion,
	      completion and correction for incremental	 completion  and  only
	      completion for prediction one could use:

		     zstyle ':completion:*' completer \
			     _complete _correct _approximate
		     zstyle ':completion:incremental:*' completer \
			     _complete _correct
		     zstyle ':completion:predict:*' completer \
			     _complete

	      It is a good idea to restrict the completers used in prediction,
	      because they may be automatically	 invoked  as  you  type.   The
	      _list and _menu completers should never be used with prediction.
	      The _approximate, _correct, _expand, and _match  completers  may
	      be  used,	 but be aware that they may change characters anywhere
	      in the word behind the cursor, so you need  to  watch  carefully
	      that the result is what you intended.

       cursor The  insert-and-predict  widget  uses this style, in the context
	      `:predict', to decide where to place the cursor after completion
	      has been tried.  Values are:

	      complete
		     The cursor is left where it was when completion finished,
		     but only if it is after a character equal to the one just
		     inserted  by the user.  If it is after another character,
		     this value is the same as `key'.

	      key    The cursor is left after the nth occurrence of the	 char‐
		     acter  just inserted, where n is the number of times that
		     character appeared in  the	 word  before  completion  was
		     attempted.	  In short, this has the effect of leaving the
		     cursor after the character just typed even if the comple‐
		     tion  code	 found out that no other characters need to be
		     inserted at that position.

	      Any other value for this style unconditionally leaves the cursor
	      at the position where the completion code left it.

       list   When using the incremental-complete-word widget, this style says
	      if the matches should be listed on every key press (if they  fit
	      on  the  screen).	 Use the context prefix `:completion:incremen‐
	      tal'.

	      The insert-and-predict widget uses this style to decide  if  the
	      completion  should  be  shown even if there is only one possible
	      completion.  This is done if the value  of  this	style  is  the
	      string  always.	In  this  case	the context is `:predict' (not
	      `:completion:predict').

       match  This style is used by smart-insert-last-word to provide  a  pat‐
	      tern (using full EXTENDED_GLOB syntax) that matches an interest‐
	      ing word.	 The context is	 the  name  of	the  widget  to	 which
	      smart-insert-last-word is bound (see above).  The default behav‐
	      ior of smart-insert-last-word is equivalent to:

		     zstyle :insert-last-word match '*[[:alpha:]/\\]*'

	      However, you might want to include words that contain spaces:

		     zstyle :insert-last-word match '*[[:alpha:][:space:]/\\]*'

	      Or include numbers as long as the word is at least  two  charac‐
	      ters long:

		     zstyle :insert-last-word match '*([[:digit:]]?|[[:alpha:]/\\])*'

	      The above example causes redirections like "2>" to be included.

       prompt The  incremental-complete-word  widget  shows  the value of this
	      style in the status line	during	incremental  completion.   The
	      string  value may contain any of the following substrings in the
	      manner of the PS1 and other prompt parameters:

	      %c     Replaced by the name of the completer function that  gen‐
		     erated the matches (without the leading underscore).

	      %l     When the list style is set, replaced by `...' if the list
		     of matches is too long to fit on the screen and  with  an
		     empty  string otherwise.  If the list style is `false' or
		     not set, `%l' is always removed.

	      %n     Replaced by the number of matches generated.

	      %s     Replaced by `-no match-',	`-no  prefix-',	 or  an	 empty
		     string if there is no completion matching the word on the
		     line, if the matches have no common prefix different from
		     the  word	on the line, or if there is such a common pre‐
		     fix, respectively.

	      %u     Replaced by the unambiguous part of all matches, if there
		     is any, and if it is different from the word on the line.

	      Like `break-keys', this uses the `:incremental' context.

       stop-keys
	      This style is used by the incremental-complete-word widget.  Its
	      value is treated similarly to the one for the  break-keys	 style
	      (and  uses  the same context: `:incremental').  However, in this
	      case all keys matching the pattern given as its value will  stop
	      incremental  completion  and will then execute their usual func‐
	      tion.

       toggle This boolean style is used by predict-on and its related widgets
	      in the context `:predict'.  If set to one of the standard `true'
	      values, predictive typing is automatically toggled off in situa‐
	      tions  where it is unlikely to be useful, such as when editing a
	      multi-line buffer or after moving into the middle of a line  and
	      then  deleting  a character.  The default is to leave prediction
	      turned on until an explicit call to predict-off.

       verbose
	      This boolean style is used by predict-on and its related widgets
	      in the context `:predict'.  If set to one of the standard `true'
	      values, these widgets display a message below  the  prompt  when
	      the  predictive state is toggled.	 This is most useful in combi‐
	      nation with the toggle style.   The  default  does  not  display
	      these messages.

       widget This style is similar to the command style: For widget functions
	      that use zle to call other widgets, this style can sometimes  be
	      used  to	override  the widget which is called.  The context for
	      this style is the name of the calling widget (not	 the  name  of
	      the  calling function, because one function may be bound to mul‐
	      tiple widget names).

		     zstyle :copy-earlier-word widget smart-insert-last-word

	      Check the documentation for the calling widget  or  function  to
	      determine whether the widget style is used.

MIME FUNCTIONS
       Three  functions	 are available to provide handling of files recognised
       by extension, for example to dispatch a file text.ps when executed as a
       command to an appropriate viewer.

       zsh-mime-setup [-flv]
       zsh-mime-handler
	      These   two   functions	use   the   files   ~/.mime.types  and
	      /etc/mime.types, which associate types and extensions,  as  well
	      as  ~/.mailcap and /etc/mailcap files, which associate types and
	      the programs that handle them.  These are provided on many  sys‐
	      tems with the Multimedia Internet Mail Extensions.

	      To  enable  the  system,	the  function zsh-mime-setup should be
	      autoloaded and run.  This allows files  with  extensions	to  be
	      treated  as  executable; such files be completed by the function
	      completion system.  The  function	 zsh-mime-handler  should  not
	      need to be called by the user.

	      The  system  works by setting up suffix aliases with `alias -s'.
	      Suffix aliases already installed by the user will not  be	 over‐
	      written.

	      Repeated	calls  to  zsh-mime-setup do not override the existing
	      mapping between suffixes and executable files unless the	option
	      -f  is given.  Note, however, that this does not override exist‐
	      ing suffix aliases assigned to handlers other than zsh-mime-han‐
	      dler.   Calling  zsh-mime-setup  with  the  option  -l lists the
	      existing mappings without altering them.	Calling zsh-mime-setup
	      with  the option -v causes verbose output to be shown during the
	      setup operation.

	      The system respects the mailcap flags  needsterminal  and	 copi‐
	      ousoutput, see mailcap(4).

	      The  functions  use the following styles, which are defined with
	      the zstyle builtin command (see zshmodules(1)).  They should  be
	      defined  before  zsh-mime-setup  is  run.	 The contexts used all
	      start with :mime:, with additional components in some cases.  It
	      is  recommended  that a trailing * (suitably quoted) be appended
	      to style patterns in case the  system  is	 extended  in  future.
	      Some examples are given below.
	      mime-types
		     A	list  of  files	 in  the  format  of ~/.mime.types and
		     /etc/mime.types to be read during	setup,	replacing  the
		     default list which consists of those two files.  The con‐
		     text is :mime:.  A + in the list will be replaced by  the
		     default files.

	      mailcap
		     A	 list  of  files  in  the  format  of  ~/.mailcap  and
		     /etc/mailcap to  be  read	during	setup,	replacing  the
		     default list which consists of those two files.  The con‐
		     text is :mime:.  A + in the list will be replaced by  the
		     default files.

	      handler
		     Specifies	a handler for a suffix; the suffix is given by
		     the context as :mime:.suffix:, and the format of the han‐
		     dler  is exactly that in mailcap.	Note in particular the
		     `.' and trailing colon to distinguish  this  use  of  the
		     context.	This  overrides	 any  handler specified by the
		     mailcap files.  If the handler requires a	terminal,  the
		     flags style should be set to include the word needstermi‐
		     nal, or if the output is to be displayed through a	 pager
		     (but  not	if  the	 handler is itself a pager), it should
		     include copiousoutput.

	      flags  Defines flags to go with a handler; the context is as for
		     the  handler style, and the format is as for the flags in
		     mailcap.

	      pager  If set, will be used instead of $PAGER or more to	handle
		     suffixes  where  the copiousoutput flag is set.  The con‐
		     text is as for handler, i.e. :mime:.suffix: for  handling
		     a file with the given suffix.

	      Examples:

		     zstyle ':mime:*' mailcap ~/.mailcap /usr/local/etc/mailcap
		     zstyle ':mime:.txt:' handler less %s
		     zstyle ':mime:.txt:' flags needsterminal

	      When  zsh-mime-setup is subsequently run, it will look for mail‐
	      cap entries in the two files given.  Files of suffix  .txt  will
	      be  handled  by running `less file.txt'.	The flag needsterminal
	      is set to show that this program must run attached to  a	termi‐
	      nal.

	      As there are several steps to dispatching a command, the follow‐
	      ing should be checked if attempting to execute a file by	exten‐
	      sion .ext does not have the expected effect.

	      The command `alias -s ext' should show
		     `ps=zsh-mime-handler'.    If  it  shows  something	 else,
		     another suffix alias was already installed	 and  was  not
		     overwritten.    If	 it  shows  nothing,  no  handler  was
		     installed:	 this is most likely because  no  handler  was
		     found in the .mime.types and mailcap combination for .ext
		     files.  In that  case,  appropriate  handling  should  be
		     added to ~/.mime.types and mailcap.

	      If the extension is handled by zsh-mime-handler but the file is
		     not  opened correctly, either the handler defined for the
		     type is incorrect, or the flags associated with it are in
		     appropriate.   Running  zsh-mime-setup  -l	 will show the
		     handler and, if there are any, the flags.	A  %s  in  the
		     handler  is replaced by the file (suitably quoted if nec‐
		     essary).  Check that the handler program listed lists and
		     can  be  run in the way shown.  Also check that the flags
		     needsterminal or copiousoutput are	 set  if  the  handler
		     needs to be run under a terminal; the second flag is used
		     if the output should be sent to a pager.  An example of a
		     suitable mailcap entry for such a program is:

			    text/html; /usr/bin/lynx '%s'; needsterminal

       pick-web-browser
	      This  function is separate from the two MIME functions described
	      above and can be assigned directly to a suffix:

		     autoload -U pick-web-browser
		     alias -s html=pick-web-browser

	      It is provided as an intelligent front end  to  dispatch	a  web
	      browser.	 It  will  check if an X Windows display is available,
	      and if so if there is already a browser running which can accept
	      a	 remote	 connection.  In that case, the file will be displayed
	      in that browser; you should check explicitly if it has  appeared
	      in the running browser's window.	Otherwise, it will start a new
	      browser according to a builtin set of preferences.

	      Alternatively, pick-web-browser can be run as a zsh script.

	      Two styles are available to customize the	 choice	 of  browsers:
	      x-browsers   when	 running  under	 the  X	 Windows  System,  and
	      tty-browsers otherwise.  These are arrays in decreasing order of
	      preference  consiting  of	 the command name under which to start
	      the browser.  They are looked up in the  context	:mime:	(which
	      may  be  extended	 in  future, so appending `*' is recommended).
	      For example,

		     zstyle ':mime:*' x-browsers opera konqueror netscape

	      specifies that pick-web-browser should first look for  a	runing
	      instance	of Opera, Konqueror or Netscape, in that order, and if
	      it fails to find any should attempt to start Opera.

OTHER FUNCTIONS
       There are a large number of helpful  functions  in  the	Functions/Misc
       directory  of  the  zsh	distribution.  Most are very simple and do not
       require documentation here, but a few are worthy of special mention.

   Descriptions
       colors This function initializes	 several  associative  arrays  to  map
	      color names to (and from) the ANSI standard eight-color terminal
	      codes.  These are used by the prompt theme system	 (see  above).
	      You seldom should need to run colors more than once.

	      The  eight  base	colors	are:  black, red, green, yellow, blue,
	      magenta, cyan, and white.	 Each of these	has  codes  for	 fore‐
	      ground  and  background.	 In addition there are eight intensity
	      attributes: bold, faint, standout,  underline,  blink,  reverse,
	      and  conceal.   Finally,	there  are  six	 codes	used to negate
	      attributes: none (reset all attributes to the defaults),	normal
	      (neither	bold  nor faint), no-standout, no-underline, no-blink,
	      and no-reverse.

	      Some terminals do not support all	 combinations  of  colors  and
	      intensities.

	      The associative arrays are:

	      color
	      colour Map all the color names to their integer codes, and inte‐
		     ger codes to the color names.  The eight base  names  map
		     to	 the foreground color codes, as do names prefixed with
		     `fg-', such as `fg-red'.  Names prefixed with `bg-', such
		     as `bg-blue', refer to the background codes.  The reverse
		     mapping from code to color yields	base  name  for	 fore‐
		     ground codes and the bg- form for backgrounds.

		     Although  it  is  a misnomer to call them `colors', these
		     arrays also map the other fourteen attributes from	 names
		     to codes and codes to names.

	      fg
	      fg_bold
	      fg_no_bold
		     Map  the  eight basic color names to ANSI terminal escape
		     sequences that  set  the  corresponding  foreground  text
		     properties.   The	fg  sequences change the color without
		     changing the eight intensity attributes.

	      bg
	      bg_bold
	      bg_no_bold
		     Map the eight basic color names to ANSI  terminal	escape
		     sequences	that  set the corresponding background proper‐
		     ties.  The bg sequences change the color without changing
		     the eight intensity attributes.

	      In  addition,  the  scalar parameters reset_color and bold_color
	      are  set	to  the	 ANSI  terminal	 escapes  that	turn  off  all
	      attributes and turn on bold intensity, respectively.

       fned name
	      Same  as	zed -f.	 This function does not appear in the zsh dis‐
	      tribution, but can be created by linking zed to the name fned in
	      some directory in your fpath.

       is-at-least needed [ present ]
	      Perform  a  greater-than-or-equal-to  comparison	of two strings
	      having the format of a zsh version number; that is, a string  of
	      numbers  and text with segments separated by dots or dashes.  If
	      the present string is not provided, $ZSH_VERSION is used.	  Seg‐
	      ments  are  paired left-to-right in the two strings with leading
	      non-number parts ignored.	 If one string has fewer segments than
	      the other, the missing segments are considered zero.

	      This  is	useful in startup files to set options and other state
	      that are not available in all versions of zsh.

		     is-at-least 3.1.6-15 && setopt NO_GLOBAL_RCS
		     is-at-least 3.1.0 && setopt HIST_REDUCE_BLANKS
		     is-at-least 2.6-17 || print "You can't use is-at-least here."

       nslookup [ arg ... ]
	      This wrapper function for	 the  nslookup	command	 requires  the
	      zsh/zpty	module	(see  zshmodules(1)).  It behaves exactly like
	      the standard  nslookup  except  that  it	provides  customizable
	      prompts  (including  a  right-side  prompt)  and	completion  of
	      nslookup commands, host  names,  etc.  (if  you  use  the	 func‐
	      tion-based  completion  system).	 Completion  styles may be set
	      with the context prefix `:completion:nslookup'.

	      See also the pager, prompt and rprompt styles below.

       run-help
	      See `Accessing On-Line Help' above.

       tetris Zsh was once accused of not being as complete as Emacs,  because
	      it  lacked  a  Tetris game.  This function was written to refute
	      this vicious slander.

	      This function must be used as a ZLE widget:

		     autoload -U tetris
		     zle -N tetris
		     bindkey keys tetris

	      To start a game, execute the widget by typing the	 keys.	 What‐
	      ever  command  line you were editing disappears temporarily, and
	      your keymap is also temporarily replaced by the  Tetris  control
	      keys.   The  previous editor state is restored when you quit the
	      game (by pressing `q') or when you lose.

	      If you quit in the middle of a game, the next invocation of  the
	      tetris widget will continue where you left off.  If you lost, it
	      will start a new game.

       zargs [ option ... -- ] [ input ... ] [ -- command [ arg ... ] ]
	      This function works like GNU xargs, except that instead of read‐
	      ing  lines  of  arguments from the standard input, it takes them
	      from the command line.  This is useful because  zsh,  especially
	      with  recursive  glob  operators,	 often can construct a command
	      line for a shell function that is longer than can be accepted by
	      an external command.

	      The  option list represents options of the zargs command itself,
	      which are the same as those of xargs.  The  input	 list  is  the
	      collection  of  strings (often file names) that become the argu‐
	      ments of the command, analogous to the standard input of	xargs.
	      Finally,	the  arg  list	consists  of  those arguments (usually
	      options) that are passed to the command each time it runs.   The
	      arg  list precedes the elements from the input list in each run.
	      If no command is provided, then no arg list may be provided, and
	      in  that event the default command is `print' with arguments `-r
	      --'.

	      For example, to get a long ls listing of all plain files in  the
	      current directory or its subdirectories:

		     autoload -U zargs
		     zargs -- **/*(.) -- ls -l

	      Note  that  `--' is used both to mark the end of the option list
	      and to mark the end of the input list, so it must	 appear	 twice
	      whenever the input list may be empty.  If there is guaranteed to
	      be at least one input and the first input does not begin with  a
	      `-', then the first `--' may be omitted.

	      In  the event that the string `--' is or may be an input, the -e
	      option may be used to change  the	 end-of-inputs	marker.	  Note
	      that  this does not change the end-of-options marker.  For exam‐
	      ple, to use `..' as the marker:

		     zargs -e.. -- **/*(.) .. ls -l

	      This is a good choice in that example because no plain file  can
	      be  named	 `..',	but the best end-marker depends on the circum‐
	      stances.

	      For details of the other zargs  options,	see  xargs(1)  or  run
	      zargs with the --help option.

       zcalc [ expression ... ]
	      A reasonably powerful calculator based on zsh's arithmetic eval‐
	      uation facility.	The syntax is similar to that of  formulae  in
	      most  programming languages; see the section `Arithmetic Evalua‐
	      tion' in	zshmisc(1)  for	 details.   The	 mathematical  library
	      zsh/mathfunc  will be loaded if it is available; see the section
	      `The zsh/mathfunc Module' in  zshmodules(1).   The  mathematical
	      functions correspond to the raw system libraries, so trigonomet‐
	      ric functions are evaluated using radians, and so on.

	      Each line typed is evaluated as an expression.  The prompt shows
	      a	 number, which corresponds to a positional parameter where the
	      result of that calculation is stored.  For example,  the	result
	      of the calculation on the line preceded by `4> ' is available as
	      $4.  Full command line editing, including the history of	previ‐
	      ous calculations, is available; the history is saved in the file
	      ~/.zcalc_history.	 To exit, enter a blank line or	 type  `q'  on
	      its own.

	      If  arguments  are  given to zcalc on start up, they are used to
	      prime the first few positional parameters.  A visual  indication
	      of this is given when the calculator starts.

	      The  constants  PI (3.14159...) and E (2.71828...) are provided.
	      Parameter assignment is possible, but note that  all  parameters
	      will be put into the global namespace.

	      An  extra	 facility  is provided for changing the default output
	      base.  Use, for example, `[#16]' to display  hexadecimal	output
	      preceded	by an indication of the base, or `[##16]' just to dis‐
	      play the raw number in the given	base.	Bases  themselves  are
	      always  specified	 in decimal.  `[#]' restores the normal output
	      format.  Note that setting an output  base  suppresses  floating
	      point output; use `[#]' to return to normal operation.

	      The  output  base	 can  be  initialised  by  passing  the option
	      `-#base', for example `zcalc -#16'  (the	`#'  may  have	to  be
	      quoted, depending on the globbing options set).

	      The  prompt is configurable via the parameter ZCALCPROMPT, which
	      undergoes standard prompt expansion.  The index of  the  current
	      entry is stored locally in the first element of the array psvar,
	      which can be referred to in ZCALCPROMPT as `%1v'.	  The  default
	      prompt is `%1v> '.

	      The  output  precision  may be specified within zcalc by special
	      commands familiar from many calculators:
	      norm   The default output format.	 It corresponds to the	printf
		     %g	 specification.	 Typically this shows six decimal dig‐
		     its.

	      sci digits
		     Scientific notation, corresponding to the printf %g  out‐
		     put format with the precision given by digits.  This pro‐
		     duces either fixed point or exponential notation  depend‐
		     ing on the value output.

	      fix digits
		     Fixed point notation, corresponding to the printf %f out‐
		     put format with the precision given by digits.

	      eng digits
		     Exponential notation, corresponding to the printf %E out‐
		     put format with the precision given by digits.

	      See the comments in the function for a few extra tips.

       zed [ -f ] name
       zed -b This function uses the ZLE editor to edit a file or function.

	      Only  one	 name argument is allowed.  If the -f option is given,
	      the name is taken to be that of a function; if the  function  is
	      marked  for  autoloading,	 zed  searches for it in the fpath and
	      loads it.	 Note that functions edited  this  way	are  installed
	      into  the	 current  shell,  but not written back to the autoload
	      file.

	      Without -f, name is the path name of the	file  to  edit,	 which
	      need not exist; it is created on write, if necessary.

	      While  editing, the function sets the main keymap to zed and the
	      vi command keymap to zed-vicmd.  These will be copied  from  the
	      existing	main  and vicmd keymaps if they do not exist the first
	      time zed is run.	They can be used to provide special key	 bind‐
	      ings used only in zed.

	      If it creates the keymap, zed rebinds the return key to insert a
	      line break and `^X^W' to accept the edit in the zed keymap,  and
	      binds `ZZ' to accept the edit in the zed-vicmd keymap.

	      The  bindings  alone can be installed by running `zed -b'.  This
	      is suitable for putting into a  startup  file.   Note  that,  if
	      rerun,  this  will  overwrite  the  existing  zed	 and zed-vicmd
	      keymaps.

	      Completion is available, and styles may be set with the  context
	      prefix `:completion:zed'.

	      A zle widget zed-set-file-name is available.  This can be called
	      by name from within zed  using  `\ex  zed-set-file-name'	(note,
	      however,	that because of zed's rebindings you will have to type
	      ^j at the end instead of the return key), or can be bound	 to  a
	      key in either of the zed or zed-vicmd keymaps after `zed -b' has
	      been run.	 When the widget is called, it prompts for a new  name
	      for  the	file  being  edited.   When zed exits the file will be
	      written under that name and  the	original  file	will  be  left
	      alone.  The widget has no effect with `zed -f'.

	      While zed-set-file-name is running, zed uses the keymap zed-nor‐
	      mal-keymap, which is linked from the main keymap	in  effect  at
	      the  time	 zed  initialised  its bindings.  (This is to make the
	      return key operate normally.)  The result is that	 if  the  main
	      keymap has been changed, the widget won't notice.	 This is not a
	      concern for most users.

       zcp [ -finqQvwW ] srcpat dest
       zln [ -finqQsvwW ] srcpat dest
	      Same as zmv -C and zmv -L, respectively.	These functions do not
	      appear  in  the  zsh distribution, but can be created by linking
	      zmv to the names zcp and zln in some directory in your fpath.

       zkbd   See `Keyboard Definition' above.

       zmv [ -finqQsvwW ] [ -C | -L | -M | -p program ] [ -o optstring ]  src‐
       pat dest
	      Move (usually, rename) files matching the pattern srcpat to cor‐
	      responding files having names of the form given by  dest,	 where
	      srcpat  contains	parentheses surrounding patterns which will be
	      replaced in turn by $1, $2, ... in dest.	For example,

		     zmv '(*).lis' '$1.txt'

	      renames	`foo.lis'   to	 `foo.txt',   `my.old.stuff.lis'    to
	      `my.old.stuff.txt', and so on.

	      The  pattern is always treated as an EXTENDED_GLOB pattern.  Any
	      file whose name is not changed by	 the  substitution  is	simply
	      ignored.	Any error (a substitution resulted in an empty string,
	      two substitutions gave the same result, the destination  was  an
	      existing	regular	 file  and -f was not given) causes the entire
	      function to abort without doing anything.

	      Options:

	      -f     Force overwriting of destination  files.	Not  currently
		     passed  down  to  the mv/cp/ln command due to vagaries of
		     implementations (but you can use -o-f to do that).
	      -i     Interactive: show each line to be executed	 and  ask  the
		     user  whether to execute it.  `Y' or `y' will execute it,
		     anything else will skip it.  Note that you just  need  to
		     type one character.
	      -n     No execution: print what would happen, but don't do it.
	      -q     Turn bare glob qualifiers off: now assumed by default, so
		     this has no effect.
	      -Q     Force bare glob qualifiers on.  Don't turn this on unless
		     you are actually using glob qualifiers in a pattern.
	      -s     Symbolic, passed down to ln; only works with -L.
	      -v     Verbose: print each command as it's being executed.
	      -w     Pick  out	wildcard  parts	 of  the pattern, as described
		     above, and implicitly add parentheses  for	 referring  to
		     them.
	      -W     Just  like	 -w, with the addition of turning wildcards in
		     the replacement pattern into sequential ${1} .. ${N} ref‐
		     erences.
	      -C
	      -L
	      -M     Force  cp, ln or mv, respectively, regardless of the name
		     of the function.
	      -p program
		     Call program instead of cp, ln or mv.  Whatever it	 does,
		     it	 should	 at least understand the form `program -- old‐
		     name newname' where oldname  and  newname	are  filenames
		     generated by zmv.
	      -o optstring
		     The  optstring is split into words and passed down verba‐
		     tim to the cp, ln or mv command  called  to  perform  the
		     work.  It should probably begin with a `-'.

	      For more complete examples and other implementation details, see
	      the zmv source file, usually located in one of  the  directories
	      named in your fpath, or in Functions/Misc/zmv in the zsh distri‐
	      bution.

       zrecompile
	      See `Recompiling Functions' above.

       zstyle+ context style value [ + subcontext style value ... ]
	      This makes defining styles a bit simpler by using a  single  `+'
	      as  a  special token that allows you to append a context name to
	      the previously used context name.	 Like this:

		     zstyle+ ':foo:bar' style1 value1 \
			   + ':baz'	style2 value2 \
			   + ':frob'	style3 value3

	      This defines `style1' with `value1' for the context :foo:bar  as
	      usual,  but  it also defines `style2' with `value2' for the con‐
	      text :foo:bar:baz and `style3' with `value3' for	:foo:bar:frob.
	      Any  subcontext may be the empty string to re-use the first con‐
	      text unchanged.

   Styles
       insert-tab
	      The zed function sets this style in context  `:completion:zed:*'
	      to  turn	off completion when TAB is typed at the beginning of a
	      line.  You may override this by setting your own value for  this
	      context and style.

       pager  The  nslookup  function  looks  up  this	style  in  the context
	      `:nslookup' to determine the program used to display output that
	      does not fit on a single screen.

       prompt
       rprompt
	      The  nslookup  function  looks  up  this	style  in  the context
	      `:nslookup' to set the prompt and the right-side prompt, respec‐
	      tively.	The  usual  expansions for the PS1 and RPS1 parameters
	      may be used (see zshmisc(1)).

ZSHALL(1)							     ZSHALL(1)

FILES
       $ZDOTDIR/.zshenv
       $ZDOTDIR/.zprofile
       $ZDOTDIR/.zshrc
       $ZDOTDIR/.zlogin
       $ZDOTDIR/.zlogout
       ${TMPPREFIX}*   (default is /tmp/zsh*)
       /etc/zshenv
       /etc/zprofile
       /etc/zshrc
       /etc/zlogin
       /etc/zlogout    (installation-specific - /etc is the default)

SEE ALSO
       sh(1), csh(1), tcsh(1), rc(1), bash(1), ksh(1)

       IEEE Standard for information Technology -  Portable  Operating	System
       Interface  (POSIX)  - Part 2: Shell and Utilities, IEEE Inc, 1993, ISBN
       1-55937-255-9.

zsh 4.2.6		       November 28, 2005		     ZSHALL(1)
[top]

List of man pages available for YellowDog

Copyright (c) for man pages and the logo by the respective OS vendor.

For those who want to learn more, the polarhome community provides shell access and support.

[legal] [privacy] [GNU] [policy] [cookies] [netiquette] [sponsors] [FAQ]
Tweet
Polarhome, production since 1999.
Member of Polarhome portal.
Based on Fawad Halim's script.
....................................................................
Vote for polarhome
Free Shell Accounts :: the biggest list on the net